Mil STD 750e
Mil STD 750e
Mil STD 750e
MIL-STD-750E
20 November 2006
SUPERSEDING
MIL-STD-750D
28 FEBRUARY 1995
DEPARTMENT OF DEFENSE
TEST METHOD STANDARD
FOREWARD
1. This Standard is approved for use by all Departments and Agencies of the Department of Defense.
3. Comments, suggestions, or questions on this document should be addressed to: Commander, Defense Supply
Center Columbus, ATTN: DSCC-VAT, 3990 E. Broad Street, Columbus, OH 43218-5000, or emailed to
[email protected]. Since contact information can change, you may want to verify the currency of this address
information using the ASSIST Online database at http://assist.daps.dla.mil.
ii
CONTENTS
Section Paragraph Page
1. SCOPE ..................................................................................................................................... 1
2. APPLICABLE DOCUMENTS.................................................................................................... 2
3. DEFINITIONS ........................................................................................................................... 4
iii
CONTENTS
Section Paragraph Page
6. NOTES..................................................................................................................................... 13
Figure Page
iv
Test Methods
Test Methods
vi
Test Methods
Test Methods
viii
Test Methods
ix
Test Methods
1. SCOPE
1.1 Purpose. This standard establishes uniform methods for testing semiconductor devices, including basic
environmental tests to determine resistance to deleterious effects of natural elements and conditions surrounding
military operations, and physical and electrical tests. For the purpose of this standard, the term "devices" includes
such items as transistors, diodes, voltage regulators, rectifiers, tunnel diodes, and other related parts. This standard
is intended to apply only to semiconductor devices. The test methods described herein have been prepared to serve
several purposes:
a. To specify suitable conditions obtainable in the laboratory that give test results equivalent to the actual
service conditions existing in the field, and to obtain reproducibility of the results of tests. The tests
described herein are not to be interpreted as an exact and conclusive representation of actual service
operation in any one geographic location, since it is known that the only true test for operation in a specific
location is an actual service test at that point.
b. To describe in one standard all of the test methods of a similar character which now appear in the various
joint-services semiconductor device specifications, so that these methods may be kept uniform and thus
result in conservation of equipment, man-hours, and testing facilities. In achieving this objective, it is
necessary to make each of the general tests adaptable to a broad range of devices.
c. The test methods described herein for environmental, physical, and electrical testing of devices shall also
apply, when applicable, to parts not covered by an approved military sheet-form standard, specification
sheet, or drawing.
1.2 Numbering system. The test methods are designated by numbers assigned in accordance with the following
system:
1.2.1 Classification of tests. The tests are divided into five areas. Test methods numbered 1001 to 1999 inclusive,
cover environmental tests; those numbered 2001 to 2999 inclusive, cover mechanical- characteristics tests.
Electrical- characteristics tests are covered in two groups; 3001 to 3999 inclusive, covers tests for transistors and
4001 to 4999 inclusive, covers tests for diodes. Test methods numbered 5000 to 5999 inclusive, are for high
reliability space applications.
1.2.2 Revisions. Revisions are numbered consecutively using a period to separate the test method number and
the revision number. For example, 4001.1 is the first revision of test method 4001.
1.3 Method of reference. When applicable, test methods contained herein shall be referenced in the individual
specification by specifying the method number of this standard, and the details required in the summary of the
applicable method. To avoid the necessity for changing specifications that refer to this standard, the revision number
should not be used when referencing test methods. (For example: use 4001, not 4001.1.)
2. APPLICABLE DOCUMENTS
2.1 General. The documents listed in this section are specified in sections 3, 4, or 5 of this standard. This section
does not include documents cited in other sections of this standard or recommended for additional information or as
examples. While every effort has been made to ensure the completeness of this list, document users are cautioned
that they must meet all specified requirements documents cited in sections 3, 4, or 5 of this specification, whether or
not they are listed.
2.2 Government documents.
* 2.2.1 Specifications, standards, and handbooks. The following specifications, standards, and handbooks form a
part of this document to the extent specified herein. Unless otherwise specified, the issues of these documents are
those cited in the solicitation or contract.
DEPARTMENT OF DEFENSE SPECIFICATIONS
MIL-PRF-19500 - Semiconductor Devices, General Specification for.
TT-I-735 - Isopropyl Alcohol
DEPARTMENT OF DEFENSE STANDARDS
(Copies of these documents are available online at http://www.dscc.dla.mil/Programs/MilSpec or from the Defense
Supply Center, DSCC-VAC, P.O. Box 3990, Columbus, Ohio 43218.)
* 2.3 Non-Government publications. The following documents form a part of this document to the extent specified
herein. Unless otherwise specified, the issues of these documents are those cited in the solicitation or contract.
ANSI/NCSL-Z540-1-1994
(Copies of this document are available online at http://www.ansi.org or from the American National Standards
Institute, 1819 L Street, NW, Suite 600, Washington, DC 20036)
(Copies of this document are available online at http://www.asme.org or from the ASME International, Three Park
Avenue, New York, NY 10016-5990)
ASTM Test Method D1120 - Standard Test Method for Boiling Point of Engine Coolants
ASTM Test Method D1331 - Standard Test Methods for Surface and Interfacial Tension of Solutions of
Surface-Active Agents
ASTM Test Method D2109 - Standard Test Methods for Nonvolatile Matter in Halogenated Organic Solvents
and Their Admixtures
ASTM Test Method D877 - Standard Test Method for Dielectric Breakdown Voltage of Insulating Liquids
Using Disk Electrodes
ASTM Test Method D941 - Standard Test Method for Density and Relative Density (Specific Gravity) of
Liquids by Lipkin Bicapillary Pycnometer
ASTM Test Method D971 - Standard Test Method for Interfacial Tension of Oil Against Water by the Ring
Method
ASTM Test Method F134 - Standard Test Methods for Determining Hermeticity of Electron Devices with a
Helium Mass Spectrometer Leak Detector
ASTM Test Method F50 - Standard Practice for Continuous Sizing and Counting of Airborne Particles in
Dust-Controlled Areas and Clean Rooms Using Instruments Capable of Detecting
Single Sub-Micrometre and Larger Particles
ASTM Test Method F25 - Standard Test Method for Sizing and Counting Airborne Particulate Contamination
in Cleanrooms and Other Dust-Controlled Areas
ASTM Test Method F-1192 - Standard Guide for he Measurement of Single-Event Phenomena from Heavy Ion
Irradiation of Semiconductor Devices
(Copies of these documents are available online at http://www.astm.org or from the American Society for Testing
and Materials, P O Box C700, 100 Barr Harbor Drive, West Conshohocken, PA 19428-2959)
NBS Handbook 59 - Permissible Dose From External Sources of Ionizing Radiation, Recommendations
of National Committee on Radiation Protection.
NBS Handbook 73 - Protection Against Radiations from Sealed Gamma Sources.
NBS Handbook 76 - Medical X-Ray Protection Up to 3 Million Volts.
(Application for copies should be addressed to the Superintendent of Documents, Washington, DC 20402.)
(Copies of these documents are available online at http://www.sae.org or from the SAE World Headquarters 400
Commonwealth Drive, Warrendale, PA 15096-0001 USA)
(Application for copies should be addressed to the McGraw-Hill Book Company, Inc., New York, N.Y. 42840.)
3
2.4 Order of precedence. In the event of a conflict between the text of this document and the references cited
herein, the text of this document takes precedence. Nothing in this document, however, supersedes applicable laws
and regulations unless a specific exemption has been obtained.
3. DEFINITIONS
3.1 Abbreviations, symbols, and definitions. For the purposes of this standard, the abbreviations, symbols, and
definitions specified in MIL-PRF-19500, ASME Y14.38M, and herein shall apply.
3.1.1 Abbreviations used in this standard. Abbreviations used in this standard are defined as follows:
m. Hz - Hertz.
n. IF - Intermediate frequency.
r. mH - Microhenries.
u. ns - Nanosecond.
w. pF - Picofarad.
x. RH - Relative humidity.
4. GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
4.1 Test conditions. Unless otherwise specified herein or in the individual specification, all measurements and
tests shall be made at thermal equilibrium at an ambient temperature of 25C 3C and at ambient atmospheric
pressure and relative humidity and the specified test condition C (at environmentally elevated and reduced
temperatures) shall have a tolerance of 3 percent or +3C, whichever is greater. Whenever these conditions must
be closely controlled in order to obtain reproducible results, the referee conditions shall be as follows: Temperature
25C 1C, relative humidity 50 5 percent, and atmospheric pressure from 650 to 800 millimeters of mercury.
Unless otherwise specified in the detail test method, for mechanical test methods, 2000 series, the ambient
temperature may be 25C 10C.
4.1.1 Permissible temperature variation in environmental chambers. When chambers are used, specimens under
test shall be located only within the working area defined as follows:
a. Temperature variation within working area: The controls for the chamber shall be capable of maintaining the
temperature of any single reference point within the working area within 2C or 4 percent, whichever is
greater.
b. Space variation within working area: Chambers shall be so constructed that, at any given time, the
temperature of any point within the working area shall not deviate more than 3C or 3 percent, whichever
is greater, from the reference point, except for the immediate vicinity of specimens generating heat.
c. Chambers with specified minimum temperatures (such as those used in burn-in and life tests): When test
requirements involve a specified minimum test temperature, the controls and chamber construction shall be
such that the temperature of any point within the working area shall not deviate more than +8C, -0C; or +8
percent, -0 percent, whichever is greater, from the specified minimum temperature, except for the immediate
vicinity of the specimens generating heat.
4.1.2 Electrical test frequency. Unless otherwise specified, the electrical test frequency shall be 1,000 25 Hertz
(Hz).
4.1.3 Accuracy. The specified limits are for absolute (true) values, obtained with the specified (nominal) test
conditions. Proper allowance shall be made for measurement errors (including those due to deviations from nominal
test conditions) in establishing the working limits to be used for the measured values, so that the true values of the
device parameters (as they would be under nominal test conditions) are within the specified limits.
The following electrical test tolerances and precautions, unless otherwise specified in the applicable acquisition
document, shall be maintained for all device measurements to which they apply (3000, 4000 series and other
specified electrical measurements). Wherever test conditions are specified in the applicable acquisition document to
a precision tighter than the tolerances indicated below, the specified conditions shall apply and take precedence over
these general requirements.
b. Such properties as input pulse characteristics, repetition rates, and frequencies shall be held to within 10
percent. Nominal values should be chosen so that 10 percent variation (or the actual test equipment
variation, if less than 10 percent) does not affect the accuracy or validity of the measurement of the specified
value.
c. Voltages applied in breakdown testing shall be held within 1 percent of specified value.
h. Switching parameters shall be measured to within 5 percent or 1 nanosecond (ns), whichever is greater.
4.1.3.1 Test methods and circuits. Unless otherwise stated in the specific test method, the methods and circuits
shown are given as the basic measurement method. They are not necessarily the only method or circuit which can
be used, but the manufacturer shall demonstrate to the acquiring activity that alternate methods or circuits which they
may desire to use are equivalent and give results within the desired accuracy of measurement (see 4.1.3).
4.1.4 Calibration requirements. Calibration and certification procedures shall be provided in accordance with
ANSI/NCSL-Z540-1-1994 for plant standards and instruments used to measure or control production processes and
semiconductor devices under test. For those measurements that are not traceable to the National Institute of
Standards and Technology (NIST), correlation samples shall be maintained and used as the basis of proving
acceptability when such proof is required. In addition, the following requirements shall apply:
a. The accuracy of a calibrating instrument shall be at least four times greater than that of the item being
calibrated, unless the item being calibrated is state of the art equipment, which may be near or equal in
accuracy to the state of the art calibrating equipment, in which case the four time requirement does not
apply. However, the instrument shall be calibrated to correlate with standards established by the NIST.
b. Except in those cases where the NIST recommends a longer period and concurrence is obtained from the
qualifying activity, calibration intervals for plant electrical standards shall not exceed one year, and for plant
mechanical standards shall not exceed two years.
4.2 Orientations:
X is the orientation of a device with the main axis of the device normal to the direction of the accelerating force,
and the major cross section parallel to the direction of the accelerating force.
Y is the orientation of a device with the main axis of the device parallel to the direction of the accelerating force,
and the principal base toward (Y1), or away from (Y2), the point of application of the accelerating force.
Z is the orientation of a device with the main axis and the major cross section of the device normal to the
direction of the accelerating force. Z is 90 degrees of X.
NOTE: For case configurations, other than those shown on figures 1 and 2, the orientation of the device
shall be as specified in the individual specification.
4.3 General precautions. The following precautions shall be observed in testing the devices.
4.3.1 Transients. Devices shall not be subjected to conditions in which transients cause the rating to be exceeded.
4.3.2 Test conditions for electrical measurements. Unless otherwise required for a specified test method,
semiconductor devices should not be subjected to any condition that will cause any maximum rating of the device to
be exceeded. The precautions should include limits on maximum instantaneous currents and applied voltages. High
series resistances (constant current supplies) and low capacitances are usually required. If low cutoff, or reverse
current devices are to be measured; for example, nanoampere units, care should be taken to ensure that parasitic
circuit currents or external leakage currents are small, compared with the cutoff or reverse current of the device to be
measured.
4.3.2.1 Steady-state dc measurements (method 4000). Unless otherwise specified, all steady-state dc parameters
are defined using steady-state dc conditions.
4.3.2.2 Pulse measurements (method 4000). When device static or dynamic parameters are measured under
pulsed conditions, in order to avoid measurement errors introduced by device heating during the measurement
period, the following items should be covered in the performance specification sheet:
b. Unless otherwise specified, the pulse time (tp) shall be 10 milliseconds and the duty cycle shall be a
maximum of 2 percent; within this limit the pulse must be long enough to be compatible with test equipment
capability and the accuracy required, and short enough to avoid heating.
4.3.3 Test circuits. The circuits shown are given as examples which may be used for the measurements. They
are not necessarily the only circuits which can be used but the manufacturer shall demonstrate to the Government
that other circuits which they may desire to use will give results within the desired accuracy of measurement. Circuits
are shown for PNP transistors in one circuit configuration only. They may readily be adapted for NPN devices and for
other circuit configurations.
4.3.3.1 Test method variation. Variation from the specified test methods used to verify the electrical parameters
are allowed provided that it is demonstrated to the preparing activity or their agent that such variations in no way relax
the requirements of this specification and that they are approved before testing is performed. For proposed test
variations, a test method comparative error analysis shall be made available for checking by the preparing activity or
their agent.
8
4.3.4 Soldering. Adequate precautions shall be taken to avoid damage to the device during soldering required for
tests.
4.3.5 Order of connection of leads. Care should be taken when connecting a semiconductor device to a power
source. The common terminal shall be connected first.
4.3.6 Radiation precautions. Due precautions shall be used in storing or testing semiconductor devices in
substantial fields of X-rays, neutrons, or other energy particles.
4.3.7.1 UHF and microwave devices. Handling precautions for UHF and microwave devices shall be as follows:
b. Make hand contact to the equipment while holding the base end and maintain hand contact with the
equipment until the device is in place.
c. Where applicable, keep devices in metal shields until they are inserted in the equipment or until necessary
to remove for test.
4.3.7.2 Electrostatic discharge sensitive devices. Handling precautions shall be observed in accordance with
MIL-HDBK-263 during testing of Electrostatic Discharge Sensitive (ESDS) devices. The area where ESDS device
tests are performed shall meet the requirements of an ESD Protected Area of MIL-STD-1686.
4.4 Continuity verification of burn-in and life tests. The test setup shall be monitored at the test temperature
initially and at the conclusion of the test to establish that all devices are being stressed to the specified requirements.
The following is the minimum acceptable monitoring procedure:
a. Device sockets. Initially and at least each 6 months thereafter, each test board or tray shall be checked to
verify continuity to connector points to assure that the correct voltage bias will be applied. Except for this
initial and periodic verification, each device or device socket does not have to be checked; however,
random sampling techniques shall be applied prior to each time a board is used and shall be adequate to
assure that there are correct and continuous electrical connections to the Device under test (DUT).
b. Connectors to test boards or trays. After the test boards are loaded with devices, inserted into the system,
and brought up to the specified operating conditions, each required test voltage and signal condition shall
be verified in at least one location on each test board or tray so as to assure electrical continuity and the
correct application of specified electrical stresses for each connection or contact pair used in the applicable
test configuration. The system may be opened for a maximum of 10 minutes.
c. At the conclusion of the test period, prior to removal of devices from temperature and bias conditions, the
voltage and signal condition verification of 4.4b shall be repeated.
d. For class S devices, each test board or tray and each test socket shall be verified prior to test to assure that
the specified bias conditions are applied to each device. This may be accomplished by verifying the device
functional response at each device output(s) or by performing a socket verification on each socket prior to
loading. An approved alternate procedure may be used.
4.4.1 Bias interruption. Where failures or open contacts occur which result in removal of the required bias stresses
for any period of the required bias duration, the bias time shall be extended to assure actual exposure for the total
minimum specified test duration. Any loss(es) or interruption(s) of bias in excess of 10 minutes total duration while
the chamber is at temperature during the final 8 hours of burn-in shall require extension of the bias duration for an
uninterrupted 8 hours minimum, after the last bias interruption.
4.5 Requirements for High Temperature Reverse Bias (HTRB) and burn-in.
a. The temperature of +20C minimum is the ambient air temperature to which all devices should be exposed
during power screening where room ambient is specified.
b. An increase in effective ambient temperature from cumulative induced power to DUTs shall not result in
device junction temperature exceeding maximum ratings.
c. Ambient temperature shall not be measured in the convection current (above) or downstream (Fan Air) of
DUTs.
d. Moving air greater than 30 CFM (natural convection) may be allowed for the purpose of temperature
equalization within high device density burn-in racks.
e. High velocity or cooled air shall not be used for the purpose of increasing device ratings.
f. Power up of burn-in racks may occur when ambient is less than specified. When thermal equilibrium has
been reached, or five hours maximum has occurred, the ambient shall be at the specified value. Time
accrued prior to reaching specified ambient shall not be chargeable to the life test duration.
g. If the ambient, at or beyond the five hour point is not the specified value, a nonconformance shall exist
requiring corrective action.
h. Time is not chargeable during the period when specified conditions are not maintained. If device maximum
ratings (if life test, finish the test and use for credit; if shippable, use this criteria) are exceeded and the
manufacturer intends to submit the lot affected, the product on test shall be evaluated by re-starting the
burn-in or HTRB from zero hours at the specified temperature and verifying that the end-point failure rate is
typical for this product type from a review of established records.
i. Chamber temperature for HTRB and burn-in shall be controlled to 3 percent of the specified value (unless
otherwise specified in 4.1.1). This temperature shall be maintained within the chamber. Forced air may be
used to equalize temperature within the chamber but shall not be used as a coolant to increase device
power capability.
a. Bias errors at the power supply source caused by changing power supply loads during temperature
transitions shall not exceed 5 percent of that specified value.
b. Bias values at the source, during stabilized conditions, shall not exceed 3 percent of the specified value.
c. Burn-in apparatus shall be arranged so as to result in the approximate average power dissipation for each
device whether devices are tested individually or in a group. Bias and burn-in circuitry tolerances should
not vary test conditions to individual devices by more than 5 percent of specified conditions.
d. Normal variation in individual device characteristics need not be compensated for by burn-in circuitry.
e. Burn-in equipment shall be arranged so that the existence of failed or abnormal devices in a group does not
negate the effect of the test for other devices in the group. Periodic verification will assure that specified
conditions are being maintained. Verification shall be performed, as a minimum, at the starting and the end
of screening.
f. Lead, stud, or case mounted devices shall be mounted in their normal mounting configuration and the point
of mechanical connection shall be maintained at no less than the specified ambient.
10
4.7 Destructive tests. Unless otherwise demonstrated, the following MIL-STD-750 tests are classified as
destructive:
All other mechanical or environmental tests (other than those listed in 4.8) shall be considered destructive initially, but
may subsequently be considered nondestructive upon accumulation of sufficient data to indicate that the test is
nondestructive. The accumulation of data from five repetitions of the specified test on the same sample of product,
without significant evidence of cumulative degradation in any device in the sample, is considered sufficient evidence
that the test is nondestructive for the device of that manufacturer. Any test specified as a 100-percent screen shall be
considered nondestructive for the stress level and duration or number of cycles applied as a screen.
11
4.8 Nondestructive tests. Unless otherwise demonstrated, the following MIL-STD-750 tests are classified as
nondestructive:
When the junction temperature exceeds the device maximum rated junction temperature for any operation or test
(including electrical stress test), these tests shall be considered destructive except under transient surge or
nonrepetitive fault conditions or approved accelerated screening when it may be desirable to allow the junction
temperature to exceed the rated junction temperature. The feasibility shall be determined on a part by part basis and
in the case where it is allowed adequate sample testing, shall be performed to provide the proper reliability
safeguards.
12
4.9 Laboratory suitability. Prior to processing any semiconductor devices intended for use in any military system
or sub-system, the facility performing the test(s) must be audited by the Defense Electronics Supply Center, Sourcing
and Qualification Division (DESC-ELST) and be granted written Laboratory Suitability status for each test method to
be employed. Processing of any devices by any facility without Laboratory Suitability status for the test methods
used shall render the processed devices nonconforming.
5. DETAILED REQUIREMENTS
6. NOTES
(This section contains information of a general or explanatory nature that may be helpful, but is not mandatory.)
6.1 Intended Use. The intended use of this standard is to establish appropriate conditions for testing
semiconductor devices to give test results that simulate the actual service conditions existing in the field. This
standard has been prepared to provide uniform methods, controls, and procedures for determining with predictability
the suitability of such devices within Military, Aerospace and special application equipment.
6.2 International standardization agreement. Certain provisions of this standard are the subject of international
standardization agreement. When amendment, revision, or cancellation of this standard is proposed which will affect
or violate the international agreement concerned, the preparing activity will take appropriate reconciliation action
through international standardization channels, including departmental standardization offices, if required.
Environmental tests
Mechanical characteristics tests
Electrical characteristics tests for bipolar transistors
Circuit-performance and thermal resistance measurements
Low frequency tests
High frequency tests
Electrical characteristics tests for MOS field-effect transistors
Electrical characteristics tests for Gallium Arsenide transistors
Electrical characteristics tests for diodes
Electrical characteristics tests for microwave diodes
Electrical characteristics tests for tunnel diodes
High reliability space application tests
6.4 Changes from previous issue. Marginal notations are not used in this revision to identify changes with respect
to the previous issue due to the extent of the changes.
13
1000 Series
Environmental tests
METHOD 1001.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to check the device capabilities under conditions simulating the low
pressure encountered in the nonpressurized portions of aircraft in high altitude flight.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus used for the barometric-pressure test shall consist of a vacuum pump and a suitable
sealed chamber having means for visual observation of the specimen under test when necessary. A suitable
pressure indicator shall be used to measure the simulated altitude in feet in the sealed chamber.
3. Procedure. The specimens shall be mounted in the test chamber as specified and the pressure reduced to the
value indicated in one of the following test conditions, as specified. Previous references to this method do not
specify a test condition; in such cases, test condition B shall be used. While the specimens are maintained at the
specified pressure, and after sufficient time has been allowed for all entrapped air in the chamber to escape, the
specimens shall be subjected to the specified test.
a. Twenty minutes before and during the test, the test temperature shall be +25C 3C.
b. The specified voltage shall be applied and monitored over the range from atmospheric pressure to the
specified minimum pressure and returned so that any device malfunctions, if they exist, will be detected.
4. Failure criteria. A device which exhibits arc-overs, harmful coronas, or any other defect or deterioration that
may interfere with the operation of the device shall be considered a failure.
5. Summary. The following conditions must be specified in the performance specification sheet:
METHOD 1001.2
1 of 1
METHOD 1011.1
IMMERSION
1. Purpose. This test is performed to determine the effectiveness of the seal of component parts. The immersion
of the part under evaluation into liquid at widely different temperatures subjects it to thermal and mechanical
stresses which will readily detect a defective terminal assembly, or a partially closed seam or molded enclosure.
Defects of these types can result from faulty construction or from mechanical damage such as might be produced
during physical or environmental tests. The immersion test is generally performed immediately following such tests
because it will tend to aggravate any incipient defects in seals, seams, and bushings which might otherwise escape
notice. This test is essentially a laboratory test condition, and the procedure is intended only as a measurement of
the effectiveness of the seal following this test. The choice of fresh or salt water as a test liquid is dependent on the
nature of the component part under test. When electrical measurements are made after immersion cycling to obtain
evidence of leakage through seals, the use of a salt solution instead of fresh water will facilitate detection of moisture
penetration. This test provides a simple and ready means of detection of the migration of liquids. Effects noted can
include lowered insulation resistance, corrosion of internal parts, and appearance of salt crystals. The test described
is not intended as a thermal-shock or corrosion test, although it may incidentally reveal inadequacies in these
respects.
2. Procedure. The test consists of successive cycles of immersions, each cycle consisting of immersion in a hot
bath of fresh (tap) water at a temperature of 65C +5C, -0C (149F +9F, -0F) followed by immersion in a cold
bath. The number of cycles, duration of each immersion, and the nature and temperature of the cold bath shall be
as indicated in the applicable test condition listed in the specified test. .
Test condition Number of cycles Duration of each Immersion bath (cold) Temperature of cold bath
immersion
(C)
(Minutes)
The transfer of specimens from one bath to another shall be accomplished as rapidly as practicable. After
completion of the final cycle, specimens shall be thoroughly and quickly washed and all surfaces wiped or air-blasted
clean and dry.
3. Measurements. Unless otherwise specified, measurements shall be made at least 4 hours, but not more than
24 hours, after completion of the final cycle. Measurements shall be made as specified.
b. Time after final cycle allowed for measurements, if other than that specified (see 3).
METHOD 1011.1
1of 1
METHOD 1015.1
1. Purpose. This test procedure establishes the means for measuring the steady-state primary photocurrent (IPH)
generated in semiconductor devices when these devices are exposed to ionizing radiation. In this test method, the
test device is irradiated in the primary electron beam of a linear accelerator (LINAC).
1.1 Definitions. The following definitions shall apply for this test method.
1.1.1 Primary photocurrent (IPH). The flow of excess charge carriers across a P-N junction due to ionizing
radiation creating electron-hole pairs in the vicinity of the P-N junction.
1.1.2 Measurement interferences. A current measured in the test circuits that does not result from primary
photocurrent (see appendix herein).
2. Apparatus.
2.1 Ionizing pulse source. The ionizing pulse shall be produced by an electron LINAC. The ionizing pulse shall
have dose rate variations within 15 percent of nominal during the pulse and shall consist of electrons with an
energy equal to or greater than 10 MeV.
2.2 Pulse recording equipment. Pulse recording equipment shall be provided that will display and record both the
photocurrent and the pulse-shape monitor signal. It may consist of oscilloscopes with recording cameras,
appropriate digitizing equipment, or other approved recording equipment. The equipment shall have an accuracy
and resolution of five percent of the pulse width and maximum amplitude of the ionizing source.
2.3 Test circuits. One of the following test circuits shall be selected, radiation-shielded, and close enough to the
DUT in order to meet the requirements of 3.2.
2.3.1 Resistor sampling circuits. The resistor sampling circuits shall be as shown on figure 1015-1.
2.3.2 Current transformer circuit. The current transformer circuit shall be as shown on figure 1015-2.
2.4 Irradiation pulse-shape monitor. One of the following devices shall be used to develop a signal proportional to
the dose rate delivered to the DUT. Any time constants which degrade the linear response of the monitor signal
shall be less than 10 percent of the beam pulse width. The dose rate at the monitor shall be proportional to the dose
rate at the DUT and the variation from proportionality shall not exceed 3 percent.
2.4.1 Signal diode. The signal diode selected shall have a response that is linear within 5 percent of the dose
rate over the selected irradiation range. Depending on the sensitivity of the diode, it may be positioned at a point
within the beam from the ionizing source at which it will remain in the linear region. The signal diode shall be placed
in one of the test circuits described in 2.3, and it shall be back biased at not more than fifty percent of the diode
breakdown voltage.
2.4.2 P-type-intrinsic-N-type (P-I-N) diode. A P-I-N diode shall be used as stated in 2.4.1.
2.4.3 Current transformer. A transformer with a hollow central axis that shall be mounted around the output of the
ionizing source.
2.4.4 Secondary-emission monitor. The secondary-emission monitor shall consist of a thin foil mounted in a
chamber evacuated to .134 Pa (0.01 mmHg), which is located in the path of the beam from the ionizing source.
The foil shall be biased negatively with respect to ground, or shielded with positively biased grids.
2.5 Dosimeter. The dosimeter shall be used to calibrate the output of the pulse-shape monitor in terms of dose
rate. The dosimeter type shall be a commercial thermoluminescent detector (TLD), thin calorimeter, or other system
as specified. The dosimetry measurement technique shall be accurate to 20 percent.
METHOD 1015.1
1 of 5
NOTES:
1. R1 = 1,000 , 5 percent.
2. R2 = 5 , 1 percent.
3. C1 = 15 F, 5 percent.
4. C2 = .01 F, 5 percent.
5. RT = Characteristic termination for coaxial cable.
6. Circuit B shall be used for large photocurrents (those for which more than 10 percent of the bias appears
across resistor RT in circuit A).
7. Photocurrent for circuit A:
METHOD 1015.1
2
NOTES:
1. R1 = 1,000 , 5 percent.
2. C1 = 15 F, 5 percent.
3. C2 = .01 F, 5 percent.
4. RT = Characteristic termination for coaxial cable.
5. Photocurrent calculation:
3. Procedure.
3.1 General. The test facility shall select a test fixture and pulse shape monitor. The test fixture and monitor shall
be aligned with the beam from the ionizing source. In addition, any shielding, collimation, or beam scattering
equipment shall be properly positioned. If repositioning of any equipment or the test circuit is required to accomplish
the device testing, the repositioning shall be demonstrated to be reliable and repeatable.
3.2 Test circuit check-out. The ionizing source shall be pulsed either with an empty device package or without the
DUT in the test circuit and with all required bias applied. The ionizing source shall be adjusted to supply the dose
rate required for this test. The recorded current from the pulse recording equipment shall be no more than 10
percent of the steady-state photocurrent expected to be measured for this test (see 3.4.3). If this condition is not
met, see appendix herein.
METHOD 1015.1
3
3.3 Ionizing source calibration. Mount the selected dosimeter in place of the DUT. Pulse the ionizing source,
record the pulse-shape monitor signal, and determine the radiation dose measured by the dosimeter. Calculate a
dose rate factor as follows:
Measureddosimeterdose[rad(Si)]
Doseratefactor =
Integratedpulseshapemonitorsignal(voltsxseconds)
This measurement shall be repeated five times, and the average of the six dose rate factors obtained shall be the
dose rate factor used for the test. One dosimeter may be used repetitively if the dose is read for each pulse.
3.4.1 Mounting. Mount the DUT in the beam from the ionizing source and connect it to the rest of the test circuit.
The bias applied shall be as specified in the device specification; or if not specified, the bias shall be fifty percent of
the specified breakdown voltage of the DUT.
3.4.2 Dose rate. Either adjust the ionizing source beam current or use an alternate method (i.e., scatterers or a
different sample location) to obtain the specified dose rate 20 percent. Pulse the ionizing source and record the
pulse-shape monitor signal and the photocurrent signal from the DUT.
3.4.3 Calculate photocurrent. The steady-state photocurrent shall be calculated as expressed on the figure
selected for the test circuit in 2.3.
3.4.4 Verify test circuit. Check the current recorded in the test circuit in 3.2 and verify that the value of the current
does not exceed 10 percent of the photocurrent recorded in 3.4.3.
3.5 Test circuit checkout. Repeat the device test (see 3.4) for each dose rate that is required by the device
specification. The calibration (see 3.3) shall be performed for each dose rate to be tested. The test circuit checkout
(see 3.2) shall be performed when a new device type is tested or when any change is made in the position of the test
circuit or DUT supporting structure.
a. The pulse width requirements of the ionizing pulse source. (The pulse width must exceed the
semiconductor minority lifetime by at least a factor of two .)
e. When required, a description of the placement of the device in the beam with respect to the junction.
f. When required, for multi-junction devices, the device terminals that are to be monitored.
g. When required, the procedure for approval of the test facility and dosimetry.
METHOD 1015.1
4
APPENDIX
MEASUREMENT INTERFERENCES
1. Scope. The following problems commonly arise when electronics are tested in a radiation environment. Most
of these interferences are present when the test circuit is irradiated under bias with the DUT removed. This Appendix
is not a mandatory part of the standard. The information contained herein is intended for guidance only.
1.1 Air ionization. The irradiation pulse can ionize the air around the test circuit and provide a spurious
conduction path. The air ionization contribution to the signal is proportional to the applied bias. The effect of air
ionization is minimized by reducing the circuit components exposed to the beam pulse, by coating exposed leads
with a thick nonconducting layer or by performing the test in a vacuum.
1.2. Secondary emission. The beam pulse irradiating any electrical lead or component can cause a net charge to
enter or leave the exposed surfaces. This spurious current alters the measured photocurrent. Secondary emission
effects are reduced by minimizing the circuit components exposed to the direct beam.
1.3. Perturbed irradiation field. Any material exposed to the beam pulse will scatter and modify the incident
radiation of the beam. A nearby DUT or dosimeter will then be exposed to a noncharacterized and unexpected form
of radiation. These field perturbations are reduced by minimizing the mass of the structure supporting the DUT and
the dosimeter that is exposed to the beam. All materials should have a low atomic number; e.g., plastics and
aluminum.
1.4. RF pickup. The ionizing pulse source discharges large amounts of electromagnetic energy at the same time
the photocurrent is being measured. Good electrical practice is necessary to eliminate resonant structure, noise
pick-up on signal cables, common mode pick-up, ground loops, and similar interferences.
METHOD 1015.1
5
METHOD 1016
INSULATION RESISTANCE
METHOD 1016
1of 1
METHOD 1017.1
NEUTRON IRRADIATION
1. Purpose. The neutron irradiation test is performed to determine the susceptibility of discrete semiconductor
devices to degradation in the neutron environment. This test is destructive. Objectives of the test are:
a. To detect and measure the degradation of critical semiconductor device electrical characteristics as a
function of neutron fluence.
b. To determine if specified semiconductor device electrical characteristics are within specified limits after
exposure to a specified level of neutron fluence (see 2.4.1 4).
2. Apparatus.
2.1 Test instruments. Test instrumentation to be used in the radiation test shall be standard laboratory electronic
test instruments such as power supplies, digital voltmeters, and picoammeters, capable of measuring the electrical
parameters required. Parameter test methods and calibration shall be in accordance with this general specification.
2.2 Radiation source. The radiation source used in the test shall be in a TRIGA Reactor or a Fast Burst Reactor.
Operation may be in either pulse or steady-state repetitive pulse conditions as appropriate. The source shall be one
that is acceptable to the acquiring activity.
b. CaF2 TLD.
2.4.1 Neutron fluence. The neutron fluence used for device irradiation shall be obtained by measuring the
amount of radioactivity induced in a fast-neutron threshold activation foil such as 32S, 54Fe, or 58Ni, irradiated
simultaneously with the device. A standard method for converting the measured radioactivity in the specific
activation foil employed into a neutron fluence is given in the following (DoD) adopted (ASTM) standards:
ASTM E263 Standard Test Method for Measuring Fast-Neutron Flux by Radioactivation of Iron.
ASTM E264 Standard Test Method for Measuring Fast-Neutron Flux by Radioactivation of Nickel.
ASTM E265 Standard Test Method for Measuring Fast-Neutron Flux by Radioactivation of Sulfur.
The conversion of the foil radioactivity into a neutron fluence requires a knowledge of the neutron spectrum incident
on the foil. If the spectrum is not known, it shall be determined by use of the following DoD adopted ASTM
standards, or their equivalent:
ASTM E720 Standard Guide for Selection of a Set of Neutron-Activation Foils for Determining
Neutron Spectra used in Radiation-Hardness Testing of Electronics.
ASTM E721 Standard Method for Determining Neutron Energy Spectra with Neutron-Activation
Foils for Radiation-Hardness Testing of Electronics.
ASTM E722 Standard Practice for Characterizing Neutron Energy Fluence Spectra in Terms of an
Equivalent Monoenergetic Neutron Fluence for Radiation-Hardness Testing of
Electronics.
METHOD 1017.1
1 of 3
Once the neutron energy spectrum has been determined and the equivalent monoenergetic fluence calculated, then
an appropriate monitor foil (such as 32S, 54Fe, or 58Ni) should be used in subsequent irradiations to determine the
neutron fluence as discussed in E722. Thus, the neutron fluence is described in terms of the equivalent
monoenergetic neutron fluence in accordance with the unit monitor response. Use of a monitor foil to predict the
equivalent monoenergetic neutron fluence is valid only if the energy spectrum remains constant.
2.4.2 If absorbed dose measurements of the gamma-ray component during the device test irradiations are
required, then such measurements shall be made with CaF2 TLDs, or their equivalent. These TLDs shall be used in
accordance with the recommendations of the following DoD adopted ASTM standard:
3. Procedure.
3.1 Safety requirements. Neutron irradiated parts may be radioactive. Handling and storage of test specimens or
equipment subjected to radiation environments shall be governed by the procedures established by the local
Radiation Safety Officer or health physicist.
NOTE: The receipt, acquisition, possession, use, and transfer of this material after irradiation
is subject to the regulations of the U.S. Nuclear Regulatory Commission, Radioisotope License
Branch, Washington, DC 20555. A by-product license is required before an irradiation facility
will expose any test devices. (U.S. Code, see 10 CFR 30-33.)
3.2 Test samples. Unless otherwise specified, a test sample shall be randomly selected and consist of a
minimum of ten parts. All sample parts shall have met all the requirements of the governing specification for that
part. Each part shall be serialized to enable pre and post test identification and comparison.
3.3 Pre-exposure.
3.3.1 Electrical tests. Pre-exposure electrical tests shall be performed on each part as required. Where delta
parameter limits are specified, the pre-exposure data shall be recorded.
3.3.2 Exposure set-up. Each device shall be mounted unbiased and have its terminal leads either all shorted or
all open. For Metal oxide semiconductor (MOS) devices all leads shall be shorted. An appropriate mounting fixture
which will accommodate both the sample and the required dosimeters (at least one actuation foil and one CaF2
TLD) shall be used. The configuration of the mounting fixture will depend on the type of reactor facility used and
should be discussed with reactor facility personnel. Test devices shall be mounted such that the total variation of
fluence over the entire sample does not exceed 20 percent. Reactor facility personnel shall determine both the
position of the fixture and the appropriate pulse level or power time product required to achieve the specified neutron
fluence level.
3.4 Exposure. The test devices and dosimeters shall be exposed to the neutron fluence as specified. The
exposure level may be obtained by operating the reactor in either the pulsed or power mode. If multiple exposures
are required, the post-irradiation electrical tests shall be performed (see 3.5.1) after each exposure. A new set of
dosimeters are required for each exposure level. Since the effects of neutrons are cumulative, each additional
exposure level will have to be determined to give the specified total accumulated fluence. All exposures shall be
made at 20C 10C and shall be correlated to a 1 MeV equivalent fluence.
METHOD 1017.1
2
3.5 Post-exposure.
3.5.1 Electrical tests. Test devices shall be removed only after clearance has been obtained from the health
physicist at the test facility. The temperature of the sample devices shall be maintained at +20C 10C from the
time of the exposure until the post-electrical tests are made. The post-exposure electrical tests shall be made within
24 hours after the completion of the exposure. If the residual radioactivity level determined by the local Radiation
Safety Officer is too high for device handling purposes, the elapsed time before post-test electrical measurements
are made shall be extended to 1 week or remote testing shall be utilized. All required data must be recorded for
each device after each exposure.
3.5.2 Failure analysis. Devices which exhibit anomalous behavior (e.g., non-linear degradation of 1/) shall be
subjected to failure analysis.
3.6 Reporting. In reporting the results of radiation tests on discrete devices, adequate identification of the devices
is essential. As a minimum, the report shall include the device type number, serial number, the manufacturer,
controlling specification, the date code, and other Part or Identifying Numbers (PINs) provided by the manufacturer.
Each data sheet shall include radiation test date, electrical test conditions, radiation test levels, and ambient
conditions, as well as the test data. When other than specified electrical test circuits are employed, the parameter
measurement circuits shall accompany the data. Any anomalous incidents during the test shall be fully explained in
footnotes to the data.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the request for test, or when applicable, the
performance specification:
a. Device types.
METHOD 1017.1
3
METHOD 1018.3
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the atmosphere inside a metal or ceramic hermetically-sealed
device. Of particular interest is the measurement of the moisture content to determine if the device meets the
specified moisture criteria. Also of interest is the measurement of all the other gases because they reflect upon the
quality of the sealing process and provide information about the long term chemical stability of the atmosphere inside
the device. This test is destructive.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus for the internal water-vapor content test shall be as follows:
(1) Spectra range. The mass spectrometer shall be capable of reading a minimum spectra range of 1 to
100 atomic mass units (AMUs).
(2) Detection limit. The mass spectrometer shall be capable of reproducibly detecting the specified
moisture content for a given volume package with signal to noise ratio of 20 to 1 (i.e., for a specified
limit of 5,000 parts per million volume (ppmv), .01 cc, the mass spectrometer shall demonstrate a 250
ppmv minimum detection limit to moisture for a package volume of .01 cc). The smallest volume shall
be considered the worst case.
(3) System calibration. The calibration of the mass spectrometer shall be accomplished quarterly with a
moisture level in the 4,500 to 5,500 ppmv range and with a moisture level in the 2,000 to 3,000 ppmv
range, and with a moisture level in the 7,000 to 8,000 range using the same sensitivity factor. This
calibration needs to be performed for each calibrator volume to demonstrate a linear response and to
detect offset. A minimum of three data points for each moisture level shall be collected. Package
simulators which have the capability of generating at least three known volumes of gas 10 percent on
a repetitive basis by means of a continuous sample volume purge of known moisture content 5
percent shall be used. Moisture content shall be established by the standard generation techniques
(i.e., 2 pressure, divided flow, or cryogenic method). The dew point hygrometer shall be recalibrated a
minimum of once per year using equipment traceable to National Institute of Standards and
Technology (NIST) or by a suitable commercial calibration services laboratory using equipment
traceable to NIST standards. The dew point hygrometer shall be capable of measuring the dew point
o
temperature to an accuracy of +0.2 C. The system shall have a pressure sensor to measure the
pressure in line with the temperature dew point sensor to an accuracy of +0.1 inches of Hg for the
range of pressure being used. In addition, the test laboratory shall have a procedure to calculate the
concentration of moisture, in units of ppmv, from the dew point temperature measurement and the
pressure measurement. Gas analysis results obtained by this method shall be considered valid only in
the moisture range or limit bracketed by at least two (volume or concentration) calibration points (i.e.,
5,000 ppmv between .01 to .1 cc or 1,000 to 5,000 ppmv between .01 to .1 cc). A best fit curve shall
be used between volume calibration points. Systems not capable of bracketing may use an equivalent
procedure as approved by the qualifying activity. Corrections of sensitivity factors deviating greater
than 10 percent from the mean between calibration points shall be required.
NOTE: It is recommended that the percentage of water vapor contained in a gas flowing through the
gas humidifier be compared to the dewpoint sensor reading for accuracy of the sensor. The following
equation may be used to calculate the percent of water vapor contained in a gas flowing through the
gas humidifier.
METHOD 1018.3
1 of 6
100 (Pv mb )
% H 2O =
68 . 95 mb/psi Pg + 1 . 33 mb/mm Pa
Where:
Pv = vapor pressure of water in the GPH based on water temperature in degrees centigrade,
Pg = gauge pressure in psi, and
Pa = atmospheric pressure in mm Hg.
(4) Annual calibration for other gases. Calibration shall be required for all gases found in concentrations
greater than .01 percent by volume. As a minimum, this shall include all gases listed in 3b. The
applicable gases shall be calibrated at approximately 1 percent concentrations requirements, with the
exception of fluorocarbons, which may use a concentration of approximately 200 ppmv; NH3 which
may use a concentration of approximately 200 ppmv; hydrogen, which may use a concentration of
approximately 200 ppmv; nitrogen, which may use a concentration of approximately 80 percent;
helium, which may use a concentration of approximately 10 percent; and oxygen, which may use a
concentration of approximately 20 percent.
(5) Daily calibration check. The system calibration shall be checked on the day of test prior to any testing.
This shall include checking the calibration by in-letting a sample with a moisture level in the 4,500-
5,500 ppmv range at the required volumes and comparing the result with the dew point hygrometer.
The resulting moisture reading shall be within 250 ppmv of the moisture level in the calibration sample.
NOTE: Equipment error needs to be determined and subtracted from the allowed maximum deviation
of 250 ppmv. The calibration check shall be performed using the same conditions used for testing
devices (e.g. background pressure, background environment, time between sample inlets, package
simulator volume etc) Calibration performed on the day of test prior to any testing may be substituted
for this calibration check. Calibration records shall be kept on a daily basis.
(6) Performed on the day of test prior to any testing may be substituted for this calibration check.
(7) Precision tuning shall be performed following significant maintenance or repair of the ion source.
(8) A record of all changes made to the sensitivity factors shall be maintained.
b. A vacuum opening chamber which can contain the device and a vacuum transfer passage connecting the
device to the mass spectrometer of 2.a. A vacuum transfer passage shall efficiently (without significant loss
of moisture from adsorption) transfer the gas from the device to the mass spectrometer ion source for
measurement.
For initial certification of systems or extension of suitability, device temperature on systems using an
external fixture shall be characterized by placing a thermocouple into the cavity of a blank device of similar
mass, internal volume, construction, and size. This shall be a means for proving the device temperature that
has been maintained at 100C 5C for the minimum 10 minutes. This also applies to devices prebaked in
an external oven but tested with the external fixture to adjust for any temperature drop during the transfer.
These records shall be maintained by the test laboratory.
c. A piercing arrangement functioning within the opening chamber or transfer passage of 2.b, which can pierce
the specimen housing (without breaking the mass spectrometer chamber vacuum and without disturbing the
package sealing medium), thus allowing the specimen's internal gases to escape into the chamber and
mass spectrometer.
NOTE: A sharp-pointed piercing tool, actuated from outside the chamber wall via a bellows to permit
movement shall be used to pierce both metal and ceramic packages. For ceramic packages, or devices
with thick metal lids, the package lid or cover should be locally thinned by abrasion to facilitate localized
piercing.
METHOD 1018.3
2
d. A pressure sensing device located in the transfer passage to measure the pressure rise in the transfer
passage during the test. This pressure sensor is used to read a relative pressure change when the device is
punctured. This relative pressure change indicates the relative quantity of gas in the device when
comparing the test results of one device to another device. The significance of the reading is not intended to
be absolute. Although the pressure gauge reading is reported, the pressure gauge is for indication only.
3. Procedure. All devices shall be prebaked for 16 to 24 hours at 100C 5C prior to test. Ovens shall have a
means to indicate if a power interruption occurs during the prebaking period and for how long the temperature drops
below 100C 5C. Devices whose temperature drops below 100C 5C for more than 1 hour shall undergo another
prebake to begin a minimum of 12 hours later.
A maximum 5 minute transfer time from prebake to hot insertion into apparatus shall be allowed. If 5 minutes is
exceeded, device shall be returned to the prebake oven and prebake continued until device reaches 100C 5C.
The system shall be maintained at a stable temperature equal to or above the device temperature. The fixturing in
the vacuum opening chamber shall position the specimen as required by the piercing arrangement of 2.c, and
maintain the device at 100C 5C for a minimum of 10 minutes prior to piercing.
After device insertion, the device and chamber shall be pumped down and baked out at a temperature of 100C 5C
until the background pressure level will not prevent achieving the specified measurement accuracy and sensitivity.
The background vacuum spectra shall be acquired and shall later be subtracted from the sample spectra. After pump
down, the device case or lid shall be punctured and the following properties of the released gases shall be measured,
using the mass spectrometer:
a. The water-vapor content of the released gases, as a percent by unit volume or ppmv of the total gas
content.
b. The proportions (by volume) of the other following gases: N2, He, Mass 69 (fluorocarbons), O2, Ar, H2, CO2,
CH4, NH3, and other solvents, if available. Calculations shall be made and reported on all gases present.
Data reduction shall be performed in a manner, which will preclude the cracking pattern interference from
other gas specie in the calculations of moisture content. Data shall be corrected for any system dependent
matrix effects such as the presence of hydrogen in the internal ambient.
c. The increase in chamber pressure as the gases are released by piercing the device package. A pressure
change of 25 percent from expected for that package volume and pressurization may indicate that (1) the
puncture was not fully accomplished, (2) the device package was not sealed hermetically, or (3) does not
contain the normal internal pressure.
d. The test laboratory should provide comments describing the spectra of unknowns or gases that are present
but not in sufficient concentration to be identified or quantified with reasonable certainty.
e. If the test laboratory has reason to believe that the test results may be invalid due to reasons such as
improper puncture of the device or equipment malfunction, the results shall be reported as no test with
additional comments provided. The device may be replaced with another.
NOTE: The device shall be hermetic in accordance with test method 1071 of this standard, and free from any surface
contaminants which may interfere with accurate water vapor content measurement. The internal water vapor content
laboratory is not required to test for hermeticity in accordance with test method 1071 of this standard. It is
recommended that samples submitted for testing shall include information about the manufacturing process, including
sealing pressure, sealing gas, free internal cavity volume, lid thickness at puncture site, lid material, and the location
of the puncture site.
METHOD 1018.3
3
a. The Internal gas analysis (IGA) laboratory shall not classify devices as passed or failed.
b. A device being tested in a batch system which exhibits an abnormally low total gas content, as defined in
3.c, shall constitute a hermeticity failure not an IGA failure. Such a device may be replaced by another
device from the same population; if the replacement device exhibits normal total gas content for its type,
neither it nor the original device shall constitute a failure for this cause.
4. Implementation. Suitability for performing method 1018 analysis is granted by the qualifying activity for specific
limits and volumes. Method 1018 calibration procedures and the suitability survey are designed to guarantee 20
percent lab-to-lab correlation in making a determination whether the sample passes or fails the specified limit. Water
vapor contents reported either above or below the range of suitability are not certified as correlatable values. This out
of specification data has meaning only in a relative sense and only when one laboratory's results are being
compared. The specification limit of 5,000 ppmv shall apply to all package volumes (unless otherwise specified), with
the following correction factors permitted, to be used by the manufacturer provided they are documented and shown
to be applicable:
a. For package volumes less than .01 cc internal free volume which are sealed while heated in a furnace:
T r + 273
CT =
T s + 273
Where:
CT = correction factor (temperature)
Tr = room temperature (C)
Ts = sealing temperature (C).
Ps
CP =
Pa
Water vapor (corrected) = water vapor (measured) x CX; where CX is the applicable correction factor.
The range of suitability for each laboratory will be extended by the qualifying activity when the analytical laboratories
demonstrate an expanded capability. Information on current analytical laboratory suitability status can be obtained by
contacting Defense Supply Center, Columbus, ATTN: DSCC-VQE, P.O. Box 3990, Columbus, OH 43216-5000 or
e-mail [email protected].
METHOD 1018.3
4
5. Surrogate monitors. Surrogate monitors are only applicable for packages less than .01 cc to evaluate the
process baseline. Surrogate monitors will be subject to IGA testing in accordance with method 1018 herein. A
production lot will be validated by the performance of its monitors. It is well known and established that pre-seal bake
and storage conditions of packaging materials will severely impact the levels of moisture detected in almost any
package type. The use of the surrogate monitors without a controlled and disciplined manufacturing line is of
questionable value. The proposed test is not, nor is it intended to be, a direct measurement of small packaged
product internal moisture. However, it is a quantifiable indicator that the process and controls used are consistent.
This is an improvement over the existing situation in which there is a requirement for control of internal moisture and
no accurate and repeatable method of measurement.
5.1. Requirements. Surrogate monitors are to be procured from the same manufacturer and be manufactured in
the same technology as the production headers, using the same materials, plating, processing, and technology. For
example, the UB packages: Kyocera header, multilayer cofired ceramic technology; SemiAlloys lid, Alloy 52, nickel
underplate, and gold plate.
a. The device manufacturer shall use the same preconditioning on surrogate monitors and production
product, i.e. vacuum bake time and temperature, storage conditions, die attach materials and process.
b. Surrogate monitors shall be sealed at the same time and using the same process as the production
parts.
c. To optimize the effect of preconditioning, the transit time from the oven to the seal furnace shall be
controlled and minimal.
(3) Second vacuum bake overnight (a minimum of 12 hrs) just prior to seal.
e. Surrogate monitor packages will be under baseline documentation control. Full traceability from
procurement to utilization shall be maintained.
f. Initially, the surrogate monitors will be used at the beginning of the seal operation and at 2 hour intervals.
A minimum of six monitors must be processed for each seal lot (a "seal lot" may consist of multiple
production lots if they go through sealing without interruptions (other than the scheduled breaks) and
have identical traceability of headers and lids).
g. It is expected that it will take approximately 6 months for a manufacturer to collect enough lots and data
to establish a baseline. Later modifications of the preconditioning process will be evaluated against this
baseline.
h. The device manufacturer will submit to DSCC the results from a minimum of three seal lots to establish
the effectiveness of the process baseline. Additional testing will be retained and available to DSCC upon
request.
6. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable acquisition document: The maximum
allowable water vapor content if other than 5,000 ppmv.
METHOD 1018.3
5
METHOD 1019.5
1. Purpose. This test procedure defines the requirements for testing discrete packaged semiconductor devices for
60
ionizing radiation (total dose) effects from a cobalt-60 ( Co) gamma ray source. In addition, this procedure provides
an accelerated annealing test for estimating low dose rate ionizing radiation effects on devices. This annealing test is
important for low dose-rate or certain other applications in which devices may exhibit significant time dependent
effects. This procedure addresses only steady-state irradiations, and is not applicable to pulse type irradiations. This
test may produce severe degradation of the electrical properties of irradiated devices and thus should be considered
a destructive test.
1.1 Definitions. Definitions of terms used in this procedure are given below:
a. Ionizing radiation effects: The changes in the electrical parameters of a device resulting from
radiation-induced charge. It is also referred to as total dose effects.
c. Not in-flux tests: Electrical measurements made on devices at any time other than during irradiation.
d. Remote tests: Electrical measurements made on devices which are physically removed from the irradiation
location for the measurements.
e. Time dependent effects. Significant changes in electrical parameters caused by the growth or annealing, or
both, of radiation induced trapped charge and interface traps after irradiation. Similar effects also take place
during irradiation.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus shall consist of the radiation source, electrical test instrumentation, test circuit
board(s), cable, interconnect board or switching system, if used, and appropriate dosimetry measurement system, if
used. Adequate precautions shall be observed to obtain an electrical measurement system with sufficient insulation,
ample shielding, satisfactory grounding, and with suitable low noise from the main power supply.
60
2.1 Radiation source. The radiation source used in the test shall be the uniform field of a Co gamma ray source.
Uniformity of the radiation field in the volume where devices are irradiated shall be within 10 percent as measured
60
by the dosimetry system, unless otherwise specified. The intensity of the gamma ray field of the Co source shall be
known with an uncertainty of no more than 5 percent. Field uniformity and intensity can be affected by changes in
the location of the device with respect to the radiation source and the presence of radiation absorption and scattering
materials.
2.1.1 Cobalt-60 source. The gamma ray field of a Cobalt-60 source shall be calibrated at least every 3 years to
an uncertainty of no more than 5 percent as measured with an appropriate dosimetry system whose calibration is
traceable to the NIST. Corrections for Cobalt-60 source decay shall be made monthly.
2.2 Dosimetry system. An appropriate dosimetry system shall be provided which is capable of carrying out the
measurements required in 3.3. The following American Society for Testing and Materials (ASTM) standards, or other
appropriate standards, shall be used:
ANSI/ASTM E 666 - Standard Method for Calculation of Absorbed Dose from Gamma or X Radiation.
ASTM E 1250 - Standard Method for Application of Ionization Chambers to Assess the Low Energy
Gamma Component of Cobalt 60 Irradiators Used in Radiation Hardness Testing of
Silicon electronic Devices.
METHOD 1019.5
1 of 9
ASTM E 1275 - Standard Practice for Use of a Radiochromic Film Dosimetry System.
ASTM E 1249 - Minimizing Dosimetry Errors in Radiation Hardness Testing of Silicon Electronic
Devices.
These industry standards address the conversion of absorbed dose from one material to another and the proper
use of various dosimetry systems.
(Application for copies should be addressed to ASTM International, 100 Barr Harbor Drive, PO Box C700, West
Conshohocken, PA, 19428-2959, http://www.astm.org.)
2.3 Electrical test instruments. All instrumentation used for electrical measurements shall have stability, accuracy,
and resolution required for accurate measurement of the electrical parameters. Any instrumentation required to
operate in a radiation environment above 10 REM per hour shall be appropriately shielded, or the radiation level
must be less than the instrumentation manufacturer's recommended maximum.
2.4 Test circuit board(s). Devices to be irradiated shall be mounted on, or connected to, circuit boards together
with any associated circuitry necessary for device biasing during irradiation or for in-site measurements. Unless
otherwise specified, all device input terminals and any others which may affect the radiation response shall be
electrically connected during irradiation, i.e., not left floating. The geometry and materials of the completed board
shall allow uniform irradiation of the device under test (DUT). Good design and construction practices shall be used
to prevent oscillations, minimize leakage currents, prevent electrical damage, and obtain accurate measurements.
Only sockets, which are radiation resistant and do not exhibit significant leakages (relative to the DUT) shall be used
to mount devices and associated circuitry to the test board(s). All apparatus used repeatedly in radiation fields shall
be checked periodically for physical or electrical degradation. Components which are placed on the test circuit
board, other than DUTs, shall be insensitive to the accumulated radiation, or they shall be shielded from the
radiation. Test fixtures shall be made such that materials will not perturb the uniformity of the radiation field intensity
at the DUT. Leakage current shall be measured out of the radiation field. With no devices installed in the sockets,
the test circuit board shall be connected to the test system such that all expected sources of noise and interference
are operative. With the maximum specified bias for the test device applied, the leakage current between any two
terminals shall not exceed ten percent of the lowest current limit value in the pre-irradiation device specification. Test
circuit boards used to bias devices during accelerated annealing must be capable of withstanding the temperature
requirements of the accelerated annealing test and shall be checked before and after testing for physical and
electrical degradation.
2.5 Cabling. Cables connecting the test circuit boards in the radiation field to the test instrumentation shall be as
short as possible. If long cables are necessary, line drivers may be required. The cables shall have low capacitance
and low leakage to ground, and low leakage between wires.
2.6 Interconnect or switching system. This system shall be located external to the radiation environment location,
and provides the interface between the test instrumentation and the DUTs. It is part of the entire test system and
subject to the limitation specified in 2.4 for leakage between terminals.
2.7 The environmental chamber. The environmental chamber for time-dependent effects.
3. Procedure. The test devices shall be irradiated and subjected to accelerated annealing (if required for time-
dependent effects testing) as specified by a test plan. This plan shall specify the device description, irradiation
conditions, device bias conditions, dosimetry system, operating conditions, measurement parameters and
conditions, and accelerated annealing test conditions (if required). See figure 1019-I herein.
3.1 Sample selection and handling. Only devices which have passed the electrical specification as defined in the
test plan shall be submitted to radiation testing. Unless otherwise specified, the test samples shall be randomly
selected from the parent population and identically packaged. Each part shall be individually identifiable to enable
pre- and post-irradiation comparison. For device types which are ESD sensitive, proper handling techniques shall be
used to prevent damage to the devices.
METHOD 1019.5
2
3.2 Burn-in. For some devices, there are differences in the total dose radiation response before and after burn-in.
Unless it has been shown by prior characterization or by design that burn-in has negligible effect (parameters remain
within post-irradiation specified electrical limits) on the total dose radiation response, then one of the following shall
be done:
a. The manufacturer shall subject the radiation samples to the specified burn-in conditions prior to conducting
total dose radiation testing.
b. The manufacturer shall develop a correction factor (which is acceptable to the parties to the test), taking into
account the changes in total dose response resulting from subjecting product to burn-in. The correction
factor shall then be used to accept product for total dose response without subjecting the test samples to
burn-in.
3.3 Dosimetry measurements. The radiation field intensity at the location of the DUT shall be determined prior to
testing by dosimetry or by source decay correction calculations, as appropriate, to assure conformance to test level
and uniformity requirements. The dose to the DUT shall be determined one of two ways: (1) by measurement
during the irradiation with an appropriate dosimeter, or (2) by correcting a previous dosimetry value for the decay of
the Cobalt-60 source intensity in the intervening time. Appropriate correction shall be made to convert the measured
or calculated dose in the dosimeter material to the dose in the DUT.
3.4 Lead/aluminum (Pb/Al) container. Test specimens shall be enclosed in a Pb/Al container to minimize dose
enhancement effects caused by low-energy, scattered radiation. A minimum of .059 inch (1.5 mm) Pb, surrounding
an inner shield of at least .028 inch (0.7 mm) Al, is required. This Pb/Al container produces an approximate charged
particle equilibrium for Si and for TLDs such as CaF2. The radiation field intensity shall be measured inside the
Pb/Al container: (1) initially, (2) when the source is changed, or (3) when the orientation of configuration of the
source, container, or test-fixture is changed. This measurement shall be performed by placing a dosimeter (e.g., a
TLD) in the device irradiation container at the approximate test device position. If it can be demonstrated that
low-energy scattered radiation is small enough that it will not cause dosimetry errors due to dose enhancement, the
Pb/Al container may be omitted.
3.5 Radiation level(s). The test devices shall be irradiated to the dose level(s) specified in the test plan within
10 percent. If multiple irradiations are required for a set of test devices, then the post-irradiation electrical
parameter measurements shall be performed after each irradiation.
3.6.1 Condition A. The dose rate range shall be between 50 and 300 rads (Si)/s (0.5 and 3 Gy(Si)/s) for
Cobalt-60. (The SI unit for the quantity absorbed dose is the gray symbol Gy. 100 rad = 1 Gy.) The dose rates may
be different for each radiation dose level in a series; however, the dose rate shall not vary by more than 10 percent
during each irradiation.
3.6.2 Condition B. For condition B, for MOS devices only, if the maximum dose rate is < 50 rad(Si)/s in the
intended application, the parties to the test may agree to perform the test at a dose rate greater than or equal to the
maximum dose rate of the intended application. Unless the exclusions in 3.12.1b are met, the accelerated annealing
test of 3.12.2 shall be performed.
3.6.3 Condition C. As an alternative, the test may be performed at the dose rate of the intended application, if this
is agreed to by the acquisition activity.
3.7 Temperature requirements. Since radiation effects are temperature dependent, DUTs shall be irradiated in an
ambient temperature of +24C 6C as measured at a point in the test chamber in close proximity to the test fixture.
The electrical measurements shall be performed in an ambient temperature of +25C 5C. If devices are
transported to and from a remote electrical measurement site, the temperature of the test devices shall not be
allowed to increase by more than +10C from the irradiation environment. If any other temperature range is
required, it shall be specified.
METHOD 1019.5
3
3.8 Electrical performance measurements. The electrical parameters to be measured, and functional tests to be
performed, shall be specified in the test plan. As a check on the validity of the measurement system and pre- and
post-irradiation data, at least one control sample shall be measured using the operating conditions provided in the
governing device specifications. For automatic test equipment (ATE), there is no restriction on the test sequence
provided that the rise in the device junction temperature is minimized. For manual measurements, the sequence of
parameter measurements shall be chosen to allow the shortest possible measurement period. When a series of
measurements is made, the tests shall be arranged so that the lowest power dissipation in the device occurs in the
earliest measurements and the power dissipation increases with subsequent measurements in the sequence. The
pre- and post-irradiation electrical measurements shall be done on the same measurement system and the same
sequence of measurements shall be maintained for each series of electrical measurements of devices in a test
sample. Pulse type measurements of electrical parameter should be used as appropriate to minimize heating and
subsequent annealing effects. Devices which will be subjected to the accelerated annealing testing (see 3.12) may
be given a pre-irradiation burn-in to eliminate burn-in related failures.
3.9 Test conditions The use of in-flux or not in-flux shall be specified in the test plan. (This may depend on the
intended application for which the data is being obtained.) The use of in-flux testing may help to avoid variations
introduced by post-irradiation time dependent effects. However, errors may be incurred for the situation where a
device is irradiated in-flux with static bias, but where the electrical testing conditions require the use of dynamic bias
for a fraction of the total irradiation period. Not in-flux testing generally allows for more comprehensive electrical
testing, but can be misleading if significant post-irradiation time dependent effects occur.
3.9.1 In-flux testing. Each test device shall be checked for operation within specifications prior to being irradiated.
After the entire system is in place for the in-flux radiation test, it shall be checked for proper interconnections,
leakage (see 2.4), and noise level. To assure the proper operation and stability of the test setup, a control device
with known parameter values shall be measured at all operational conditions called for in the test plan. This
measurement shall be done either before the insertion of test devices or upon completion of the irradiation after
removal of the test devices or both.
3.9.2 Remote testing. Unless otherwise specified, the bias shall be removed and the device leads placed in
conductive foam (or similarly shorted) during transfer from the irradiation source to a remote tester and back again
for further irradiation. This minimizes post-irradiation time dependent effects.
3.9.3 Bias and loading conditions. Bias conditions for test devices during irradiation or accelerated annealing
shall be within 10 percent of those specified by the test plan. (If known, the bias applied to the test devices shall be
selected to produce the greatest radiation induced damage or the worst-case damage for the intended application.)
The specified bias shall be maintained on each device in accordance with the test plan. Bias shall be checked
immediately before and after irradiation. Care shall be taken in selecting the loading such that the rise in the junction
temperature is minimized.
3.10 Post-irradiation procedure. Unless otherwise specified, the following time intervals shall be observed:
a. The time from the end of an irradiation to the start of electrical measurements shall be a maximum of 1
hour.
b. The time to perform the electrical measurements and to return the devices for a subsequent irradiation, if
any, shall be within two 2 hours of the end of the prior irradiation.
To minimize time dependent effects, these intervals shall be as short as possible. The sequence of parameter
measurements shall be maintained constant through the test series.
METHOD 1019.5
4
3.11 Extended room temperature anneal test. The tests of 3.1 through 3.10 are known to be overly conservative
for some devices in a very low dose rate environment (e.g. dose rates characteristic of space missions). The
extended room temperature anneal test provides an estimate of the performance of a device in a very low dose rate
environment even though the testing is performed at a relatively high dose rate (e.g. 50 to 300 rad(Si)/s). The
procedure involves irradiating the device in accordance with tests 3.1 through 3.10 and post-irradiation subjecting
the DUT to a room temperature anneal for an appropriate period of time (see 3.11.2c) to allow leakage related
parameters that may have exceeded their pre-irradiation specification to return to within specification. The procedure
is known to lead to a higher rate of device acceptance in cases:
a. Where device failure, when subjected to the tests in 3.1 through 3.10, has been caused by the buildup of
trapped positive charge in relatively soft oxides, and
3.11.1 Need to perform an extended room temperature anneal test. The following criteria shall be used to
determine whether an extended room temperature anneal test is appropriate:
b. The procedure is appropriate where only parametric failures (as opposed to functional failure) occurs. The
parties to the test shall take appropriate steps to determine that the DUT is subject to only parametric failure
over the total ionizing dose testing range.
c. The procedure is appropriate where the natural annealing response of the DUT will serve to correct the out of
specification of any parametric response. Further, the procedure is known to lead to a higher rate of device
acceptance in cases where the expected application irradiation dose rate is sufficiently low that ambient
temperature annealing of the radiation induced trapped positive charge can lead to a significant
improvement of device behavior. Cases where the expected application dose rate is lower than the test
dose rate, and lower than 0.1 rad(Si)/s, should be considered candidates for the application of this
procedure. The parties to the test shall take appropriate steps to determine that the technology under test
can provide the required annealing response over the total ionizing dose testing range.
3.11.2 Extended room temperature anneal test procedure. If the device fails the irradiation and testing specified in
3.1 through 3.10, an additional room temperature annealing test may be performed as follows:
a. Following the irradiation and testing of 3.1 through 3.10, subject the DUT to a room temperature anneal
under worst-case static bias conditions. For information on worst case bias see 3.9.3.
b. The test will be carried out in such a fashion that the case of the DUT will have a temperature within the
range 24C 6C.
c. Where possible, the room temperature anneal should continue for a length of time great enough to allow
device parameters that have exceeded their pre-irradiation specification to return to within specification or
post-irradiation parametric limit (PIPL) as established by the manufacturer. However, the time of the room
temperature anneal shall not exceed tmax, where
tmax = Dspec__
Rmax
Dspec is the total ionizing dose specification for the part and Rmax is the maximum dose rate for the intended
use.
d. Test the DUT for electrical performance as specified in 3.7 and 3.8. If the DUT passes electrical performance
tests following the extended room temperature anneal, this shall be considered acceptable performance for a
very low dose rate environment in spite of having previously failed the post-irradiation and electrical tests of
3.1 through 3.10.
METHOD 1019.5
5
3.12 MOS accelerated annealing test. The accelerated annealing test provides an estimate of worst-case
degradation of MOS devices in low dose rate environments. The procedure involves heating the device following
irradiation at a specified temperature, time, and bias conditions. An accelerated annealing test (see 3.12.2) shall be
performed for cases where time dependent effects (TDE) can cause a device to degrade significantly or fail. Only
standard testing shall be performed as specified in 3.1 through 3.10 for cases where TDE are known not to cause
significant device degradation or failure (see 3.12.1), or where they do not need to be considered, as specified in
3.12.1.
3.12.1 Need to perform accelerated annealing test. The parties to the test shall take appropriate steps to
determine whether accelerated annealing testing is required. The following criteria shall be used:
a. The tests called out in 3.12.2 shall be performed for any MOS device.
(3) The lifetime of the device from the onset of the irradiation in the intended application, if known, is short
compared with TDE times, or
(4) The test is carried out at the dose rate of the intended application, or
(5) The device has been demonstrated via characterization testing not to exhibit TDE changes in device
parameters greater than experimental error (or greater than an otherwise specified upper limit) and the
variables that affect TDE response are demonstrated to be under control for the specific vendor
processes.
c. This document provides no guidance on the need to perform accelerated annealing tests on non-MOS
devices.
3.12.2 Accelerated annealing test procedure. If the device passes the tests in 3.1 through 3.10, or if it passes 3.11
(if that procedure is used), to the total ionizing dose level specified in the test plan or device specification or drawing
and the exclusions of 3.12.1 do not apply, the accelerated annealing test shall be conducted as follows:
a. Overtest. Irradiate each test device to an additional 0.5 times the specified dose using the standard test
conditions (3.1 through 3.10). Note that no electrical testing is required at this time.
b. Accelerated annealing. Heat each device under worst-case static bias conditions in an environmental
chamber according to one of the following conditions:
(2) At an alternate temperature and time that has been demonstrated via characterization testing to cause
equal or greater change in the parameter(s) of interest, in each test device as that caused by 3.12.2.b.1,
or
(3) At an alternate temperature and time which will cause trapped hole annealing of >60 percent and
interface state annealing of <10 percent as determined via characterization testing.
c. Electrical testing. Following the accelerated annealing, the electrical test measurements shall be performed
as specified in 3.8 and 3.9.
METHOD 1019.5
6
3.13 Bipolar transistor delta(1/hFE) post irradiation [hFE] gain calculations. Bipolar transistors require special
calculations to report their post-irradiation performance. One of the following two calculations may be required:
(a) Delta(1/hFE): Let hFE1 be the measured hFE at a specific test point (Vce, Ic) prior to irradiation. Let hFE2 be
the measured hFE post-irradiation at that same test point. Then: Delta(1/hFE) = (1/hFE) = 1/hFE2 1/hFE1
and is unitless as is hFE.
Example: hFE1 = 200 before irradiation and post-irradiation it has decreased to hFE2 = 125. Then:
(1/hFE) = 1/125 1/200 = 0.00300.
(b) [hFE] calculation is not a directly measured value of hFE but, rather, a calculated value used by system
analysis engineers. It signifies exactly how well the bipolar transistor will perform in the system after
exposure to a radiation fluence. This [hFE] is denoted in square brackets [ ] to delineate it from any
measured value of hFE and uses the calculated values from 3.13.a but adds one additional term.
Calculate as follows:
Let hFE(min) be the pre-irradiation spec minimum h FE limit at the same test point in 3.13.a. Then:
[hFE] = inverse { (1/hFE) + 1/hFE)min }
Example: hFE(min) = 100 and, in accordance with 3.13.a, (1/hFE) = 0.00300. Then:
[hFE] = inverse { 0.00300 + 1/100 } = inverse { 0.003 + 0.01 } = 1 / { 0.013} = 76.92.
(c) When (1/hFE), [hFE] or both are required by the control specification, these calculations will only be
required on the irradiation test samples. The test report in 3.14 shall then contain, in spreadsheet fashion,
the appropriate pre and post hFE measurements as well as the required calculation results. Unless
otherwise specified, all devices shall adhere to the specification maximum hFE limits that were imposed
pre-irradiation.
3.14 Test report. As a minimum, the report shall include the device type number, serial number, CAGE code of the
manufacturer, package type, controlling specification, date code, and any other identifying numbers given by the
manufacturer. The bias circuit, parameter measurement circuits, the layout of the test apparatus with details of
distances and materials used, and electrical noise and current leakage of the electrical measurement system for in-
flux testing shall be reported using drawings or diagrams as appropriate. Each data sheet shall include the test date,
the radiation source used, the bias conditions during irradiation, the ambient temperature around the devices during
irradiation and electrical testing, the duration of each irradiation, the time between irradiation and the start of the
electrical measurements, the duration of the electrical measurements and the time to the next irradiation when step
irradiations are used, the irradiation dose rate, electrical test conditions, dosimetry system and procedures, and the
radiation test levels. The pre- and post-irradiation data shall be recorded for each part and retained with the parent
population data in accordance with the requirements of MIL-PRF-19500. Any anomalous incidents during the test
shall be fully documented and reported. The accelerated annealing procedure, if used, shall be described. Any other
radiation test procedures or test data required for the delivery shall be specified in the device specification, drawing,
or order.
METHOD 1019.5
7
4. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable acquisition document as required.
c. Radiation test levels including dose and dose rate (see 3.5 and 3.6).
d. Irradiation, electrical test, and transport temperature; if other than as specified in 3.7.
e. Electrical parameters to be measured and device operating conditions during measurement (see 3.8).
f. Test conditions, i.e., in-flux or not in-flux type tests (see 3.8 and 3.9).
i. Requirement for extended room temperature anneal test, if required (see 3.11).
METHOD 1019.5
8
METHOD 1020.2
1. Purpose. This method establishes the procedure for classifying semiconductors according to their
susceptibility to damage or degradation by exposure to electrostatic discharge (ESD). This classification is used to
specify appropriate packaging and handling requirements in accordance with MIL-PRF-19500, and to provide
classification data to meet the requirements of MIL-STD-1686.
1.1 Definitions. The following definition shall apply for the purposes of this test method.
1.1.1 ESD. A transfer of electrostatic charge between two bodies at different electrostatic potentials.
2. Apparatus.
2.1 Test apparatus. ESD pulse simulator and device under test (DUT) socket equivalent to the circuit of figure
1020-1, and capable of supplying pulses with the characteristics required by figure 1020-2.
2.2 Measurement equipment. Equipment, including an oscilloscope and current probe, to verify conformance of
the simulator output pulse to the requirements of figure 1020-2.
2.2.1 Oscilloscope and amplifier. The oscilloscope and amplifier combination shall have a 350 MHz minimum
bandwidth and a visual writing speed of 4 cm/ns minimum.
2.2.2 Current probe. The current probe shall have a minimum bandwidth of 350 MHz (e.g., Tektronix CT-1 at
1,000 MHz).
2.2.3 Charging of voltage probe. The charging voltage probe shall have a minimum input resistance of 1,000 M
and a division ratio of 4 percent maximum (e.g., HP 34111A).
2.3 Calibration. Periodic calibration shall include, but not be limited to, the following.
2.3.1 Charging voltage. The meter used to display the simulator charging voltage shall be calibrated to indicate
the actual voltage at points C and D of figure 1020-1, over the range specified in table 1020-I.
2.3.2 Effective capacitance. Effective capacitance shall be determined by charging C1 to the specified voltage
(see table 1020-I), with no device in the test socket and the test switch open, and by discharging C1 into an
electrometer, coulombmeter, or calibrated capacitor connected between points A and B of figure 1020-1. The
effective capacitance shall be 100 pF 10 percent over the specified voltage range and shall be periodically verified
at 1,000 volts. (NOTE: A series resistor may be needed to slow the discharge and obtain a valid measurement.)
2.3.3 Current waveform. The procedure of 3.2 shall be performed for each voltage step of table 1020-I. The
current waveform at each step shall meet the requirements of figure 1020-2.
2.4 Qualification. Apparatus acceptance tests shall be performed on new equipment or after major repair.
Testing shall include, but not be limited to, the following.
2.4.1 Current waveform verification. Current waveform shall be verified at every pin of each test fixture using the
pin nearest terminal B (see figure 1020-1) as the reference point. All waveforms shall meet the requirements of
figure 1020-2. The pin pair representing the worst case (closest to the limits) waveform shall be identified and used
for the verification required by 3.2.
3. Procedure.
3.1 General.
3.1.1 Test circuit. Classification testing shall be performed using a test circuit equivalent to figure 1020-1 to
produce the waveform shown on figure 1020-2.
3.1.2 Test temperature. Each device shall be stabilized at room temperature prior to and during testing.
3.1.3 ESD classification testing. ESD classification testing of devices shall be considered destructive.
METHOD 1020.2
1 of 5
3.2 ESD simulator current waveform verification. To ensure proper simulator operation, the current waveform
verification procedure shall be done, as a minimum, at the beginning of each shift when ESD testing is performed, or
prior to testing after each change of the socket/board, whichever is sooner. At the time of initial facility certification
and recertifications, photographs shall be taken of the waveforms observed as required by 3.2.c. through 3.2.e. and
be kept on file for purposes of audit and comparison. (Stored digitized representations of the waveforms are
acceptable in place of photographs.)
a. With the DUT socket installed on the simulator, and with no DUT in the socket, place a short (see figure
1020-1) across two pins of the DUT socket and connect one of the pins to simulator terminal A and the
other pin to terminal B.
b. Connect the current probe around the short near terminal B (see figure 1020-1). Set the simulator
charging voltage source VS to 4,000 volts corresponding to step 4 of table 1020-1.
c. Initiate a simulator pulse and observe the leading edge of the current waveform. The current waveform
shall meet the rise time, peak current, and ringing requirements of figure 1020-2.
d. Initiate a simulator pulse again and observe the complete current waveform. The pulse shall meet the
decay time and ringing requirement of figure 1020-2.
e. Repeat the above verification procedure using the opposite polarity (VS = 4,000 volts).
f. It is recommended that the simulator output be checked to verify that there is only one pulse per initiation,
and that there is no pulse while capacitor C1 is being charged. To observe the recharge transient, set the
trigger to the opposite polarity, increase the vertical sensitivity by approximately a factor of ten, and initiate
a pulse.
a. A sample of devices (see 4.c) shall be characterized for the device ESD failure threshold using the voltage
steps shown in table 1020-I, as a minimum. Finer voltage steps may optionally be used to obtain a more
accurate measure of the failure voltage. Testing may begin at any voltage step, except for devices which
have demonstrated healing effects, including those with spark gap protection, which shall be started at the
lowest step. Examination of known technology family input or output V/I damage characteristics (i.e., curve
tracer), or other simplified test verification techniques may be used to validate the failure threshold (e.g.,
cumulative damage effects may be eliminated by retesting at the failure voltage step using a new sample
of devices and possibly passing the step).
b. A new sample of devices shall be selected and subjected to the next lower voltage step used. Each device
shall be tested using three positive and three negative pulses using each of the pin combinations shown in
table 1020-II. A minimum of one-second delay shall separate the pulses.
c. The sample device shall be electrically tested to group A, subgroup II of the specification sheet as
applicable (room temperature dc parameters).
d. If one or more of the devices fail, the testing of 3.3.b and 3.3.c shall be repeated at the next lower voltage
step used.
METHOD 1020.2
2
e. If none of the devices fail, record the failure threshold determined in 3.3.a. Note the highest step passed
and use it to classify the device in accordance with table 1020-III.
Using table 1020-II, select the terminal to be used for the ESD tests.
Class Voltage
a. Devices which fail the post test electrical at +25C of group A, subgroup 2 of the specification sheet shall be
considered class 1 devices.
b. All devices subjected to this test shall be considered destroyed and shall not be shipped for use in any
application.
METHOD 1020.2
3
4. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable order or contract, if other than specified
herein.
R1 = 106 to 107
C1 = 100 pF 10 percent (Insulation resistance 1012 minimum)
R2 = 1,500 1 percent
S1 = High voltage relay (Bounceless, mercury wetted, or equivalent
S2 = Normally closed switch (Open during discharge pulse and capacitance measurement)
NOTES:
1. The performance of this simulator circuit is strongly influenced by parasitics. Capacitances across relays
and resistor terminals, and series inductance in wiring and in all components, shall be minimized.
2. As a precaution against transients upon recharge of C1, the supply voltage VS may be reduced before
switch S1 is returned to the charging position.
3. Piggybacking DUT sockets is not permitted during verification or classification testing.
4. Switching terminals A and B internal to the simulator to obtain opposite polarity is not recommended.
5. C1 represents the effective capacitance (see 2.3.2).
6. The current probe connection shall be made with double shielded cable into a 50 termination at the
oscilloscope. The cable length shall not exceed 3 feet.
METHOD 1020.2
4
NOTES:
1. The current waveforms shown shall be measured as described in the waveform verification
procedure of 3.2, using equipment meeting the requirements of section 2 herein.
2. The current pulse shall have the following characteristics:
FIGURE 1020-2. ESD classification test circuit waveforms (human body model).
METHOD 1020.2
5
METHOD 1021.3
MOISTURE RESISTANCE
1. Purpose. The moisture resistance test is performed for the purpose of evaluating, in an accelerated manner,
the resistance of component parts and constituent materials to the deteriorative effects of the high-humidity and heat
conditions typical of tropical environments. Most tropical degradation results directly or indirectly from absorption of
moisture vapor and films by vulnerable insulating materials, and from surface wetting of metals and insulation.
These phenomena produce many types of deterioration, including corrosion of metals; constituents of materials; and
detrimental changes in electrical properties. This test differs from the steady-state humidity test and derives its
added effectiveness in its employment of temperature cycling, which provides alternate periods of condensation and
drying essential to the development of the corrosion processes and, in addition, produces a "breathing" action of
moisture into partially sealed containers. Increased effectiveness is also obtained by use of a higher temperature,
which intensifies the effects of humidity. The test includes a low-temperature subcycle that acts as an accelerator to
reveal otherwise indiscernible evidences of deterioration since stresses caused by freezing moisture tend to widen
cracks and fissures. As a result, the deterioration can be detected by the measurement of electrical characteristics
(including such tests as voltage breakdown and insulation resistance) or by performance of a test for sealing.
Provision is made for the application of a polarizing voltage across insulation to investigate the possibility of
electrolysis, which can promote eventual dielectric breakdown. This test also provides for electrical loading of
certain components, if desired, in order to determine the resistance of current-carrying components, especially fine
wires and contacts, to electrochemical corrosion. Results obtained with this test are reproducible and have been
confirmed by investigations of field failures. This test has proved reliable for indicating those parts which are
unsuited for tropical field use.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus used for the moisture resistance test shall include temperature-humidity chambers
capable of maintaining the cycles and tolerance described on figure 1021-1 and electrical test equipment capable of
performing the measurements in 3.6 and 4.
3. Procedure. Specimens shall be tested in accordance with 3.2 through 3.7 inclusive, and figure 1021-1.
Specimens shall be mounted in a manner that will expose them to the test environment.
3.1 Initial conditioning. Unless otherwise specified and prior to mounting specimens for the moisture resistance
test, the device leads shall be subjected to a bending stress, initial conditioning in accordance with test condition E
of method 2036. Where the specific sample devices being subjected to the moisture resistance test have already
been subjected to the required initial conditioning, as part of another test employing the same sample devices, the
lead bend need not be repeated.
3.2 Initial measurements. Prior to step 1 of the first cycle, the specified initial measurements shall be made at
room ambient conditions, or as specified. When specified, the initial conditioning in a dry oven (see figure 1021-1)
shall precede initial measurements and the initial measurements shall be completed within 8 hours after removal
from the drying oven.
3.3 Number of cycles. Specimens shall be subjected to ten continuous cycles, each as shown on figure 1021-1.
In the event of no more than one unintentional test interruption (power interruption or equipment failure) prior to the
completion of the specified number of cycles (except for the last cycle) the cycle shall be repeated and the test may
continue. Unintentional interruptions occurring during the last cycle require a repeat of the cycle plus an additional
uninterrupted cycle. Any intentional interruption, or any unintentional interruption of greater than 24 hours, requires
completion of missing cycles plus one additional cycle.
3.4 Subcycle of step 7. During at least five of the ten cycles, a low temperature subcycle shall be performed. At
least 1 hour, but not more than 4 hours, after step 7 begins, the specimens shall be either removed from the
humidity chamber, or the temperature of the chamber shall be reduced, for performance of the subcycle. Specimens
during the subcycle shall be conditioned at -10C +2C, -5C, with humidity not controlled, for 3 hours minimum as
indicated on figure 1021-1. When a separate cold chamber is not used, care should be taken to assure that the
specimens are held at -10C +2C, -5C for the full period. After the subcycle, the specimens shall be returned to
+25C at 80 percent RH minimum and kept there until the next cycle begins.
METHOD 1021.3
1 of 4
3.5 Applied voltage. During the moisture resistance test as specified on figure 1021-1, when specified (see 4),
the device shall be biased in accordance with the specified bias configuration which should be chosen to maximize
the voltage differential between chip metallization runs or external terminals, minimize power dissipation, and to
utilize as many terminals as possible to enhance test results.
3.6 Conditions (see figure 1021-1). The rate of change of temperature in the chamber is unspecified; however,
specimens shall not be subject to the radiant heat from the chamber conditioning processes. Unless otherwise
specified, the circulation of air in the chamber shall be at a minimum cubic rate per minute equivalent to five times
the volume of the chamber. The steady-state temperature tolerance is 2C of the specified temperature at all
points within the immediate vicinity of the specimens and at the chamber surfaces. Specimens weighing 25 pounds
or less shall be transferred between temperature chambers in less than 2 minutes.
3.7 Final measurements. Following step 6 of the final cycle (or step 7 if the subcycle of 3.3 is performed during
the tenth cycle), devices shall be conditioned for 24 hours at room ambient conditions after which either an insulation
resistance test in accordance with method 1016, or the specified +25C electrical end-point measurements shall be
performed. Electrical measurements may be made during the 24 hour conditioning period. However, any failures
resulting from this testing shall be counted, and any retesting of these failures later in the 24 hour period for the
purpose of obtaining an acceptable result is prohibited. No other test (e.g., seal) shall be performed during the 24
hour conditioning period. The insulation resistance test or the alternative +25C electrical end-point measurements
shall be completed within 48 hours after removing the devices from the chamber. When the insulation resistance
test is performed, the measured resistance shall be no less than 10 M and the test shall be recorded and data
submitted as part of the end-point data. If the package case is electrically connected to the die substrate by design,
the insulation resistance test shall be omitted and the specified +25C electrical end-point measurements shall be
completed within 48 hours after removal of the device from the chamber. A visual examination and any other
specified end-point electrical parameter measurements (see 4.c) shall also be performed.
a. Specified markings which are missing in whole or in part, faded, smeared, blurred, shifted, or dislodged to
the extent that they are not legible. This examination shall be conducted with normal room lighting and
with a magnification of 1X to 3X.
b. Evidence of corrosion over more than five percent of the area of the finish or base metal of any package
element (i.e., lid, lead, or cap) or any corrosion that completely crosses the element when viewed with a
magnification of 10X to 20X.
d. Corrosion formations which bridge between leads, or between leads and metal case.
NOTE: The finish shall include the package and entire exposed lead area from meniscus to the lead tip (excluding
the sheared off tip itself) and all other exposed metal surfaces.
4. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable acquisition document:
a. Initial measurements and conditions, if other than room ambient see 3.1.
b. Applied voltage, when applicable see 3.5, and bias configuration, when required. This bias configuration
shall be chosen in accordance with the following guidelines:
(1) Only one supply voltage (V) either positive or negative is required, and an electrical ground (GND) or
common terminal. The magnitude of V will be the maximum such that the specified absolute
maximum ratings are not exceeded and test conditions are optimized.
(2)
Unless otherwise specified, all normally specified voltage terminals and ground leads shall be
connected to GND.
METHOD 1021.3
2
(3) Unless otherwise specified, all data inputs shall be connected to V. The polarity and magnitude of V
is chosen to minimize internal power dissipation and current flow into the device. Unless otherwise
specified, all extender inputs shall be connected to GND.
(4) All additional leads (e.g. clock, set, reset, outputs) considered individually, shall be connected to V or
GND, whichever minimizes current flow.
(5) Leads with no internal connection shall be biased to V or GND whichever is opposite to an adjacent
lead.
c. Final measurements (see 3.7). Final measurements shall include all electrical characteristics and
parameters which are specified as end-point electrical parameters.
METHOD 1021.3
3
NOTE: The subcycle of step 7 (see 3.4) shall be performed for a minimum of five of the ten cycles. Humidity is
uncontrolled for the -10C portion of step 7.
METHOD 1021.3
4
METHOD 1022.5
RESISTANCE TO SOLVENTS
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to verify that the markings will not become illegible on the component
parts when subjected to solvents. The solvents will not cause deleterious, mechanical or electrical damage, or
deterioration of the materials or finishes.
1.1 Formulation of solvents. The formulation of solvents herein is considered typical and representative of the
desired stringency as far as the usual coatings and markings are concerned. Many available solvents which could
be used are either not sufficiently active, too stringent, or even dangerous to humans when in direct contact or when
the fumes are inhaled.
1.2 Check for conflicts. When this test is referenced, care should be exercised to assure that conflicting
requirements, as far as the properties of the specified finishes and markings are concerned, are not invoked.
2. Materials.
2.1 Solvent solutions. The solvent solutions used in this test shall consist of the following:
(1) One part by volume of isopropyl alcohol, A.C.S. (American Chemical Society) Reagent Grade, or
isopropyl alcohol in accordance with TT-I-735, grade A or B.
(2) Three parts by volume of mineral spirits in accordance with MIL-PRF-680, type II, grade A, or three
parts by volume of a mixture of 80 percent by volume of kerosene and 20 percent by volume
ethylbenzene.
b. A semiaqueous based solvent (defluxer (e.g., a turpene)) consisting of a minimum of 60 percent Limonene
and a surfactant heated to +32C 5C. 1/
2.1.1 Solvent solutions, safety aspects. Solvent solutions listed in 2.1 herein exhibit some potential for health and
safety hazards. The following safety precautions should be observed:
2.2 Vessel. The vessel shall be a container made of inert material, and of sufficient size to permit complete
immersion of the specimens in the solvent solutions specified in 2.1.
2.3 Brush. The brush shall be a brush with a handle made of a nonreactive material. The brush shall have three
long rows of hard bristles, the free ends of which shall lie substantially in the same plane. The brush shall be used
exclusively with a single solvent and when there is any evidence of softening, bending, wear, or loss of bristles, it
shall be discarded.
3. Procedure. The specimens subjected to this test shall be divided into three groups. Metal lidded leadless chip
carrier (LCC) packages shall be preconditioned by immersing the specimens in room temperature ROL1 flux (in
accordance with J-STD-004A, Requirements for Soldering Fluxes) for 5 to 10 seconds. The specimens shall then be
subjected to an ambient temperature of +215C 5C for 60 seconds +5, -0 seconds. After the preconditioning,
each device lid shall be cleaned with isopropyl alcohol. Each group shall be individually subjected to one of the
following procedures:
a. The first group shall be subjected to the solvent solution as specified in 2.1.a. maintained at a temperature
of +25C 5C.
b. The second group shall be subjected to the solvent solution as specified in 2.1.b. maintained at a
temperature of +32C 5C.
c. The third group shall be subjected to the solvent solution as specified in 2.1.c. maintained at a
temperature of +63C to +70C.
The specimens and the bristle portion of the brush shall be completely immersed for 1 minute minimum in the
specified solution contained in the vessel specified in 2.2. Immediately following immersion, the specimen shall be
brushed with normal hand pressure (approximately 2 to 3 ounces) for ten strokes on the portion of the specimen
where marking has been applied, with the brush specified in 2.3. Immediately after brushing, the above procedure
shall be repeated two additional times, for a total of three immersions followed by brushings. The brush stroke shall
be directed in a forward direction, across the surface of the specimen being tested. After completion of the third
immersion and brushing, devices shall be rinsed and all surfaces air blown dry. After 5 minutes, the specimens shall
be examined to determine the extent, if any, of deterioration that was incurred.
3.1 Optional procedure for the third group. The test specimens shall be located on a test surface of known area
which is located 6 1 inches (15.24 2.54 centimeters) below a spray nozzle(s) which discharges 0.139 gpm
(0.6 .0.02 liters/ minute) of solution (see 2.1.c) 1 in2 (6.5 square centimeters) of surface area at a pressure of 20 5
psi (137.90 34.41 kilopascal). The specimens shall be subjected to this spray for a period of 10 minutes minimum.
Within five minutes after removal of the specimens, they shall be examined in accordance with 3.1.1. The
specimens may be rinsed with clear water and air blown dried prior to examination.
3.1.1 Failure criteria. After subject to the test, evidence of damage to the device and any specified markings
which are missing in whole or in part, faded, smeared, blurred, or shifted (dislodged) to the extent that they cannot
be readily identified from a distance of at least 6 inches (15.24 cm) with normal room lighting, and without the aid of
magnification, or with a viewer having a magnification no greater than 3X, shall constitute a failure.
4. Summary. The number of specimens to be tested shall be specified in the individual specification (see 3.).
METHOD 1022.5
2
METHOD 1026.5
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine compliance with the specified lambda () for devices
subjected to the specified conditions.
2. Procedure. The semiconductor device shall be subjected to the steady-state operation life test at the
temperature specified for the time period in accordance with the life test requirements of MIL-PRF-19500 and herein.
The device shall be operated under the specified conditions.
Unless otherwise specified, lead-mounted devices should be mounted by the leads with jig mounting clips at least
.375 inch (9.5 mm) from the body, or from the lead tabulation, if the lead tubulation projects from the body. Unless
otherwise specified, mounting and connections to surface mount devices shall be made only at their terminations.
Unless a free-air life test is specified, case mounted device types (e.g., stud, flange, disc) shall be mounted by their
normal case surface. The point of connection shall be maintained at a temperature not less than the specified
temperature.
After the termination of the test, or in accordance with the period specified in MIL-PRF-19500 and the performance
specification, if otherwise defined, the sample units shall be removed from the specified test conditions and allowed
to reach standard test conditions. Specified end-point measurements for qualification and quality conformance
inspection shall be completed within 96 hours after removal of sample units from the specified test conditions.
Additional readings may be taken at the discretion of the manufacturer. If end-point measurements cannot be
performed within the specified time, the devices shall be subjected to the same test conditions for a minimum of 24
additional hours before post test measurements are performed.
a. Test type and details; rectifying or forward dc current and Vr for rectifiers and signal diodes, dc power (or
current) for zener diodes, power (and range of VCE and VDS) for bipolar and FETs (see 2).
METHOD 1026.5
1 of 1
METHOD 1027.3
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine compliance with the specified sample plan for devices
subjected to the specified conditions.
2. Procedure. Unless otherwise specified, the semiconductor device shall be subjected to the steady-state
operation test at the temperature specified for 340 hours minimum. The device shall be operated under the
specified conditions.
Unless otherwise specified, lead-mounted devices should be mounted by the leads with jig mounting clips at least
.375 inch (9.5 mm) from the body or from the lead tubulation if the lead tubulation projects from the body. Unless
otherwise specified, mounting and connections to surface mount devices shall be made only at their terminations.
Unless free-air life test is specified, case mounted device types (e.g., stud, flange, disc) shall be mounted by their
normal case surface. The point of connection shall be maintained at a temperature not less than the specified
temperature.
After the termination of the test, or in accordance with the period specified by MIL-PRF-19500 and the performance
specification if otherwise defined, the sample units shall be removed from the specified test conditions and allowed
to reach standard test conditions. Specified end-point measurements for qualification and quality conformance
inspection shall be completed within 96 hours after removal of sample units from the specified test conditions.
Additional readings may be taken at the discretion of the manufacturer. If end-point measurements cannot be
performed within the specified time, the devices shall be subjected to the same test conditions for a minimum of 24
additional hours before post test measurements are performed.
a. Test type and details; rectifying or forward dc current and Vr for rectifiers and signal diodes, dc power (or
current) for zener diodes, power (and range of VCE and VDS) for bipolar and FETs (see 2).
METHOD 1027.3
1 of 1
METHOD 1031.5
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determined compliance with the specified lambda ( ) for devices
subjected to the specified conditions.
2. Procedure. The device shall be stored under the specified ambient conditions (normally the maximum
temperature) for a time period in accordance with the life test requirements of MIL-PRF-19500. In accordance with
the life test period specified by MIL-PRF-19500, the sample units shall be removed from the specified ambient
conditions and allowed to reach standard test conditions. Specified end-point measurements for qualification and
quality conformance inspection shall be completed within 96 hours after removal of sample units from the specified
ambient conditions. If measurements can not be performed within the specified time, the devices shall be subjected
to the same test conditions for a minimum of 24 additional hours before post test measurements are performed.
Additional readings may be taken at the discretion of the manufacturer.
2.1 Visual examination. The markings shall be legible after the test. There shall be no evidence (when examined
without magnification) of flaking or pitting of the finish or corrosion that will interfere with the mechanical and
electrical application of the device.
METHOD 1031.5
1 of 1
METHOD 1032.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine compliance with the specified sample plan for devices
subjected to the specified conditions.
2. Procedure. Unless otherwise specified, the device shall be stored under the specified ambient conditions
(normally the maximum temperature) 340 hours minimum. The sample units shall be removed from the specified
ambient conditions and allowed to reach standard test conditions. Specified end-point measurements for
qualification and quality conformance inspection shall be completed within 96 hours after removal of sample units
from the specified ambient conditions. If measurements cannot be performed within the specified time, the devices
shall be subjected to the same test conditions for a minimum of 24 hours before post test measurements are
performed. Additional readings may be taken at the discretion of the manufacturer.
2.1 Visual examination. The markings shall be legible after the test. There shall be no evidence (when examined
without magnification) of flaking or pitting of the finish or corrosion that will interfere with the mechanical and
electrical application of the device.
METHOD 1032.2
1 of 1
METHOD 1033
1. Purpose. This test method is designed to evaluate the short tem leakage stability of product under reverse
bias conditioning. It is not intended to replace, nor does it duplicate, the high temperature reverse bias conditioning.
The failure mechanisms that are addressed in this test method are not sustained upon the removal of applied bias to
the device. As an example; certain semiconductor designs are quite susceptible to unstable reverse leakage due to
the presence of hydrogen in the device. This method can be used to ascertain the susceptibility of a technology to
this type of a problem or the effectiveness of countermeasures.
2. Procedure. Condition A: Apply to the DUT at room temperature, +25C, a minimum of 80 percent of the
specified Vcb, Vds, Vr as applicable. Apply bias and measure and record the leakage current.
After 1 hour minimum re-measure and record the reverse leakage of the device. Interruption of the applied bias for
any reason between the pre- and post-leakage measurements invalidates the test. Bias shall not be interrupted to
make the reverse leakage measurement.
3. Failure criteria. The following shall be used as the pass/fail criteria for this test:
4. Condition B. Sweep the voltage in the BVCEO mode until the breakdown of the device is observed and study
the breakdown leakage plot for a minimum of 10 seconds for stability. An unstable plot will be considered any device
which exhibits one or more of the following:
a. Collapsing.
b. Leakage increasing.
A device will be considered passing when none of the instability modes are noticed from 4.a and 4.b after a period of
approximately 10 seconds. The device will be then subjected to a leakage test.
Sweep the voltage of the device to the maximum leakage identified on the applicable performance specification
sheet. Observe the amplitude of the leakage. Leakage is defined as Icbo, Ices, or Icex as specified in the applicable
performance specification.
After 30 seconds minimum, the maximum change in leakage allowed is as specified for burn-in in the performance
specification.
Perform the breakdown and leakage on the specified number of samples in accordance with the individual
performance specification. One hundred percent must be performed on the entire lot if any device from the sample
fails the above tests.
METHOD 1033
1 of 1
METHOD 1036.3
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine compliance with the specified lambda () for devices
subjected to the specified conditions.
2. Procedure. The device shall be subjected intermittently to the specified operating and nonoperating conditions
for the time period in accordance with the life test requirements of MIL-PRF-19500. The on- and off-periods shall be
initiated by sudden, not gradual, application or removal of the specified operating conditions. Lead-mounted devices
should be mounted by the leads with jig mounting clips at least .375 inch (9.5 mm) from the body or lead tubulation,
if the lead tubulation projects from the body. The point of connection shall be maintained at a temperature not less
than the specified temperature. Within the time interval of 24 hours before to 72 hours after termination of the test,
in accordance with the life test period specified by MIL-PRF-19500, the sample units shall be removed from the
specified test conditions and allowed to reach standard test conditions. Specified end-point measurements for
qualification and quality conformance inspection shall be completed within 96 hours after removal of sample units
from the specified test conditions. Additional readings may be taken at the discretion of the manufacturer.
METHOD 1036.3
1 of 1
METHOD 1037.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine compliance with the specified numbers of cycles for devices
subjected to the specified conditions. It accelerates the stresses on all bonds and interfaces between the chip and
mounting face of devices subjected to repeated turn on and off of equipment and is therefore most appropriate for
case mount style (e.g., stud, flange, and disc) devices.
2. Mounting. Clips or fixtures appropriate for holding the device terminations and reliably conducting the heating
current shall be used. This method is intended to allow the case temperature to rise and fall appreciably as the
junction is heated and cooled; thus it is not appropriate to use a large heat sink. Lead-mounted devices, when
specified, should be mounted by the leads with jig mounting clips at least .375 inch (9.5 mm) from the body, or from
the lead tubulation if it projects from the body.
3. Procedure. All test samples shall be subjected to the specified number of cycles. When stabilized after initial
warm-up cycles, a cycle shall consist of an "on" period, when power is applied suddenly, not gradually, to the device
for the time necessary to achieve a delta case temperature (delta is the high minus the low mounting surface
temperatures) of +85C (+60C for thyristors) +15C, -5C, followed by an off period, when the power is suddenly
removed, for cooling the case through a similar delta temperature. Auxiliary (forced) cooling is permitted during the
off period only.
DC current shall be used for the power required during the "on" period except, for rectifiers and thyristors, equivalent
half sine wave (or full sine wave for triacs) is permissible. The test power, or current, shall be at least the free air
rating. For disc types, where functional mounting requires heat sinking, it shall be at least 25 percent of the
continuous, case referenced, rating. The on time (leaded and axial leaded devices) shall be at least 30 seconds.
Unless otherwise specified, for TO-3, DO-5, and larger devices it shall be at least one minute. Specified end-point
measurements for qualification and quality conformance inspection shall be completed within 96 hours after removal
of sample units from the specified test conditions. Additional readings may be taken at the discretion of the
manufacturer. If measurements cannot be performed within the specified time, the devices shall be subjected to the
same test conditions for a minimum of 200 additional cycles before post test measurements are performed.
NOTE: Heat sinks are not intended to be used in this test, however, small heat sinks may be used when it is
otherwise difficult to control case temperature of test samples, such as with small package types (e.g., TO-39).
METHOD 1037.2
1 of 1
METHOD 1038.4
1. Purpose. This test is performed to eliminate marginal devices or those with defects resulting from
manufacturing aberrations that are evidenced as time and stress dependent failures. Without the burn-in, these
defective devices would be expected to result in early lifetime failures under normal use conditions. It is the intent of
this test to operate the semiconductor device at specified conditions to reveal electrical failure modes that are time
and stress dependent.
a. HTRB screens for mobile or temperature activated impurities within (and without) the device's passivation
layers. It is equally effective on most device types including diodes, rectifiers, zeners, and transient
voltage suppressors.
b. SSOP, when properly specified, simulates actual device operation but with accelerated conditions. Some
of the elements of HTRB are combined with screening for die bond integrity. It is effective on some device
types including diodes, rectifiers, and zeners. The conditions used for zeners provide the desired HTRB
screen concurrently with the SSOP screen.
2. Mounting. Unless otherwise specified in the performance specification, mounting shall be in accordance with
the following.
2.1 Test condition A, HTRB. The method of mounting is usually optional for high temperature bias since little
power is dissipated in the device. (Devices with normally high reverse leakage current may be mounted to heat
sinks to prevent thermal run-away conditions.)
a. Devices with leads projecting from the body (e.g., axial) shall be mounted by their leads at least .375 inch
(9.73 mm) from the body or lead tabulation.
b. Unless otherwise specified, devices designed for case mounting (e.g., stud, flange, and disc) shall be
mounted by the stud or case according to the design specifications for the package. Care must be
exercised to avoid stressing or warping of the package. Thermally conductive compounds may optionally
be used provided that they are removed afterwards and do not leave a residue on the package.
3. Procedure. The semiconductor device shall be subjected to the burn-in at the temperature and for the time
specified herein or on the performance specification. Pre-burn-in measurements shall be made as specified. The
failure criteria shall be as specified in the appropriate performance specification. If measurements cannot be
performed within the specified time, the devices shall be subjected to the same test conditions for a minimum of 24
additional hours before test measurements are performed.
METHOD 1038.4
1 of 4
3.1 Test condition A, HTRB. Unless otherwise specified, HTRB is performed with the cathode positively biased at
an artificially elevated temperature for 48 hours minimum. These conditions apply to both rectifiers and to avalanche
and zener voltage regulators.
a. The junctions of rectifiers shall be reverse biased at 50 to 80 percent in accordance with figure 1038-1 of
their rated working peak reverse voltage; avalanche and zener voltage regulators, when specified, shall be
reverse biased at 80 percent of their minimum avalanche or zener voltages except when voltage exceeds
2,500, see figure 1038-1. The reverse bias shall be a dc bias with less than 20 percent ripple except
where rectified (pulsating) dc is permitted. The ambient or case test temperature shall be as specified
(normally +150C for silicon devices) (see figure 1038-1).
b. At the end of the high-temperature test time, as specified, the ambient temperature shall be lowered. The
test voltage shall be maintained on the devices until a case temperature of +30C 5C is attained.
Testing shall be completed within 24 hours after the removal of voltage. After removal of the bias voltage,
no other voltage shall be applied to the device before taking the post HTRB reverse current measurement.
Post HTRB measurements shall be taken as specified.
Uni-directional transient voltage suppressors shall be treated as avalanche and zener voltage regulators for the
purposes of conducting HTRB.
Bi-directional transient voltage suppressors shall be treated as two discrete avalanche or zener voltage regulators
(when specified) with each polarity taking turns receiving HTRB and post HTRB testing. Post HTRB testing of one
must be completed before reversing the device and commencing HTRB with opposite polarity bias voltage. The
second polarity may be achieved either electrically or by mechanically reversing the devices.
3.2 Test condition B, steady-state operating power. Unless otherwise specified, the devices shall be subjected to
the maximum rated test conditions for a minimum of 96 hours. The test temperature shall be as specified. Unless
otherwise specified, post burn-in readings shall be taken within 96 hours. If ambient temperature is specified, it shall
comply with the general requirements for HTRB or burn-in of this specification (see 4.5). The following indicates the
test conditions to be specified for each of the three types of power burn-in tests:
a. Rectifying test. Unless otherwise specified, average rectified current, peak reverse voltage, frequency, and
temperature (case, junction, or ambient) are as specified in the performance specification.
b. Forward bias test. Unless otherwise specified, forward current and temperature (case or junction) are as
specified in the performance specification.
c. Voltage regulator (zener) test. Unless otherwise specified, voltage regulator diode current and temperature
(case or junction) are as specified in the performance specification. At the end of the test time, the power
level shall be reduced to five percent of the operating level. If the ambient is artificially elevated, it shall
also be reduced to room temperature. The object is to let the devices cool down under bias. When the
junction or case temperature has stabilized to below +50C, the bias may be removed and the devices
tested within 96 hours after removal of reverse bias. No other voltage may be applied to the devices until
completion of electrical test.
METHOD 1038.4
2
METHOD 1038.4
3
4. Summary. The test condition letter (A or B) and the following details shall be specified in the applicable
performance specification.
e. Time for completion of post burn-in measurements, if other than 24 hours (see 3.1).
e. Time for completion of post burn-in measurements, if other than 96 hours (see 3.2).
METHOD 1038.4
4
METHOD 1039.4
1. Purpose. This test is performed to eliminate marginal devices or those with defects resulting from
manufacturing aberrations that are evidenced as time and stress dependent failures. Without the burn-in, these
defective devices would be expected to result in early lifetime failures under normal use conditions. It is the intent of
this test to operate the semiconductor device at specified conditions to reveal electrical failure modes that are time
and stress dependent.
2. Procedure. The semiconductor device shall be subjected to the burn-in at the temperature and for the time
specified herein. Preburn-in measurements shall be made as applicable. The failure criteria shall be as specified.
2.1 Mounting. Devices with leads projecting from the body shall be mounted by their leads at least .250 inch (6.35
mm) from the seating plane. Unless otherwise specified, devices with studs or case shall be mounted by the stud or
case.
2.1.1 Test condition A, steady-state reverse bias. The transistor primary blocking junction, as specified, shall be
reverse biased for 48 hours minimum, except PNP bipolar transistors shall be 24 hours, at the ambient temperature
specified (normally +150C) and at 80 percent of its maximum rated collector-base voltage. For bipolar transistors,
the VCB base is not to exceed the maximum collector-emitter voltage rating. For field-effect (signal or low power)
transistors, the gate to source voltage, with drain to source shorted, shall be as specified. At the end of the
high-temperature test time, specified herein, the ambient temperature shall be lowered. The test voltage shall be
maintained on the devices until TC = +30C 5C is attained. After room ambient temperature has been established,
the bias voltage shall be removed. After removal of the bias voltage, no other voltage shall be applied to the device
before taking the post burn-in reverse-current measurement(s). Unless otherwise specified, after burn-in voltage is
removed, post burn-in measurements shall be completed within 24 hours. If measurements cannot be performed
within the specified time, the devices shall be subjected to the same test conditions for a minimum of 24 additional
hours before post test measurements are performed.
2.1.2 Test condition B, steady-state power. All devices shall be operated at the maximum rated power related to
the test temperature for 160 hours minimum at the specified test conditions (excluding microwave).
a. For bipolar transistors, the temperature and power shall be specified. Unless otherwise specified, the
temperature shall be as follows:
TA = room ambient as defined in, 4.5 of the general specification. for small signal,
switching, and medium power devices intended for printed circuit board mounting; TJ
= maximum rated temperature, +0C, -25C, for devices intended for chassis or heat
sink mounting. Case temperature burn-in at maximum ratings (typically TC = +100C)
may be substituted on the chassis or heat sink mounted devices at the supplier's
option. If the voltage conditions specified herein cause the SOA rating to be
exceeded, then the voltage shall be decreased until the SOA rating is met while
maintaining the full rated power condition. For microwave bipolar transistors, the
temperature, voltage, and current shall be as specified in the detail specification.
b. For unijunction and field-effect (signal and low power) transistors, the temperature, voltage, and current
shall be as specified.
d. Unless otherwise specified, post burn-in readings shall be taken within 96 hours. If measurements cannot
be performed within the specified time, the devices shall be subjected to the same test conditions for a
minimum of 24 additional hours before post test measurements are performed.
METHOD 1039.4
1 of 2
3. Summary. Test condition letter and the following conditions shall be specified in the performance specification.
f. Time for completion of post burn-in measurements, if other than 24 hours (see 2.1.1).
f. Time for completion of post burn-in measurements, if other than as specified in 2.1.2.
METHOD 1039.4
2
METHOD 1040
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to eliminate marginal or defective semiconductor devices by operating
them at specified screening conditions which reveal electrical failure modes that are time and stress dependent. In
the absence of burn-in, these defective devices would be expected to result in early lifetime failures under normal
use conditions.
2. Procedure. Lead mounted devices shall be mounted by the leads at least .375 inch (9.5 mm) from the body or
lead tubulation, if the lead tubulation projects from the body. Unless otherwise specified, stud or case mounted
devices shall be mounted by the stud or case respectively. The devices shall then be subjected to the burn-in
screen(s) at the temperature and for the time specified. Pre burn-in and postburn-in measurements shall be made
as specified.
2.1 Test condition A (ac blocking voltage). The rated peak reverse and the rated peak forward blocking voltage
shall be alternately applied, each in the form of a 60 Hz half wave sinusoidal pulse using the circuit of figure 1040-1.
The test temperature shall be as specified. At the end of the specified high temperature test time, the ambient
temperature shall be lowered. The test voltage shall be maintained on the devices until TC = +30C 5C is
attained. After bias is removed and prior to post-test measurements, the devices shall be maintained at room
ambient temperature and no voltage shall be applied prior to that voltage specified for the post-test measurements.
The post-test end-points shall be completed within the specified time after the bias voltage is removed. Any device
which switches from the off-state to the on-state as indicated by a blown fuse shall be removed from the lot.
2.2 Test condition B (dc forward blocking voltage). The rated dc forward blocking voltage shall be applied as
indicated in the circuit on figure 1040-2. The test temperature shall be as specified. At the end of the specified
high-temperature test time, the ambient temperature shall be lowered. The test voltage shall be maintained on the
devices until TC = +30C 5C is attained. After bias is removed and prior to post test measurements, the devices
shall be maintained at room ambient temperature and no voltage shall be applied prior to that voltage specified for
the post test measurements. The post test end points shall be completed within the specified time after the bias
voltage is removed. Any device which switches from the off-state to the on-state as indicated by a blown fuse shall
be removed from the lot.
METHOD 1040
1 of 2
3. Measurements. Initial readings shall be taken prior to burn-in. Post-test readings shall be taken within 96
hours.
4. Summary. The test condition letter and the following conditions shall be specified in the performance
specification:
a. Test condition A:
b. Test condition B:
METHOD 1040
2
METHOD 1041.3
1. Purpose. This test is an accelerated laboratory corrosion test simulating the effects of seacoast atmospheres
on devices.
2. Apparatus. Apparatus used in the salt-atmosphere test shall include the following:
b. Salt-solution reservoir.
c. Means for atomizing the salt solution, including suitable nozzles and compressed-air supply.
e. Means for humidifying the air at a temperature above the chamber temperature.
3. Procedure. The device shall be placed within the test chamber. Unless otherwise specified, a salt atmosphere
fog having a temperature of +35C (+95F) shall be passed through the chamber for a period of 24 +2, -0 hours.
The fog concentration and velocity shall be adjusted so that the rate of salt deposit in the test area is between 10
and 50 g/m2/day.
4. Examinations. Unless otherwise specified, upon completion of the test, and to aid in the examinations, devices
shall be prepared in the following manner: Salt deposits shall be removed by a gentle wash or dip in running water
not warmer than +37C (+100F) and a light brushing, using a soft-hair brush or plastic bristle brush. A device with
illegible markings, leads missing, broken, or partially separated, evidence (when examined with 10X magnification)
of flaking or pitting of the finish or corrosion exceeding five percent of the package area or five percent of the lead
shall be considered a failure. Discoloration of the plating or lead finish shall not be considered a failure. The
marking legibility requirement shall not apply to characters with a height of less than .030 inches (0.76 mm).
METHOD 1041.3
1 of 1
METHOD 1042.3
1. Purpose. Test conditions A, B, and C are performed to eliminate marginal devices or those with defects
resulting from manufacturing aberrations that are evidenced as time and stress failures under normal use conditions.
Test condition D is performed to eliminate marginal lots with manufacturing defects. For the IGBT, replace the drain
and source MOSFET designations with collector and emitter IGBT designations,
D = C and S = E.
2. Procedure. The semiconductor device shall be subjected to the burn-in at the temperature and for the time
specified herein. Preburn-in measurements shall be made as applicable. The failure criteria shall be as specified.
2.1.1 Test condition A, steady-state reverse bias. All devices shall be operated at 80 percent of the maximum
rated drain to source voltage at the specified test temperature for 160 hours minimum, at the specified test
conditions. The drain to source voltage, with gate to source shorted, shall be as specified. At the end of the high-
temperature test time, specified herein, the ambient temperature shall be lowered. The burn-in voltage shall be
maintained on the devices until TC = 30C 5C is attained. The interruption of bias for up to one minute for the
purpose of moving devices to cool down positions separate from the chamber, within which life testing was
performed, shall not be considered removal of bias.
After removal of the burn-in voltage, no other voltage shall be applied to the device before taking the postburn-in
reverse current measurement(s). After burn-in voltage is removed, postburn-in measurements shall be completed
within 96 hours, unless otherwise specified. (See figure 1042-1.) Unless otherwise specified, the burn-in
temperature shall be TA = 150C. The VDS burn-in voltage shall be as follows. For IGBT devices, burn-in
temperature shall be TJ = 150C, -15C to +0C, and test time shall be 96 hours minimum.
V(BR)DSS voltages in between shall revert to the next lower VDS burn-in voltage.
2.1.1.1 Temperature accelerated test details. In an accelerated test, devices are subjected to bias conditions at a
temperature exceeding the maximum rated junction temperature. The maximum ambient temperature for MOSFETs
is +175C for a minimum of 48 hours. It is recommended that an adequate sample of devices be exposed to the
high temperature while measuring the voltage(s) and current(s) of the devices to assure that the applied stresses do
not induce damaging overstress. An adequate sample which has completed the accelerated test should also be
subjected to a 1,000 hour steady-state reverse bias at standard test conditions to assure the devices have not been
deleteriously affected. Details of the accelerated test will be found in the performance and /or general specification.
METHOD 1042.3
1 of 4
2.1.2 Test condition B, steady-state gate bias. All devices shall be operated at 80 percent of the maximum rated
gate to source voltage at the specified temperature for a minimum of 48 hours. (See figure 1042-2.) For MOSFET
power transistors, the temperature and voltage shall be as specified. Unless otherwise specified, the temperature
(TA) shall be 150C.
2.1.3 Test condition C, steady-state power. All devices shall be operated at the maximum junction temperature
+0C, 24C by means of applying power to the device while maintaining an ambient temperature of +25C +10C,
-5C. The junction temperature shall be verified by means of measuring junction temperature using the change in
body diode voltage drop or calculated by applying the following equations:
TC = Temperature of case
PD = VDS x ID
ID = Drain-source current
NOTE: The power indicated by the safe operating curve shall not be exceeded.
2.1.4 Test condition D, intermittent power. 1/ All devices shall be subjected to the number of cycles as specified.
A cycle shall consist of applying power to the device for the time necessary to achieve a +100C +15C, -10C
minimum rise in junction temperature followed by an off period for the time necessary for the junction to cool.
Forced air cooling is permitted during the off period only.
The power level, power-on time, and heat sink used, if any, shall be chosen to ensure that at the end of the heating
cycle, the case temperature is not more than 15C below the junction temperature. The rise in junction temperature
during the on period shall be verified by means of measuring junction temperature using the change in body diode
voltage drop or calculated by applying the following equation.
TP = thermal time constant of device package, and the heat sink used.
t = heating time, RJA = thermal resistance junction to ambient, for the period of heating time
specified, of the device and any necessary heat sink used.
This test is intended to allow the case temperature to rise and fall appreciably as the junction is heated and cooled;
thus, it is not appropriate to use a large heat sink or a high power short pulse.
_______
1/ This test condition is destructive.
METHOD 1042.3
2
3. Summary. Test condition letter and the following details shall be specified in the individual performance
specification.
a. Drain to source voltage for MOSFET power field-effect transistors (VDS) (see 2.1.1).
a. Ambient temperature (if one is desired) and thermal resistance (see 2.1.4).
METHOD 1042.3
3
NOTES:
1. The load circuit shall be selected or designed to ensure that the voltage across the load circuit of each
acceptable device shall not exceed 10 percent of the specified test voltage. The load circuit may be a
resistor, fuse, or circuit which:
a. Protects the power supply.
b. Isolates the defective devices from the other devices under test.
c. Insures a minimum of 98 percent of the specified test voltage is applied across the DUT.
2. If the circuit does not maintain bias on a failed device, then means must be provided to identify that device.
METHOD 1042.3
4
METHOD 1046.3
1. Purpose. This test is proposed as an accelerated laboratory corrosion test simulating the effects of seacoast
atmosphere on devices. This test can also be used to detect the presence of free iron contaminating the surface of
another metal, by inspection of the corrosion products.
2. Apparatus. Apparatus used in the salt-spray test shall include the following:
c. Means for atomizing the salt solution, including suitable nozzles and compressed-air supply.
e. Means for humidifying the air at a temperature above the chamber temperature.
2.1 Chamber. The chamber and all accessories shall be made of material which will not affect the corrosiveness
of the fog, such as glass, hard rubber, or plastic. Wood or plywood shall not be used since they are resiniferous.
Materials shall not be used if they contain formaldehyde or phenol in their composition. In addition, all parts which
come in contact with test specimens shall be of materials that will not cause electrolytic corrosion. The chamber and
accessories shall be so constructed and arranged that there is no direct impinging of the spray or dripping of the
condensate on the specimens, so that the spray circulates freely about all specimens to the same degree, and so
that no liquid which has come in contact with the test specimens returns to the salt-solution reservoir. The chamber
shall be properly vented to prevent pressure build up and allow uniform distribution of salt spray. The discharge end
of the vent shall be protected from strong drafts which can cause strong air current in the chamber.
2.2 Atomizers. The atomizer of atomizers used shall be of such design and construction as to produce a finely
divided, wet dense fog. The atomizing nozzle shall be made of material which does not react with the salt solution.
2.3 Air supply. The compressed air entering the atomizers shall be free from all impurities such as oil and dirt.
Means shall be provided to humidify and warm the compressed air as required to meet the operating conditions.
The air pressure shall be suitable to produce a finely divided dense fog with the atomizer or atomizers used. To
insure against clogging the atomizers by salt deposition, the air should have a relative humidity of 95 to 98 percent at
the point of release from the nozzle. A satisfactory method is to pass the air in very fine bubbles through a tower
containing heated water. The temperature of the water shall be +95F (+35C) or higher. The permissible
temperature is increased with increasing volume of air and with decreasing heat insulation of the chamber and
temperature of its surroundings. It shall not exceed a value above which an excess of moisture is introduced into the
chamber (for example, +110F (+43.3C) at an air pressure of 12 pounds per square inch), or a value which makes it
impossible to meet the requirement for operating temperature.
2.4 Salt solution. The salt solution concentration shall be 5 percent by weight. The salt used shall be sodium
chloride containing on the dry basis of more than 0.1 percent of sodium iodide, and not more than 0.5 percent of
total impurities. The 5 percent solution shall be prepared by dissolving 5 1 parts by weight of salt in 95 parts by
weight of distilled or other water. Distilled or other water used in the preparation of solutions shall contain nor more
than 200 parts per million of total solids. The solution shall be kept free from solids by filtration using a filter similar
to that shown on figure 1046-1, and located in the salt solution reservoir in a manner such as that illustrated on
figure 1046-2. The solution shall be adjusted to, and maintained at, a specific gravity in accordance with figure
1046-3. The pH shall be maintained between 6.5 and 7.2 when measured at temperature between +93F and +97F
(+33.9C and +36.1C). Only dilute chemically pure (cp) grade hydrochloric acid or sodium hydroxide shall be used
to adjust the pH. The pH measurement shall be made electrometrically using a glass electrode with a saturated
potassium-chloride bridge or by a colorimetric method such as bromothymol blue, provided the results are equivalent
to those obtained with the electrometric method.
2.5 Filter. A filter fabricated of noncorrosive materials similar to that shown on figure 1046-1 shall be provided in
the supply line and immersed in the reservoir in a manner such as shown on figure 1046-2.
METHOD 1046.3
1 of 4
2.6 Preparation of specimens. Specimens shall be given a minimum of handling, particularly on the significant
surfaces, and shall be prepared for test immediately before exposure. Unless otherwise specified, uncoated metallic
or metallic-coated specimens shall be thoroughly cleaned of oil, dirt, and grease as necessary until the surface is
free from water break. The cleaning methods shall not include the use of corrosive solvents nor solvents which
deposit wither corrosive or protective films, nor the use of abrasives other than a paste of pure magnesium oxide.
Specimens having an organic coating shall not be solvent cleaned. Those portions of specimens which comes in
contact with the support and, unless otherwise specified in the case of coated specimens or samples, cut edges and
surfaces not required to be coated, shall be protected with a suitable coating of wax or similar substance impervious
to moisture.
a. At the conclusion of the test, the device will be dried for 24 hours at +40C 5C before the examination. A
device with illegible marking, evidence (when examined without magnification) of flaking or pitting of the
finish, or corrosion that will interfere with the application of the device shall be considered a failure.
3.1 Location of specimens. Unless otherwise specified, flat specimens and, where practicable, other specimens
shall be supported in such a position that the significant surface is approximately 15 degrees from the vertical and
parallel to the principal direction of horizontal flow of the fog through the chamber. Other specimens shall be
positioned so as to ensure most uniform exposure. Whenever practicable, the specimens shall be supported from
the bottom or from the side. When specimens are suspended from the top, suspension shall be by means of glass
or plastic hooks or wax string; if plastic hooks are used, they shall be fabricated of material which is nonreactive to
the salt solution such as Lucite. The use of metal hooks is not permitted. Specimens shall be positioned so that
they do not contact each other, so that they do not shield each other from the freely settling fog, and so that
corrosion products and condensate from one specimen do not fall upon another.
3.2.1 Temperature. The test shall be conducted with a temperature in the exposure zone maintained at +95F
+2F, -3F (+35C +1.1C, -1.7C). Satisfactory methods for controlling the temperature accurately are by housing
the apparatus in a properly controlled constant-temperature room, by thoroughly insulating the apparatus and
preheating the air to the proper temperature prior to atomization, and by jacketing the apparatus and controlling the
temperature of the water or of the air used. The use of immersion heaters for the purpose of maintaining the
temperature within the chamber is prohibited.
3.2.2 Atomization. The conditions maintained in all parts of the exposure zone shall be such that a suitable
receptacle placed at any point in the exposure zone will collect from 0.5 to 3.0 milliliters of solution per hour for each
80 square centimeters of horizontal collecting area (10 centimeters diameter) based on an average run of at least 16
hours. The 5-percent solution thus collected shall have a sodium-chloride content of from 4 to 6 percent (specific
gravity) in accordance with figure 1046-3 when measured at a temperature between +93F and +97F (+33.9C and
+36.1C). At least two clean fog-collecting receptacles shall be used, one placed near any nozzle and one placed as
far as possible from all nozzles. Receptacles shall be fastened so that they are not shielded by specimens and so
that no drops of solution from specimens or other sources will be collected. The specific gravity and quantity of the
solution collected shall be checked following each salt-spay test. Suitable atomization has been obtained in boxes
having a volume of less than 12 cubic feet with the following conditions:
c. Atomization of approximately 3 quarts of the salt solution per 10 cubic feet of box volume per 24 hours.
When using large-size boxes having a volume considerably in excess of 12 cubic feet, the above conditions may
have to be modified in order to meet the requirements for operating conditions.
METHOD 1046.3
2
3.3 Length of test. The length of the salt-spray test shall be that indicated in one of the following test conditions,
as specified:
A -------- 96 hours
B -------- 48 hours
Unless otherwise specified, the test shall be run continuously for the time indicated or until definite indication of
failure is observed, with no interruption except for adjustment of the apparatus and inspection of the specimen.
4. Measurements. At the completion of the exposure period, measurements shall be made as specified. To aid in
examination, specimens shall be prepared in the following manner, unless otherwise specified: Salt deposits shall
be removed by a gentle wash or dip in running water not warmer than +100F (+37.8C) and a light brushing, using a
soft-hair brush or plastic-bristle brush.
5. Summary. The following details are to be specified in the individual performance specification:
Inches | Millimeters
.50 | 12.70
1.25 | 31.75
2.00 | 50.80
5.00 | 127.00
8.00 | 203.20
METHOD 1046.3
3
FIGURE 1046-3. Variations of specific gravity of salt (NaCl) solution with temperature.
METHOD 1046.3
4
METHOD 1048
BLOCKING LIFE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine compliance with the specified lambda () for devices
subjected to the specified conditions.
2. Mounting. The method of mounting is usually optional for blocking life tests since little power is dissipated in
the device. (Devices with normally high reverse leakage current may be mounted to heat sinks to prevent thermal
run-away conditions.)
3. Procedure. Blocking life is performed with the primary blocking junction, or insulation, reverse biased at an
artificially elevated temperature for the time period in accordance with the life test requirements of MIL-PRF-19500
and herein; at the temperature specified (normally +150C and at 80 to 85 percent of the rated voltage relevant to
the device (VR, VZ(min), VCB, VAG, VDG, and VGS).
At the end of the high-temperature test time, as specified, the ambient temperature shall be lowered. The test
voltage shall be maintained on the devices until a case temperature of +30C 5C is attained. After this ambient
temperature has been established, the bias voltage shall be maintained until testing is performed; testing shall be
completed within 24 hours after the removal of power. After removal of the bias voltage, no other voltage shall be
applied to the device before taking the post-test leakage current measurement. Post-test measurements shall be
taken as specified.
4. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable performance specification:
e. Time for completion of post-test measurements, if other than 24 hours (see 3.).
METHOD 1048
1 of 1
METHOD 1049
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine compliance with the specified sample plan for devices
subjected to the specified conditions.
2. Mounting. The method of mounting is usually optional for blocking life tests since little power is dissipated in
the device. (Devices with normally high reverse leakage current may be mounted to heat sinks to prevent thermal
run-away conditions.)
3. Procedure. Unless otherwise specified, blocking life is performed with the primary blocking junction, or
insulation, reverse biased at an artificially elevated temperature for 340 hours, at the temperature specified (normally
+150C and at 80 to 85 percent of the rated voltage relevant to the device (VR, VZ (min), VCB, VAG, VDG, and VGS).
At the end of the high-temperature test time, as specified, the ambient temperature shall be lowered. The test
voltage shall be maintained on the devices until a case temperature of +30C 5C is attained. After this ambient
temperature has been established, the bias voltage shall be maintained until testing is performed; testing shall be
completed within 24 hours after the removal of power. After removal of the bias voltage, no other voltage shall be
applied to the device before taking the post-test leakage current measurement. Post-test measurements shall be
taken as specified.
4. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable performance specification:
e. Time for completion of post test measurements, if other than 24 hours (see 3.1).
METHOD 1049
1 of 1
METHOD 1051.6
1. Purpose. This test is conducted to determine the resistance of a part to extremes of high and low
temperatures, and to the effect of alternate exposures to these extremes.
1.1.1 Load. The specimens under test and the fixtures holding those specimens during the test. Maximum load
shall be determined by using the worst case load temperature with specific specimen loading. Monolithic loads used
to simulate loading may not be appropriate when air circulation is reduced by load configuration. The maximum
loading must meet the specified conditions.
1.1.2 Monitoring sensor. The temperature sensor that is located and calibrated so as to indicate the same
temperature as at the worst case indicator specimen location. The worst case indicator specimen location is
identified during the periodic characterization of the worst case load temperature.
1.1.3 Worst case load temperature. The worst case load temperature is the temperature of a specific area in the
chamber when measured by thermocouples located at the center and at each corner of the load. The worst case
load temperature shall be determined at periodic intervals.
1.1.4 Working zone. The volume in the chamber(s) in which the temperature of the load is controlled within the
limits specified in table 1051-I.
1.1.6 Transfer time. The elapsed time between specimen removal from one temperature extreme and
introduction into the other.
1.1.7 Maximum load. The largest load for which the worst case load temperature meets the timing requirements
(see 3.1).
1.1.8 Soak time. The elapsed time that occurs after the load has reached the temperature specified in table
1051-I.
NOTE: During chamber profiling and characterization, a device temperature sensitive parameter should be used to
ensure that for various load conditions, the specified soak time shall be guaranteed.
1.1.9 Ramp time. The time allowed for reaching a given temperature. This timing starts when the load is
introduced to the chamber and ends when the load reaches the temperature specified in table 1051-I.
CAUTION: Due to the ramp capability of test equipment available today, if care is not taken when profiling and
characterizing various load conditions or setting up the equipment, thermal shock can be induced. The ramp rate
should be controlled as defined in 3.1 or one can create a thermal shock instead of temperature cycling.
2. Apparatus. The chamber(s) used shall be capable of providing and controlling the specified temperatures in
the working zone(s) when the chamber is loaded with a maximum load. The thermal capacity and air circulation
shall enable the working zone and loads to meet the specified conditions and timing (see 3.1). Worst case load
temperature shall be continually monitored during test by indicators or recorders reading the monitoring sensor.
Direct heat conduction to specimens shall be minimized.
METHOD 1051.6
1 of 3
3. Procedure. Specimens shall be placed in such a position with respect to the air stream that there is
substantially no obstruction to the flow of air across and around the specimen. When special mounting is required, it
shall be specified. The specimen shall then be subjected to the specified condition for the specified number of
cycles performed continuously. This test shall be conducted for a minimum of 20 cycles using test condition C. One
cycle consists of steps 1 and 2 or the applicable test condition to be counted as a cycle. Completion of the total
number of cycles specified for the test may be interrupted for the purpose of test chamber loading or unloading of
device lots or as the result of power or equipment failure. However, if for any reason the number of incomplete
cycles exceed 10 percent of the total number of cycles specified, one cycle must be added for each incomplete
cycle. See Figure 1051-I herein.
Graph depicting two possible scenarios based on current interpretations of wording in specification.
* 3.1 Timing. The total transfer time from hot to cold or cold to hot shall not exceed 1 minute. The load may be
transferred after a soak of 1 minute minimum. However the ramp time shall not exceed 15 minutes. The ramp rate
for DUT shall operate within the following temperature change rates: 15C/minute minimum and 50C/minute
maximum independent of load size.
METHOD 1051.6
2
2 10 85 +10 125 +15 175 +15 200 +15 300 +15 150 +15 150 +15
Hot -0 -0 -0 -0 -0 -0 -0
NOTE: Steps 1 and 2 may be interchanged. The load temperature may exceed the + or - zero (0) tolerance
during the recovery time. Other tolerances shall not be exceeded.
4. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable performance specification:
b. Test condition letter, if other than test condition C herein (see 3.).
d. End-point measurements and examinations, e.g., end-point electrical measurements, seal test (method
1071 of this general specification), or other acceptance criteria.
METHOD 1051.6
3
METHOD 1054.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine device design susceptibility to intermittent open failures in
conformally coated circuit boards environments while under thermal cycle. The destructive effects of tension and
compression are magnified in the potted condition allowing for early detection of design weakness.
2. Equipment.
a. Container of 3 cubic inches minimum with rigid walls of .125 inch (3.18 mm) minimum.
b. Devices for testing corrected to a common bussbar arranged in a common cathode or common anode
configuration (see figure 1054-1).
3. Procedure:
a. Place devices in a common connection configuration into the container with provisions made to ensure
device clearance of .125 inch (3.18 mm) minimum from the container walls.
b. Pour stycast potting compound into shell and allow to cure while following all manufacturer's
recommendations.
METHOD 1054.1
1 of 2
c. Place cured assembly on a hot plate and allow the assembly to reach thermal equilibrium of +70C.
Unless otherwise specified, observe the forward voltage trace of each device at a current level of 100 mA.
Forward voltage trace should show no incidence of instability or open condition. Record all failures by
serial number.
d. Allow assembly to cool at room temperature and place into a thermal shock chamber to perform 20 shocks
in accordance with method 1051 of this general specification. Remove assembly and allow to reach room
temperature.
METHOD 1054.1
2
METHOD 1055.1
1. Purpose. This test is to determine the ability of devices to withstand the effect of thermal stress and rapid
dimensional change on internal structural elements caused by the application of power in rapidly changing
temperature environments as in mission profile system testing.
2. Apparatus. The equipment required shall consist of that listed below and shall have the stated capabilities.
a. A chamber of sufficient temperature range and change rate capability with cabling exiting through insulated
barriers to external bias and monitoring electronics. Cabling for all monitoring equipment shall provide
Kelvin connections.
b. Electronic regulated power supply(s) capable of maintaining the stated bias tolerances.
c. Electronic voltage monitoring device with capability of indicating an open circuit of 20 ms or more in
duration.
3. Procedure.
a. Devices conforming to all electrical and mechanical parameter requirements shall be first subjected to high
temperature stabilization bake of method 1032 of this general specification. They shall then be subjected
to temperature cycling non-operational thermal shock of method 1051 of this general specification, except
that no dwell time is required at +25C. Test condition C shall be +175C, +5C, -0C. Temperature shall
remain at the stabilized extremes for 10 minutes minimum.
b. Electrical measurements shall be performed to ensure that, proceeding to the monitored thermal cycle
portion of this test, all devices have remained within specification.
c. Unless otherwise specified, the temperature extremes shall be as stated below (from worse case mission
profile requirements of MIL-HDBK-781.
d. The temperature and operating profile shall be specified on figure 1055-1. Temperature change rate shall
average not less than 5C per minute, but not greater than 10C per minute.
e. The device(s) shall be placed individually, or in series connection, within the chamber. The device(s) shall
be connected to a constant current power supply capable of supplying current to raise the device
junction(s) to +125C minimum, +150C maximum temperature during the high temperature portion of
each cycle.
METHOD 1055.1
1 of 3
3.1 Electrical monitoring. Connect electrical monitoring volt meter leads to the extremes of the device(s) and
series resistor (see figure 1055-2). Apply the current to raise each junction temperature approximately +50C. The
value of R shall be chosen to cause a 10 3 percent increase in monitoring voltage, VM, if open circuit occurs. Open
switch S1 and verify an increase in VM to verify circuit operation. Remove power.
METHOD 1055.1
2
3.2 Monitoring voltage increase. Close S1 and perform six cycles of figure 1055-1 while monitoring for increases
in voltage level above the highest (cold temperature) value.
3.3 Failures. Failures in the first two cycles may be considered non-chargeable de-bug events, if analysis finds
fault with test circuitry. The last four cycles shall be failure free.
NOTE: Unless otherwise specified, a momentary, or continuous, open circuit (indicated by an increase in the
monitored voltage) in any of the last four cycles, shall be considered failure.
METHOD 1055.1
3
METHOD 1056.7
1. Purpose. This test is conducted to determine the resistance of the part to sudden exposure to extreme
changes in temperature and to the effect of alternate exposures to these extremes.
1.1.1 Cycle. A cycle consists of starting at ambient room temperature, proceeding to step 1, then to step 2, or
alternately proceeding to step 2, then to step 1 of table 1056.I and 1056.II, and then back to ambient room
temperature without interruption.
1.1.2 Dwell time. The total time the load is immersed in the bath.
1.1.3 Load. The DUTs and the fixtures holding those devices.
1.1.4 Maximum load. The maximum mass of devices and fixtures that can be placed in the bath while maintaining
specified temperatures and times.
1.1.6 Transfer time. The elapsed time measured from removal of the load from one bath until insertion in the
other bath.
1.1.7 Worst case load temperature. The body temperature of a specific device located at the center of the load.
2. Apparatus. The baths used shall be capable of providing and controlling the specified temperatures in the
working zone(s) when the bath is loaded with a maximum load. The thermal capacity and liquid circulation must
enable the working zone and loads to meet the specified conditions and timing (see 3.1). Worst case load
temperature shall be continually monitored during test by indicators or recorders reading the monitoring sensor(s).
The worst case load temperature under maximum load conditions and configuration shall be verified as needed to
validate bath performance. Perfluorocarbons that meet the physical property requirements of table 1056.II shall be
used for conditions B and C.
3. Procedure. Specimens shall be placed in the bath in a position so that the flow of liquid across and around
them is substantially unobstructed. The load shall then be subjected to condition A or as otherwise specified (see
4.b) of table 1056.I for a duration of 15 cycles. Completion of the total number of cycles specified for the test may be
interrupted for the purpose of loading or unloading of device lots or as the result of power or equipment failure.
However, if the number of interruptions for any given test exceeds 10 percent of the total number of cycles specified,
the test must be restarted from the beginning.
3.1 Timing. The total transfer time from hot to cold or from cold to hot shall not exceed 10 seconds. The load
may be transferred when the worst case load temperature is within the limits specified in table 1056.II. However, the
dwell time shall not be less than 2 minutes and the load shall reach the specified temperature within 5 minutes.
4. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable performance specification.
d. End-point measurements and examinations such as end-point electrical measurements, seal test (method
1071 of this general specification), or other acceptance criteria.
METHOD 1056.7
1 of 2
1/ The perfluorocarbon used shall have a viscosity less than or equal to the thermal shock
equipment manufacturer's recommended viscosity at the minimum temperature.
A and B C D
Test condition
Temperature Temperature Temperature
METHOD 1056.7
2
METHOD 1057.1
1. Purpose. This method provides a means of judging the relative resistance of glass encapsulated electronic
components to cracking under conditions of thermal stress. It employs immersion in a hot liquid and then water to
simulate the thermal stresses associated with both device manufacturing processes and end user assembly
procedures.
2. Apparatus. Liquid baths shall be used which are capable of providing and maintaining the specified
temperatures in the working zone when loaded with a maximum load. Bath temperatures under maximum load
conditions shall be verified, as needed, to validate bath performance. Liquid composition shall be as specified herein.
3. Procedure. Remove any paint or other surface coatings. Clean test specimens using a general purpose
cleaner/degreaser, rinse in water, and then acetone. Subsequent to cleaning, specimens shall be placed into the
baths defined in table 1057.I for the applicable test condition using a dipping tool that will not significantly heat sink
the body of the device under test (DUT). Specimens shall be fully immersed in the first bath for the specified period
of time then transferred to, and fully immersed in, the second bath. Unless otherwise specified, the test shall be
considered complete upon removal of the specimen from the second bath.
3.1 Timing. Specimens shall be immersed into, and removed from, the first (hot) bath at a rate of 1.0 .5 inch
(25.4 12.7 mm) per second. The maximum preheat dwell time above the hot bath prior to immersion shall be in
accordance with table 1057.1. Immersion dwell time in the hot bath shall be in accordance with table 1057.1.
Specimens shall be released completely into the cold bath after their removal from the hot bath in accordance with
the dwell time specified in table 1057.1.
4. Failure criteria. Specimens that fail to meet the glass crack criteria of method 2074 of MIL-STD-750 shall be
considered rejects. If flux was used for condition B, it shall be removed prior to any visual examination.
b. Test condition.
1/ Use of flux is optional but recommended to prevent solder irregularities and blobs.
METHOD 1057.1
1 of 1
METHOD 1061.1
TEMPERATURE MEASUREMENT,
CASE AND STUD
1. Purpose. This proposal covers a method of measuring case temperature of hex-base devices.
2. Test equipment.
2.1 Type of thermocouple. The thermocouple material shall be copper-constantan, as recommended by the
"Standard Handbook for Electrical Engineers", for the range of -190C to +350C. The wire size shall be no larger
than AWG size 30. The junction of the thermocouple shall be welded together to form a bead rather than soldered
or twisted.
2.2 Accuracy. The thermocouple shall have an accuracy of .5C. Under load conditions, slight variations in the
temperature of different points on the case may reduce this accuracy to 1.0C for convection cooling, and 2.0C
for forced air ventilation.
3. Procedure.
3.1 Method of mounting. A small hole, just large enough to insert the thermocouple, shall be drilled approximately
.031 inch (0.79 mm) deep into the flat of the case hex at a point chosen by the manufacturer. The edge of the hole
should then be peened with a small center punch to force a rigid mechanical contact with the welded bead of the
thermocouple. If forced air ventilation is used, the thermocouple shall be mounted away from the air stream and the
thermocouple leads close to the junction shall be shielded.
3.2 Other methods of mounting. Other methods of mounting thermocouple, with the possible exception of the
thermocouple welded directly to the case, will result in temperature readings lower than the actual temperature.
These deviations will result from:
b. External heat sink in contact with the thermocouple using pressure contacts.
METHOD 1061.1
1 of 1
METHOD 1066.1
DEW POINT
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to monitor the device parameter for a discontinuity under the specified
conditions.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus used in this test shall be capable of varying the temperature from the specified high
temperature to -65C and return to the specified high temperature while the parameter is being measured.
3. Procedure. The voltage and current specified in the performance specification shall be applied to the terminals
and the parameter monitored from the specified high temperature to -65C and return to the specified high
temperature. The dew point temperature is indicated by a sharp discontinuity in the parameter being measured with
respect to temperature. If no discontinuity is observed, it shall be assumed that the dew point is at a temperature
lower than -65C and the DUT is acceptable.
METHOD 1066.1
1 of 1
METHOD 1071.8
HERMETIC SEAL
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the hermeticity of semiconductor devices with designed
internal cavities.
2.1 Standard leak rate. Standard leak rate is defined as that quantity of dry air at +25C in atmospheric cubic
centimeters flowing through a leak, or multiple leak, paths per second when the high-pressure side is at 15 psi (101
kPa) and the low-pressure side is at a pressure of not greater than .0193 psi (133 pA). Standard leak rate shall be
expressed in units of atmospheric cubic centimeters per second (atm cm3/s air).
2.2 Measured leak rate. Measured leak rate (R1) is defined as the leak rate of a given package as measured
under specified conditions and employing a specified test medium. Measured leak rate shall be expressed in units of
atmospheric cubic centimeters per second (atm cm3/s of the gas medium used for the test). For purposes of
comparison with rates determined by other methods of testing, the measured leak rates must be converted to the
equivalent standard leak rates, (converted to air equivalents).
2.3 Equivalent standard leak rate. The equivalent standard leak rate (L) of a given package, with a measured leak
rate (R1), is defined as the leak rate of the same package with the same leak geometry that would exist under the
standard leak rate. The equivalent standard leak rate shall be expressed in units of atmospheric cubic centimeters
per second (atm cm3/s) (air).
NOTE: The leak rate measurements are not necessarily performed with a one atmosphere differential, as implied by
the standard leak rate. The equivalent conversion represents gas medium only.
3. Test conditions.
a. Gross leaks. Test conditions A, B, C, D, E, G2, J, K, or L should be specified for gross leaks.
(1) Test condition A: Radioisotope wet gross leak test (see 4.).
(2) Test condition B: Radioisotope dry gross leak test (see 5.).
(7) Test condition K: Fluorocarbon vapor detection gross leak (see 12.).
(10) Test condition CH1 and CH2: Cumulative helium gross/fine combination (see 10.).
b. Gross leaks. Test condition D may be specified when a sensitivity of 1 x 10-3 atm cm3/s or greater will
satisfy reliability requirements. This condition shall not be used for devices that have internal free volumes
of less than 1 cm3.
METHOD 1071.8
1 of 17
c. Fine leak. Test condition G1, G2, H, CH, or L should be specified for the fine leak test.
(1) Test condition G1, radioisotope fine or G2, gross/fine combination leak test (see 9.).
(2) Test conditions H1 and H2: Tracer gas leak test (helium) (see 10.).
(3) Test condition CH1 and CH2: Cumulative helium gross/fine combination (see 10.).
d. Obsolete.
e. Fine and gross leak test procedure. Unless otherwise specified by applicable performance specification,
tests shall be conducted in accordance with table 1071-I. When specified (see 15 herein) measurements
after test shall be conducted following the leak test procedures. Where bomb pressure specified exceeds
the device package capability, alternate pressure, exposure time, and dwell time conditions shall be used
provided they satisfy the leak rate, pressure, and time relationships which apply and provided no less than
30 psi (207 kPa) bomb pressure is applied in any case, or for condition L1, a minimum 10 psi differential test
pressure is applied.
Fine and gross leak tests shall be conducted in accordance with the requirements and procedures of the
specified test condition. Testing order shall utilize only the all-dry gas tests first, followed by any liquid
immersion gross leak test (i.e.; the option to use the radioisotope gross, fine, or gross/fine combination leak
test conditions B, G1, and G2 (respectively), may be used together, or in succession, as long as the
minimum test requirements are met). The radioisotope dry gas gross leak test B or G2 may be used for
gross leak testing prior to any dry gas fine test. Optical gross leak test (L1) is an all-dry gas test and can be
used before any fine leak test. If any other gross leak test is used, (condition A, C, D, E, F, J, or K), the
sequence of testing shall use the dry gas fine leak test first, followed by the gross leak test, except in
accordance with 14, note 1. When batch testing (more than one device in the leak detector at one time) is
used in performing test condition H1, H2, CH, and a reject condition occurs, it shall be noted as a batch
failure. Each device with a cavity greater than 0.5 cm3 may then be tested individually one time for
acceptance if all devices in the batch are retested within 1 hour after removal from the tracer gas
pressurization chamber. Devices with cavity < 0.5 cm3 shall be measured within ten minutes or re-
pressurized and then re-read. For condition G1 only, devices may be batch tested for acceptance provided,
if a reject occurs, all remeasuring of parts individually is completed within 30 minutes after removal from the
tracer gas pressurization chamber. For condition G2 only, devices may be batch tested for acceptance
provided, if a reject occurs, all remeasuring of parts individually is completed within 10 minutes after
removal from the tracer gas pressurization chamber. For condition K only, devices that are batch tested,
and indicate a reject condition, may be retested individually one time using the procedure of 12.2 herein,
except that repressurization is not required if the devices are immersed in detector fluid within 20 seconds
after completion of the first test, and they remain in the bath until retest. For condition CH only, devices that
are batch tested, and indicate a reject condition, may be retested individually if they are placed in a bag or
container with at least 50 percent helium at atmospheric pressure and then individually removed and tested
within 1 hour after removal from the initial helium pressurization chamber.
METHOD 1071.8
2
1/ Condition J cannot be used for packages whose internal volume is <0.001 cm3.
2/ Condition D cannot be used for packages whose internal volume is 1 cm3.
3/ Condition J may be used as a single test for devices with an internal cavity volume of >0.4 cm3
provided the specified requirements can be satisfied by a leak rate of 1 x 10-6 atm cm3/s.
4/ Condition B and G2 may be used for small cavity devices that contain approved getting material.
4.1 Apparatus. The apparatus required for the seal test shall be as follows:
b. Counting station equipment consisting of a scintillation crystal, photomultiplier tube, preamplifier, ratemeter,
and krypton-85 reference standards. The counting station shall be of sufficient sensitivity to determine
through the device wall, the radiation level of any krypton-85 tracer gas present within the device. The
counting station detector shall have a minimum detectability of 500 c/m of krypton-85 above ambient
background, and shall be calibrated at least once every working shift using krypton-85 reference standards
and following the equipment manufacturer's instruction.
c. A container of sufficient volume to allow the devices to be covered with oil and to be degreased with a
suitable solvent.
d. Solutions:
(1) Hydrocarbon vacuum pump oil. The solution shall be kept clean and free of contaminants.
e. A tracer gas consisting of a mixture of krypton-85 and air. The concentration of krypton-85 in air shall be no
less than 100 microcuries per atmospheric cubic centimeter. This value shall be determined at least once
each 30 days, following manufacturer's procedure, and recorded in accordance with the calibration
requirements of this standard.
4.2 Procedure. The devices shall be immersed in the oil and evacuated to a pressure of 10 torr or less for 10
minutes and then pressurized with air for 1 hour at 310 kPa (45 psi) minimum. The devices shall be removed from
the oil and flushed with solvent to remove all of the surface oil. The devices shall then be placed in the radioisotope
pressurization tank, and the tank evacuated to a pressure of 0.5 torr. The devices shall then be pressurized to a
minimum of three atmospheres absolute pressure of krypton-85/air mixture for twelve (12) minutes minimum. The
gas mixture shall then be transferred to storage until a pressure of 2.0 torr maximum exists in the tank. This transfer
shall be completed in 2 minutes maximum. The tank shall then be filled with air, and the devices immediately
removed from the tank and leak tested within 10 minutes after gas exposure, with a scintillation crystal equipped
counting station. Any device indicating 1,000 c/m or greater above the ambient background of the counting station
shall be considered a gross leak.
METHOD 1071.8
3
5. Test condition B, radioisotope dry gross leak. This test shall be used to test devices that internally contain some
krypton-85 absorbing or adsorbing medium, such as electrical insulation, organic, or molecular sieve, or approved
gettering material. If the device does not contain any adsorbing medium this can only be used on parts with 0.02 cc
internal free volume or larger, or that can demonstrate that the following requirements are met:
a. A 5 mil diameter hole shall be made in a representative unit of the devices to be tested.
b. The device shall be subjected to this test condition and removed from the pressurization tank immediately
after the tank is vented to atmosphere, and measured in the counting station. A net reading indicating 1,000
cpm or greater is considered a reject. The device must remain a reject for a minimum of 10 minutes after
removal from the pressurization tank. If the device does not fail, this test may not be used.
5.1 Apparatus. Apparatus for this test shall consist of the following:
b. Counting station with a minimum sensitivity of 10,000, counts per minute per microcurie of krypton-85 tracer
gas and a minimum detectable count rate of 500 counts per minute above background level.
c. A tracer gas consisting of a mixture of krypton-85 and air. The concentration of krypton-85 in air shall be no
less than 100 microcuries per atmospheric cubic centimeter. This value shall be determined at least once
each 30 days, following manufacturer's procedure, and recorded in accordance with the calibration
requirements of this standard.
5.2 Procedure. The devices shall be placed in a radioactive tracer gas pressurization tank and the tank shall be
evacuated to a pressure not to exceed 0.5 torr. The devices shall then be subjected to a minimum of 45 psia of
krypton-85/air gas mixture for 2 minutes. The gas mixture shall then be transferred to storage until a pressure of 2.0
torr maximum exists in the pressurization tank. This gas transfer shall be complete in 3 minutes maximum. The tank
shall then be backfilled with air. The devices shall then be removed from the tank and measured within 10 minutes
after gas exposure, with a scintillation-crystal-equipped counting station. Any device indicating 1,000 counts per
minute, or greater, above the ambient background of the counting station shall be considered a gross leak failure.
6. Test condition C, liquid (fluorocarbon) gross leak. Packages with less than 0.01 cm3 internal free volume shall
be tested with extremely careful observation. The number of test samples, configuration, and all critical test criteria
shall be included in the manufacturers test procedure.
6.1 Apparatus. Apparatus for this test shall consist of the following:
a. A vacuum/pressure chamber for the evacuation and subsequent pressure bombing of devices up to 90 psi
(618 kPa) for a maximum of 24 hours.
b. A suitable observation container with provisions to maintain the indicator fluid at a temperature of +125C
5C (+100C for Germanium transistors with temperature rating of +100C maximum) and a filtration
system capable of removing particles greater than one micrometer in size from the fluid.
c. A magnifier capable of magnifying an object 1.5 to 30 times its normal size (4 to 120 diopters) for
observation of bubbles emanating from devices when immersed in the indicator fluid.
d. Sources of type I detector fluids and type II indicator fluids as specified in table 1071-II.
e. A lighting source capable of producing a collimated beam of at least 161,000 luxes (15,000 foot candles) in
air at a distance equal to that which the most distant device in the bath will be from the source. The lighting
source shall not require calibration, but shall be placed for best detection of bubbles, without excessive
incident or reflective glare being directed toward observer.
f. Suitable calibrated instruments to indicate that test temperatures, pressures, and times are as specified.
METHOD 1071.8
4
Density at +25C (gm/ml) > 1.6 > 1.6 > 1.6 D-941
Dielectric strength (volts/mil) > 300 > 300 > 300 877
6.2 Procedure. The devices shall be placed in a vacuum/pressure chamber and the pressure reduced to 0.0972
psia(670 Pa) or less and maintained for 30 minutes minimum, except for devices with an internal volume 0.1 cm3
this vacuum cycle may be omitted. A sufficient amount of type I detector fluid shall be admitted to cover the devices.
When the vacuum cycle is performed, the fluid will be admitted after the minimum 30 minute period but before
breaking the vacuum. The devices shall then be pressurized in accordance with table 1071-III. When the
pressurization period is complete, the pressure shall be released and the devices removed from the chamber without
being removed from a bath of detector fluid for greater than 20 seconds. A holding bath may be another vessel or
storage tank. When the devices are removed from the bath, they shall be dried for 2 minutes 1 minute in air prior to
immersion in type II indicator fluid, which shall be maintained at +125C 5C. The devices shall be immersed with
the uppermost portion at a minimum depth of 2 inches (50.80 mm) below the surface of the indicator fluid, one at a
time or in such a configuration that a single bubble from a single device out of a group under observation may be
clearly observed as to its occurrence and source. Unless rejected earlier, the device shall be observed against a dull,
nonreflective black background through the magnifier, while illuminated by the lighting source, from the instant of
immersion until expiration of a 30 second minimum observation period.
45 8 4
60 4 2
75 2 1
90 1 0.5
6.2.1 Failure criteria. A definite stream of bubbles, or two or more bubbles originating from the same point, shall
be cause for rejection.
METHOD 1071.8
5
6.2.2 Precautions. The following precautions shall be observed in conducting the fluorocarbon gross leak test:
a. Perfluorocarbons fluids shall be filtered through a filter system capable of removing particles greater than
one micrometer prior to use. Bulk filtering and storage is permissible. Liquid which has accumulated
observable quantities of particulate matter during use shall be discarded or reclaimed by filtration for re-use.
Precaution should be taken to prevent contamination.
b. Observation container shall be filled to assure coverage of the device to a minimum of 2 inches (50.80 mm).
c. Devices to be tested shall be free of foreign materials on the surface, including conformal coatings, and any
markings which may contribute to erroneous test results.
d. Precaution should be taken to prevent operator injury due to package rupture or violent evolution of bomb
fluid when testing large packages.
e. Packages with less than 0.01 cm3 internal free volume shall be tested, with extremely careful observation.
7. Test condition D, bubble test (type II indicator fluid as specified in table 1071-II.) (NOTE: These fluids replace
ethylene glycol as a medium for the gross leak bubble test.) Packages with less than 0.01 cm3 internal free volume
shall be tested with extremely careful observation.
7.1 Apparatus. Apparatus for this test shall consist of the following:
b. Container of sufficient volume to allow the devices to be covered with solution to a minimum depth of 2
inches (50.80 mm). The container shall have flat sides to minimize reflections and distortions (example of
an acceptable container is a battery jar).
c. Liquid of sufficient volume maintained at no less than +125C 5C for the duration of the test.
d. A light source capable of producing a collimated beam of at least 161,000 luxes (15,000 foot candles) in air
at a distance equal to that which the most distant device in the bath will be from the source. The lighting
source shall not require calibration.
7.2 Procedure. The devices shall be placed in the container of liquid at +125C, immersed to a minimum depth of
2 inches (50.80 mm) for a minimum of 1 minute, and observed during the entire immersion period for bubbles or
bubbling. Side lighting (see 7.1.d) shall be used to facilitate viewing the bubbles, and the devices shall be observed
against a black nonreflective background.
7.2.1 Failure criteria. Any device that shows one or more nonreflective attached growing bubbles, one continuous
stream, or a succession of two or more from the same point shall be considered a failure.
8.1 Apparatus. Apparatus for this test shall consist of the following:
a. Ultraviolet light source with peak radiation at approximately the frequency causing maximum reflection of
the dye (3650 for Zyglo; 4935 for Flurosecein; 5560 for Rhodamine B).
c. Solution of fluorescent dye, (such as Rhodamine B, Fluorescein, Dye-check, Zyglo, FL-50 or equivalent),
mixed in accordance with the manufacturer's specification.
d. A magnifier capable of magnifying an object 1.5 to 30 times its nominal size (4 to 120 diopters).
METHOD 1071.8
6
8.2 Procedure. This test shall be permitted only on transparent glass encased devices or for destructive
verification of opaque devices. The pressure chamber shall be filled with the dye solution to a depth sufficient to
completely cover all the devices. The devices shall be placed in the solution and the chamber pressurized at 104
psia (719 kPa) minimum for 3 hour minimum. For device packages which will not withstand 105 psia (724 kPa), 60
psia (414 kPa) minimum for 10 hours may be used. The devices shall then be removed and carefully washed, using
a suitable solvent for the dye used, followed by an air jet dry. Transparent devices may be examined under
magnification capable of magnifying an object up to 1.5 times its normal size (4 diopters) using ultraviolet light source
of appropriate frequency for evidence of the dye penetration. For the destructive examination of opaque devices, the
devices shall be delidded and examined internally under the magnifier using an ultraviolet light source of appropriate
frequency.
8.2.1 Failure criteria. Any evidence of dye in the cavity of the device shall constitute a failure.
8.2.1.1 Opaque devices. After de-lidding or separation of the device (as applicable), any evidence of dye
penetration shall be cause for rejection. Area of examination shall be as shown on figures 1071-1 and 1071-2.
8.2.1.2 Transparent glass, with large cavity (i.e. S-Bend, C-Bend, or straight-through constructions). Any evidence
of dye penetration in the device cavity shall be cause for rejection. Area of examination shall be as shown on figure
1071-3.
8.2.1.3 Transparent glass, double plug construction (-1 and tungsten). Any evidence of dye penetration in the die
area shall be cause for rejection. In addition, evidence of dye penetration into a crack, fracture, void, which is closer
to the die than 50 percent of the designed seal length shall be rejected. Area of examination shall be as shown on
figure 1071-4.
9.2 Testing parameters. The bombing pressure and soak time shall be determined in accordance with the
following equation:
R
Equation (1): QS =
SKT Pt
The parameters of equation (1) are defined as follows:
QS = The maximum leak rate allowable, in atm cc/s Kr, for the devices to be tested.
R = Counts per minute above the ambient background after pressurization if the device leak rate were
exactly equal to QS. This is the reject count above the background of both the counting equipment and
the component, if it has been through prior radioactive leak tests.
S = The specific activity, in microcuries per atmospheric cubic centimeter, of the krypton-85 tracer gas in
the pressurization system.
K = The overall counting efficiency of the scintillation crystal in counts per minute per microcurie of
krypton-85 in the internal void of the specific component being evaluated. This factor depends upon
component configuration and dimensions of the scintillation crystal. The counting efficiency shall be
determined in accordance with 9.3.
T = Soak time, in hours, that the devices are to be pressurized.
P = Pe2 - Pi2, where Pe is the pressure in atmospheres absolute, and Pi is the original internal pressure of
the devices in atmospheres absolute. The bombing pressure (Pe) may be established by specification
or, if a convenient soak time (T) has been established, the pressure (Pe) can be adjusted to satisfy
equation (1).
NOTE: The complete version of equation (1) contains a factor (PO2 - (P)2) in the numerator which is a correction
factor for elevation above sea level. PO is sea level pressure in atmospheres absolute and P is the difference in
pressure, in atmospheres between the actual pressure at the test station and sea level pressure. For the purpose of
this test method, this factor has been dropped.
9.3 Determination of counting efficiency (K). The counting efficiency (K) of equation (1) shall be determined as
follows:
a. A representative unit of the device type being tested shall have a known microcurie content of krypton-85
placed in the internal void of the device.
b. The counts per minute from the representative unit shall be measured in the shielded scintillation crystal of
the counting station in exactly the same position as the actual samples will be measured. From this value,
the counting efficiency, in counts per minute per microcurie, shall be calculated.
METHOD 1071.8
8
9.4 Evaluation of surface sorption. All device encapsulations consisting of glass, metal, substrate and chip
coatings, and ceramic or combinations thereof, that also include external coatings and external sealants or labels,
shall be evaluated for surface sorption of krypton-85 before establishing the leak test parameters. Representative
samples with the questionable surface material shall be subjected to the predetermined pressure and time conditions
established for the device configuration as specified by 9.2. The samples shall then be measured at the counting
station every 10 minutes, with count rates noted, until the count rate becomes asymptotic with time. (This is the point
in time at which surface sorption is no longer a problem.) This time lapse shall be noted and shall determine the "wait
time" specified in 9.5.
9.5 Procedure. The devices shall be placed in the radioactive tracer gas pressurization tank. The tank may be
partially filled with inert material (aluminum filler blocks), to reduce machine cycle time and increase the efficiency of
the system. The tank shall be evacuated to 0.5 torr. The devices shall be subjected to a minimum of 45 psi absolute
pressure of krypton-85/nitrogen mixture for a minimum of 12 minutes. Actual pressure and soak time shall be
determined in accordance with 9.2. The R value in counts per minute shall not be less than 500 above background.
The krypton-85/nitrogen gas mixture shall be transferred to storage until 0.5 torr pressure exists in the pressurization
tank. The storage cycle shall be completed in 3 minutes maximum as measured from the end of the bombing cycle
or from the time the tank pressure reaches 60 psia (414 kPa) if a higher bombing pressure is used. The tank shall
then immediately be backfilled with air. The devices shall then be removed from the tank and measured within one-
half hour after gas exposure with a scintillation-crystal-equipped counting station. Device encapsulations that come
under the requirements of 9.4 shall be exposed to ambient air for a time not less than the "wait time" determined by
9.4. In no case will the time between removal from the pressurization chamber and test exceed 1 hour. This air
exposure shall be performed after gas exposure but before determining leak rate with the counting station. Device
encapsulations that do not come under the requirements of 9.4 may be tested without a "wait time". (The number of
devices removed from pressurization for measurement shall be limited such that the test of the last device can be
completed within one half hour.)
The actual leak rate of the component shall be calculated with the following equation:
Equation (2):
9.5.1 Failure criteria. Unless otherwise specified, devices that exhibit a leak rate equal to or greater than the test
limits of table 1071-IV shall be considered as failures.
9.6.2 Testing parameters. The bombing pressure and soak time shall be as in 9.2.
METHOD 1071.8
9
9.6.5 Procedure G1/G2 combination gross/fine test. The devices shall be placed in a radioactive gas pressurization
chamber. The pressurization chamber must be filled with inert material (aluminum filler blocks), to reduce cycle time
and make the test more efficient. The chamber shall be evacuated to 0.5 torr. The devices shall be subjected to a
minimum of 45 psia of krypton-85/air mixture for a minimum of 12 minutes. Actual pressure and soak time for G1
shall be in accordance with 9.5. The R value in counts per minute shall not be less than 500 c/m above background.
When the soak time is completed the krypton-85/air mixture shall be transferred to storage until 2.0 torr pressure
exists in the pressurization chamber. The storage cycle shall be completed in 3 minutes as measured from the end of
the pressurization cycle or from the time the tank pressure reaches 60 psia, (if a higher pressure was used). The tank
shall then be backfilled with air. The devices shall immediately be removed from the tank and measured at the
counting station within 10 minutes after removal from the tank. Devices that come under the conditions of 9.6.4 and
require a wait time, cannot be subjected to the gross/fine combination test. Those devices must be subjected to G1
and G2 separately.
10. Test condition H1 or H2 tracer gas (He) fine leak and CH1 or CH2 combined fine/gross leak. Test condition H1
is a "fixed" method with specified conditions in accordance with table 1071-V that will ensure the test sensitivity
necessary to detect the required measured leak rate (R1). Test condition H2 is a "flexible" method that allows the
variance of test conditions in accordance with the formula of 10.2.1.2 to detect the specified equivalent standard leak
rate (L) at a predetermined leak rate (R1). Test conditions CH1 and CH2 expand the range of H1 and H2 to include
the gross leak range and require the same test conditions using specialized apparatus.
10.1 Apparatus. Apparatus required for test conditions H1, H2, CH1, and CH2 shall consist of suitable pressure
and vacuum chambers and a mass spectrometer-type leak detector properly calibrated for a helium leak rate
sensitivity sufficient to read measured helium leak rates of 1 x 10-9 atm cm3/s and greater. The volume of the
chamber used for leak rate measurement should be held to the minimum practical, since this chamber volume has an
adverse effect on sensitivity limits. The leak detector indicator shall be calibrated using a diffusion-type calibrated
standard leak at least once every working shift. In addition, the test apparatus for CH1 and CH2 shall utilize a
specialized pumping system which enables the volume of helium released to be measured as well as the rate of
change or slope of the helium such that the leak rate is determined from the slope measurement for fine leaks and
the volume for gross leaks.
10.2 Procedure applicable to "fixed" and "flexible" methods. The completed devices(s) shall be placed in a sealed
chamber which is then pressurized with a tracer gas of 100 +0, -5 percent helium for the required time and pressure.
The pressure shall then be relieved (an optional air nitrogen wash may be applied except for CH1 and CH2) and each
specimen transferred to another chamber, or chambers, which are connected to the evacuating system and a
mass-spectrometer-type leak detector. When the chamber(s) is evacuated, any tracer gas which was previously
forced into the specimen will thus be drawn out and indicated by the leak detector as a measured leak rate (R1).
(The number of devices removed from pressurization for leak testing shall be limited such that the test of the last
device can be completed within 60 minutes for test condition H1 or CH1 or within the chosen value of dwell time t2 for
test condition H2 or CH2).
10.2.1 Evaluation of surface sorption. All device encapsulations consisting of glass, metal, and ceramic, or
combinations thereof, including coatings and external sealants, shall be evaluated for surface sorption of helium
before establishing the leak test parameters. Representative specimens of the questionable devices should be
opened and all parts of each device as a unit shall be subjected to the predetermined pressure and time conditions
established for the device configuration as specified in table 1071-V and 10.2.1.2. The measured leak rate for each
device shall be monitored and the lapsed time shall be determined for the indicated leak rate to fall to 0.5 R1 as
specified in table 1071-V for test condition H1 or as predetermined for test condition H2. The average of the lapsed
time following the release of pressure will determine the minimum usable dwell time. Note that the sensitivity of
measurement increases as this background indicated leak rate decreases relative to the R1 reject level. Alternately,
whole (unopened) specimens of the questionable devices shall be subjected to the same process; then, the shorted
value of lapsed time so obtained will determine the minimum dwell time. The fixed method will not be used if the
consequent dwell time exceeds the value specified in table 1071-V. It is noted that sorption may vary with pressure
and time of exposure so that some trial may be required before satisfactory exposure values are obtained. The test
conditions CH1 and CH2 require the same dwell times be established before the slope is determined and, in addition,
a volume determination must be made to eliminate the potential for a false gross leak.
METHOD 1071.8
10
10.2.1.1 Test condition H1 and CH1 fixed method. The device(s) shall be tested using the appropriate conditions
specified in table 1071-V for the internal cavity volumes of the package under test. The t1 is the time under pressure
and time t2 is the maximum time allowed after the release of pressure before the device shall be read. The fixed
method shall not be used if the maximum standard leak rate limit given in the performance specification is less than
the limits specified herein for the flexible method.
10.2.1.2 Test condition H2 and CH2 flexible method. Values for bomb pressure, exposure time, and dwell time
shall be chosen such that actual measured tracer gas leak rate (R1) readings obtained for the DUTs (if defective) will
be greater than the minimum detectable leak rate capability of a mass spectrometer. The devices shall be subjected
to a minimum of 29 psi (203 kPa) of helium atmosphere. The chosen values of pressurization and time of
pressurization, in conjunction with the value of the internal volume of the device package to be tested, and the
maximum equivalent standard leak rate (L) limit as specified in 10.2.2, shall be used to calculate the measured leak
rate (R1) limit using the following formula:
Equation (3):
METHOD 1071.8
11
The minimum detectable leak rate shall be determined as in 10.2.1 and shall be taken as the indicated value
corresponding to a lapsed time t0 < t2. The lapsed time t0 shall be taken as the minimum usable dwell time, and leak
testing shall be accomplished in the interval between t0 and t2. Alternately, pressurization parameters may be
chosen from the fine leak approximate solution of equation (3) for L < 1 x 10-5 as:
Equation (4):
1/2
P R V
L = o 1
2.69 P e t 1
with a graphical representation given on figure 1071-5. If chosen dwell time t2 is greater than 60 minutes, equation
(2) shall be used to determine an R1 value which will assure a maximum detectable standard leak rate large enough
to overlap with the selected gross leak test condition. Alternately, the largest detectable leak rate (L) as a function of
dwell time may be obtained from the approximate solution:
Equation (5):
V 2.69 L Pe
L max = P o 1n
2.69 t 2 P R
o 1
with graphical representation given on figure 1071-6. In each case (equations (4) and (5)) R1 shall be taken large
compared to the minimum detectable value. 1/
10.2.1.3 Package volume and leak rate limits for CH1 and CH2. For test methods CH1, the minimum size package
is determined by the ability of the apparatus to effectively detect a gross leak one hour after the device has been
removed from the trace gas pressurization chamber with a signal to noise (background) ratio of at least five to one. It
may be necessary to use a shorter test interval if the apparatus has a high background level of helium or the surface
absorption of the device is high. A reasonable lower limit would be 0.0005 scc. The only limit on maximum size is the
size of the test chamber to accommodate the DUT. A gross leak is defined as a hole in the package at least .010
inches (0.254 mm) in diameter. Very small packages may be stored in an atmosphere containing at least 10 percent
helium after bombing to insure adequate signal to noise ratio for the gross leak test over the one hour test interval.
Please note that for the CH2 test method, the dwell time chosen should be less than 60 minutes or a 10 percent
helium storage container must be used to store the device from the time it is removed from the pressurization
chamber to when it is inserted into the test apparatus. The demonstrated minimum detectable leak rate for this test
method is 3E-13 atm-cc/sec; however, the design of the apparatus can increase or decrease this limit.
____________
1/ From "Standard Recommended Practices for Determining Hermeticity of Electron Devices with a Helium Mass
Spectrometer Leak Detector," ASTM Designation F134, Pt. 43.
10.2.2 Failure criteria. Unless otherwise specified, devices with an internal cavity volume of 0.01 cm3 or less shall
-9
not be accepted if the equivalent standard leak rate (L) exceeds 1 x 10 atm cm3/s. Devices with an internal cavity
3 3
volume greater than 0.01 cm , and equal to or less than 0.5 cm , shall not be accepted if the equivalent standard leak
-9 3
rate (L) exceeds 5 x 10 atm cm3/s. Devices with an internal cavity volume greater than 0.5 cm shall not be
-8
accepted if the equivalent standard leak rate (L) exceeds 1 x 10 atm cm3/s.
METHOD 1071.8
12
11.1 Apparatus. Apparatus for this test shall consist of the following:
a. A vacuum/pressure chamber for the evacuation and subsequent pressure bombing of devices up to 90 psia
(618 kPa) for up to 10 hours.
d. A filtration system capable of removing particles greater than one micrometer in size from the fluid.
f. A suitable solvent.
11.2 Procedure. The devices shall be cleaned by placing them in a container of a suitable solvent at +25C and
allowed then to soak for 2 minutes minimum. The devices shall then be removed and placed in an oven at +125C
5C for 1 hour minimum, after which they shall be allowed to cool to room ambient temperature. Each device shall
be weighed and the initial weight recorded, or the devices may be categorized into cells as follows: Devices having a
volume of 0.01 cm3 shall be categorized in cells of 0.5 milligram increments and devices with volumes >0.01 cm3
shall be categorized in cells of 1.0 milligram increments. The devices shall be placed in a vacuum/pressure chamber
and the pressure reduced to 0.0967 psia (667 Pa) and maintained for 1 hour except that for devices with an internal
cavity volume 0.1 cm3, this vacuum cycle may be omitted. A sufficient amount of type III detector fluorocarbon fluid
shall be admitted to the pressure chamber to cover the devices. When the vacuum cycle is performed, the fluid shall
be admitted after the 1 hour period but before breaking the vacuum. The devices shall then be pressurized to 75 psia
(517 kPa) except that 618 kPa (90 psia) shall be used when the vacuum has been omitted. The pressure shall be
maintained for two hours minimum. If the devices will not withstand the 75 psia (517 kPa) test pressure, the pressure
may be lowered to 45 psia (310 kPa) with the vacuum cycle and pressure maintained for 10 hours minimum. Upon
completion of the pressurization period, the pressure shall be released and the devices removed from the pressure
chamber and retained in a bath of the fluorocarbon fluid. When the devices are removed from the fluid they shall be
air dried for 2 minutes 1 minute prior to weighing. The devices shall be transferred singly to the balance and the
weight, or weight category, of each device determined. All devices shall be tested within 4 minutes following removal
from the fluid. The delta weight shall be calculated from the record of the initial weight and the post weight of the
device. Devices which were categorized shall be separated into two groups, one of which shall be the devices which
shifted one cell or less, and the other devices which shifted more than one cell.
11.3 Failure criteria. A device shall be rejected if it gains 1.0 milligram or more and has an internal volume of
0.01 cm3, and 2.0 milligrams or more if the volume is >0.01 cm3. If the devices are categorized, any device which
gains enough weight to cause the device to shift by more than one cell shall be considered a reject. A device which
loses weight of an amount which, if gained, would cause the device to be rejected may be retested after it is baked at
+125C 5C for a period of 8 hours minimum.
METHOD 1071.8
13
a. A vacuum/pressure chamber for the evacuation and subsequent pressure bombing of devices up to 90 psia
(620 kPa) for up to 12 hours.
b. A fluorocarbon vapor detection system capable of detecting vapor quantities equivalent to 0.28 milligram of
type I fluid.
d. Suitable calibrated instruments to indicate that test, purge times, and temperatures are as specified. The
detection system shall be calibrated at least once each shift when production occurs by introducing 1
microliter of type I detector fluid into the test chamber. The resulting reading shall be adjusted in
accordance with the manufacturer's instructions.
e. The vapor detector used for condition K shall be calibrated at least once each working shift using a type I
fluid calibration source, and following the manufacturer's instructions.
12.2 Procedure. The devices shall be placed in a vacuum/pressure chamber and the pressure reduced to 5 torr or
less and maintained for 30 minutes minimum. A sufficient amount of type I detector fluid shall be admitted to the
pressure chamber to cover the devices. The fluid shall be admitted after the 30 minute vacuum period but before
breaking the vacuum. The devices shall then be pressurized and maintained in accordance with table 1071-III. Upon
completion of the pressurization period, the pressure shall be released, the devices removed from the pressure
chamber without being removed from the detector fluid for more than 20 seconds, and then retained in a bath of
fluorocarbon fluid. When the devices are removed from the fluid they shall be air dried for a minimum of 20 seconds
and a maximum of 5 minutes prior to the test cycle. If the type I detector fluid has a boiling point of less than +80C,
the maximum drying time shall be 3 minutes. The devices shall then be tested with a fluorocarbon vapor detection
system that is calibrated in accordance with 12.1. "Purge" time shall be in accordance with table 1071-VI. Test time
shall be a minimum of 3.5 seconds unless the device is rejected earlier. The system's purge and test chambers shall
be at a temperature of +125C 5C. Test time shall be 2.5 seconds minimum with the purge and test chambers at a
temperature of +150C 5C.
NOTE: Test temperature shall be measured at the chamber surface that is in contact with the DUT.
12.3 Failure criteria. A device shall be rejected if the detector instrumentation indicates more than the equivalent
of 0.28 milligrams of type I detector fluid in accordance with table 1071-II.
0.01 5
0.01 0.10 9
0.1 13
NOTE: Purge time shall be defined as the total time the device is heated
prior to entering the test mode. Maximum purge time can be determined by
cycling a device with a .02 inch to .05 inch (0.51 mm to 1.27 mm) hole and
measuring the maximum purge time that can be used without permitting the
device to escape detection.
METHOD 1071.8
14
13.1 Apparatus:
a. An optical inspection station capable of evacuation and pressurization, and subsequent detection of
package lid deformation.
b. Suitable calibration instrumention to indicate test results, times, and pressures are as specified.
13.2 Lid stiffness. Test condition L1 and L2 are valid only for packages with thin lids (thickness < 0.025 typically for
metallic lids). The test sensitivity is related to the extent of deformation of the lid due to the specific pressure change
and the test time used. For a specific lid material ad size the following formula must be met:
Where: R = The minimum width of free lid (inside braze or cavity dimension in inches).
E = The modulus of elasticity of the lid material.
Aluminum: E = 10 x 106 lb/in2.
Kovar: E = 20 x 106 lb/in2.
Ceramic: E = 60 x 106 lb/in2.
T = The thickness of the lid (inches).
13.3 Leak sensitivity. The optical leak test shall be performed with a test pressure (Po) and time (t), which will
provide the leak rate sensitivity required. The leak rate sensitivity is provided by the following equation:
13.4 Test condition L1 - optical gross leak. The completed device(s) shall be placed in the sealed test chamber.
The optical interferometer shall be set to observe the package lid. The chamber shall then be evacuated while the
deformation of the lid is being observed with the optical interferometer. The deformation of the lid with pressure
change, and the lack of continued deformation of the lid with reduced pressure held for time t1 (or equivalent
procedure), will be observed for each package in the field of view simultaneously.
13.4.1 Failure criteria. A device shall be rejected if the optical interferometer did not detect deformation of the lid
as the chamber pressure was initially changed, or if the interferometer detects the lid deforming as the chamber
pressure is held constant (or equivalent procedure).
13.5 Test condition L2 - optical gross/fine leak. The completed device(s) shall be placed in the sealed test
chamber. The optical interferometer shall be set to observe the package lid. The chamber shall then be evacuated
while the deformation of the lid is being observed with the optical interferometer. The deformation of the lid with
pressure change, and the lack of continued deformation of the lid with reduced pressure held for time t1 (or equivalent
procedure), will be observed for each package in the field of view simultaneously. The sealed test chamber is then
pressurized with helium gas to no more than 2 atmospheres. The lack of deformation of the lid is then observed with
an optical interferometer to time t2 (or equivalent procedure).
METHOD 1071.8
15
13.5.1 Failure criteria. A device shall be rejected for any of the three following criteria: (1) If the interferometer did
not detect deformation of the lid as the chamber pressure was initially changed; or, (2) if the interferometer detects
the lid deforming form the package leaking its entrapped internal pressure during time t1 as the pressure is held
constant (or equivalent procedure); or, (3) if the interferometer detects the lid deforming from the package leaking in
the pressurized helium gas during time t2 as the pressure is held constant (or equivalent procedure).
14. Notes.
1. The fine leak test shall be performed first if condition A or E is used for gross leak. Gross leak may be
performed prior to fine leak if condition C, D, J, K, or L is used for gross leak and provided that the vapor
pressure of the fluorocarbon material used in condition C, J, and K (which may be inside the device) is
greater than 59 psia (406 kPa), TA = +125C. The devices shall be subjected to a bake at this temperature
for a minimum of 1 hour prior to performing the fine leak test. This sequence should be true regardless of
whether the leak tests are part of a screening sequence or are included as group B or group C
requirements.
2. For test conditions A through E, K, and L1, the maximum allowable leak rate should not be specified
because these tests are "go"/"no-go" type tests that do not provide an indication of actual leak rate.
(Although test conditions A, B, K, and L1 have a definite quantitative measurement to be met, they are still
considered "go"/"no-go" tests.)
3. When retesting devices to test condition H, the history of device exposure to helium including dates,
backfilling performed, tracer gas concentrations, pressure, and time exposed, should be known in order to
ensure reliable results. When retesting devices to conditions G1 or G2, the history of the prior testing is not
required. The devices are pre-read for residual krypton-85 gas just prior to retesting. Any prior krypton-85
reading is subtracted from the reading after retesting. The new net reading indicates leakage.
4. Reject value of equivalent standard leak rate as a function of pressurization conditions and indicated leak
rate as computed from the approximate solution, for small leaks where dwell time t2 is not a significant
factor. The reject level R2 shall be taken larger relative to the minimum detectable R value.
METHOD 1071.8
16
NOTE:
Upper test limit of equivalent standard leak rate as a function of dwell time, pressurization, and indicated
leak rate as computed from the approximate solution, (e.g., for larger leaks where internal pressurization is
complete).
15. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable performance specification:
b. Accept or reject leak rate for test conditions G, H1, or H2 when other than the accept or reject leak rate
specified herein applies (see 9.5.1, 10.2.1.1, and 10.2.2).
d. Retest acceptability for test conditions G and H (see 9.). For K (see 3.e.).
e. Order of performance of fine and gross if other than fine followed by gross (see 3.).
METHOD 1071.8
17
METHOD 1080
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to describe the procedure for conducting heavy ion irradiation of
power MOSFETs. This test method establishes a procedure for characterization and for verification (acceptance or
qualification) of discrete power MOSFETs for single-event burnout (SEB) and single-event gate rupture (SEGR). In
principle, this test method may be applicable to testing where neutrons, protons, or other light particles are used.
1.1 Terms and definitions. The following symbols and terms shall apply for the purpose of this test method:
g. Linear energy transfer (LET): The amount of energy transferred per unit length as the ion travels through
2
a material, expressed as MeV/(mg/cm ) in this test method.
h. Single-event burnout (SEB): A single-ion-induced condition that causes a localized high-current state
resulting in a catastrophic device failure characterized by an increase in drain current that exceeds the
manufacturers rated leakage current at the drain electrode.
i. Single-event gate rupture (SEGR): A single-ion-induced condition that causes a localized defect in the
gate dielectric resulting in a catastrophic device failure, characterized by an increase in gate current that
exceeds the manufacturers rated leakage current at the gate electrode.
j. SEB circumvention: A technique used to prevent the device from catastrophically failing during an SEB
event.
k. SEB cross-sectional area: Calculated as the number of SEB events per unit fluence.
l. SEGR cross-sectional area: Calculated as the reciprocal of the fluence required to induce the SEGR
event.
m. SEGR post gate-stress test: After the heavy ion irradiation, a test is conducted to verify the gate integrity
by applying the maximum specified VGS.
n. Threshold LET: The minimum LET required to cause a single-ion-induced failure under the specified bias
conditions.
q. VTH: The value of VGS where the inversion layer is formed and the device turns on.
METHOD 1080
1 of 10
1.2 Applicable documents. The following documents form part of this test method. The most current revision of
these documents shall take precedence over those cited.
ASTM F-1192 - Standard Guide for the Measurement of Single-Event Phenomena from Heavy Ion
Irradiation of Semiconductor Devices.
1.3 Device handling. Special care shall be taken to ensure that the devices are not damaged before testing.
Since the lids are removed before irradiation, extra precautions shall be taken to protect the exposed die.
Otherwise, devices shall be handled in accordance with standard operating procedures to protect against damage
and electrostatic discharge. Use of anti-static foams, grounding straps, and other precautions is recommended.
NOTE: Some power MOSFETs may require voltages that exceed 500 volts and voltages in excess of 32 volts can
present a safety hazard. Safety precautions shall be taken to ensure safe operation of all equipment and personnel.
Note that conformal coatings may interfere with the test, changing the penetration depth of the ion as well as
degrading the ion energy. The effect of conformal coatings shall be evaluated. Conformal coatings, such as
polyamide, shall be chemically removed before testing.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus required for SEB/SEGR testing consists of a heavy ion source, a vacuum chamber
system, DUT test instrumentation, test circuit board(s), cabling, switching system (if required), an x-y-z stage system
(if required), and dosimetry measurement instrumentation. Precautions shall be taken to obtain an electrical
measurement system with sufficient insulation, shielding, and grounding to measure a gate current, IGS, of 10 nA or
less (measurement resolution).
2.1 Heavy ion source. The heavy ion source shall be a cyclotron, Van de Graaff accelerator, or other suitable
2
source. The heavy ion source shall be capable of providing an average ion flux up to 100,000 ions/cm s. The
average beam uniformity should be maintained within 15 percent over the die area unless otherwise specified. The
ion beam energy shall provide sufficient ion penetration depth to induce the SEGR response or as agreed to by both
parties to the test. Note that the accelerator design determines the maximum ion beam energy; and, therefore,
some accelerators may be inadequate to perform a worst-case test condition. Also, note that some accelerators are
rf-type machines (e.g. cyclotrons) and may have higher instantaneous fluxes.
2.2 Vacuum chamber system. The chamber shall have a test circuit board mounting frame and cable feed-
through. The vacuum chamber system should be capable of accepting an x-y-z stage mechanism. The pumping
-1 -3
system shall be capable of evacuating the vacuum chamber below1.3 x 10 Pa (10 torr). Precautions shall be
taken to ensure that any component placed in the vacuum chamber does not interfere with the vacuum system.
Note that certain materials can out-gas, affecting the vacuum quality. Also note that some capacitors (e.g.,
electrolytic capacitors) can explode, fail, or out-gas when placed in a vacuum.
2.3 Test instrumentation. Standard electrical test instruments capable of establishing the required test conditions
and measuring the required electrical parameters shall be used. Note that many power MOSFETs may require
operating voltages in excess of 32 volts and safety precautions shall be followed to ensure safe operation of all
equipment and personnel.
2.3.1 SEB instrumentation. Test instrumentation to bias and monitor the DUT may consist of one or more of the
following types of instruments:
a. Power supply.
b. Ammeter.
c. Voltmeter.
d. Counter.
e. Oscilloscope.
METHOD 1080
2
2.3.2 SEGR instrumentation. Test instrumentation to bias and monitor the DUT may consist of one or more of the
following types of instruments:
a. Power supply.
b. Ammeter.
c. Voltmeter.
2.4 Test circuit board. The test circuit board contains the test socket, delidded DUT, any additional wiring, and
any auxiliary components. The test board provides a mounting surface and interface between the test
instrumentation and the DUT, applying VGS and VDS, while monitoring IGS and IDS. Figure 1080-1 shows a
representative test circuit and figure 1080-2 shows a typical SEB circumvention and monitoring technique. Any
auxiliary components, such as the resistors, capacitors, or current probes, shall be included in the final test circuit.
Any accepted SEB circumvention and monitoring technique is acceptable. The test board can have multiple test
sockets to minimize the time required to vent and evacuate the vacuum chamber. The test socket, in which the DUT
is inserted, is mounted in such a way that the DUT surface shall be perpendicular (nominally within 5C) to the
heavy ion beam. The DUT is delidded prior to testing, and the entire die shall be irradiated.
DUT DUT
IG ID IG ID
Current
V GS V DS VGS Probe VDS
FIGURE 1080-1. Basic SEB/SEGR test circuit. FIGURE 1080-2. SEB circumvention and
monitoring circuit.
2.5 Cabling. Cables are typically used to connect the test circuit board, located in the vacuum chamber, to the
test instrumentation, normally placed outside the vacuum chamber. The cable length shall be minimized to prevent
interference with the desired measurement. However, the actual cable length is dictated by the size of the vacuum
chamber, the spatial location of the test board with respect to the cabling feed-throughs, and the minimum distance
from the cabling feed-throughs to the DUT test instrumentation. Observation of SEB pulses shall be performed
using properly terminated shielded cables to minimize reflections and other signal/noise interference.
2.6 Switching system. A switching system can be used when multiple devices are placed on the test board. The
switching system shall provide electrical isolation between the gate and drain electrodes of the various test devices
on the test board. Inclusion of a switching system shall not interfere with the electrical measurement system, as
specified in 2.
2.7 X-Y-Z stage system. If multiple devices are placed on the test board, an x-y-z stage system can be used to
provide a mechanical mechanism to move the device into and out of the heavy ion beam.
2.8 Dosimetry system. The dosimetry system shall be used to determine the ion beam energy, LET, average ion
beam flux, fluence, and average ion beam uniformity. Note that many facilities provide this dosimetry system.
METHOD 1080
3
3. SEB/SEGR prediction. To assist in the preparation of the test plan and the selection of initial bias conditions,
an appropriate SEB/SEGR prediction method may be utilized to predict the SEB/SEGR failure thresholds. The
preferred prediction method is to use previous measurements on similar device types. Test personnel should use
these predicted failure thresholds to help verify that the SEGR and SEB test measurements are valid. If a significant
difference (nominally greater than a 30 percent deviation from the predicted response) is observed, the test
personnel should verify the test setup including the ion specie, ion energy, bias conditions, and device type. These
predictions can help to develop the overall test plan.
3.1 SEB prediction. Currently, there are not any accurate prediction models available for SEB. Predictions based
upon previously obtained SEB data are helpful, but, due to the nature of the failure mechanism, cannot be used to
accurately predict SEB.
3.2 SEGR prediction. Predictions of SEGR can be made from previous SEGR data or calculated using currently
accepted models. If previous test results are unavailable or the device layout, design, or process has been modified,
then SEGR failure thresholds can be predicted using an empirical prediction method or an analytical prediction
method.
3.2.1 SEGR empirical prediction. The empirical prediction method uses an empirically derived equation to predict
the SEGR failure threshold of the oxide capacitor when VDS = 0 volts, as expressed by equation (1).
( EOX _ BR )(TOX )
VGS =
LET
1+
53
Where: EOX_BR is the breakdown field strength of the oxide (V/cm), TOX is the thickness of the gate oxide
dielectric (cm), and LET_PEAK is the maximum LET value of the given ion species in MeV/mg/cm2.
An approximation of the substrate response for the case when VDS is biased can be obtained by using an expanded
form of equation (1). This expanded equation is expressed by equation (2).
LET
( EOX _ BR )(TOX )
VGS =(0.84)(1 e 17
)(VDS )
LET
1+
53
Where: EOX_BR is the breakdown field strength of the oxide (V/cm), TOX is the thickness of the gate oxide
dielectric (cm), and LET is the linear energy transfer in (MeV/mg/cm2). LET PEAK is the maximum LET
value of the given ion species in MeV/mg/cm2
3.2.2 SEGR analytical prediction. Analytical predictions can be obtained using sophisticated numerical
simulations to predict the SEGR failure threshold response. Additional information concerning these predictions can
be found in the literature.
METHOD 1080
4
4. Characterization tests. Characterization testing is that testing required to obtain an SEB cross-sectional area
curve, an SEGR cross-sectional area curve, or an SEGR failure threshold curve. Data points are taken to describe
the response of the discrete MOSFET as a function of VGS and/or VDS over the operating range of the device and/or
over a range of LET values. Characterization testing should be conducted initially to define the worst-case operating
conditions of the device or to identify the sensitive die area. Additional characterization testing may be required after
process and/or design changes have been made to the device. Characterization tests are useful for establishing the
conditions for subsequent verification tests. Characterization testing does not have to be performed as a part of the
verification testing unless fabrication changes have been made that might invalidate the initial technology
characterization. Note that angling the die surface away from the plane where the ion beam is perpendicular to the
die surface to produce an effective LET is invalid and shall not be used. It has been reported that the ion energy can
influence the measured SEGR failure thresholds, suggesting that the ion energy shall be considered when a worst
case test condition is specified. The maximum allowable VDS bias increment for a DUT shall be no more than 10
percent of the devices rated drain voltage. The maximum allowable VGS bias increment for a DUT shall be no more
than 5 volts. Smaller VDS and VGS bias increments are recommended. Also, note that increasing the DUTs
operating temperature has been demonstrated to increase the LET threshold for SEB but not for SEGR, indicating
that lower operating temperatures are a worst case test condition.
4.1 SEB characterization. Characterization requires that an SEB circumvention method be utilized. SEB
characterization produces a cross-sectional area curve as a function of LET for a fixed VDS and VGS. SEB is not
sensitive to changes in the gate bias, VGS. The VGS bias shall be sufficient to bias the DUT in an off state (a few
volts below VTH), allowing for total dose effects that may reduce the VTH. Multiple SEB cross-sectional area curves
may be required, expressing different operating conditions for VDS. Note that p-channel devices have not been
demonstrated to be sensitive to SEB.
4.1.1 SEB cross-sectional area If specified as a test requirement and if SEB is observed, one of the many
reported techniques can be used to circumvent catastrophic SEB failure, such as a current-limiting resistor placed
between the drain stiffening capacitor and the drain electrode. Then, to obtain an SEB error count, a current probe
(Tektronix CT-2, sense resistor, or other suitable current probe) shall be inserted between the source electrode and
ground. Using this setup, an SEB event will produce current pulses. SEB occurrence can be monitored using an
electronic oscilloscope to record the shape of the SEB pulse(s), if required, and a pulse counter to record the
number of SEB occurrences. A point on the SEB cross-sectional area curve is then obtained by dividing the number
of SEB events by the fluence for that given test condition. The SEB cross sectional curve is subsequently found by
finding points at several different LET values. After the DUTs have been delidded and the chamber evacuated,
apply the specified VGS and VDS bias condition; and irradiate the DUT to the specified fluence level (typical ranges
5 7 2
are between 10 and 10 ions/cm ). If SEB occurs, record the event by incrementing the counter. The flux shall be
adjusted so that the number of SEB events is no more than 100 events per second. When the desired fluence is
achieved, the beam is shuttered; and the total number of SEB events are recorded. This process is continued,
selecting different ions to obtain the required LET values. Repeat this process for the specified samples and
conditions.
4.2 SEGR characterization. SEGR characterization may produce three unique curves: An SEGR cross-sectional
area curve as a function of LET for a fixed VGS and VDS bias condition; an SEGR threshold curve of VGS as a function
of VDS for a fixed LET value; or an SEGR threshold curve of VDS as a function of LET at a fixed VGS. Multiple SEGR
cross sectional area curves may be required to express different VDS and VGS conditions. Multiple SEGR threshold
curves may be required to express different VGS, VDS, or LET conditions. SEGR characterization may be performed
in conjunction with SEGR verification.
METHOD 1080
5
4.2.1 SEGR cross-sectional area. If specified in the test requirements and if SEGR occurs, an SEGR cross-
sectional area curve can be obtained. However, SEGR cannot be circumvented. Hence, to obtain an SEGR cross-
sectional area curve requires the destruction of numerous devices. For a given device, the ion irradiation would be
terminated upon detection of SEGR. One point on the SEGR cross-sectional area curve can be obtained by dividing
one SEGR event by the measured fluence to induce that event. After the DUTs have been delidded and the
chamber evacuated, apply the specified VGS and VDS bias condition; and irradiate the DUT to the specified fluence
level. If SEGR occurs, immediately terminate the exposure; and record the accumulated fluence. Note that the ion
flux can be lowered to obtain a more accurate fluence. If the maximum fluence is achieved and the DUT passes the
post gate-stress test, a new test condition or a new DUT is selected. If SEGR occurs, a new DUT is selected. Apply
the new test condition (incrementing VGS, VDS, or changing the ion specie). This process is repeated until the
desired curve is obtained. Repeat this process to obtain the required curves. Note that characterization results in
device failure and only represents a single data point for that device. For the special case where the applied dc field
across the gate dielectric is less than 1 MV/cm, the procedure to obtain a cross-sectional area curve should be
modified as follows:
b. After each irradiation step, a post gate-stress test shall be performed to verify device functionality;
c. If SEGR is not detected, continue irradiation steps until SEGR occurs or until the maximum accumulated
fluence is obtained; and
d. Select new device and bias condition and repeat test procedure until the desired curve is obtained.
4.2.2 SEGR post gate-stress test. If the gate bias is small (typically VGS < 10 volts) during irradiation, SEGR may
or may not produce a catastrophic failure until sufficient gate bias is applied. If an insufficient gate bias is applied,
SEGR may only produce a latent defect site. Therefore, after the irradiation, a post gate-stress test shall be
performed on each test device. The post gate-stress test shall apply a gate bias equal to the maximum operating
gate voltage (nominally 10 percent) or as specified.
5. Verification tests. Verification testing requires the irradiation of the DUT to specified test conditions (e.g. gate
bias, drain bias, ion species, ion energy, ion LET, ion range, ion flux, and ion fluence). Verification testing is useful
for hardness assurance and qualification testing of discrete power MOSFETs to determine their suitability at the
specified test conditions. These tests use a "pass"/"no pass" criterion and can be destructive. Note that angling the
die surface away from the plane where the ion beam is perpendicular to that surface to produce an effective LET is
invalid and shall not be used to conduct these tests. It has been reported that the ion energy can influence the
measured SEGR failure thresholds, suggesting that the ion energy should be considered to achieve a worst case
test condition. Also, note that increasing the DUTs operating temperature has been demonstrated to increase the
LET threshold for SEB but not for SEGR, indicating that lower operating temperatures are a worst case test
condition.
5.1 SEB verification tests. For SEB verification, a sufficiently large capacitance is placed at the drain electrode to
produce catastrophic failure. Note that no circumvention techniques are used in this test. After the DUTs have been
delidded and the chamber evacuated, apply the specified VGS and VDS bias condition and irradiate the DUT to the
specified fluence level. If failure occurs, the exposure can be terminated. Record SEB results. Repeat for the
specified samples and conditions.
METHOD 1080
6
5.2 SEGR verification tests. For SEGR verification, this test is a two-step process. After DUTs have been delidded
and the chamber evacuated, apply the specified VGS and VDS bias condition and irradiate the DUT to the specified
fluence. If failure occurs, the exposure can be terminated. The second step requires a post gate-stress test to be
performed after irradiation, if the gate bias during irradiation was less than the maximum operating gate voltage.
Record SEGR result. Repeat for the specified samples and conditions.
6. SEB/SEGR test procedure. The test plan should document the proper steps to be followed before, during, and
after heavy ion irradiation. Sufficient samples shall be obtained to conduct the test. Samples with conformal
coatings, such as polyamide, should be chemically removed before testing. SEB and SEGR both can result in
catastrophic failure that produces large leakage currents, destroying the device. In SEB testing, a capacitance
sufficient to hold the bias voltage within 10 percent may be required to induce damage during an SEB event. For
characterization testing, SEB can be circumvented and recorded producing an SEB event count, which then can be
used to produce a point on the cross-sectional area curve. To help select the proper biases, an SEB/SEGR
prediction shall be made. The required ion specie is selected and the ion beam energy shall be tuned and verified
using the dosimetry system. The test circuit board, cabling, and instrumentation shall be connected and its operation
verified. Before irradiation, test devices shall be delidded and inserted into the test board. The drain and gate
currents, IGS and IDS, shall be monitored before, during, and after the irradiation(s), as well as during the post gate-
stress test, to verify the condition of the DUT. After completion of the test run, the results of the test shall be
recorded and documented.
6.1 Test plan. A test plan shall be devised that supports each test. The test plan shall be used as a guide for the
procedures and decisions during irradiation. The test plan shall be developed, and the following conditions shall be
outlined.
6.1.1 Ion specie and energy. The test plan shall identify the ion specie and an appropriate energy to perform the
test. Selection of a specific ion specie and its energy determines the LET value. Obtaining a range of LET values
requires using different ion species at different energies. Note that using angles to modulate the LET value is
unacceptable. Selection of a different ion specie and energy by test personnel requires verification that the ion LET
and its range meet the test requirements. Verification can be made using the TRIM code or other suitable simulation
codes for the given device material. Also, note that the energy of the ion beam has been shown to influence the
SEGR failure thresholds. Therefore, determination of the worst case test condition can require multiple irradiations
with the same ion at different energies.
6.1.2 Device information. The test plan shall provide a description of the devices to be tested and the number of
test samples required for each test. The test plan shall identify the device type, acceptance lot, and other critical
information. Devices shall be marked for traceability so that lids can be removed. Identification markers should be
placed on the flange and not on the lid. Only devices that have passed the pre-electrical tests shall undergo heavy
ion testing. Test samples shall be randomly selected from the parent population. The number of samples shall be
specified to meet the test requirements. For the purposes of verification testing, a representative sample should be
selected from the lot.
6.1.3 Electrical parameters. The test plan shall specify the electrical parameters to be measured before and after
irradiation.
6.1.4 Test configuration. The test plan shall specify the bias and exposure conditions for each test sample. The
test plan shall specify the case temperature of the DUT if it is required to be set at other than the room ambient
temperature.
6.1.5 Test sequence. The test plan should specify a test sequence similar to figure 1080-3. For characterization
testing, the test plan shall define an initial bias condition and the bias increment. The VDS bias increment shall not
exceed 10 percent of the devices rated drain breakdown voltage. For verification testing, the test plan shall define
the specified biases, the minimum number of samples that shall be tested at each bias, and the handling of the
devices after testing. Any additional electrical tests shall be specified and any special handling requirements shall
be specified.
6.1.6 SEB/SEGR detection. The test plan shall specify the procedure to monitor the drain and gate currents, IGS
and IDS, before, during, and after the irradiation(s). In addition, the gate and drain currents shall be monitored during
the post gate-stress test to verify that the DUT was not damaged during the previous irradiation.
METHOD 1080
7
SELECT
START
DUT
Increment VDS Expose DUT to Ion Beam Expose DUT to Ion Beam
Monitor IGS and IDS Currents Monitor IGS and IDS Currents
Test Condition
No
Post Gate-Stress Test Post Gate Stress Test
Yes Max. VDS Monitor IGS Current Monitor IGS Current
Reached?
6.1.7 Data recording. The test plan shall specify the necessary parameters that shall be recorded during the test.
6.1.8 Reporting requirements. The test plan shall specify the test documentation as required by 7 herein.
METHOD 1080
8
6.2 Radiation test procedure. The test plan shall be used as a guide to perform the radiation test. A typical
SEB/SEGR test procedure is given here as an example.
a. Test personnel shall specify the selected ion specie and energy to the facility operators as defined in the
SEGR/SEB test plan specifying the desired flux, fluence, LET, range, and beam uniformity. Dosimetry shall
be performed to verify that the ion beam characteristics are as specified.
b. The SEGR/SEB test board shall be mounted in the test fixture mounting frame. All necessary test cables
shall be connected to the test board and vacuum feed-through inside the vacuum chamber.
c. The test instrumentation shall be set up as close as possible to the vacuum chamber. All necessary test
cables shall be connected to the test hardware and vacuum feed-through outside the vacuum chamber.
d. When the test system is set up, the operation of the test system shall be verified for continuity and operation.
Note that a quick check can be performed by applying a VGS and VDS and verifying the presence of these
voltages with a voltmeter.
e. After test system verification is completed, ground all electrodes, and insert the devices for test. Handling of
devices shall be in accordance with normal ESD practices. If lids were not removed before placement on the
test board, remove the device lids. To verify that the devices were not damaged during the delidding process
or insertion into the test board, a simple electrical check of IGS and IDS should be performed.
f. After device verification is completed, the device to be tested shall be aligned to the ion beam. With the beam
shuttered and the DUT biases set at 0 volts, perform an alignment of the DUT to the ion beam. Note that
some facilities provide a laser alignment system for this task.
g. When positional alignment is complete, turn off any lighting systems and laser systems in the vacuum
chamber. Apply the selected bias conditions to the DUT, and begin monitoring the gate and drain leakage
currents, IGS and IDS. Note that excitation by lights or laser may produce photocurrents which may interfere
with the measurements.
h. When ready, open the ion beam shutter, exposing the DUT to the heavy ion beam. Note that most facilities
include instrumentation to monitor the ion beam characteristics monitoring the average flux, fluence, and
beam uniformity which should be recorded. When the desired fluence level is achieved, shutter the ion beam,
terminating the irradiation.
(1) If performing an SEB characterization test, the test circuit shall include an appropriate circumvention
technique and a current-sensing circuit. The number of current pulses for each irradiation shall be
recorded (see 4.1).
(2) If performing an SEGR characterization test, the ion beam shall be shuttered immediately following the
detection of SEGR-any significant gate current change. The ion fluence at failure shall be recorded.
Note that detection of SEGR may require the test personnel to make a judgment concerning the SEGR
status of the device.
(3) If performing an SEGR or SEB verification test, the gate and drain leakage currents, IGS and IDS, shall be
-7
monitored. If a current change is recorded (typically, a flag can be set, e.g. an IGS > 10 amps),
document the observed conditions.
METHOD 1080
9
i. After the ion beam is shuttered, a post gate-stress test shall be performed. During the post gate-stress test
(the rated gate voltage is applied), the gate current shall be monitored. If a current change is detected
-7
(typically, a flag can be set, e.g. an IGS > 10 amps), document any observed conditions.
j. Upon completion of the post gate-stress test, record all pertinent test data. Record run number, ion specie,
ion energy, range, LET, average flux, fluence, and test conditions (VGS, VDS). Record any changes in the
drain or gate currents (IGS and IDS) before, during, and after the ion irradiation. Record any changes in the
drain and gate currents, IGS and IDS, during the post gate-stress test. Determine the status of the test run. If
the test is a characterization test, increment the test condition or select new device as required. Repeat test
procedure. If the test is a verification, select next device and test conditions. Repeat test procedure.
7. Data formatting reporting. Test data/test reports shall be maintained and shall include the following
information:
c. Facility, accelerator type, identification of ion, energy, average flux, LET, range in device material, and
fluence.
METHOD 1080
10
2000 Series
METHOD 2005.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to establish the capability of axial lead glass body diodes to be
free of intermittents or opens when measured in the forward mode under conditions of tensile stress and controlled
temperature. This test may be destructive.
2. Equipment or apparatus.
a. Digital volt meter and constant current source capable of supplying 100 mA of dc current to the
DUT. A battery supply is preferred but if a constant current supply is used, a voltage clamp of
approximately five volts shall be used.
b. Load cell with 10 pounds full scale dial (or equivalent) capable of measuring 8 pounds 10
percent.
c. Pull test fixture capable of clamping both ends of the diode while applying an 8 pound axial pull. One
clamp must be electrically isolated allowing the diode forward voltage to be monitored.
d. Hot air supply capable of heating the diode ambient to TA = +150C 5C. (TJ approximately
+175C)
3. Procedure. The diode under test shall be mounted in the pull test fixture. The electrical monitoring equipment
shall be connected to the diode leads. A forward current of 100 mA is passed through the diode while noting the
forward voltage. The ambient temperature of the diode is then increased to 150C. NOTE: The diode junction
temperature (TJ) will be approximately +25C higher than ambient (TJ approximately +175C) due to the thermal
resistance of the diode when testing small (computer) diodes at 100 mA dc in the forward direction. A silicon diode
(computer type) also has an approximate negative 1.2 mV/C temperature coefficient at 100 mA. Therefore a
150 mV decline (100 mV minimum) in voltage should be expected during the ambient temperature increase (from
+25C to +150C). After stabilizing at this temperature, then the axial lead pull force of eight pounds shall be applied
while observing the forward voltage change.
4. Criteria for rejection. An acceptable device shall not exhibit a forward voltage increase of more than 30 mV
during the 8 pound pull. Any instability or open is cause for rejection.
METHOD 2005.2
1 of 1
METHOD 2006
CONSTANT ACCELERATION
1. Purpose. The constant acceleration test is used to determine the effect on devices of a centrifugal force. This
test is an accelerated test designed to indicate types of structural and mechanical weaknesses not necessarily
detected in shock and vibration tests.
2. Apparatus. Constant acceleration tests shall be made on an apparatus capable of meeting the minimum
requirements of the individual specification sheets.
3. Procedure. The device shall be restrained by its case, or by normal mountings, and the leads or cables
secured. A centrifugal acceleration of the value specified shall then be applied to the device for one minute in each
of the orientations X1, X2, Y1, Y2, Z1, and Z2. The acceleration shall be increased gradually, to the value
specified, in not less than 20 seconds. The acceleration shall be decreased gradually to zero in not less than 20
seconds.
METHOD 2006
1 of 1
METHOD 2016.2
SHOCK
1. Purpose. This test method is intended to determine the ability of the devices to withstand moderately severe
shocks such as would be produced by rough handling, transportation, or field operation. Shocks of this type may
disturb operating characteristics or cause damage similar to that resulting from excessive vibration, particularly if the
shock pulses are repetitive.
2. Apparatus. The shock testing apparatus shall be capable of providing shock pulses of the specified peak
acceleration and pulse duration to the body of the device. The acceleration pulse, as determined from the output of
a transducer with a natural frequency greater than or equal to five times the frequency of the shock pulse being
established, shall be a half-sine waveform with an allowable distortion not greater than 20 percent of the specified
peak acceleration. The pulse duration shall be measured between the points at 10 percent of the peak acceleration
during rise time and at 10 percent of the peak acceleration during decay time. Absolute tolerances of the pulse
duration shall be the greater of 0.6 milliseconds (ms) or 15 percent of the specified duration for specified durations
of 2 ms and greater. For specified duration less than 2 ms, absolute tolerances shall be the greater of 0.1 ms or
30 percent of the specified duration.
3. Procedure. The shock-testing apparatus shall be mounted on a sturdy laboratory table, or equivalent base, and
leveled before use. The device shall be rigidly mounted or restrained by its case with suitable protection for the
leads. The device shall be subjected to the specified number of blows in the specified direction. For each blow, the
carriage shall be raised to the height necessary for obtaining the specified acceleration and then allowed to fall.
Means may be provided to prevent the carriage from striking the anvil a second time. Electrical load conditions and
measurements to be taken during the shock test, if applicable, shall be as specified. End-point measurements shall
be as specified.
METHOD 2016.2
1 of 1
METHOD 2017.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to establish the integrity of the semiconductor die attachment to
the package header or other substrate.
2. Apparatus. The test equipment shall consist of a force-applying instrument with an accuracy of 5 percent of
full scale or 50 grams, whichever is less. A circular dynamometer with a lever arm or a linear motion force-applying
instrument may be used to apply the force required for testing. The test equipment shall have the following
capabilities:
a. A die contact tool which applies a uniform distribution of the force gradually to an edge of the die (see
figure 2017-1).
b. Provisions to assure that the face of the die contact tool is perpendicular to the die mounting plane of the
header or substrate.
c. A rotational capability, relative to the header/substrate holding fixture and the die contact tool, to facilitate
line contact parallel to the edge of the die; the tool applying the force to the die shall contact the die edge
from end-to-end (see figure 2017-2).
d. A binocular microscope with a minimum magnification of 10X and sufficient lighting for visual inspection of
the die and die contact tool interface during testing.
e. Optional apparatus for devices with a die area less than 25.5 X 10-4 in2 instead of a calibrated instrument.
Any hand held tool may be used. The general requirements of 2.a., 2.b., and 2.d. shall apply. The tool
which shall apply a uniform perpendicular force to the edge of the die (see figures 2017-1, 2017-2, and
2017-3) and a microscope with a minimum magnification of 10X shall be used.
f. Apparatus for test condition C: A hammer, chisel, or spring loaded punch are suitable.
3. Test condition A die shear. For die directly bonded to a header or substrate.
3.1 Procedure. The test shall be conducted as defined herein or to the test conditions specified in the applicable
specification sheet consistent with the particular part construction. All die strength tests shall be counted and the
specific sampling, acceptance, and added sample provisions shall be observed, as applicable. (This test shall be
considered destructive.)
3.1.1 Shear strength. A force sufficient to shear the die from its mounting, or equal to twice the minimum
specified shear strength (see figure 2017-4), whichever occurs first, shall be applied to the die using the apparatus of
2 above.
a. When a linear motion force-applying instrument is used, the direction of the applied force shall be parallel
with the plane of the header or substrate and perpendicular to the edge of the die being tested.
b. When a circular dynamometer with a lever arm is employed to apply the force required for testing, it shall
be pivoted about the lever arm axis and the motion shall be parallel with the plane of the header or
substrate and perpendicular to the edge of the die being tested. The contact tool attached to the lever arm
shall be at a proper distance to assure an accurate value of applied force.
c. The die contact tool shall apply a force gradually from zero to a specified value against an edge of the die
which most closely approximates a 90 degree angle with the base of the header or substrate to which it is
bonded (see figure 2017-3). For rectangular die, the force shall be applied perpendicular to the longer side
of the die. When constrained by package configurations, any available side of the die may be tested if the
above options are not available.
METHOD 2017.2
1 of 5
d. After initial contact with the die edge and during the application of force, the relative position of the contact
tool shall not move vertically such that contact is made with the header/substrate or die attach material. If
the tool rides over the die, a new die may be substituted or the die may be repositioned, provided that the
requirements of 3.1.3 are met.
3.1.2.1 Failure criteria. A device will be considered a failure if the die bond shears as follows:
a. With a force less than the minimum shear strength requirements specified on figure 2017-4 (1.0 X line).
b. With a force less than 1.25 times (1.25 X line) the minimum shear strength requirements (1.0 X line)
specified on figure 2017-4 and evidence of adhesion, of the die attach material, less than 50 percent of the
die attach area.
c. With a force less than 1.5 times (1.5 X line) the minimum shear strength requirements (1.0 X line) specified
on figure 2017-4 and evidence of adhesion, of the die attach material, less than 25 percent of the die
attach area.
d. With a force less than 2.0 times (2.0 X line) the minimum shear strength requirements (1.0 X line) specified
on figure 2017-4 and evidence of less than 10 percent adhesion of the die attach material.
3.1.2.2 Acceptance criteria. A device will be considered acceptable if the die bond:
a. Does not shear with a force equal to or greater than 2.0 times (2.0 X line) the minimum shear strength
requirements (1.0 X line) specified on figure 2017-4.
b. Shears with evidence of remaining semiconductor material equal to or greater than 50 percent of the die
attach area regardless of the shearing force applied. (This criteria applicable only for devices with die area
less than 25.5 X 10-4 in2 (1.645 mm2)).
NOTE: Residual semiconductor material attached in discrete areas of the die attach medium shall be considered as
evidence of such adhesion.
3.1.2.3 Separation categories. When specified, the force required to achieve separation and the category of the
separation shall be defined as:
3.1.3 Summary. The following details shall be specified in the specification sheet.
a. The minimum die attach strength if other that shown on figure 2017-4.
METHOD 2017.2
2
METHOD 2017.2
3
FIGURE 2017-4. Die shear strength criteria (minimum force versus die attach area).
4. Test condition B, mechanical impact. Test condition B may be used on devices which have a metallurgical
bond between a header or contact plate and the silicon die on only one side of the die and is to be used for those
devices with a contact plate bonded to both sides of the die or to one side of the die with the other side bonded to a
header. This method shall not be used for die with area less than .25 square inch (6.35 mm).
METHOD 2017.2
4
5. Procedure. The die assemblies are placed on a suitable anvil. For die with a contact plate or header on only
one side, the die is struck with a ball peen hammer such that the silicon is shattered. The silicon will not be adhered
to those areas of the bond where solder, braze, or alloy voids exist and the voids will thus be visible. The contact
plate or header can now be visually examined to determine the size and density of any voids. The size and density
of the voids are compared to the established visual standards for acceptable die attachment. For die with both sides
die attached (a contact plate on both sides or a header on one side and contact plate on the other) the die can be
struck with a hammer on one contact plate or cleaved by striking with a chisel on the edge. If cleaved with a chisel,
each side should be struck with a hammer to break free any voided silicon. Visual comparison to the standards is
then done as above.
a. Use of a chisel or hammer can result in flying debris. Eye protection and protective clothing must be worn.
b. Breaking of the silicon can result in the exposure of sharp edges. Care in handling must be taken to avoid
injury.
a. Any single void has an area greater than 3 percent of the total die area.
b. The sum total of all void areas exceeds 6 percent of the total die area.
METHOD 2017.2
5
METHOD 2026.11
SOLDERABILITY
1. PURPOSE. The purpose of this test method is to provide a referee condition for the evaluation of the
solderability of terminations (including leads up to .125 inch in diameter) that will be assembled using tin lead
eutectic solder. This evaluation is made on the basis of the ability of these terminations to be wetted and to produce
a suitable fillet when coated by tin lead eutectic solder. These procedures will test whether the packaging materials
and processes used during the manufacturing operations process produce a component that can be successfully
soldered to the next level assembly using tin lead eutectic solder. A preconditioning test is included in this test
method which degrades the termination finish to provide a guardband against marginal finishes.
2. PROCEDURE. The solderability test shall be performed in accordance with IPC/EIA J-STD-002 (current
revision) Solderability Tests for Component Leads, Terminations, Lugs, Terminals and Wires and herein. The
following details and exceptions shall apply:
2.1 Contractual Agreements. The contractual agreements statement in J-STD-002 shall not apply. Any exceptions
to the requirements specified in J-STD-002 current revision and this test method shall be documented in the
individual military procurement document or approved by the procuring military activity.
2.2 Coating Durability. The coating durability category (from J-STD-002 current revision) shall be as follows:
a. Category 2 - For stranded wire (1 hour +/- 5 minutes steam preconditioning with insulation removed).
b. Category 3 - For all other components (8 hours +/- 15 minutes steam preconditioning).
2.3 Test Method. The test method from J-STD-002 (current revision) shall be used as follows:
Test A - For through hole mount and surface mount leaded components, solid wire less than 0.045 inch
diameter and stranded wire 18 AWG or smaller. If not otherwise specified in the procurement
document, angle of immersion for surface mount leaded components shall be 90 degrees.
Test C - For lugs, tabs, terminals, solid wire greater than 0.045 inch diameter and stranded wire greater than 18
AWG.
3. SUMMARY. The following details shall be specified in the applicable procurement document.
METHOD 2026.11
1 of 1
METHOD 2031.3
1. Purpose. This test method is performed to determine whether wire and other component parts can withstand
the effects of the heat to which they will be subjected during the soldering process (solder iron, solder dip, solder
wave, or solder reflow). The heat can be either conducted heat through the termination into the component part or
radiant heat from the solder bath when in close proximity to the body of the component part, or both. The solder dip
method is used as a reasonably close simulation of the conditions encountered in wave soldering, in regard to
radiated and conducted heat. This test also is intended to evaluate the impact of reflow techniques to which
components may be exposed. The heat of soldering can cause solder reflow which may affect the electrical
characteristics of the component part and may cause mechanical damage to the materials making up the part, such
as loosening of terminations or windings, softening of insulation, opening of solder seals, and weakening of
mechanical joints.
1.1 Scope. This test method is intended to confirm that semiconductor components are capable of withstanding
the elevated temperatures and thermal shocks associated with hot solder attachment. It is not intended to evaluate
conformal coating, printed circuit designs, poor thermal expansion matching, and mistreatment due to improper pre-
heat or automation tools.
This test method does not require the supplier to buy the same processing equipment as employed by the user. The
equipment and procedures listed herein are to serve as a guide with the supplier having the option, with DSCC
approval, of substituting soldering heat tests using equivalent equipment that is capable of meeting the intent of this
method with techniques that apply equal or better soldering tests.
Semiconductors will be tested to the solder attach procedures that are applicable to the package design. For
example, many surface mount packages have their solder pads hidden when mounted so the soldering iron test is
not appropriate. In addition, a soldering iron shall never be applied to the top of a surface mount package in an
attempt to achieve a sweat solder bond. Permanent damage will result.
2. Apparatus.
2.1 Solder pot. A static solder pot, of sufficient size to accommodate the mounting board (see 2.4) and to
immerse the terminations to the depth specified for the solder dip (without touching the bottom of the pot), shall be
used. This apparatus shall be capable of maintaining the solder at the temperature specified. The solder bath
temperature shall be measured in the center of the pot at a depth of at least .500 inch (12.7 mm), but no deeper than
1 inch (25.4 mm) below the surface of the solder.
2.2 Heat sinks or shielding. The use of heat sinks or shielding is prohibited except when it is a part of the
component. When applicable, heat sinks or shielding shall be specified in the individual specification, including all of
the details, such as materials, dimensions, method of attachment, and location of the necessary protection.
2.3 Fixtures. Fixtures, when required, shall be made of a non-solderable material designed so that they will make
minimum contact (i.e., minimum heat sink) with the component. Further, they shall not place undue stress on the
component when fixtured.
2.4 Mounting board. A mounting board, in accordance with NEMA grade FR-4 of IPC-4101, 9 square inches
(i.e., 3 x 3, 1 x 9.), minimum area, .062 inch .0075 inch (1.57 mm .191 mm) thick, shall be used, unless otherwise
specified. Component lead holes shall be drilled such that the diametrical clearance between the hole and
component terminals shall not exceed .015 inch (0.38 mm). Metal eyelets or feed-throughs shall not be used.
Surface mount boards, when specified in the individual specification, shall have pads of sufficient size and number to
accommodate the component being tested.
2.5 Solder iron. A solder iron, capable of maintaining a temperature of 350C 10C, shall be used.
METHOD 2031.3
1 of 6
2.6 Reflow chambers. The reflow chambers or equivalent (vapor phase reflow (VPR) chamber, infrared reflow
(IRR) oven, air circulating oven.) shall be of sufficient size to accommodate the mounting board and components to
be tested. The chamber shall be capable of generating the specified heating rate, temperatures, and environments.
2.7 Temperature measurement. Low mass thermocouples that do not affect the heating rate of the sample shall
be used. A temperature recording device is recommended. The equipment shall be capable of maintaining an
accuracy of 1C at the temperature range of interest.
3. Materials.
3.1 Solder. The solder or solder paste shall be tin-lead alloy with a nominal tin content of 50 percent to 70
percent in accordance with ANSI/J-STD-006, Requirements for Electronic Grade Solder Alloys and Fluxed and Non-
Fluxed Solid Solders for Electronic Soldering Applications or ANSI/J-STD-005, Requirements for Soldering Pastes.
When specified in the individual specification, other solders can be used provided they are molten at the specified
temperature.
3.2 Flux. When flux is used, it shall conform to type A of ANSI/J-STD-004, Requirements for Soldering Fluxes,
or as specified in the individual specification.
3.3 VPR fluid. A perfluorocarbon fluid that has a boiling point of 215C shall be used.
4. Procedure.
4.1 Special preparation of specimens. Any special preparation of specimens prior to testing shall be as specified
in the individual specification. This could include specific instructions such as bending or any other relocation of
terminations, cleaning, application of flux, pretinning, or attachment of heat sinks or protective shielding (see 2.2),
prior to the solder immersion.
4.2 Preparation of solder bath. The molten solder shall be agitated to assure that the temperature is uniform.
The surface of the solder shall be kept clean and bright.
4.3 Application of flux. When flux is used, the terminations to be tested shall be immersed in the flux (see 3.2),
which is at room ambient temperature, to the depth specified for the solder dip. The duration of the immersion shall
be from 5 seconds to 10 seconds.
4.4 Test conditions. Unless otherwise specified in the individual specification, the test shall be performed on all
solder terminations attached to the component part. There are six types of soldering techniques covered by these
test conditions. The test conditions are outlined below and in table 2031-I.
Test condition A: Solder iron - Hand soldering of solder cups, through hole components, tab and post
terminations, solder eyelet terminations.
Test condition B: Solder dip - Simulates hot solder dipping (tinning) of leaded components.
Test condition C: Wave solder - Simulates wave solder of topside board mount product.
Test condition D: Wave solder - Simulates wave solder of bottom side board mount product.
Test conditions I, J, K: Infrared/convection reflow - Simulates IRR, natural convection, and forced air
convection reflow environments.
METHOD 2031.3
2
a. When testing a solder cup, tab and post termination, or solder eyelet termination, the applicable wire size,
properly prepared for the solder termination, shall be attached in the appropriate manner.
When testing a board mount component, the component shall be placed on a mounting board (see 2.4).
c. Unless otherwise specified, a solder iron in accordance with 2.5 shall be used.
d. The solder iron shall be heated to 350C 10C and applied to the termination for a duration of 4 seconds to
5 seconds as specified in table 2031-I. The solder and iron shall be applied to the area of the assembly
closest to the component body that the product is likely to experience. For surface mount components, the
iron shall be placed on the pad only.
e. Remove the iron and allow the component to cool and stabilize at room ambient conditions. If flux was
used, the component shall be cleaned using an appropriate cleaning solution.
c. The specific combination of temperature, immersion and emersion rate, immersion duration, and number of
heats shall be as specified in table 2031-I. Unless otherwise specified, terminations shall be immersed to
within .050 inch (1.27 mm) of the component body. Terminations shall be immersed simultaneously, if the
geometry of the component permits.
d. After the solder dip, the component shall be allowed to cool and stabilize at room ambient conditions. If flux
was used, the component shall be cleaned using an appropriate cleaning solution.
a. The component under test shall be mounted on a mounting board (see 2.4).
Wire leads: Wire leads shall be brought through the board holes and bent at least 30 degrees from a line
perpendicular to the board. Leads shall extend from .050 inch to .100 inch (1.27 mm to 2.54 mm) from the
bottom of the board. Axial leads shall be bent at a 90 degree angle at a point between .06 inch and .08
inch (1.5 mm and 2.1 mm) from the body, eyelet fillet, or weld unless otherwise specified.
Pin leads: Where the component is designed with rigid pin leads, the full length of the termination shall be
retained. Pin leads shall not be cut or bent.
c. The specific combination of temperature, duration, and number of heats shall be as specified in table
2031-I.
d. The components, mounted on the board, shall be immersed in the solder pot so that the bottom of the
board floats on the molten solder.
METHOD 2031.3
3
e. After the float, the components shall be allowed to cool and stabilize at room ambient conditions. If flux was
used, the components shall be cleaned using an appropriate cleaning solution.
4.4.4 Test condition D: Wave solder bottom side board mount product.
c. The specific combination of temperature, preheat conditions, immersion and emersion rates, immersion
duration, and number of heats shall be as specified in table 2031-I.
d. The component shall be preheated and fully immersed in the solder bath in accordance with 4.4.4c.
e. After the immersion, the component shall be allowed to cool and stabilize at room ambient conditions. If
flux was used, the component shall be cleaned using an appropriate cleaning solution.
a. Components shall be mounted on a mounting board (see 2.4). Through-hole mounted components shall
have their terminals inserted into the termination holes. Surface mount components shall be placed on top
of the board.
b. A test chamber (see 2.6) shall be used which is large enough to suspend the mounting board without
touching the sides or the solution. The VPR fluid shall be placed in the test chamber and shall be heated
until it is boiling. The solution shall be allowed to boil for 5 minutes prior to suspending the mounting board.
c. The specific combination of temperature, duration of exposure, and number of heats shall be as specified in
table 2031-I.
d. After chamber equalization, the mounting board shall be suspended into the vapor in a horizontal plane.
The mounting board shall not touch the solution.
e. After the heat, the components shall be allowed to cool and stabilize at room ambient conditions. If a solder
paste was used, the component shall be cleaned using an appropriate solution.
a. Components shall be mounted on a mounting board (see 2.4). Through-hole mounted components shall
have their terminals inserted into the termination holes. Surface mount components shall be placed on top
of the board.
c. A low mass thermocouple shall be attached tightly to the component at an appropriate position away from
the edges.
d. The specific combination of temperature, preheat, duration, and number of heats shall be as specified by
test condition I, J, or K in table 2031-I and the individual procurement document.
METHOD 2031.3
4
e. The board shall be placed into the test chamber and the temperature of the component ramped at a rate of
1C/s to 4C/s as measured by the thermocouple. The assembly shall be above 183C for 90 seconds to
120 seconds and held at the final temperature and time designated by the test condition. The assembly
shall then be allowed to cool to room ambient temperature. This constitutes one heat cycle. The assembly
shall be exposed to three heat cycles.
5. Examinations and measurements. Examinations and measurements to be made before and after the test, as
applicable, shall be as specified in the individual specification. After the procedure, the specimens shall be allowed
to cool and stabilize at room ambient conditions, for the time specified in the individual specification.
5.1 Internal examination. When specified, internal examination of the part shall be made after the test to check
for solder reflow or heat damage.
6. Summary. The following details are to be specified in the performance specification sheet:
a. The use of heat sinks or shielding is prohibited except when they are part of the component (see 2.2).
d. Flux, if applicable and if different from that specified (see 3.2, 4.1, and 4.3).
g. Depth of immersion in the molten solder, if different from that specified (see 4.4.2).
i. Cooling time prior to final examinations and measurements (see 4.4 and 5.).
j. Examinations and measurements before and after test, as applicable (see 5.).
METHOD 2031.3
5
Test condition codes E, F, and G have not been used in this method.
METHOD 2031.3
6
METHOD 2036.4
TERMINAL STRENGTH
1.1. Purpose. This test method is designed to check the capabilities of the device leads, welds and seals to
withstand a straight pull.
1.2. Apparatus. The tension test requires suitable clamps, vise, and hand vise for securing the device and for
securing the specified weight to the device lead without lead restriction.
1.3. Procedure. The specified weight shall be applied, without shock, to each lead or terminal. The case of the
device shall be held in a fixed position. When testing axial lead devices, the device shall be supported, with the
leads in a vertical position, by securing one lead to a clamp or vise. With a hand vise or equivalent, the specified
weight, including the attaching device, shall be fastened to the lower lead for the time specified. Each lead shall be
fastened as close to its end as practicable. When examined using 10X magnification after removal of the stress, any
evidence of breakage (other than meniscus), loosening, or relative motion between the terminal lead and the device
body shall be considered a device failure.
1.4. Summary. The following shall be specified in the performance specification sheet
2.1. Purpose. This test is designed to check device leads and seals for their resistance to twisting motions.
2.2. Apparatus. The torque test requires suitable clamps and fixtures and a torsion wrench or other suitable
method of applying the specified torque without lead restriction.
2.3. Procedure. The body of the device shall be securely clamped, with a suitable fixture, and the specified torque
shall be applied to the portion of the terminal nearest the seal for the specified time. The specified torque shall be
applied, without shock, about the device axis. The torque shall be applied between the lead or terminal and the case
in a direction which tends to cause loosening of the lead or terminal.
2.3.1 UHF and microwave diodes. Unless otherwise specified, a torque of 1.5 pound-inches (.17 newton-meter)
about the diode axis shall be applied for the specified time, without shock, between the terminals, and in a direction
which tends to cause loosening of the terminals. The manufacturer's recommendation shall be allowed in the
method clamping.
2.3.2 Examination under magnification. When examined using 10X magnification after removal of the stress, any
evidence of breakage (other than meniscus), loosening, or relative motion between the terminal lead and the device
body shall be considered a device failure.
2.4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the performance specification sheet
METHOD 2036.4
1 of 3
3.1. Purpose. This test is designed to check the resistance of the device with threaded mounting stud to the
stress caused by tightening the device when mounting.
3.2. Apparatus. The torque test requires suitable clamps and fixtures and a torsion wrench or suitable method of
applying the specified torque.
3.3. Procedure. The device shall be clamped by its body or flange. A flat steel washer of a thickness equal to
6-thread pitches of the stud being tested and a class 2 fit steel nut shall be assembled in that order on the stud, with
all parts clean and dry. The specified torque shall be applied for the specified length of time without shock to the nut.
The nut and washer shall then be disassembled from the device, and the device then examined for compliance with
the requirements.
3.4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the performance specification sheet
4.1. Purpose. This test is to check the resistance of the device leads to metal fatigue.
4.2. Apparatus. The lead-fatigue test shall be made using the specified weight and with suitable clamping or
attaching devices.
4.3. Procedure. Where applicable, two leads on each device shall be tested. The leads shall be selected in a
cyclical manner (regular recurring), when applicable; that is, leads number 1 and 2 on the first device, number 2 and
3 on the second device. Unless otherwise specified, a weight of 8 0.5 ounces (225 15 grams) shall be applied to
each lead for three 90 5 degrees arcs of the case. An arc is defined as the movement of the case, without torsion,
to a position perpendicular to the pull axis and return to normal. All arcs on a single lead shall be made in the same
direction and in the same plane without lead restriction. One bending cycle shall be completed in from 2 to 5
seconds. Any glass fracture (other than meniscus) or broken lead shall be considered a failure.
4.4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the performance specification sheet
a. Weight to be attached to the lead, if other than 8 0.5 ounces (225 15 grams) (see 4.3.).
METHOD 2036.4
2
5.1. Purpose. This test is made to check the quality of the leads, lead welds, and glass-to-metal seals of the
devices.
5.2. Apparatus. Bending-stress tests shall be made using attaching devices, such as suitable clamps or other
supports for stud-mounted devices.
5.3. Procedure.
5.3.1 Method A (for cylindrical devices). With one contact of the device held in a suitable clamp, the specified
force shall be applied, without shock, at right angles to the reference axis of the device, as near the top of the
opposite contact or tubulation as practicable.
5.3.2 Method B (for stud-mounted devices). The device shall be securely fastened, with its reference axis in a
horizontal position, by screwing the stud into a suitable support. With a hand vise, or equivalent, the specified
weight shall be suspended from the hold in the lug for the length of time specified.
5.3.3 Failure criteria. When examined using 10X magnification after removal of the stress, any evidence of
breakage (other than meniscus), loosening, or relative motion between the terminal lead and the device body shall
be considered a failure.
5.4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the performance specification sheet
MEHTOD 2036.4
3
METHOD 2037.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to measure bond strengths, evaluate bond strength distributions, or
determine compliance with specified bond strength requirements of the applicable acquisition document. This test
may be applied to the wire-to-die bond, wire-to-substrate bond, or the wire-to-package lead bond inside the package
of wire-connected microelectronic devices bonded by soldering, thermocompression, ultrasonic, or related
techniques. It may also be applied to bonds external to the device such as those from device terminals-to-substrate
or wiring board or to internal bonds between die and substrate in non-wire-bonded device configurations such as
beam lead or flip chip devices.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus for this test shall consist of suitable equipment for applying the specified stress to the
bond, lead wire, or terminal as required in the specified test condition. A calibrated measurement and indication of
the applied stress in grams force (gf) shall be provided by equipment capable of measuring stresses up to twice the
specified minimum limit value, with an accuracy of 5 percent or 0.25 gf, whichever is the greater tolerance.
3. Procedure. The test shall be conducted using the test condition specified in the applicable acquisition document
consistent with the particular device construction. All bond pulls shall be counted and the specified sampling,
acceptance, and added sample provisions shall be observed, as applicable. Unless otherwise specified, for
conditions A, C, and D of table 2037 - I, the sample size number specified for the bond strength test shall determine
the minimum sample size in terms of the minimum number of bond pulls to be accomplished rather than the number
of complete devices in the sample, except that the required number of bond pulls shall be randomly selected from a
minimum of 4 devices. Bond pulls in accordance with test conditions D, F, G, and H of table 2037 - I, while involving
two or more bonds, shall count as a single pull for bond strength and sample size number purposes. Unless
otherwise specified, for conditions F, G, and H, the sample size number specified shall determine the number of die
to be tested (not bonds). For multichip devices (all conditions), a minimum of 4, die or use all die if four are not
available, on a minimum of 2 completed devices shall be used. Where there is any adhesive, encapsulant, or other
material under, on, or surrounding the die such as to increase the apparent bond strength, the bond strength test
shall be performed prior to application.
When flip chip or beam-lead chips are bonded to substrates other than those in completed devices, the following
conditions shall apply:
a. The sample of chips for this test shall be taken at random from the same chip population as that used in the
completed devices that they are intended to represent.
b. The chips for this test shall be bonded on the same bonding apparatus as the completed devices, during the
time period within which the completed devices are bonded.
c. The test chip substrates shall be processed, metallized, and handled identically with the completed device
substrates, during the same time period within which the completed device substrates are processed.
3.1.1 Test condition A - bond peel. This test is normally employed for bonds external to the device package. The
lead or terminal and the device package shall be gripped or clamped in such a manner that a peeling stress is
exerted with the specified angle between the lead or terminal and the board or substrate. Unless otherwise specified,
an angle of 90 degrees shall be used. When a failure occurs, the force causing the failure and the failure category
shall be recorded.
3.1.2 Test condition C - wire pull (single bond). This test is normally employed for internal bonds at the die or
substrate and the lead frame of microelectronic devices. The wire connecting the die or substrate shall be cut so as
to provide two ends accessible for pull test. In the case of short wire runs, it may be necessary to cut the wire close
to one termination in order to allow pull test at the opposite termination. The wire shall be gripped in a suitable device
and simple pulling action applied to the wire or to the device (with the wire clamped) in such a manner that the force
is applied approximately normal to the surface of the die or substrate. When a failure occurs, the force causing the
failure and the failure category shall be recorded.
MEHTOD 2037.1
1 of 7
3.1.3 Test condition D - wire pull (double bond). This procedure is identical to that of test condition C, except that
the pull is applied by inserting a hook under the lead wire (attached to die, substrate or header or both ends) with the
device clamped and the pulling force applied approximately in the center of the wire in a direction approximately
normal to the die or substrate surface or approximately normal to a straight line between the bonds. When a failure
occurs, the force causing the failure, and the failure category, shall be recorded. The minimum bond strength shall
be taken from table 2037 - I. Figure 20371 - 1 may be used for wire diameters not specified in table 2037 -I. For wire
diameter or equivalent cross section >0.005 inch (0.127 mm), where a hook will not fit under the wire, a suitable
clamp can be used in lieu of a hook.
3.1.4 Test condition F - bond shear (flip chip). This test is normally employed for internal bonds between a
semiconductor die and a substrate to which it is attached in a face-bonded configuration. It may also be used to test
the bonds between a substrate and an intermediate carrier or secondary substrate to which the die is mounted. A
suitable tool or wedge shall be brought in contact with the die (or carrier) at a point just above the primary substrate
and a force applied perpendicular to one edge of the die (or carrier) and parallel to the primary substrate, to cause
bond failure by shear. When a failure occurs, the force at the time of failure, and the failure category, shall be
recorded.
3.1.5 Test condition G - push-off test (beam lead). This test is normally employed for process control and is used
on a sample of semiconductor die bonded to a specially prepared substrate. Therefore, it shall not be used for
random sampling of production or inspection lots. A metallized substrate containing a hole shall be employed. The
hole appropriately centered, shall be sufficiently large to provide clearance for a push tool, but not large enough to
interfere with the bonding areas. The push tool shall be sufficiently large to minimize device cracking during testing,
but not large enough to contact the beam leads in the anchor bond area. Proceed with push-off tests as follows: The
substrate shall be rigidly held and the push tool inserted through the hole. The contact of the push tool to the silicon
device shall be made without appreciable impact (less than 0.01 inch/minute (0.254 mm/minute ) and forced against
the underside of the bonded device at a constant rate. When failure occurs, the force at the time of failure, and the
failure category, shall be recorded.
3.1.6 Test condition H - pull-off test (beam lead). This test is normally employed on a sample basis on beam lead
devices which have been bonded down on a ceramic or other suitable substrate. The calibrated pull-off apparatus
(see 2) shall include a pull-off rod (i.e., a current loop of nichrome or Kovar wire) to make connection with a hard
setting adhesive material (i.e., heat sensitive polyvinyl acetate resin glue) on the back (top side) of the beam lead die.
The substrate shall be rigidly installed in the pull-off fixture and the pull-off rod shall make firm mechanical connection
to the adhesive material. The device shall be pulled within 5 degrees of the normal to at least the calculated force
(see 3.2), or until the die is at .10 inch(2.54 mm) above the substrate. When a failure occurs, the force at the time of
failure, the calculated force limit, and the failure category shall be recorded.
3.2 Failure criteria. Any bond pull which results in separation under an applied stress less than that indicated in
table 2037 -I as the required minimum bond strength for the indicated test condition, composition, and construction
shall constitute a failure.
3.2.1 Failure category. Failure categories are as follows: When specified, the stress required to achieve
separation and the category of separation or failure shall be recorded.
METHOD 2037.1
2
(a-4) Failure in bond (interface between wire and metallization) at substrate, package post, or other than die.
(b-3) Failure in bond interface (in solder or at point of weld interface between lead or terminal and the board
or substrate conductor to which the bond was made).
(c-2) Fracture of die (or carrier) or substrate (removal of portion of die or substrate immediately under the
bond).
(c-3) Lifted metallization (separation of metallization or bonding pedestal from die (or carrier) or substrate.
(d-7) Lifted metallization (separation of metallization) from die, separation of bonding pad.
METHOD 2037.1
3
NOTE: RF/microwave that require extremely flat loops, which may cause erroneous wire pull data, may use the
following formula to determine the proper wire pull value.
V1 = V2 sin
Also, RF/microwave that contain wires that cannot be accessed with a pull hook must be duplicated on a test
coupon in such a way to allow hook access for purposes of pull testing. These wires are to be bonded at the
same time the production devices are bonded using the same setup, operator, and schedule. The test wires are
to be pull tested in lieu of the tuning or inaccessible wires on the production devices. Failures on the test coupon
shall be considered as failures to production units and appropriate action is to be taken in accordance with the
applicable specification (figure 2037-3).
METHOD 2037.1
4
1/ For wire diameters not specified, use the curve of figure 2037-1 to determine the bond pull limit.
2/ For ribbon wire, use the equivalent round wire diameter which gives the same cross-sectional
area as the ribbon wire being tested.
3/ For condition G or H, the bond strength shall be determined by dividing the breaking force by
the total of the nominal beam widths before bonding.
4. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Minimum bond strength if other than specified in 3.2 or details of required strength distributions if applicable.
c. Sample size number and accept number or number, and selection of bond pulls, to be tested on each device,
and number of devices, if other than 4.
d. For test condition A, angle of bond peel if other than 90 degrees, and bond strength limit (see 3.2).
e. Requirement for reporting of separation forces and failure categories, when applicable (see 3.2.1).
METHOD 2037.1
5
NOTE: The minimum bond strength should be taken from table 2037 - I. Figure 2037 1 may be used for wire
diameters not specified in table 2037 - I.
METHOD 2037.1
6
METHOD 2037.1
7
METHOD 2046.2
VIBRATION FATIGUE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to determine the effect on the device of vibration in the frequency
range specified.
2. Procedure. The device shall be rigidly fastened on the vibration platform and the leads or cables adequately
secured. The device shall then be subjected to a sample harmonic motion in the range of 60 20 Hz, with a constant
peak acceleration of 20 g minimum. The vibration shall be applied for 32 8 hours, minimum, in each of the
orientations X, Y, and Z for a total of 96 hours, minimum.
3. Summary. The measurements after test shall be specified in the specification sheet.
METHOD 2046.2
1 of 1
METHOD 2051.1
VIBRATION NOISE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to measure the amount of electrical noise produced by the device
under vibration.
2. Procedure. The device and its leads shall be rigidly fastened on the vibration platform and the leads or cables
adequately secured. The device shall be vibrated with simple harmonic motion with a constant peak acceleration of
20 g minimum. The vibration frequency shall be varied approximately logarithmically between 100 and 2,000 Hz.
The entire frequency range shall be traversed is not less than four minutes for each cycle. This cycle shall be
performed once in each of the orientations X1, Y1, and Z1 (total of 3 times), so that the motion shall be applied for a
total period of approximately 12 minutes. The specified voltages and currents shall be applied in the test circuit. The
maximum noise-output voltage across the specified load resistance during traverse shall be measured with an
average-responding root-means-square (rms) calibrated high impedance voltmeter. The meter shall measure, with
an error of not more than 3 percent, the rms value of a sine-wave voltage at 2,000 Hz. The characteristic of the
meter over a bandwidth of 20 to 20,000 Hz shall be 1 decibel (dB) of the value at 2,000 Hz, with an attenuation rate
below 20 and above 20,000 Hz of 6 2 dB per octave. The maximum inherent noise in the circuit shall be at least
10 dB, below the specified noise-output voltage.
c. Post-test measurements.
METHOD 2051.1
1 of 1
METHOD 2052.4
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to detect loose particles inside a device cavity. The test provides
a nondestructive means of identifying those devices containing particles of sufficient mass that, upon impact with the
case, excite the transducer.
2. Apparatus. The equipment required for the PIND test shall consist of the following (or equivalent):
a. A threshold detector to detect particle noise voltage exceeding a preset threshold of the absolute value of
15 1 mV peak reference to system ground.
b. A vibration shaker and driver assembly capable of providing essentially sinusoidal motion to the device under
test (DUT) at:
c. PIND transducer, calibrated to a peak sensitivity of -77.5 3 dB in regards to one volt per microbar at a point
within the frequency of 150 to 160 kHz.
d. A sensitivity test unit (STU) (see figure 2052-1) for periodic assessment of the PIND system performance.
The STU shall consist of a transducer with the same tolerances as the PIND transducer and a circuit to excite
the transducer with a 250 microvolt 20 percent pulse. The STU shall produce a pulse of about 20 mV peak
on the oscilloscope when the transducer is coupled to the PIND transducer with attachment medium.
e. PIND electronics, consisting of an amplifier with a gain of 60 2 dB centered at the frequency of peak
sensitivity of the PIND transducer. The noise at the output of the amplifier shall not exceed 10 mV peak.
f. Attachment medium. The attachment medium used to attach the DUT to the PIND transducer shall be the
same attachment medium as used for the STU test.
g. Shock mechanism or tool capable of imparting shock pulses of 1,000 200 g's peak to the DUT. The
duration of the main shock shall not exceed 100 s. If an integral co-test shock system is used, the shaker
vibration may be interrupted or perturbed for period of time not to exceed 250 ms from initiation of the last
shock pulse in the sequence. The co-test duration shall be measured at the 50 5 percent point.
3. Procedures.
3.1 Test equipment setup. Shaker drive frequency and amplitude shall be adjusted to the specified conditions. The
shock pulse shall be adjusted to provide 1,000 200 g's peak to the DUT.
3.2 Test equipment checkout. The test equipment checkout shall be performed a minimum of one time per
operation shift. Failure of the system to meet checkout requirements shall require retest of all devices tested
subsequent to the last successful system checkout.
3.2.1 Shaker drive system checkout. The drive system shall achieve the shaker frequency and the shaker
amplitude specified. The drive system shall be calibrated so that the frequency settings are within 8 percent and
the amplitude vibration settings are within 10 percent of the nominal values. If a visual displacement monitor is
affixed to the transducer, it may be used for amplitudes between .04 and .12 inch (1.02 and 3.05 mm). An
accelerometer may be used over the entire range of amplitudes and shall be used below amplitudes of .040 inch
(1.02 mm).
METHOD 2052.4
1 of 4
3.2.2 Detection system checkout. With the shaker de-energized, the STU transducer shall be mounted
face-to-face and coaxial with the PIND transducer using the attachment medium used for testing the devices, prior to
attaching any special fixtures. The STU shall be activated several times to verify low level signal pulse visual and
threshold detection on the oscilloscope. Not every application of the STU will produce the required amplitude. All
pulses which are greater than 20 mV shall activate the detector.
3.2.3 System noise verification. System noise will appear as a fairly constant band and shall not exceed 20 mV
peak to peak when observed for a period of 30 to 60 seconds.
3.3 Test sequence. The following sequence of operations (3.3.a through 3.3.i) constitute one test cycle or run.
b. Vibration 3 1 seconds.
d. Vibration 3 1 seconds.
f. Vibration 3 1 seconds.
h. Vibration 3 1 seconds.
i. Accept or reject.
3.3.1 Mounting requirements. Special precautions (e.g., in mounting, grounding of DUT leads, or grounding of
test operator) shall be taken as necessary to prevent electrostatic damage to the DUT. Batch or bulk testing is
prohibited.
Most part types will mount directly to the transducer via the attachment medium. Parts shall be mounted with the
largest flat surface against the transducer at the center or axis of the transducer for maximum sensitivity. The DUT
shall placed directly over the transducer detection crystal or crystals. In the case of a single crystal transducer, the
geometric center of the DUT shall be aligned to the center of the transducer within .078 inch (2 mm). In the case of
multiple crystal transducers, the geometric center of the DUT should be arranged to have the maximum sensitivity
utilizing as many crystals as possible. Where more than one large surface exists, the one that is the thinnest in
section or has the most uniform thickness shall be mounted toward the transducer, e.g., flat packs are mounted top
down against the transducer. Small axial-lead, right circular cylindrical parts are mounted with their axis horizontal
and the side of the cylinder against the transducer. Parts with unusual shapes may require special fixtures. Such
fixtures shall have the following properties:
a. Low mass.
e. No moving parts.
METHOD 2052.4
2
3.3.2 Test monitoring. Each test cycle (see 3.3) shall be continuously monitored, except for the period during
co-test shocks and 250 ms maximum after the shocks. Particle indications can occur in one, or any combination, of
the three detection systems as follows:
a. Visual indication of high frequency spikes which exceed the normal constant background white noise level.
b. Audio indication of clicks, pops, or rattling which is different from the constant background noise present with
no DUT on the transducer.
c. Threshold detection shall be indicated by the lighting of a lamp or by deflection of the secondary oscilloscope
trace.
3.4 Failure criteria. Any noise bursts, as detected by any of the three detection systems exclusive of background
noise, except those caused by the shock blows, during the monitoring periods, shall be cause for rejection of the
device. Rejects shall not be retested except for retest of all devices in the event of test system failure. If additional
cycles of testing on a lot are specified, the entire test procedure (equipment setup and checkout mounting, vibration,
and co-shocking) shall be repeated for each retest cycle. Reject devices from each test cycle shall be removed from
the lot and shall not be retested in subsequent lot testing.
3.5 Screening lot acceptance. Unless otherwise specified, the inspection lot (or sub lot) to be screened for lot
acceptance shall be submitted to 100 percent PIND testing a maximum of five times in accordance with condition A
herein. PIND prescreening shall not be performed. The lot may be accepted on any of the five runs if the
percentage of defective devices in that run is less than 1 percent and the cumulative number of defective devices
does not exceed 25 percent. All defective devices shall be removed after each run. Resubmission is not allowed.
NOTE: The shaker drive test frequency (F) for condition A (see 3.1) is determined by the package internal cavity
height using the following formula:
F = 20 /[(D )X (0.0511)]
NOTE: The use of this formula is to be limited to frequencies in the range of 40 130 Hz and should not be used for
package heights outside this range unless a frequency outside this range is approved by the acquiring activity.
TABLE I. Package Height vs. Test Frequency for 20 g Acceleration (condition A).
F = 20 /[(D )X (0.0511)]
NOTE: The approximate average internal package height shall be measured from the floor of the package cavity or the top
of the major substrate for hybrid or multichip assemblies and shall exclude the thickness of the die mounted inside the
package.
4. Summary. The following details shall be specified in the applicable performance specification sheets:
d. Pre-test shock level and co-test shock level, if other than specified.
NOTES:
1. Pushbutton switch: Mechanically quiet, fast make, gold contacts (e.g. T2 SM4 microswitch).
2. Resistance tolerance five percent noninductive.
3. Voltage source can be a standard dry cell.
4. The coupled transducers must be coaxial during test.
5. Voltage output to STU transducer 250 microvolts, 20 percent.
METHOD 2052.4
4
METHOD 2056
1. Purpose. The variable-frequency-vibration test method is performed for the purpose of determining the effect
on component parts of vibration in the specified frequency range.
2. Procedure.
2.1 Mounting. The device shall be rigidly fastened on the vibration platform and the leads or cables adequately
secured.
2.2 Amplitude. The device shall be subjected to a constant peak acceleration of 20 g minimum.
2.2.1 Frequency range. The vibration frequency shall be varied approximately logarithmically between 100 and
2,000 Hz.
2.2.2 Sweep time and duration. The entire frequency range of 100 to 2,000 Hz and return to 100 Hz shall be
traversed in not less than four minutes. This cycle shall be performed 4 times in each of the orientations X, Y, and Z
(a total of 12 times), so that the motion shall be applied for a total period of approximately 48 minutes.
3. Summary. The measurements after test shall be specified in the performance specification sheets.
METHOD 2056
1 of 1
METHOD 2057.2
1. Purpose. This test method is performed for the purpose of detecting malfunctions of semiconductor devices
during vibration in the specified frequency range at the specified acceleration.
2. Procedure.
2.1 Mounting. The device shall be rigidly fastened on the vibration platform. Special care is required to ensure
the position of the electrical connection to the device leads to prevent intermittent contacts during vibration. Care
must also be exercised to avoid magnetic fields in the area of the device being vibrated.
2.2 Amplitude. The device shall be vibrated with a simple harmonic motion with a constant peak acceleration of
20 g minimum. The acceleration shall be monitored at a point where the g level is equivalent to that of the support
point for the device(s).
2.3 Frequency range. The vibration shall be varied logarithmically between 100 and 2,000 Hz.
2.4 Sweep time and duration. The entire frequency range of 100 to 2,000 Hz and return to 100 Hz shall be
traversed in not less than 8 minutes. This frequency range shall be executed at one time in each of the orientations
X, Y, and Z (total of 3 times) so that the motion shall be applied for a total of 24 minutes minimum. Interruptions are
permitted provided the requirements for rate of change and test duration are met. Completion of vibration within any
separate frequency band is permissible before going on to the next band.
3. Measurements. With the specified dc voltages and currents applied, the semiconductor device shall be
monitored continuously, during the vibration period, for intermittent opens and shorts. The monitoring equipment
shall be capable of detecting voltage or current changes of the duration and magnitude specified on the performance
specification sheet. In addition, the equipment shall utilize a positive-indication "go-no go" technique or a recorded
trace. Equipment requiring continuous visual monitoring, such as an oscilloscope, shall not be used.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the performance specification sheet:
c. Post-test measurements.
METHOD 2057.2
1 of 1
METHOD 2066
PHYSICAL DIMENSIONS
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to check the physical dimensions of the device.
2. Apparatus. Equipment used in this examination shall be capable of demonstrating conformance to the
requirements of the performance specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The semiconductor device shall be examined to verify that the physical dimensions are as
specified in the performance specification sheet.
4. Summary. The dimensions which are capable of physically describing the device shall be specified in the
performance specification sheet.
METHOD 2066
1 of 1
METHOD 2068
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to visually inspect glass-encased, double plug, noncavity, axial
leaded devices for cracks which may affect the integrity of the hermetic seal.
2. Apparatus. A binocular microscope with a magnification of 10X to 20X and sufficient lighting for visual
inspection of the glass body.
3. Procedure. The examination shall be performed prior to any body coating. The devices shall be examined
under a magnification of 10X to 20X for evidence of glass body cracks.
3.1 Failure criteria. Any device exhibiting cracks in the body glass shall be rejected. Cracks or chipouts in the
meniscus area at either end of the body are not cause for rejection.
METHOD 2068
1 of 1
METHOD 2069.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to verify the construction and quality of workmanship in the
assembly process to the point of pre-cap inspection. These various inspections and tests are intended to verify
compliance with the requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus for this inspection shall consist of the following:
b. Adequate fixturing for handling the devices being inspected without causing damage.
c. Adequate covered storage and transportation containers to protect devices from mechanical damage and
environmental contamination.
d. Any visual standards (e.g., drawings, photographs) necessary to enable the inspector to make objective
decisions as to the acceptability of devices being inspected.
3. Procedure.
3.1 General. The devices shall be examined in a suitable sequence of observations with the specified
magnification range to determine compliance with the requirements of this test method and the applicable
specification sheet.
a. Sequence of inspection. The order in which criteria are presented is not a required order of inspection and
may be varied at the discretion of the manufacturer.
b. Inspection control. Within the time interval between visual inspection and preparation for sealing, devices
shall be stored in a controlled environment (i.e., an environment in which air-borne particles and relative
humidity are controlled). The use of a positive pressure inert gas environment, such as dry nitrogen, shall
satisfy the requirement of storing in a controlled environment. Unless a cleaning operation is performed
prior to sealing, devices inspected in accordance with this test method shall be inspected in a class 100,000
environment in accordance with FED-STD-209. The maximum allowable relative humidity shall not exceed
65 percent. Devices shall be in clean covered containers when transferred through any uncontrolled
environment.
c. Magnification. Inspection shall be performed with either a monocular, binocular, or stereo microscope and
the inspection performed with any appropriate angle, with the device under suitable illumination.
Magnification shall be performed within the range of 3X to 100X. All criteria of this test method shall be met
for the full range of magnification.
METHOD 2069.2
1 of 13
3.2 Bonding inspection (low magnification). This inspection and criteria shall be the required inspection for the
bond type(s) and location(s) to which they are applicable when viewed from above (see figures 2069-1 and 2069-2).
(Wire tail is not considered part of the bond when determining physical bond dimensions.) No device shall be
acceptable which exhibits any of the following defects.
a. Gold ball bonds where the ball bond diameter is less than 2 times or greater than 5 times the bonding wire
diameter.
b. Gold ball bonds where the wire exit is not completely within the periphery of the ball.
c. Gold ball bonds where the exiting wire is not within boundaries of the bonding pad.
d. Any visible intermetallic formation at the periphery of any gold ball bond.
a. Ultrasonic/thermasonic wedge bonds that are less than 1.2 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter
in width, or are less than 1.5 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in length, before cutoff, as
viewed from above.
b. Thermocompression wedge bonds that are less than 1.2 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in
width or are less than 1.5 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in length.
a. Tailless bonds that are less than 1.2 times or greater than 5.0 times the wire diameter in width, or are less
than 0.5 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in length.
b. Tailless bonds where the bond impression does not cover the entire width of the wire.
3.2.4 General (gold ball, wedge, and tailless). As viewed from above, no device shall be acceptable which
exhibits any of the following defects:
a. Bonds on the die where less than 75 percent of the bond is within the unglassivated bonding pad area
(except where due to geometry, the bonding pad is smaller than the bond, the criteria shall be 50 percent).
b. Wire bond tails that extend over and make contact with any metallization not covered by glassivation and not
connected to the wire.
c. Wire bond tails that exceed two wire diameters in length at the die bonding pad or four wire diameters in
length at the package or post.
d. Bonds on the package post that are not bonded entirely on the flat surface of the post top.
e. A bond on top of another bond, bond wire tail, or residual segment of lead wire. An ultrasonic wedge bond
alongside a previous bond where the observable width of the first bond is reduced less than 0.25 mil is
considered acceptable.
f. Bonds placed so that the separation between bond and adjacent unglassivated die metallization not
connected to it, is less than 1.0 mil.
g. Rebonding.
h. Gold bonds where less than 50 percent of the bond is located within an area that is free of eutectic melt.
METHOD 2069.2
2
3.2.5 Internal lead wires. This inspection and criteria shall be required inspection for the location(s) to which they
are applicable when viewed from above. No device shall be acceptable that exhibits any of the following defects:
a. Any wire that comes closer than one wire diameter to unglassivated operating metallization, another wire
(common wires excluded), package post, unpassivated die area of opposite polarity, or any portion of the
package of opposite polarity including the plane of the lid to be attached (except by design, but in no case
should the separation be less than 0.25 mil). (Within a 5.0 mil spherical radial distance from the perimeter of
the bond on the die surface, the separation shall be greater than 1.0 mil.)
b. Nicks, tears, bends, cuts, crimps, scoring, or neckdown in any wire that reduces the wire diameter by more
than 25 percent, except in bond deformation area.
e. Any wire which runs from die bonding pad to package post and has no arc or stress relief.
f. Wires which cross other wires, except common connectors, except by design, in which case the clearance
shall be 1.0 mil minimum.
g. Wire(s) not in accordance with bonding diagram (unless allowed in design documentation, for tuning
purposes).
h. Kinked wires (an unintended sharp bend) with an interior angle of less than 90 degrees or twisted wires to an
extent that stress marks appear.
i. Wire (ball bonded devices) not within 10 degrees of the perpendicular to the surface of the chip for a distance
of greater than 0.5 mil before bending toward the package post or other termination point.
3.3 Package conditions (low magnification). No device shall be acceptable which exhibits any of the following
defects.
3.3.1 Foreign material on die surface. All foreign material or particles may be blown off with a nominal gas blow
(approximately 20 psig) or removed with a soft camel hair brush. The device shall then be inspected for the following
criteria:
a. Loosely attached conductive particles (conductive particles which are attached by less than one-half of their
largest dimension) that are large enough to bridge the narrowest unglassivated active metal spacing (silicon
chips or any opaque material shall be included as conductive particles).
b. Liquid droplets, chemical stains, or photoresist on the die surface that bridge any combination of
unglassivated metallization or bare silicon areas, except for unused cells.
c. Ink on the surface of the die that covers more than 25 percent of a bonding pad area (or interferes with
bonding) or that bridges any combination of unglassivated metallization or bare silicon areas, except for
unused cells.
METHOD 2069.2
3
a. Die to header mounting material which is not visible around at least three sides or 75 percent of the die
perimeter. Wetting criteria is not required if the devices pass an approved die attached evaluation test.
b. Any balling of the die mounting material which does not exhibit a fillet when viewed from above.
d. Any die mounting material which extends onto the die surface or extends vertically above the top surface of
the die and interferes with bonding.
a. A die which is not oriented or located in accordance with the applicable assembly drawing of the device.
b. Die is visibly tipped or tilted (more than 10 degrees) with respect to the die attach surface.
3.3.4 Internal package defects (low magnification inspection) (applicable to headers, bases, caps, and lids). As
an alternative to 100 percent visual inspection of lids and caps in accordance with the criteria of 3.3.1.a, the lids or
caps may be subjected to a suitable cleaning process and quality verification procedure approved by the qualifying
activity, provided the lids or caps are subsequently held in a controlled environment until capping or preparation for
seal.
a. Any header or post plating which is blistered, flaked, cracked, or any combination thereof.
b. Any conductive particle which is attached by less than one-half of the longest dimension.
c. A bubble or a series of interconnecting bubbles in the glass surrounding the pins which are more than
one-half the distance between the pin and body or pin-to-pin.
e. Any glass, die, or other material greater than 1.0 mil in its major dimension which adheres to the flange or
side of the header and would impair sealing.
f. Any stain, varnish, or header discoloration which appears to extend under a die bond or wire bond.
(1) Any defect or abnormality causing the designed isolating paths between the metal island to be reduced to
less than 50 percent of the design separation.
b. Carrier metallization which is smeared or is obviously not uniform in metallization design pattern to the extent
that there is less than 50 percent of the original design separation, or 0.5 mil, whichever is less, between
operating pads, paths, lid mounting metallization, edges, or any combination thereof.
c. Any crack in the BeO or operating metallization that would affect hermetic seal or die mounting metallization.
(Tooling marks or cold form interface lines are not cracks and are not cause for rejection.)
METHOD 2069.2
4
e. Any attached conductive foreign material which bridges any combination of metallization paths, leads, or
active circuit elements.
f. A scratch or void in the metallization which exposes the substrate anywhere along its length and leaves less
than 75 percent of the original metal width undisturbed.
NOTE: Occasionally package metallization is intentionally burnished or scratched, in areas which require wire
bond attachment, to improve surface bondability; such conditions are not cause for rejection. Burnished or
scratched areas must satisfy the criteria of 3.3.4.b.
h. Any staple, bridge, or clip with solder joint which exhibits less than 50 percent wetting around the section that
is attached to the package.
i. Any header post(s) which are not perpendicular within 10 degrees of the horizontal plane of the header.
j. Any lead attach eutectic or solder which extends across greater than 50 percent of the design separation gap
between metallization pads.
3.3.6 Presence of extraneous matter. Extraneous matter (foreign particles) shall include, but not be limited to:
a. Any foreign particle, loose or attached, greater than .003 inch (0.08 mm) or of any lesser size which is
sufficient to bridge nonconnected conducting elements of the device.
b. Any wire tail extending beyond its normal end by more than two diameters at the semiconductor die pad or by
more than four wire diameters at the package post (see figure 2069-3).
c. Any burr on a post (header lead) greater than .003 inch (0.08 mm) in its major dimension or of such
configuration that it may break away.
d. Excessive semiconductor die bonding material buildup. A semiconductor die shall be mounted and bonded
so that it is not tilted more than 10 degrees from mounting surface. The bonding agent that accumulates
around the perimeter of the semiconductor die and touches the side of the semiconductor die shall not
accumulate to a thickness greater than that of the semiconductor die (see figures 2069-4 and 2069-5).
Where the bonding agent is built up but is not touching the semiconductor die, the build up shall not be
greater than twice the thickness of the semiconductor die. There shall be no excess semiconductor die
bonding material in contact with the active surface of the semiconductor die or any lead or post, or separated
from the main bonding material area (see figure 2069-6).
f. Extraneous ball bonds anywhere inside case, except for attached bond residue when rebonding is allowed.
3.4 Semiconductor conditions. No device shall be acceptable which exhibits any of the following defects.
b. Any die containing a void in the metallization at the bonding pad covering more that 25 percent of the pad
area.
c. For devices with non-expanded contacts and all power devices. Any scratch or void which isolates more than
25 percent of the total metallization of an active region from the bonding pad.
d. For all devices with expanded contacts. A scratch or void, whether or not underlying material is exposed,
which leaves less than 50 percent undisturbed metal width in the metal connecting the pad and the contact
regions.
METHOD 2069.2
5
e. For expanded contacts with less than or equal to 10 contact regions. A scratch or void extending across
more than 50 percent of the first half of any contact region (beginning at the bonding area) in more than 10
percent of the contact regions.
f. For expanded contacts with less than or equal to 10 contact regions. A scratch or void in the contact area
which isolates more then 10 percent of the metallized area form the bonding area.
3.4.3 Metallization adherence. Any metallization which has lifted, peeled, or blistered.
3.4.4 Metallization probe marks. Criteria found in 3.4.1 shall apply as limitations for probing damage.
3.4.5 Metallization bridging. Metallization bridging between two normally unconnected metallization paths which
reduces the separation, such that a line of oxide is not visible (no less than 0.1 mil) when viewed at the prescribed
magnification.
a. Except by design, contact window that has less than 50 percent of its area covered by continuous
metallization.
b. A metallization path not intended to cover a contact window which is separated from the window by less than
0.1 mil.
a. Any passivation fault including pinholes not covered by glassivation that exposes semiconductor material and
allows bridging between any two diffused areas, any two metallization strips, or any such combination not
intended by design.
b. Except by design, an absence of passivation visible at the edge and continuing under the metallization
causing an apparent short between the metal and the underlying material (closely spaced double or triple
lines on the edges of the defect indicate that it may have sufficient depth to penetrate down to the silicon).
a. Except by design, less than 0.1 mil passivation visible between active metallization or bond pad periphery and
the edge of the die.
c. Except by design, die having attached portions of the active area on another die, and which exceeds 10
percent of the area of the second die.
d. Any crack which extends 2.0 mils in length inside the scribe grid or scribe line that points toward active
metallization or active area and extends into the oxide area.
f. Any crack or chip-out that extends under any active metallization area.
METHOD 2069.2
6
a. Glass crazing that prohibits the detection of visual criteria contained herein.
b. Any glassivation which has delaminated. (Lifting or peeling of the glassivation may be excluded from the
criteria above, when it does not extend more than 1.0 mil from the designed periphery of the glassivation,
provided that the only exposure of metal is adjacent to bond pads or of metallization leading from those pads.)
c. Except by design, two or more adjacent active metallization paths which are not covered by glassivation.
e. Glassivation which covers more than 25 percent of the design bonding pad area.
3.5 Post protective coating visual inspection. If devices are to be coated with a protective coating, the devices
shall be visually examined in accordance with the criteria specified in 3 herein, prior to the application of the coating.
After the application and cure of the protective coating, the devices shall be visually examined under a minimum of
10X magnification. No device shall be acceptable which exhibits any of the following defects:
a. Except by design, any unglassivated or passivated areas or insulating substrate which has incomplete age.
f. Conductive particles which are embedded in the coating and are large enough to bridge the narrowest
unglassivated active metal spacing (silicon chips shall be included as conductive particles).
g. Except by design, a web of protective coating that connects the wire with the header.
b. Where applicable, any conflicts with approved circuit design topology or construction.
c. Where applicable, gauges, drawings, and photographs that are to be used as standards for operator
comparison.
METHOD 2069.2
7
A. Tailless or crescent.
NOTES:
1. 1.2 D W 5.0 D (width).
2. 0.5 D L 3.0 D (length).
B. Wedge.
Ultrasonic Thermocompression
NOTES: NOTES:
1. 1.0 D W 3.0 D (width). 1. 1.2 D W 3.0 D (width).
2. 1.5 D L 3.0 D (length). 2. 1.5 D L 3.0 D (length).
METHOD 2069.2
8
METHOD 2069.2
9
METHOD 2069.2
10
METHOD 2069.2
11
METHOD 2069.2
12
METHOD 2069.2
13
METHOD 2070.2
PRE-CAP VISUAL
MICROWAVE DISCRETE AND MULTICHIP TRANSISTORS
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to verify the construction and quality of workmanship in wafer, wafer dc
testing, die inspection, and assembly processes to the point of pre-cap inspection. These various inspections and
tests are intended to detect and remove transistor die with defects that could lead to device failure during application
and to verify compliance with the requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus for this inspection shall consist of the following:
a. Optical equipment capable of the specified magnifications, and both normal incident and darkfield lighting.
b. Adequate fixturing for handling the devices being inspected without causing damage.
c. Adequate covered storage and transportation containers to protect devices from mechanical damage and
environmental contamination.
d. Any visual standards (e.g., drawings, photographs) necessary to enable the inspector to make objective
decisions as to the acceptability of devices being inspected.
2.1 Microwave Devices. GaAs devices shall be inspected to all applicable criteria as listed herein. GaAs
microwave devices shall also have additional specific criteria as listed and the applicable high power magnification
for individual features of GaAs microwave devices shall be selected from the following table.
3. Procedure.
3.1 General. The devices shall be examined in a suitable sequence of observations with the specified
magnification range to determine compliance with the requirements of this document and the applicable specification
sheet.
a. Sequence of inspection. The order in which criteria are presented is not a required order of inspection and
may be varied at the discretion of the manufacturer.
b. Inspection control. Within the time interval between visual inspection and preparation for sealing, devices
shall be stored in a controlled environment (an environment in which air-borne particles and relative humidity
are controlled). The use of a positive pressure inert gas environment, such as dry nitrogen, shall satisfy the
requirement of storing in a controlled environment. Unless a cleaning operation is performed prior to sealing,
devices inspected in accordance with this specification shall be inspected in a class 100,000 environment in
accordance with FED-STD-209. The maximum allowable relative humidity shall not exceed 05 percent.
Devices shall be in clean covered containers when transferred through any uncontrolled environment.
METHOD 2070.2
1 of 18
c. Magnification. High magnification inspection shall be performed perpendicular to the die surface with normal
incident or darkfield illumination as required. Low magnification inspection shall be performed with either a
monocular, binocular, or stereo microscope and the inspection performed with any appropriate angle, with the
device under suitable illumination. High magnification may be used to verify a discrepancy which has first
been noted at low magnification.
(1) High magnification inspection shall be performed within the range of 00X to 200X.
(2) Low magnification shall be performed within the range of 30X to 00X.
d. General reject criteria. Unless otherwise specified, reject if the defect is present in 25 percent of any one cell
or in 10 percent of the entire die. Figures 2070-1 through 2070-4 illustrate accept and reject criteria for die
and bonds.
e. Figures 2070-5 through 2070-7 illustrate different geometries used in fabricating microwave discrete
transistors.
3.2.1 Metallization inspection. Unless otherwise specified, the 25 percent of a cell and 10 percent of a die reject
conditions apply. No die shall be acceptable which exhibits any of the following defects:
a. Metallization misalignment so that there is less than 75 percent coverage of the ohmic contact windows.
b. Contact window that has less than a continuous 50 percent of its perimeter covered by metallization. NOTE:
Metal coverage is not required at the far dielectric steps of the end base contacts under base metal finger
tips.
c. Metal must cover 50 percent of the contact that lies over the enhancement area.
d. Metallization bridging, between two normally unconnected metallization paths, which reduces the design
separation to less than 50 percent or 0.1 mil whichever is less.
g. Exception: Do not reject for missing or defective run around metal (run around metal is non active metal
used for probing purposes with multicell devices).
3.2.2 Glassivation and silicon nitride defects. (Unless otherwise specified, the 25 percent of a cell and 10 percent
of a die reject conditions apply). No die shall be acceptable which exhibits any of the following defects:
a. Glass crazing that prohibits the detection of voids or scratches during subsequent inspection or that covers
more than 25 percent of the die area.
c. Two or more adjacent active metallization paths which are not covered by glassivation, except by design.
e. Glassivation which covers more than 25 percent of the designed bonding pad area.
g. Glass cracks which form closed loops over adjacent metallization paths.
METHOD 2070.2
2
3.3 Die metallization defects (high magnification). No die shall be acceptable which exhibits any of the following
defects.
3.3.1 Metallization scratches and voids exposing underlying material (see figure 2070-1). Unless otherwise
specified, the 25 percent of a cell and 10 percent of a die conditions apply.
b. Any die containing a void in the metallization at the bonding pad covering more than 25 percent of the pad
area (see figure 2070-1).
c. For all devices with expanded contacts. A scratch, whether or not underlying material is exposed; or a void,
which leaves less than 50 percent undisturbed metal width in the metal connecting the pad and the contact
regions.
d. For expanded contacts with more than 10 contact regions. A scratch or void extending across more than 50
percent of the first half of any contact region (beginning at the bonding area) in more than 10 percent of the
contact regions.
e. For expanded contacts with less than 10 contact regions. A scratch or void in the contact area which isolates
more than 10 percent of the contact regions.
f. Metallization probing. Criteria contained in 3.3.1.b shall apply as limitation on probing damage.
3.4 Scribing and die defects (high magnification). No device shall be acceptable which exhibits any of the
following defects (see figure 2070-2).
a. Unless by design, less than 0.1 mil passivation visible between active metallization or bond pad periphery
and the edge of the die.
c. Any crack which exceeds 2.0 mils in length beyond the scribe grid or line that points toward active
metallization or an active area.
d. Any chip-out that extends to within 1.0 mil of an active area or to within 50 percent of the design spacing,
whichever is less.
f. Reject if more than 25 percent of a depletion ring is missing. A depletion ring encompasses an individual cell.
An annular ring encompasses the entire die. A true annular ring will be the same color as the emitter.
3.5 Bonding inspection (low magnification). This inspection and criteria shall be the required inspection for the
bond types and locations to which they are applicable when viewed from above (see figures 2070-3 and 2070-4).
(Wire tail is not considered part of the bond when determining physical bond dimensions.) No device shall be
acceptable which exhibits any of the following defects.
a. Gold ball bonds where the ball bond diameter is less than 2.0 times or greater than 5.0 times the bonding
wire diameter.
b. Gold ball bonds where the wire exit is not completely within the periphery of the ball.
c. Gold ball bonds where the exiting wire is not within boundaries of the bonding pad.
d. Any visible intermetallic formation at the periphery of any gold ball bond.
METHOD 2070.2
3
a. Aluminum wire: Ultrasonic/thermasonic wedge bonds that are less than 1.2 times or greater than 3.0 times
the wire diameter in width, or less than 1.5 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in length.
b. Gold wire: Ultrasonic/thermasonic wedge bonds that are less than 1.0 times or greater than 3.0 times the
wire diameter in width, or less than 0.5 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in length.
c. Thermocompression wedge bonds that are less than 1.2 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in
width or are less than 0.5 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in length.
a. Tailless bonds that are less than 1.2 times or greater than 5.0 times the wire diameter in width or are less
than 0.5 times or greater 3.0 times the wire diameter in length.
b. Tailless bonds where the bond impression does not cover the entire width of the wire.
METHOD 2070.2
4
3.5.4 General (gold ball, wedge, and tailless). As viewed from above, no device shall be acceptable which
exhibits any of the following defects.
a. Bonds on the die where less than 50 percent of the bond is within the unglassivated bonding pad area.
b. Wire bond tails that extend over and make contact with any metallization not covered by glassivation and not
connected to the wire.
c. Wire bond tails that exceed two wire diameters in length at the die bonding pad or four wire diameters in
length at the package or post.
d. Bonds on the package post that are not bonded entirely on the flat surface of the post top.
e. A bond on top of another bond, bond wire tail, or residual segment of lead wire. An ultrasonic wedge bond
alongside a previous bond where the observable width of the first bond is reduced less than 0.25 mil is
considered acceptable.
f. Bonds placed so that the separation between bond and adjacent unglassivated die metallization not
connected to it is less than 1.0 mil, except if the glass does not exhibit cracking, the separation may be 0.1
mil.
(1) No scratched, open, or discontinuous metallization paths or conductor patterns shall be repaired by
bridging with, or addition of, bonding wire or ribbon.
(2) All rebonds shall be placed on at least 50 percent undisturbed metal (excluding probe marks that do not
expose oxide) and no more than one rebond attempt at any design bond location shall be permitted at
any pad or post and no rebonds shall touch an area of exposed oxide caused by lifting metal.
(3) The total number of rebond attempts shall be limited to a maximum of 10 percent of the total number of
bonds in the device. The 10 percent limit on rebonds may be interpreted as the nearest whole number of
bonds in the device. A bond shall be defined as a wire to post or wire to bond pad. Bond-offs required to
clear the bonder after an unsuccessful first bond attempt need not be considered as rebonds provided
they can be identified as bond-offs by being made physically away from normal bond areas. The initial
bond attempt need not be visible. A replacement of one wire at one end or an unsuccessful bond
attempt at one end of the wire counts as one rebond; a replacement of wire bonded at both ends, or an
unsuccessful bond attempt of a wire already bonded at the other end, counts as two rebonds.
h. Gold bonds where less than 50 percent of the bond is located within an area that is free of eutectic melt. The
blush area shall not be considered part of the eutectic melt. (The blush area is defined as the area where a
color change can be seen but not a change in surface texture.)
METHOD 2070.2
5
3.5.5 Internal lead wires. This inspection and criteria shall be required inspection for the locations to which they
are applicable when viewed from above. No device shall be acceptable that exhibits any of the following defects.
a. Any wire that comes closer than one wire diameter to unglassivated operating metallization, another wire
(common wires excluded), package post, unpassivated die area of opposite polarity, or any portion of the
package of opposite polarity including the plane of the lid to be attached (except by design, but in no case
should the separation be less than 0.25 mil). (Within a 5.0 mil spherical radial distance from the perimeter of
the bond on the die surface, the separation shall be greater than 1.0 mil.)
b. Nicks, tears, bends, cuts, crimps, scoring, or neckdown in any wire that reduces the wire diameter by more
than 25 percent, except in bond deformation area.
e. Any wire which runs from die bonding pad to package post and has no arc or stress relief.
f. Wires which cross other wires, except common connectors, except by design, in which case the clearance
shall be 1.0 mil minimum.
g. Wires not in accordance with bonding diagram (unless allowed in design documentation, for tuning
purposes).
h. Kinked wires (an unintended sharp bend) with an interior angle of less than 90 degrees or twisted wires to an
extent that stress marks appear.
i. Wire (ball bonded devices) not within 10 degrees of the perpendicular to the surface of the chip for a distance
of greater than 0.5 mil before bending toward the package post or other termination point.
3.6 Package conditions (low magnification). No device shall be acceptable which exhibits any of the following
defects.
3.6.1 Foreign material on die surface. All foreign material or particles may be blown off with a nominal gas blow
(approximately 20 psi (138 kPa)) or removed with a soft camel hair brush. The device shall then be inspected for the
following criteria.
a. Loosely attached conductive particles (conductive particles which are attached by less than one-half of their
largest dimension) that are large enough to bridge the narrowest unglassivated active metal spacing (silicon
chips or any opaque material shall be included as conductive particles).
b. Liquid droplets, chemical stains, or photoresist on the die surface that bridge any combination of
unglassivated metallization or bare silicon areas, except for unused cells.
c. Ink on the surface of the die that covers more than 25 percent of a bonding pad area (or interferes with
bonding) or that bridges any combination of unglassivated metallization or bare silicon areas, except for
unused cells.
METHOD 2070.2
6
a. Die to header mounting material which is not visible around at least three sides or 75 percent of the die
perimeter. Wetting criteria is not required if the devices pass an approved die attached evaluation test.
b. Any balling of the die mounting material which does not exhibit a fillet when viewed from above.
d. Any die mounting material which extends onto the die surface beyond the scribe zone and comes closer than
0.5 mil to any active area or metallization, or extends vertically above the top surface of the die and interferes
with bonding.
a. A die which is not oriented or located in accordance with the applicable assembly drawing of the device.
b. Die is visibly tipped or tilted (more than 10 degrees) with respect to the die attach surface.
3.6.4 Internal package defects (applicable to headers, bases, caps, and lids). As an alternative to 100-percent
visual inspection, the lids or caps may be subjected to a suitable cleaning process and quality verification procedure
approved by the qualifying activity, provided the lids or caps are subsequently held in a controlled environment until
capping or preparation for seal.
b. Any conductive particle which is attached by less than one-half of the longest dimension.
(1) Any defect or abnormality causing the designed isolating paths between the metal islands to be reduced
to less than 50 percent of the design separation or reduced to 0.2 mil, whichever is less.
METHOD 2070.2
7
b. Carrier metallization which is smeared or is obviously not uniform in metallization design pattern to the extent
that there is less than 50 percent of the original design separation, or 0.5 mil, whichever is less, between
operating pads, paths, lid mounting metallization, edges, or any combination thereof.
c. Any crack in the BeO or operating metallization that would affect hermetic seal or die mounting metallization.
(Tooling marks or cold form interface lines are not cracks and are not cause for rejection.)
e. Any attached conductive foreign material which bridges any combination of metallization paths, leads, or
active circuit elements.
f. A scratch or void in the metallization which exposes the substrate anywhere along its length and leaves less
than 75 percent of the original metal width undisturbed.
NOTE: Occasionally package metallization is intentionally burnished or scratched, in areas which require wire
bond attachment, to improve surface bondability; such conditions are not cause for rejection. Burnished or
scratched areas must satisfy the criteria of 3.0.4.b.
h. Any staple, bridge, or clip with solder joint which exhibits less than 50 percent wetting around the section that
is attached to the package.
i. Any header posts which are not perpendicular within 10 degrees of the horizontal plane of the header.
j. Any lead attach eutectic or solder which extends across greater than 50 percent of the design separation gap
between metallization pads.
a. Scratches through the metal that extend the length of the metal and expose underlying oxide.
d. Cracks in the silicon that point toward the metal and are within 1.0 mil of the metal (except for ground bar
portion).
e. Chip-outs within 0.5 mil of the metal (except for ground bar portion).
f. Metal that has been gouged or probed over 20 percent of a bonding pad area and exposes underlying oxide.
g. Mounting material which is not visible around at least three sides or 75 percent of the capacitor perimeter.
Wetting criteria is not required if the devices pass an approved capacitor attach evaluation test. (This
inspection is to be performed at low magnification.)
NOTE: Multiple bonding is allowable for tuning purposes, however initial bond wire shall be
completely removed before rebonding and must be in accordance with design documentation.
METHOD 2070.2
8
3.8 Alignment (this applies to 25 percent of any one cell or 10 percent of any die). Reject any diffusion line which
touches another diffusion line, except for contact enhancements, which can touch an active area of the same type.
Emitter contacts can touch emitter base junction but cannot cross. Base contacts must engage 50 percent or more
of the contact enhancement.
3.9 Resistors (criteria applies to 25 percent of any one cell or 10 percent of any die). (See table 2072-2)
TABLE 2072-2. 1/
1/ Reject if 25 percent of any one cell or 10 percent of any die exhibits burned or missing resistors.
3.9.1 NICR resistor. Thin film deposited and patterned usually connecting emitter fingers to emitter feed metal to
control current. It can also be used as a passive element in RF IC's.
3.9.2 Poly SI resistors (bevel). Thin film of poly SI is deposited, doped, and patterned usually connecting emitter
fingers to emitter feed metal to control current. It can also be used as passive elements in RF IC's.
3.9.3 Diffused resistors (contact appearance). A diffused area connecting emitter fingers to emitter feed metal
used to control current.
3.9.4 Contacts and diffusion defects (contacts are not diffused). Reject if contacts are less than 50 percent of
design on 10 percent of the die. Reject any die that has a discontinuous implant or diffusion line effecting more than
10 percent of the die. A discontinuous line is a line that wanders but does not close on itself. Reject any die where
an implant or diffusion fault bridges between two diffuse areas, any two metallized stripes of any combination not
intended by design. This must effect greater than 10 percent of the die. Reject any implant or diffused area that is
less than 50 percent of design.
3.9.5 Passivation or oxide defects. This applies to 25 percent of a cell and 10 percent of the die. Reject any
active junction not covered by passivation or glassivation. Reject for absence of passivation or oxide visible at the
edge and continuing under the metallization causing a short between the metal and the underlying material (unless
by design). Reject for passivation or oxide defects that allows bridging between any two metallized stripes.
METHOD 2070.2
9
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Where applicable, any conflicts with approved circuit design topology or construction.
c. Where applicable, gauges, drawings, and photographs that are to be used as standards for operator
comparison.
METHOD 2070.2
10
METHOD 2070.2
11
Tailless or crescent.
NOTES:
1.2 D W 5.0 D (width)
0.5 D L 3.0 D (length)
Wedge.
Ultrasonic Thermocompression
NOTES: NOTES:
1. 1.0 D W 3.0 D (width) 1. 1.2 D W 3.0 D (width)
2. 1.5 D L 5.0 D (length) 2. 1.5 D L 5.0 D (length)
METHOD 2070.2
12
REJECT-BOND LIFTED
METHOD 2070.2
13
METHOD 2070.2
14
METHOD 2070.2
16
METHOD 2070.2
17
METHOD 2070.2
18
METHOD 2071.6
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to verify the workmanship of hermetically packaged devices. This
method shall also be utilized to inspect for damage due to handling, assembly, and test of the packaged device.
This test is normally employed at outgoing inspection within the device manufacturers facility, or as an incoming
inspection of the assembled device.
2. Apparatus. Apparatus used in this test shall be capable of demonstrating device conformance to the applicable
requirements of the individual specification sheet. This includes optical equipment capable of magnification of 3X
minimum to as specified herein, with a large field of view such as an illuminated ring magnifier.
3. Procedure. Unless otherwise specified, the device shall be examined under a magnification of 3X minimum.
The field of view shall be sufficiently large to contain the entire device and allow inspection to the criteria listed in 3.1.
Where inspection at a lower magnification reveals an anomaly, then inspection at a higher magnification (10X
maximum, unless otherwise specified) may be performed to determine acceptability.
When a disposition is in doubt for any dimensional criteria, that dimension may be measured for verification.
3.1 Failure criteria. Devices which exhibit any of the following shall be considered rejects.
3.1.1 Rejects. Device construction (package outline), lead (terminal), identification, markings (content,
placement, and legibility), and workmanship not in accordance with the applicable specification sheet shall be
rejected. This includes the following.
a. Any misalignment of component parts to the extent that the package outline drawing dimensions are
exceeded.
b. Visual evidence of corrosion or contamination. Discoloration is not sufficient cause for rejection. The
presence of lead carbonate formations in the form of a white/yellow crystalline shall be considered evidence
of contamination.
c. Damaged or bent leads or terminals which precludes their use in the intended application.
d. Defective finish: Evidence of blistering, or evidence of non-adhesion, peeling, or flaking which exposes
underplate or base metal.
f. Foreign material (including solder or other metallization) bridging leads or otherwise interfering with the
normal application of the device. Where adherence of foreign material is in question, devices may be
subjected to a clean filtered air stream (suction or expulsion) or an isopropyl alcohol wash and then
reinspected.
g. Protrusions beyond seating plane that will interfere with proper seating of the device.
METHOD 2071.6
1 of 13
k. Dents in metal lids which precludes their use in the intended application or causing a defect in the finish (see
3.1.1.d).
l. Gaps, separations, or other openings that are not part of the normal design configuration.
n. Weld alignment: Base weld mating surfaces not parallel, or that precludes intended use.
3.1.1.1 Failure criteria for lead/terminal seal area of metal can devices.
a. Radial cracks (except meniscus cracks) that extend more than one-half of the distance from the pin to the
outer member (see figure 2071-1). Radial cracks that originate from the outer member.
b. Circumferential cracks (except meniscus cracks) that extend more than 90 degrees around the seal center
(see figure 2071-2).
c. Open surface bubble(s) in strings or clusters that exceed two-thirds of the distance between the lead and the
package wall.
(1) Large bubbles or voids that exceed one-third of the glass sealing area (see figure 2071-3).
(2) Single bubble or void that is larger than two-thirds of the distance between the lead and the package wall
at the site of the inclusion and extends more than one-third of the glass seal depth (see figure 2071-4).
(3) Two bubbles in a line totaling more than two-thirds of the distance from pin to case (see figure 2071-5).
(4) Interconnecting bubbles greater than two-thirds of the distance between pin and case (see figure
2071-6).
e. Except as designed, re-entrant seals which exhibit non-uniform wicking or negative wicking.
f. Twenty-five percent or greater of the radius length from the center of the feedthrough to the edge of the glass
eyelet.
g. Glass meniscus cracks that are not located within one-half of the distance between the lead to the case (see
figure 2071-7). The glass meniscus is defined as that area of glass that wicks up the lead or terminal.
h. Any chip-out of ceramic or sealing glass that penetrates the sealing glass deeper than the glass meniscus
plane. Exposed base metal as a result of meniscus chip outs are acceptable if the exposed area is no
deeper than .010 inch (0.25 mm) or 50 percent of lead diameter, whichever is greater (see figure 2071-8).
3.1.1.2 Failure criteria for ceramic packages. Failure criteria for ceramic packages (see method 2009 of
MIL-STD-883).
3.1.1.3 Failure criteria for opaque glass body devices. Failure criteria for opaque glass body devices (see method
2068 of this general specification).
METHOD 2071.6
2
a. Any evidence of a crack, fracture, or a chipout closer to the die than 50 percent of the designed seal length
shall be rejected. Area of examination shall be as shown on figure 2071-9.
b. Any crack that terminates in the axial direction is cause for rejection
3.1.1.5 Transparent glass diodes, large cavity (i.e. S-bend, C-bend, or straight-through constructions). Any crack
or fracture in the glass over the area of the device cavity shall be rejected.
a. Any crack or fracture in the glass over the area of the device cavity shall be rejected.
b. Any chip out that exposes base metal shall be rejected (this does not apply to chip outs at either end of
device where glass joins external lead).
c. Any crack that terminates in the axial direction is cause for rejection.
3.1.1.6 Failure criteria for hermetic packages with ceramic eyelet feedthroughs.
a. Any separation or delamination of the braze metallization from the inner diameter (ID) or outer diameter (OD)
of the ceramic eyelet (see figures 2071-10 and 2071-11).
b. Any cracks or separation in the braze between the ceramic eyelet ID and the lead or the ceramic eyelet OD
and the package. Any voids, depressions, or pinholes the bottom of which cannot be seen at 30X maximum
magnification in the braze between the ceramic eyelet ID and the lead or the ceramic eyelet OD and the
package.
c. Any discontinuation in the braze from the ceramic eyelet ID to the lead or the ceramic eyelet OD to the
package exposing unplated metallization or bare ceramic (see figures 2071-12).
d. Any conductive material attached to the ceramic eyelet that reduces the designed isolation width by more
than one-third unless it is demonstrated that the device voltage isolation requirement can be met with less
than two-thirds of the width of the ceramic eyelet (see figures 207113 through 14).
e. Any metallization that extends beyond the height of the ceramic that is not adhered to the ceramic.
f. No cracks are allowed. Chipouts greater than .005 inch (0.127 mm) in any direction are not allowed.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable acquisition document:
METHOD 2071.6
3
FIGURE 2071-1. Radial cracks extending more than one-half the distance from pin to outer member.
METHOD 2071.6
4
METHOD 2071.6
5
METHOD 2071.6
6
METHOD 2071.6
7
Reject: Arrow indicates a crack on the inner diameter braze metallization of the ceramic eyelet.
METHOD 2071.6
8
Reject: All three figures illustrate discontinuous braze metallization on the outer diameter of the ceramic eyelet.
METHOD 2071.6
9
METHOD 2071.6
10
METHOD 2071.6
11
METHOD 2071.6
12
METHOD 2071.6
13
METHOD 2072.6
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to verify the construction and workmanship of bipolar transistors,
field effect transistors (FET), discrete monolithic, multichip, and multijunction devices excluding microwave and
selected RF devices. This test will be performed prior to capping or encapsulation to detect those devices with
internal defects that could lead to failures in normal application and verify compliance with the requirements of the
applicable specification sheet.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus for this inspection shall consist of the following.
b. Light sources of sufficient intensity to adequately illuminate the devices being inspected.
c. Adequate fixturing for handling the devices being inspected without causing damage.
d. Adequate covered storage and transportation containers to protect devices from mechanical damage and
environmental contamination.
e. Any visual standards (drawings and photographs) necessary to enable the inspector to make objective
decisions as to the acceptability of the devices being examined.
3. Definitions.
3.1 Glassivation. The top layer of transparent insulating material that covers the active circuit area metallization,
but excluding bonding pads.
3.2 Passivation. Silicon oxide, nitride, or other insulating material that is grown or deposited directly on the die
prior to the deposition of any metal.
3.3 Wetting. The spreading, and sometimes absorption, of a liquid on or into a surface.
4. Procedure.
4.1 General. The device shall be examined in a suitable sequence of observations within the specified
magnification range to determine compliance with the requirements of the applicable specification sheet and the
criteria of the specified test condition. If a specified visual inspection requirement is in conflict with the topology or
construction of a specific device design, alternate inspection criteria may be included in the specification sheet. Any
alternate inspection criteria contained in the specification sheet shall take precedence over the criteria of this test
method. Any criteria of this test method intended for a specific device process or technology has been indicated.
Where applicable, unused cells shall not be subjected to internal visual criteria.
a. Sequence of inspection. The order in which criteria are presented is not a required order of examination and
may be varied at the discretion of the manufacturer. Visual criteria specified in 4.1.1, 4.1.2, 4.1.3, and 4.1.7,
may be examined prior to die attachment with reexamination at low or high magnification after die
attachment for these criteria. Visual criteria specified in 4.1.6.2 and 4.1.6.3 may be examined prior to lead
wire bonding without reexamination after bonding.
b. Inspection control. Within the time interval between visual inspection and preparation for sealing, devices
shall be stored in a controlled environment (one which controls airborne particle count and relative humidity).
The use of an inert gas environment, such as dry nitrogen shall satisfy the requirements for storing in a
controlled environment. Devices examined in accordance with this test method shall be inspected and
stored in a class 100,000 environment, in accordance with FED-STD-209, except that the maximum
allowable relative humidity shall not exceed 65 percent.
If devices are subjected to a high temperature bake (>+100C) immediately prior to sealing, the humidity
control is not required. Unless a cleaning operation is performed prior to sealing, devices shall be in covered
containers when transferred from one controlled environment to another.
METHOD 2072.6
1 of 16
c. Magnification. High magnification inspection shall be performed perpendicular to the die surface with normal
incident illumination. Low magnification inspection shall be performed with either a monocular, binocular, or
stereo microscope, and the inspection performed within any appropriate angle, with the device under
suitable illumination. The inspection criteria of 4.1.4 and 4.1.6.1 may be examined at "high magnification" at
the manufacturer's option. High power magnification may be used to verify a discrepancy noted at a low
power.
d. Reinspection. Unless a specific magnification is required by the specification sheet, when inspection for
product acceptance or quality verification of the visual requirements herein is conducted subsequent to the
manufacturer's successful inspection, the additional inspection may be performed at any magnification
specified herein. If sampling is used rather than 100 percent reinspection, reevaluation of lot quality in
accordance with the Reevaluation of lot quality of MIL-PRF-19500 shall be used.
e. Exclusions. If conditional exclusions have been allowed, specific instruction as to the location and conditions
for which the exclusion can be applied shall be documented in the assembly inspection drawing.
4.1.1 Die metallization defects (high magnification). A die which exhibits any of the following defects shall be
rejected.
4.1.1.1 Metallization, scratches, and voids exposing underlying material (see figure 2072-1).
b. Any die containing a void in the metallization at the bonding pad covering more than 25 percent of the pad
area.
c. For devices with nonexpanded contacts and all power devices. Any scratch or void which isolates more than
25 percent of the total metallization of an active region from the bonding pad.
d. For all devices with expanded contacts. A scratch or void, whether or not underlying material is exposed,
which leaves less than 50 percent undisturbed metal width in the metal connecting the pad and contact
regions.
e. For expanded contacts with more than 10 contact regions. A scratch or void extending across more than 50
percent of the first half of any contact region (beginning at the bonding area) in more than 10 percent of the
contact regions.
f. For expanded contacts with less than 10 contact regions. A scratch or void in the contact area which
isolates more than 10 percent of the metallized area from the bonding pad.
4.1.1.3 Metallization adherence. Any metallization which has lifted, peeled, or blistered.
4.1.1.4 Metallization probing. Criteria contained in 4.1.1.1 shall apply as limitations on probing damage.
METHOD 2072.6
2
4.1.1.5 Metallization bridging. Metallization bridging between two normally unconnected metallization paths which
reduces the separation, such that a line of oxide is not visible (no less than 0.1 mil) when viewed at the prescribed
high magnification.
a. Except by design, contact window that has less than 50 percent of its area covered by continuous
metallization.
b. A metallization path not intended to cover a contact window which is separated from the window by less than
0.1 mil.
c. Except by design, any misalignment to the extent that continuous passivation color cannot be seen (i.e.,
metallization crossing passivation).
4.1.2 Passivation and diffusion faults (high magnification). A device which exhibits any of the following defects
(see figure 2072-2) shall be rejected:
a. Any diffusion fault that allows bridging between any two diffused areas, any two metallization strips, or any
such combination not intended by design.
b. Any passivation fault including pinholes not covered by glassivation that exposes semiconductor material
and allows bridging between any two diffused areas, any two metallization strips, or any such combination
not intended by design.
d. Except by design, an absence of passivation visible at the edge and continuing under the metallization
causing an apparent short between the metal and the underlying material (closely spaced double or triple
lines on the edges of the defect indicate that it may have sufficient depth to penetrate down to the silicon).
f. Unless by design, a contact window in a diffused area which extends across a junction.
4.1.3 Scribing and die defects (high magnification). A device which exhibits any of the following defects (see
figure 2072-3) shall be rejected:
a. Unless by design, less than 0.1 mil passivation visible between active metallization or bond pad periphery
and the edge of the die.
c. Except by design, die having attached portions of the active area of another die and which exceeds 10
percent of the area of the second die.
d. Any crack which exceeds 2.0 mils in length inside the scribe grid or scribe line that points toward active
metallization or active area and extends into the oxide area.
f. Any crack or chip-out that extends under any active metallization area.
4.1.4 Bond inspection (low magnification). This inspection and criteria shall be the required inspection for the
bond type(s) and location(s) to which they are applicable when viewed from above (see figures 2072-4 and 2072-5).
Wire tail is not considered part of the bond when determining physical bond dimensions. A device which exhibits
any of the following defects shall be rejected.
METHOD 2072.6
3
a. Gold ball bonds on the die or package post where the ball bond diameter is less than 2.0 times or greater
than 5.0 times the wire diameter.
b. Gold ball bonds where the wire exit is not completely within the periphery of the ball.
c. Gold ball bonds where the existing wire is not within the boundaries of the bonding pad.
d. Any visible intermetallic formation at the periphery of any gold ball bond.
a. Ultrasonic wedge bonds on the die or package post that are less than 1.2 times or greater than 3.0 times the
wire diameter in width, or are less than 1.5 times or greater than 5.0 times the wire diameter in length.
b. Thermocompression wedge bonds on the die or package post that are less than 1.2 times or greater than
3.0 times the wire diameter in width or are less than 1.5 or greater than 5.0 times the wire diameter in length.
a. Tailless bonds on the die or package post that are less than 1.2 times or greater than 5.0 times the wire
diameter in width or are less than 0.5 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in length.
b. Tailless bonds where the bond impression does not cover the entire width of the wire.
4.1.4.4 General (gold ball, wedge, and tailless). As viewed from above, a device which exhibits any of the
following defects shall be rejected.
a. Bonds on the die where less than 75 percent of the bond is within the unglassivated bonding pad area
(except where due to geometry, the bonding pad is smaller than the bond, the criteria shall be 50 percent).
b. Wire bond tails that extend over and make contact with any metallization not covered by glassivation and not
connected to the wire.
c. Wire bond tails that exceed two wire diameters in length at the bonding pad or four wire diameters in length
at the package post.
d. Bonds on the package post that are not bonded entirely on the flat surface of the post top.
f. Bonds placed so that the separation between bonds and adjacent unglassivated die metallization is less
than 1.0 mil.
g. Bonds placed so that the separation between bonds and adjacent glassivated die metallization is less than
0.25 mil.
h. Bonds placed so that the separation between adjacent bonds is less than 0.25 mil. This criteria does not
apply to designs which employ multiple bond wires in place of a single wire.
i. Bonds located where any of the bond is placed on an area containing die preform mounting material.
k. For aluminum wires over 2.0 mils diameter, the bond width shall not be less than 1.0 times the wire diameter.
METHOD 2072.6
4
4.1.5 Internal lead wires (low magnification). This inspection and criteria shall be required inspection for the
location(s) to which they are applicable when viewed from above. A device which exhibits any of the following
defects shall be rejected.
a. Any wire that comes closer than two wire diameters or 5 mils, whichever is less, to unglassivated operating
metallization, another wire (common wires and pigtails excluded) package post, unpassivated die area, or
any portion of the package, including the plane of the lid to be attached. (Within a 5.0 mil spherical radial
distance from the perimeter of the bond on the die surface, the separation can be 1.0 mil.)
b. Nicks, tears, bonds, cuts, crimps, scoring, or neckdown in any wire that reduces the wire diameter by more
than 25 percent.
d. Bond lifting or tearing at interface of pad and wire (see figure 2072-5).
e. Any wire which runs from die bonding pad to package post and has no arc or stress relief.
h. Wire is kinked (unintended sharp bend) with an interior angle of less than 90 degrees or twisted to an extent
that stress marks appear.
i. Wire (ball bonded devices) not within 10 degrees of the perpendicular to the surface of the chip for a
distance of greater than 0.5 mil before bending toward the package post or other termination point.
l. A bow or loop between double bonds at post greater than four times wire diameter.
m. Excessive loops, bows, or sags in any wire such that it could short to another wire, to another pad, to another
package post, to the die or touch any portion of the package.
n. When clips are used, solder fillets shall encompass at least 50 percent of the clip-to-die and post-to-clip
periphery. There shall be no deformation or plating defects on the clip.
4.1.6 Package conditions (magnification as indicated). A device which exhibits any of the following defects shall
be rejected.
4.1.6.1 Conductive foreign material on die surface. All foreign material or particles may be blown off with a
nominal gas blow (approximately 20 psi (138 kPa)) or removed with a soft camel hair brush. The device shall then
be inspected for the following criteria (low magnification):
a. Loosely attached foreign particles (conductive particles which are attached by less than one-half of their
largest dimension) which are present on the surface of the die that are large enough to bridge the narrowest
unglassivated active metal spacing (silicon chips shall be included as conductive particles).
b. Embedded foreign particles on the die that bridge two or more metallization paths or semiconductor
junctions, or any combination of metallization or junction.
c. Liquid droplets, chemical stains, or photoresist on the die surface that bridge any combinations of
unglassivated metal or bare silicon areas.
d. Except for unused cells, ink on the surface of the die that covers more than 25 percent of a bonding pad area
or that bridges any combination of unglassivated metallization or bare silicon areas.
METHOD 2072.6
5
a. Die mounting material buildup that extends onto the top surface of the die or extends vertically above the top
surface of the die and interferes with bonding.
b. Die to header mounting material (wetting) which is not visible on the mounting surface of the package around
at least three complete sides or 75 percent of the die perimeter. Wetting criteria is not required if the devices
pass an approved electrical die attach evaluation test.
d. Any balling of the die mounting material which does not exhibit a fillet when viewed from above.
a. Die is not located or orientated in accordance with the applicable assembly drawing of the device.
b. Die is visibly tipped or tilted (more than 10 degrees) with respect to the die attach surface.
4.1.6.4 Internal package defects (low magnification inspection) (applicable to headers, bases, caps, and lids). As
an alternative to 100-percent visual inspection of lids and caps in accordance with the criteria of 4.1.6.1.a, the lids or
caps may be subjected to a suitable cleaning process and quality verification procedure approved by the qualifying
activity, provided the lids or caps are subsequently held in a controlled environment until capping or preparation for
seal.
a. Any header or post-plating which is blistered, flaked, cracked, or any combination thereof.
b. Any conductive particle which is attached by less than one-half of the longest dimension.
c. A bubble, or a series of interconnecting bubbles, in the glass surrounding the pins which are more than
one-half the distance between the pin and body or pin-to-pin.
e. Any glass, die, or other material greater than 1.0 mil in its major dimension which adheres to the flange or
side of the header and would impair sealing.
f. Any stain, varnish, or header discoloration which appears to extend under a die bond or wire bond.
(1) Any defect or abnormality causing the designed isolating paths between the metal island to be reduced to
less than 50 percent of the design separation.
4.1.6.5 Presence of extraneous matter. Extraneous matter (foreign particles) shall include, but not be limited to:
a. Any foreign particle, loose or attached, greater than .003 inch (0.08 mm) or of any lesser size which is
sufficient to bridge nonconnected conducting elements of the device.
b. Any wire tail extending beyond its normal end by more than two diameters at the semiconductor die pad or
by more than four wire diameters at the package post (see figure 2072-6).
c. Any burr on a post (header lead) greater than .003 inch (0.08 mm) in its major dimension or of such
configuration that it may break away.
METHOD 2072.6
6
d. Excessive semiconductor die bonding material buildup. A semiconductor die shall be mounted and bonded
so that it is not tilted more than 10 degrees from mounting surface. The bonding agent that accumulates
around the perimeter of the semiconductor die and touches the side of the semiconductor die shall not
accumulate to a thickness greater than that of the semiconductor die (see figures 2072-7 and 2072-8).
Where the bonding agent is built up but is not touching the semiconductor die, the build up shall not be
greater than twice the thickness of the semiconductor die. There shall be no excess semiconductor die
bonding material in contact with the active surface of the semiconductor die or any lead or post, or separated
from the main bonding material area (see figure 2072-9).
f. Extraneous ball bonds anywhere inside case, except for attached bond residue when rebonding is allowed.
4.1.7 Glassivation and silicon nitride defects (high magnification). No device shall be acceptable that exhibits any
of the following defects.
a. Glass crazing that prohibits the detection of visual criteria contained herein.
b. Any glassivation which has delaminated. (Lifting or peeling of the glassivation may be excluded from the
criteria above, when it does not extend more than 1.0 mil distance from the designed periphery of the
glassivation, provided that the only exposure of metal is adjacent to bond pads or of metallization leading
from those pads.)
c. Except by design, two or more adjacent active metallization paths which are not covered by glassivation.
e. Glassivation which covers more than 25 percent of the design bonding pad area.
4.2 Post organic protective coating visual inspection. If devices are to be coated with an organic protective
coating, the devices shall be visually examined in accordance with the criteria specified in 4.1 prior to application of
the coating. After the application and cure of the organic protective coating, the devices shall be visually examined
under a minimum of 10X magnification. Devices which exhibit any of the following defects shall be rejected.
a. Except by design, any unglassivated or unpassivated areas or insulating substrate which has incomplete
coverage.
f. Conductive particles which are embedded in the coating and are large enough to bridge the narrowest
unglassivated active metal spacing (silicon chips shall be included as conductive particles).
g. A web of varnish (organic protective coating) that connects the wire with the header.
5. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Where applicable, any conflicts with approved circuit design topology or construction.
c. Where applicable, gauges, drawings, and photographs that are to be used as standards for operator
comparison.
METHOD 2072.6
8
METHOD 2072.6
9
METHOD 2072.6
10
A. Tailless or crescent.
NOTES:
1. 1.2.D W 5.0 D (width).
2. 0.5 D L 3.0 D (length).
B. Wedge.
Ultrasonic Thermocompression
NOTES: NOTES:
1. 1.2 D W 3.0 D (width). 1. 1.2 D W 3.0 D (width).
2. 1.5 D L 5.0 D (length). 2. 1.5 D L 5.0 D (length).
METHOD 2072.6
12
METHOD 2072.6
13
METHOD 2072.6
14
DETAIL A
METHOD 2072.6
15
METHOD 2072.6
16
METHOD 2073.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to check the quality and workmanship of semiconductor die for
compliance with the requirements of the individual specification sheet. All tests shall be performed to detect and
eliminate those die with defects that could lead to device failures. This test will normally be used prior to installation
on a 100 percent inspection basis. The test may also be employed on a sampling basis prior to encapsulation to
determine the effectiveness of the manufacturer's quality control and handling procedures.
a. Active area: Any area where electrical contact may be made on the "N" or "P" regions of the die.
b. Active region: Region covered by passivation that supports electrical activity and junction geometries.
c. Foreign material (attached): Any conductive or nonconductive material that is not part of the die construction.
Conductive foreign material is defined as any substance that appears opaque under those conditions of
lighting and magnification used in routine visual inspections. Therefore, nonconductive foreign material is
defined as any substance that appears transparent
d. Junction: The boundary between "P" and "N" type semiconductor material. (In the case of a Schottky diode,
there is no actual junction other than the guard ring. Schottky diodes have a barrier that exists at the metal-
silicon contact, however, for the purposes of this test method the barrier will be treated as a junction.)
e. Passivation: Silicon oxide, silicon nitride, or other insulating material that is grown or deposited directly over
the "P-N" junction or the Schottky guard ring P-N junction.
3. Apparatus.
a. The apparatus for this test shall include optical equipment and any visual standards (e.g., gauges, drawings,
photographs) necessary to perform an effective examination and enable the examiner to make objective
decisions on the acceptability of the die being examined. Adequate fixturing shall be provided for handling die
without contamination during examination.
b. Unless otherwise specified by the individual specification sheet or procuring activity, magnification at 20X and
30X minimum shall be performed with a monocular, binocular, or stereo microscope. The inspection shall be
performed under suitable illumination. Binocular and stereo microscopes shall have each eyepiece
individually focused for the examiner.
4. Procedure. The die shall be examined in a suitable sequence of operations and at the specified magnifications
to determine compliance with the requirements of the individual specification sheet and the criteria of the specified
test conditions. The sequence of examinations required may be varied at the discretion of the manufacturer.
4.1 Die inspections. These inspections shall apply to alloy, diffused mesa, epitaxial mesa, planar, and epitaxial
planar construction techniques. Unless otherwise specified, inspections shall be made on a random selection of at
least one side of each die being inspected. If a lot fails, 100-percent inspection of the total lot shall be performed.
METHOD 2073.1
1 of 10
4.1.1 Type of die examined. Determine type of die being examined by referring to figure 2073-1 through figure
2073-8. An exact match is not necessary, select a representative figure. If a representative figure cannot be
discerned, perhaps elements of different figures will apply. Contact the die vendor source for assistance in matching
an appropriate figure. NOTE: Hexagonal shaped die will be inspected to the same criteria as square die.
4.2 Examination options. Examine die according to the appropriate figure, its illustrations, and associated textual
criteria.
a. Option A: Front side visual inspection with sample size specified by individual specification sheet or procuring
activity. If no sample size is specified, 100-percent visual is assumed.
b. Option B: Backside visual in addition to front side visual. Backside inspection is conducted with sample size
specified by individual specification sheet or procuring activity. If no sample size is specified, use sample size
22 for class H or sample size 45 for class K and reject on 1.
NOTE: If no option is specified by the individual specification sheet or procuring activity, option A will apply.
4.3 Foreign material. Examine die for attached conductive foreign material. No detailed illustration is provided for
this due to the random nature of such material. The examiner is expected to use their own judgment in this matter.
METHOD 2073.1
2
Additional front
metallization extending
50 percent or more to
the next geometric
boundary (G) or pulled
back to reveal contact
area or any non-
passivated active
region.
Backside
Back contamination
and foreign material (I),
either firmly or loosely
attached, exceeding 10
percent of total area.
Blisters (K) in
metalization exceeding
10 percent of total area.
FIGURE 2073-1. Button contact diodes (metal button overlays junction and active area).
METHOD 2073.1
3
Reject criteria
Smears (A), scratches (B)
or probe marks (C) may not
extrude metal such that it
covers any guard rings.
Additional front
metallization extending over
nearest ring boundary (G)
or pulled back to reveal
contact area or any non-
passivated region.
Backside
Backside contamination
and foreign material (I),
either firmly or loosely
attached, exceeding 10
percent of total area.
FIGURE 2073-2. High voltage planar diode I (guard ring(s) and outside metal oxide edge cover or field plate).
METHOD 2073.1
4
Reject criteria
Smears (A), scratches (B) or
probe marks (C) may not
extrude metal such that it
extends over the next geometric
boundary (covers the P-guard
ring area).
Backside
Backside contamination and
foreign material (I), either firmly
or loosely attached, exceeding
10 percent of total area.
FIGURE 2073-3. High voltage planar diodes II (integrated P-minus guard ring).
METHOD 2073.1
5
Reject criteria
Smears (A), scratches (B)
or probe marks (C) may not
extrude metal outside
metalized region over moat
edge.
Additional front
metallization extending over
into the moat (G) or pulled
back to reveal contact area
or any non-passivated
region
Backside
Backside contamination
and foreign material (I),
either firmly or loosely
attached, exceeding 10
percent of total area.
FIGURE 2073-4. Inside moat mesa diodes (passivated moat does not extent to edge of die).
METHOD 2073.1
6
Reject criteria
Smears (A), scratches (B)
or probe marks (C) may not
extrude metal outside
metalized region more than
50 percent of the way to the
next boundary.
Additional front
metallization extending 50
percent or more to the next
geometric boundary (G) or
pulled back to reveal
contact area or any non-
passivated active region.
Backside
Backside contamination
and foreign material (I),
either firmly or loosely
attached, exceeding 10
percent of total area.
FIGURE 2073-5. Low voltage contact overlay diodes (metal overlays junction and active area field plate).
METHOD 2073.1
7
Reject criteria
Smears (A), scratches (B) or
probe marks (C) may not
extrude metal outside junction
boundary region.
Backside
Backside contamination and
foreign material (I), either firmly
or loosely attached, exceeding
10 percent of total area.
METHOD 2073.1
8
Reject criteria
Smears (A), scratches
(B) or probe marks (C)
may not extrude metal
outside metalized
region over moat
edge.
Additional front
metallization extending
over into the moat (G)
or pulled back to reveal
contact area or any
non-passivated active
region.
Backside
Backside contamination
and foreign material (I),
either firmly or loosely
attached, exceeding 10
percent of total area.
Blisters (K) in
metalization exceeding
10 percent of total area.
FIGURE 2073-7. Outside moat mesa diodes (moat extends from mesa to edge of die).
METHOD 2073.1
9
Reject criteria
Smears (A), scratches (B)
or probe marks (C) may not
extrude metal outside
metalized region more than
50 percent to the next
geometric boundry.
Additional front
metallization extending 50
percent or more to the next
geometric boundary (G) or
pulled back to reveal
contact area or any non-
passivated barrier region.
Backside
Backside contamination
and foreign material (I),
either firmly or loosely
attached, exceeding 10
percent of total area.
FIGURE 2073-8. Schottky barrier diodes (metal overlays barrier edge and active area field plate).
METHOD 2073.1
10
METHOD 2074.5
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to check the materials, design, construction, and workmanship of
discrete semiconductor diodes and other two-terminal semiconductor devices described herein. All tests shall be
performed to detect and eliminate those devices with defects that could lead to device failures. Opaque glass type
constructions shall be examined before encapsulation. (After encapsulation, see method 2068 of this general
specification). Metal can devices shall be examined before capping. (After capping or sealing, see method 2071 of
this general specification). Clear glass construction shall be examined after encapsulation.
2. Apparatus.
a. The apparatus for these tests shall include optical equipment and any visual standards (e.g., gauges,
drawings, photographs) necessary to perform an effective examination and enable the operator to make
objective decisions on the acceptability of the device being examined. Any necessary fixturing for handling
devices during examination to promote efficient operation without damaging the units shall be provided.
b. A monocular, binocular, or stereo microscope capable of magnification from 20X minimum to 30X maximum,
shall be used unless otherwise specified. The inspection shall be performed under suitable illumination.
3. Procedure. The devices shall be examined at the specified magnifications to determine compliance with the
requirements of the applicable sections of this test method based on device construction. Examinations for
transparent body devices may be performed anytime prior to body coating or painting. Axial construction devices
shall be viewed at approximate right angles to their major axis while being rotated through 360 degrees. For the time
interval, if any, between visual inspection and package sealing, devices shall be stored, handled, and processed in a
manner to avoid contamination and to preserve the integrity of the devices as inspected.
a. Chip outs. Reject for chip outs that extend more than 50 percent of the way up the moat area (mesa
devices) or that extend to within 2.0 mils of the junction. NOTE: Actual junction location will vary depending
on specific device characteristics. (See figure 2074-1.)
METHOD 2074.5
1 of 35
b. Cracks. Reject for cracks that extend to within 2.0 mils of the junction or propagate in the direction of the
junction. NOTE: The junction may be in a different place than shown depending on specific device
characteristics. (See figure 2074-2.)
3.2 Applicable body styles. The devices shall be examined in accordance with the following appendixes as
applicable for the body style involved.
Appendix B: Axial lead, transparent body, straight through lead to die contact.
Appendix C: Axial lead and surface mount, double plug, transparent body (dumet plug, round end-cap, soft glass).
Appendix D: Axial lead and surface mount, double plug, transparent body (tungsten or molybdenum plug, square
end-cap, hard glass).
Appendix F: Axial lead, double plug, opaque body, power rectifier and regulator.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 2074.5
2
A.1 Axial lead, transparent body, pressure contact design. The following examinations shall be made after
encapsulation (C and S bend whisker). This appendix is a mandatory part of the standard. The information
contained herein is intended for compliance.
A.1.1 Glass cracks and chips (see figure 2074-A1). No cracks shall be allowed in the vicinity of the cavity. Any
crack originating at either end of the package or crack that extends into the body of the glass toward the cavity more
than 25 percent of the glass-to-glass or glass-to-metal seal length shall be cause for rejection. Any glass chip deep
enough to expose the plug or lead surface and extending longitudinally into the glass-to-metal seal toward the cavity
to reduce the effective seal length to less than one external lead diameter shall be cause for rejection.
A.1.2 Incomplete seal. All devices shall be inspected for glass-to-metal seal or glass-to-glass seal. Both seals
shall be a minimum of one external lead diameter over the entire sealed portion (sealed interface).
A.1.3 Bubbles in seal. All devices shall be inspected for bubbles in the glass-to-metal or glass-to-glass seal. A
series of bubbles that reduce the effective seal length to less than one external lead diameter shall be cause for
rejection. Bubbles in the glass, but not affecting the glass-to-glass or glass-to-metal seal area, are not cause for
rejection.
A.1.4 Glass package deformities (see figure 2074-A2). Any glass envelope deformity equal to or greater than 75
percent of the external lead diameter shall be cause for rejection.
A.1.5 Extraneous matter. A device shall be rejected if there are unattached solder balls, semiconductor material,
chips, flaked plating, or opaque material that is larger than the smallest distance between exposed active areas.
METHOD 2074.5
3
METHOD 2074.5
4
A.1.6 Solder protrusions (see figure 2074-A3). All devices shall be inspected for solder protrusions. Any device
with a protrusion that extends more than twice the smallest protrusion width shall be rejected.
A.1.7 Pressure contact defects. The following misalignments or deformations shall be cause for rejection:
METHOD 2074.5
5
b. Toe contact between base of S or C spring and top surface of die caused by insufficient loading (see figure
2074-A5).
METHOD 2074.5
6
d. Heel contact between base of S or C spring and top surface of die (see figure 2074-A7).
e. Point contact between base of S or C spring and top surface of die except by design (deformed or twisted
whisker) (see figure 2074-A8).
METHOD 2074.5
7
f. Design compressed height (see figures 2074-A9 and 2074-A10). Either half of an S or C bend that is
compressed so that any dimension is reduced to less than 50 percent of its design shall be rejected.
METHOD 2074.5
8
A.1.8 Whisker weld to post. Any device that exhibits weld splash or splatter (teardrop or balled) between whisker
and post shall be rejected when it exceeds 25 percent of nominal lead diameter. The profile of the whisker weld to
post shall not allow light penetration by more than 50 percent of lead diameter when using back lighting techniques.
A.1.9 Die-to-post or die-to-die contact area. Solder shall not be rough in appearance and shall be fused to a
minimum of one-half the available bonding perimeter. Any solder overflow that touches the opposite surface of the
die or dice shall be cause for rejection.
A.1.10 Die alignment (see figure 2074-A11). A device shall be rejected if the die surface is not within 15 degrees
of being normal to the centerline of the mounting post.
A.1.11 Lead alignment defects (applicable to that portion of each lead within the glass envelope). A device lead
which is either misaligned or bent so that it makes an angle with the principle device axis greater than 10 degrees
shall be rejected.
A.1.12 Multiple chip attachment defects. A multiple chip stack that tilts more than 10 degrees from the principle
axis of the device shall be cause for rejection.
METHOD 2074.5
9
B.1 Axial lead, transparent body, straight through lead to die contact (see figure 2074-B1). The following criteria
shall be specified for the straight through construction after encapsulation but before body coating or painting. This
appendix is a mandatory part of the standard. The information contained herein is intended for compliance.
B.1.1 Glass cracks and chips (see figure 2074-A1). No cracks shall be allowed in the vicinity of the cavity. Any
crack originating at either end of the package or crack that extends into the body of the glass toward the cavity more
than 25 percent of the glass-to-glass or glass-to-metal seal length shall be cause for rejection. Any glass chip deep
enough to expose the plug or lead surface and extending longitudinally into the glass-to-metal seal toward the cavity
to reduce the effective seal length to less than one external lead diameter shall be cause for rejection.
B.1.2 Incomplete seal. All devices shall be inspected for glass-to-metal seal or glass-to-glass seal. Both seals
shall be a minimum of one external lead diameter over the entire sealed portion (sealed interface).
B.1.3 Bubbles in seal. All devices shall be inspected for bubbles in the glass-to-metal or glass-to-glass seal. A
series of bubbles that reduce the effective seal length to less than one external lead diameter shall be cause for
rejection. Bubbles in the glass, but not affecting the glass-to-glass or glass-to-metal seal area, are not cause for
rejection.
B.1.4 Glass package deformities (see figure 2074-A2). Any glass envelope deformity equal to or greater than 75
percent of the external lead diameter shall be cause for rejection.
B.1.5 Extraneous matter. A device shall be rejected if there are unattached solder balls, semiconductor material,
chips, flaked plating, or opaque material that is larger than the smallest distance between exposed active areas.
METHOD 2074.5
10
a. Solder voids (see figure 2074-B2). A device shall be rejected if solder flow is less than 50 percent of the
perimeter of the minimum available contact area of the post.
b. Solder overflow (see figure 2074-B3). A device shall be rejected if any solder flow touches the opposite
surface of the die.
METHOD 2074.5
11
B.1.7 Lead to die solder connection (see figure 2074-B4). A device shall be rejected if more than 50 percent of
the perimeter of the available contact area of the lead is void of solder.
a. Solder overflow (see figure 2074-B5). A device shall be rejected if solder flow extends beyond 50 percent of
the distance from the metal to the outer edge of the oxide.
METHOD 2074.5
12
b. Solder protrusion, slivers, and spikes (see figure 2074-B6). A device shall be rejected if solder slivers and
spikes are not securely attached to the main body. A securely attached sliver of spike is one having a cross
sectional area greater at the area of attachment than anywhere else on the solder protrusion and having no
necked down areas. Solder protrusions, slivers, and spikes whose length exceeds twice the smallest width
of attachment shall be rejected.
c. Solder balls. A device shall be rejected if there are any insecurely attached solder balls. An insecurely
attached solder ball is one whose major cross sectional area is more than twice the cross sectional area of
the attachment.
B.1.8 Die-to-die solder connection (see figure 2074-B7). A device shall be rejected if more than 50 percent of the
perimeter of the available contact area of the die is void of solder.
METHOD 2074.5
13
AXIAL LEAD AND SURFACE MOUNT, DOUBLE PLUG, TRANSPARENT BODY (DUMET PLUG, ROUND END-
CAP, SOFT GLASS)
C.1 Axial lead and surface mount, double plug, transparent body (dumet plug, round end-cap, soft glass). This
appendix is a mandatory part of the standard. The information contained herein is intended for compliance.
C.1.1 Glass cracking. Cracks (see figure 2074-C1). Spiral or longitudinal cracks of any length originating at either
end that propagate in the direction of the die are cause for rejection. Reject for cracks that are not confined to the
glass surface or the outer 25 percent of the seal length. Cracks confined to the outer 25 percent of the designed
seal length that propagate back toward the starting edge (away from the die area) are acceptable. Small surface
impact marks, c cracks, and microcracks are acceptable if they are confined to the glass surface with no other
cracks radiating from them.
METHOD 2074.5
14
C.1.2 High seal (see figure 2074-C2). Any device which displays a glass case off center condition reducing the
seal band of either plug by more than 25 percent of its designed length shall be cause for rejection.
C.1.3 Insufficient seal (see figure 2074-C3). Any anomaly such as bubbles, plug blisters, separations, leaching,
or undersealing that affects the combined seal length of either plug by reducing the a sealing band to less than 50
percent of the designed seal length on any package type shall be cause for rejection.
METHOD 2074.5
15
C.1.4 Plug alignment and displacement (see figures 2074-C4 and 2074-C5 ). All devices shall be inspected for
proper plug alignment. A plug displacement distance more than 25 percent of the diameter of the plug shall be
cause for rejection. The plug shall not tilt to the degree that it touches the chip or is misaligned from the other plug
axis more than 5 degrees.
C.1.5 Extraneous matter. A device shall be rejected if there are unattached solder balls, semiconductor material,
chips, flaked plating, or opaque material that is larger than the smallest distance between exposed active areas.
METHOD 2074.5
16
C.1.6 Lead connections (see figure 2074-C6). Lead to plug connections shall be inspected for incomplete welds.
Any partial welds less than 75 percent of total weld area shall be cause for rejection.
C.1.7.1 Die tilt greater than 5 degrees, or slug, or preform makes contact to chip on bump side.
C.1.7.2 Any die that exhibits chip outs exceeding .25 inch (6.35 mm) of the die width, or extending to within 2.0
mils of the junction, shall be rejected.
C.1.8.1 Glass-to-metal seal shall be .015 inch (0.381 mm) min for DO-213AA and .020 inch (0.508 mm) min for
DO-213AB, around the diameter of each slug.
C.1.8.2 Slug exposure shall not exceed 30 percent of the slug length .014 inch (0.3556 mm) min for DO-213AA
and .022 inch ( 0.5588 mm) min for DO-213AB.
C.1.8.3 There shall be no cracks in the device within .010 inch (0.254 mm) of the die.
C.1.8.4 There shall be no cracks in the glass that are pointed towards the die.
METHOD 2074.5
17
AXIAL LEAD AND SURFACE MOUNT, DOUBLE PLUG, TRANSPARENT BODY (TUNGSTEN OR MOLYBDENUM
PLUG, SQUARE END-CAP, HARD GLASS).
D.1 Axial lead and surface mount, double plug, transparent body (tungsten or molybdenum plug, square end-cap,
hard glass). This appendix is a mandatory part of the standard. The information contained herein is intended for
compliance.
D.1.1 Glass.
a. No cracks allowed.
b. Chip outs (see figure 2074-D1). Edge chip outs that expose a plug and are not confined to the outer 25
percent of the designed seal length are cause for rejection. Edge chip outs (regardless of size) that expose
a plug and create a sharp angle or V shape that points toward the die area are rejects
c. Holes. Any hole over the die or slug area greater that 50 percent of the glass thickness in depth is cause for
rejection, except that holes of any depth are acceptable in the outer 25 percent of the designed seal length.
d. Deformities (see figure 2074-D2.). Any glass surface deformity that causes the glass surface to be displaced
by more than 10 percent of the designed glass diameter, or that results in the device not meeting a
dimensional requirement, is cause for rejection.
METHOD 2074.5
18
e. Surface damage and discoloration. Any device with surface abrasions, chips, scratches, rough or discolored
(darkened) glass over the die area that result in the die not being clearly visible, is a reject. Using liquid
immersion to improve die visibility is acceptable.
D.1.2 Seal.
a. Glass positioning and missing glass (see figure 2074-D3.). Off center glass and portions of missing glass
that reduce the seal length on either plug by more than 25 percent of the designed seal length is cause for
rejection.
b. Insufficient seal (see figure 2074-D4.). Seal surface anomalies such as undercut, separations, plug blisters,
scratches or cracks, bubbles, silicon chips, fibers, or missing plating which, when combined, reduce the
sealing length along any linear path to less than 50 percent of the designed seal length are cause for
rejection. NOTE: Lines or strings of small bubbles are considered to be seal anomalies for the entire
length of the line.
METHOD 2074.5
19
c. Extraneous or loosely attached materials. Any unattached or loosely attached solder, braze, silicon chips,
flaked plating, fibers, or other opaque extraneous material in the die cavity (for cavity devices) that is greater
than 1.0 mil in any dimension are cause for rejection. No solder, braze, or other bonding materials shall
extend from a plug into the area between plugs.
D.1.3 Alignment. NOTE: Any die to plug non-contact that occurs as a result of die or plug misalignment is most
accurately evaluated by thermal impedance testing. In cases where pass/fail status of a device is unclear based on
the alignment requirements presented herein, thermal impedance testing may be used to determine the acceptability
of the device.
a. Die alignment. Any die that tilts more than 5 degrees with respect to the surface of either plug or that tilts
sufficiently to make any unintended contact with the plug is cause for rejection. (See figure 2074-D5.) Any
die that is out of axial alignment such that it extends beyond the slug more than 20 percent of its length or
width is cause for rejection. (See Figure 2074-D6.)
METHOD 2074.5
20
b. Plug alignment. Plugs that are not axially aligned other than in the die area to within 12.5 percent of the
diameter of the plug are cause for rejection. (See figure 2074-D7.) Any plug that tilts more than 5 degrees
with respect to the other or that tilts sufficiently to make any unintended contact with the die is cause for
rejection (see figure 2074-D8).
METHOD 2074.5
21
a. Lead alignment (leaded devices). Leads that are not axially aligned to within one lead diameter, or leads that
are not contained completely within the diameter of the plug, are cause for rejection (see figure 2074-D9).
METHOD 2074.5
22
b. Braze (leaded devices). Leads that are not brazed to the plug around at least 90 percent of the lead
perimeter are cause for rejection. Any cracks or fissures in the braze are cause for rejection. Pin holes in
the braze are acceptable.
c. End-caps (surface mount). Reject for end-caps that do not allow at least 3.0 mils clearance from the glass
body to the mounting surface on all four sides (see figure 2074-D10). Reject for end-caps that are not
perpendicular to the plugs to within 5 degrees (see figure 2074-D11). Reject for end-caps that are bent
sufficiently to cause the device to exceed any specified diode or end-cap dimension (see figure 2074-D12).
Reject for end-cap rotation where mounting surfaces are not co-planer to each other to within 5 degrees (see
figure 2074-D13). Reject for tabs that have indentations, holes, or other damage affecting more than 25
percent of any mounting surface (see figure 2074-D14). Reject for end-caps that exhibit flaking, blistering, or
peeling.
METHOD 2074.5
23
METHOD 2074.5
24
METHOD 2074.5
25
E.1 Axial lead, transparent body, point contact. The following additional criteria shall be specified for the point
contact construction after encapsulation but before body coating or painting. This appendix is a mandatory part of
the standard. The information contained herein is intended for compliance.
E.1.1 Glass cracks and chips (see figure 2074-A1) No cracks shall be allowed in the vicinity of the cavity. Any
crack originating at either end of the package or crack that extends into the body of the glass toward the cavity more
than 25 percent of the glass-to-glass or glass-to-metal seal length shall be cause for rejection. Any glass chip deep
enough to expose the plug or lead surface and extending longitudinally into the glass-to-metal seal toward the cavity
to reduce the effective seal length to less than one external lead diameter shall be cause for rejection.
E.1.2 Incomplete seal. All devices shall be inspected for glass-to-metal seal or glass-to-glass seal. Both seals
shall be a minimum of one external lead diameter over the entire sealed portion (sealed interface).
E.1.3 Bubbles in seal. All devices shall be inspected for bubbles in the glass-to-metal or glass-to-glass seal. A
series of bubbles that reduce the effective seal length to less than one external lead diameter shall be cause for
rejection. Bubbles in the glass, but not effecting the glass-to-glass or glass-to-metal seal area, are not cause for
rejection.
E.1.4 Glass package deformities (see figure 2074-A2). Any glass envelope deformity equal to or greater than 75
percent of the external lead diameter shall be cause for rejection.
E.1.5 Extraneous matter. A device shall be rejected if there are unattached solder balls, semiconductor material,
chips, flaked plating, or opaque material that is larger than the smallest distance between exposed active areas.
E.1.6 Pressure contact defects. The following misalignments or deformities shall be cause for rejection.
METHOD 2074.5
26
METHOD 2074.5
27
E.1.7 Whisker weld to post. Any device that exhibits weld splash or splatter (tear dropped or balled) between
whisker and post shall be rejected when it exceeds 25 percent of nominal lead diameter. The profile of whisker weld
to the post shall not allow light penetration by more than 50 percent of lead diameter when using back lighting
techniques.
E.1.8 Solder voids. A device shall be rejected if solder flow is less than 50 percent of the perimeter of the
minimum available contact area of the die.
E.1.9 Die to post contact area. Solder shall be smoothly formed from one element to another and shall be fused
to a minimum of one-half the available bonding area. Any solder overflow that touches the opposite surface of the
die shall be cause for rejection.
E.1.10 Die alignment. A device shall be rejected if the die surface is not within 15 degrees of being normal to the
centerline of the mounting post.
E.1.11 Lead alignment defects (applicable to that portion of each lead within the glass envelope). A device whose
lead is either misaligned or bent so that it makes an angle with the principle device axis greater than 10 degrees
shall be rejected.
E.12 Die touches glass package (see figure 2074-E4). A device shall be rejected if the die touches the glass
envelope.
METHOD 2074.5
28
AXIAL LEAD, DOUBLE PLUG, OPAQUE BODY, POWER RECTIFIER AND REGULATOR
F.1 Axial lead, double plug, opaque body. This appendix is a mandatory part of the standard. The information
contained herein is intended for compliance.
F.1.1 Die mounting and alignment. After bonding die to the heat sink, plugs, or leads, the following shall be
inspected for defects.
a. Die geometry. A die shall be rejected if it is chipped or broken to the extent that 75 percent or less of the
original surface remains.
b. Axial alignment of plugs and die. Plugs shall be aligned axially within 12.5 percent of the diameter of either
plug.
c. Tilted die. A device shall be rejected if the die is tilted so that the die surface is greater than 5 degrees from
being perpendicular to the mounting post axis.
F.1.2 Die cracks. Any die exhibiting cracks that reduce the total die area (or cracks extending into or across the
junction area) to less than 75 percent of its original area shall be cause for rejection.
F.1.3 Inadequate brazing. A device shall be rejected if less than 90 percent of the visible metallized surface
(perimeter) is brazed to the heat sink or lead.
F.1.4 Flaking or loose material. No unattached solder, braze, or other bonding material shall extend from the
plugs. Any blistering or peeling of plug surface shall be cause for rejection.
F.1.5 Extraneous matter. A device shall be rejected if there is any extraneous, particulate matter between the
terminal plugs or on the plug surface. No foreign stains shall be permitted on plug surfaces.
METHOD 2074.5
29
G.1. Axial lead, metal body, solder contact design. This appendix is a mandatory part of the standard. The
information contained herein is intended for compliance.
a. Solder defects (see figures 2074-G1 and 2074-G2). Any device with a solder protrusion that extends more
than twice the smallest protrusion width shall be rejected. Solder shall be smoothly formed from one
element to another and shall be fused to a minimum of 50 percent of the perimeter between adjacent
elements.
METHOD 2074.5
30
b. Alignment (see figure 2074-G3). Any device whose element has its geometric center displaced more than
33 percent of its width from the die, or die stack centerline, shall be rejected.
c. Tilt (see figure 2074-G4). Any element of a device that is tilted more than 10 degrees from the mounting
plane shall be cause for rejection.
METHOD 2074.5
31
d. Die chip outs (see figure 2074-G5). Any device die that exhibits chip outs extending more than 25 percent of
the die width or to within 2.0 mils of the junction area shall be cause for rejection.
e. Die cracks (see figure 2074-G6). Any die exhibiting cracks that reduce the total die area (or cracks
extending into or across the junction area) to less than 75 percent of its original area shall be cause for
rejection.
f. Extraneous matter. A device shall be rejected if there are unattached solder balls, semiconductor material,
chips, flaked plating, or opaque material that is larger than the smallest distance between exposed active
areas.
METHOD 2074.5
32
H.1 Metal body, stud mounted, solder contact design. The following inspections shall be made prior to capping.
This appendix is a mandatory part of the standard. The information contained herein is intended for compliance.
H.1.1 Die and lead assembly (see figures 2074-H1 and 2074-H2 ). The die and lead assembly shall be located
on the base pedestal so that there is complete contact over the design contact area. The lead shall be free of nicks
and scrapes that reduce the lead diameter by more than 5 percent. The die and lead assembly shall not be tilted
more than 5 degress with respect to the base.
METHOD 2074.5
33
a. Solder slivers and spikes. A device shall be rejected if solder slivers and spikes are not securely attached to
the parent body of the solder. A securely attached sliver or spike is one having a cross sectional area
greater at the area of attachment than anywhere else on the solder protrusion and having no necked-down
areas.
b. Foreign matter. A device shall be rejected if there are unattached solder balls, semiconductor materials,
chips, flaked plating, or opaque material that is larger than the smallest distance between exposed active
areas.
c. Multiple die attachments. A device shall be rejected if the attached portion of an adjacent die exceeds 25
percent of the die area.
a. Tilted elements. A device shall be rejected if any element of the assembly is tilted in excess of 10 degrees
from the normal mounting plane.
b. Misaligned elements. A device shall be rejected if any element of the assembly is misaligned or displaced in
excess of 33 percent of its width from the die or die stack centerline, bridges two active regions, or extends
beyond the isolation region of the oxide.
METHOD 2074.5
34
I.1 Metal body, diamond base regulators, solder contact design (see figure 2074-I1). This appendix is a
mandatory part of the standard. The information contained herein is intended for compliance.
a. Solder voids. A device shall be rejected if solder flow is less than 50 percent of the perimeter of the
minimum available contact area.
b. Solder overflow. A device shall be rejected if any solder flow bridges from the top to bottom surface of the
die or reduces the normal separation of two active regions by 50 percent or more.
a. Solder voids. A device shall be rejected if the wetting action of the solder to each member of the connection
is not continuous.
b. Solder overflow. A device shall be rejected if any solder flow extends on to any portion of the weld flange of
the heat sink.
METHOD 2074.5
35
METHOD 2075.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method is to verify that design and construction are the same as those
documented in the qualified design report and for which qualification approval has been granted. This test is
destructive and would normally be employed on a sampling basis during qualification, or quality conformance
inspection, of a specific device type.
2. Apparatus. Equipment used in this examination shall be capable of demonstrating conformance to the
requirements of the applicable acquisition document and shall include optical equipment with sufficient magnification
to verify all structural features of the devices.
3. Procedure. Devices shall be selected at random from the inspection lot and examined using sufficient
magnification to verify that design and construction are in accordance with the requirements of the applicable design
documentation or other specific requirements (see 4.). Specimens of constructions which do not contain an internal
cavity (e.g., sealed or embedded devices) or those which would experience destruction of internal features of
interest as a result of opening, may be obtained from manufacturing prior to sealing. Specimens of constructions
with an internal cavity shall be selected from devices which have completed all manufacturing operations and they
shall be delidded or opened taking care to minimize damage to the areas to be inspected. When specified by the
applicable specification sheet, specimens of constructions with an internal cavity may be obtained from
manufacturing prior to sealing.
3.1 Photographs of die topography and intraconnection pattern. When specified, a color photograph or
transparency shall be made showing the topography of elements formed on the die or substrate and the
metallization pattern. This photograph shall be at a minimum magnification of 80X except that if this results in a
photograph larger than 3.5 x 4.5 inches (88.90 x 114.30 mm), the magnification may be reduced to accommodate
the 3.5 x 4.5 inches (88.90 x 114.30 mm) view. In addition, a color photograph for all qualifications reports and
design changes is required. The photograph shall be submitted with the 36D form.
3.2 Failure criteria. Devices which fail to meet the detailed requirements for design and construction shall
constitute a failure.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Allowance for obtaining internal cavity devices prior to encapsulation (see 3.).
c. Requirement for photographic record, if applicable (see 3.1), and disposition of photographs.
d. Sample size.
METHOD 2075.1
1 of 1
METHOD 2076.3
RADIOGRAPHY
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to nondestructively detect defects within the sealed case, especially those
resulting from sealing of the lid to the case, and internal defects such as foreign objects, improper interconnecting
wires, and voids in the die attach material. This test establishes methods, criteria, and standards for radiographic
examination of discrete devices.
NOTE: For certain case types, the electron shielding effects of device construction materials (packages or internal)
may effectively prevent radiographic identification of certain types of defects from some or all possible viewing
angles. This factor should be considered in relation to the design of each when application of this test method is
specified.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus and materials for this test shall include:
a. Radiographic equipment with a sufficient voltage range to penetrate the device. The focal distance shall
be adequate to maintain a sharply defined image of a object with a major dimension of .001 inch (0.025
mm).
b. Radiographic film (Fuji IX50 or equivalent) or medium: Film should be selected to provide the resolution
required to view all internal components, including bond wires.
c. Radiographic viewer capable of .001 inch (0.025 mm) resolution in any major dimension.
d. Holding fixtures capable of holding devices in the required positions without interfering with the accuracy or
ease of image interpretation.
e. Radiographic quality standards capable of verifying the ability to detect all specified defects for particular
package types being x-rayed.
f. A .062 inch (1.57 mm) minimum lead topped table shall be used to prevent back scatter of radiation.
3. Procedure. The x-ray exposure factors, voltage, milliampere setting and time settings shall be selected or
adjusted as necessary to obtain satisfactory exposures and achieve maximum image details within the sensitivity
requirements for the device or defect features the radiographic test is directed toward. Unless otherwise specified,
the x-ray voltage shall be the lowest consistent with these requirements and shall not exceed 150 kV. Although
higher voltages may be necessary to penetrate certain packages, these levels may be damaging to some device
technologies and should only be used when approved by the manufacturer.
3.1 Mounting and views. The devices shall be mounted in the holding fixture so that the devices are not damaged
or contaminated and are in the proper plane as specified. The devices may be mounted in any type of fixture and
masking with lead diaphragms, or barium clay may be employed to isolate multiple specimens, provided the fixtures
or masking materials do not block the path of the x-rays to the film or any portion of the device. The manufacturer
shall provide an image of the device, either drawing or photograph, to show the correct construction of the device
and the component placement and orientation.
METHOD 2076.3
1 of 12
3.1.1 Views.
a. Unless otherwise specified, flat packages and single ended cylindrical devices shall have one view taken
with the x-rays penetrating in the Y direction as defined in figures 1 and 2 of the general requirements
herein. When more than one view is required, the second and third views, as applicable, shall be taken
with the x-rays penetrating in the X and Z directions respectively.
b. Unless otherwise specified, stud-mounted and cylindrical axial lead devices shall have one view taken with
the x-rays penetrating in the X direction as defined in figures 1 and 2 of the general requirements herein.
When more than one view is required, the second and third views, as applicable, shall be taken with the
x-rays penetrating in the Z direction and at 45E between the X and Z directions.
c. All JANS devices shall have two views minimum. The views should be specified by the manufacturer to
show the all internal components, including bond wires. Extra views shall be specified when necessary to
show all bond wires along their length (X1, X2, and Z axis.) and the Y axis. Stud-mounted and axial lead
device views shall be taken with x-rays penetrating in the X and Z directions.
3.2 Radiographic quality standard. The radiographic quality standard shall consist of a suitable standard
penetrameter such as radiographic quality standard ASTM type B - image quality indicator for semiconductor
radiography or equivalent device. Each radiograph shall have two image quality standards exposed with each view
located (and properly identified) in opposite corners of the film. The radiographic density of penetrameters chosen
shall bracket the density of the devices beings inspected. While this is the minimum resolution required, the
presence and clarity of these standards does not relieve the requirement to prepare the x-rays to produce images
that allow for detailed inspection of the internal components. For real time radiography images, the image resolution
shall be verified to insure that the image quality meets the quality standard of ASTM type B image quality indicator
for semiconductor radiography or equivalent device.
3.3 Film and marking. When used, the radiograph film shall be in a film holder backed with a minimum of .062
inch (1.57 mm) lead or the holder shall be placed on the lead topped table (see 2.f herein). The film shall be
identified using techniques that legibly print the following information, photographically on the radiograph:
e. Device serial or cross reference numbers, when applicable (see 3.3.2 herein).
3.3.1 Nonfilm techniques The use of nonfilm techniques is permitted under the following conditions:
a. Permanent records are required. Records not stored on radiographic film shall be archived using a
reproducible electronic medium. The preferred medium is a Portable Document File (PDF) with a resolution
equal to or better than attainable with radiographic films. The use of other formats such as CD-ROM's and
DVD recordings of radiography procedure are allowed with the permission of the qualifying activity,
provided the proper clarity, definition, and magnification can be demonstrated
b. The equipment is capable of producing results of equal quality when compared with film techniques.
Digital images shall be screened on display monitors capable of producing equal or better magnification
than that used to screen films.
c. All requirements of this method are complied with except those pertaining to the actual film.
METHOD 2076.3
2
3.3.2.1. Apparatus. The apparatus and materials for this test shall include:
a. Radiographic equipment with a sufficient voltage range to penetrate the device. The focal distance shall be
adequate to maintain a sharply defined image of a object with a major dimension of .001 inch (0.025 mm).
b. Radiographic viewer capable of .001 inch (0.025 mm) resolution in any major dimension.
c. Holding fixtures capable of holding devices in the required positions without interfering with the accuracy or
ease of image interpretation.
d. Radiographic quality standards capable of verifying the ability to detect all specified defects for particular
package types being x-rayed.
3.3.2.2. Procedure. The x-ray exposure factors, voltage, milliampere setting, and time settings shall be selected or
adjusted as necessary to obtain satisfactory exposures and achieve maximum image details within the sensitivity
requirements for the device, or defect features, the radiographic test is directed toward. Unless otherwise specified,
the x-ray voltage shall be the lowest consistent with these requirements and shall not exceed 150 kV. Although
higher voltages may be necessary to penetrate certain packages, these levels may be damaging to some device
technologies. Higher voltages should be used only when approved by the manufacturer because they are necessary
in some cases. Real time radiographic systems shall be characterized for their dose rate. The dose rate should be
identified and a safe time limit established to ensure devices under test are not subjected to excessive levels of
radiation.
3.3.2.3 Mounting and views. The devices shall be mounted in the holding fixture so that the devices are not
damaged or contaminated and are in the proper plane as specified. The devices may be mounted in any type of
fixture and masking with lead diaphragms, or barium clay may be employed to isolate multiple specimens, provided
the fixtures or masking materials do not block the path of the x-rays to the film or any portion of the device. The
manufacturer shall provide an image of the device, either drawing or photograph, to show the correct construction of
the device and the component placement and orientation.
3.3.2.3.1 Views.
a. Unless otherwise specified, flat packages and single ended cylindrical devices shall have three views taken
with the x-rays penetrating in the Y direction as defined in figures 1 and 2 of the general requirements
herein. When more than one view is required, the second and third views, as applicable, shall be taken
with the x-rays penetrating in the X and Z directions respectively. We are not limited by views with real time
therefore views X, Y, and Z should be taken for each device. Manufacturers recommended directions
should be included as well.
b. Unless otherwise specified, stud-mounted and cylindrical axial lead devices shall have one view taken with
the x-rays penetrating in the X direction as defined in figures 1 and 2 of the general requirements herein.
When more than one view is required, the second and third views, as applicable, shall be taken with the
x-rays penetrating in the Z direction and at 45E between the X and Z directions.
c. All JANS devices shall have two views minimum. The views should be specified by the manufacturer to
show all internal components, including bond wires. Extra views shall be specified when necessary to show
all bond wires along their length (X1, X2, and Z axis.) and the Y axis. Stud-mounted and axial lead device
views shall be taken with x-rays penetrating in the X and Z directions.
3.3.3 Serialized devices. When device serialization is required, each device shall be readily identified by a serial
number. The devices shall be radiographed in consecutive, increasing serial order. When a device is missing, the
blank space shall contain either the serial number or other x-ray opaque objects to readily identify and correlate the
x-ray data. When more than one consecutive device is missing within serialized devices, the serial number of the
last device before the skip and the first device after the skip may, at the manufacturers option, be used in place of
the multiple opaque objects.
METHOD 2076.3
3
3.3.4 Special device marking. When specified (see 4.c herein), the devices that have been x-rayed and found
acceptable shall be identified with a blue dot on the external case. The blue dot shall be approximately .062 inch
(1.57 mm) in diameter. The color selected from FED-STD-595 shall be any shade between 15102-15123 or
25102-25109. The dot shall be placed so that it is readily visible but shall not obliterate other device markings.
(Other colors, for example green, can also be used) Use blue dot for film radiography and green dot for real time
radiography.
3.4 Tests. The x-ray exposure factor shall be selected to achieve resolution of .001 inch (0.025 mm) major
dimension, less than 10 percent distortion and an "H" and "D" film density between 1 and 2.5 in the area of interest
of the device image. Radiographs shall be made for each view required (see 4 herein.). This requirement does not
apply to real time radiography.
3.5 Processing. The radiographic film manufacturer's recommended procedure shall be used to develop the
exposed film, and the film shall be processed so that it is free of processing defects such as fingerprints, scratches,
fogging, chemical spots, and blemishes. This requirement does not apply to real time radiography.
3.6 Operating personnel. Personnel who will perform radiographic inspection shall have training in radiographic
procedures and techniques so that defects revealed by this method can be validly interpreted and compared with
applicable standards. Operators shall be trained and certified in the operation of the specific real time radiographic
system they operate. The following minimum vision requirements shall apply for visual acuity of personnel
inspecting film as well as personnel authorized to conduct radiographic tests:
a. Distant vision shall equal at least 20/30 in both eyes, corrected or uncorrected.
b. Near vision shall be such that the operator can read Jaegger type No. 2 at a distance of 16 inches (406.4
mm), corrected or uncorrected.
c. Vision tests shall be performed by an oculist, optometrist, or other professionally recognized personnel at
least once a year.
3.7 Interpretation of radiographs. Utilizing the equipment specified herein, radiographs shall be inspected to
determine if each device conforms to this standard or if it is defective and shall be rejected. Interpretation of the
radiograph shall be made under low light level conditions without glare on the radiographic viewing surface. The
radiographs shall be examined on a suitable illuminator with variable intensity or on a viewer suitable for
radiographic inspection on projection type viewing equipment. The radiograph shall be viewed at a magnification
between 6X and 20X. Viewing masks may be used when necessary. Any radiograph not clearly illustrating the
features in the radiographic quality standards is not acceptable and another radiograph of the devices shall be taken.
In the event that parts of the device cannot be clearly seen and evaluated in accordance with 3.9 herein, the
radiographer shall so note on the radiography report that the criteria has not been evaluated and cannot be
confirmed.
3.7.1 Interpretation of real time images. Utilizing the equipment specified herein, real time images shall be
inspected to determine if each device conforms to this standard or if it is defective and shall be rejected. The
radiograph shall be viewed at a magnification between 6X and 20X. Viewing masks may be used when necessary.
Any radiograph not clearly illustrating the features in the radiographic quality standards is not acceptable and
another radiograph of the devices shall be taken. In the event that parts of the device cannot be clearly seen and
evaluated in accordance with 3.8 herein, the radiographer shall so note on the radiography report that the criteria
has not been evaluated and cannot be confirmed.
3.8.1 Reports of inspection. For JANS devices, or when specified for other device classes, the manufacturer shall
furnish inspection reports with each shipment of devices. The report shall describe the results of the radiographic
inspection, and list the order number or equivalent identification, the PIN, the date code, the quantity inspected, the
quantity rejected, and the date of test. For each rejected device, the PIN, the serial number, when applicable, and
the cause for rejection shall be listed. Any criteria that cannot be evaluated due to resolution of the film shall be
noted on the report.
METHOD 2076.3
4
3.8.2 Radiograph submission. When specified, one set of the applicable radiographs shall accompany each
shipment of devices. Real time radiography image results submitted on suitable media will be provided.
3.8.3 Radiograph and report retention. When specified, the manufacturer shall retain a set of the radiographs or
a set of the real time radiography images and a copy of the inspection report. These shall be retained for the period
specified.
3.9.1 Device construction. Acceptable devices shall be of the specified design and construction with regard to the
characteristics discernible through radiographic examination. Devices that deviate significantly from the specified
construction shall be rejected.
3.9.2 Individual device defects. The individual device examination shall include, but not be limited to, inspection
for foreign particles, solder or weld "splash" build up of bonding material, proper shape and placement of lead wires
or whiskers, and bond of lead or whisker to semiconductor element. Devices for which the radiograph reveals any of
the following defects shall not be accepted.
3.9.2.1 Presence of extraneous material. Extraneous matter or foreign particles shall include:
a. Any foreign material greater than .003 inch (0.076 mm) or of any lesser size which is sufficient to bridge non-
connected conducting elements of the device.
b. Any wire tail extending beyond its bond end by more than two diameters at the semiconductor bond pad or
by more than four wire diameters at the package post.
c. Any burr on a post greater than .003 inch (0.076 mm) in its major dimension.
(1) Bonding material that is higher than one times the height of the semiconductor die.
(2) There shall be no visible loose extraneous material greater than .001 inch (0.025 mm) allowed.
Excessive bonding material which is not loose and passes the requirements of 3.9.2.1.e (1) shall
be allowed unless the height of the accumulation is greater than the width of its base or the
material necks down at any point from the top of the accumulation to the base.
3.9.2.2 Unacceptable construction. In the examination of devices, the following aspects shall be considered
unacceptable construction and devices that exhibit any of the following defects shall be rejected:
a. Total contact area voids less than one-half of the total contact area is required for mechanical strength.
For thermal integrity, total contact area voids in excess of 15 percent of the total contact area, for all power
and case mounted devices and 30 percent for all other devices is rejectable unless otherwise specified on
the applicable specification sheet. Voids less than twice the thickness of the die are not applicable. If one
or more devices fail this die attach criteria the entire lot shall be re-tested to the applicable thermal
impedance requirements. In addition, if the die attach image shows any unusual anomalies or any
significant voiding directly under the active area or multiple relatively large voids, the entire lot shall be re
test to the applicable thermal impedance requirements.
b. A single void which traverses either the length or width of the semiconductor die and exceeds 10 percent of
the total intended contact area.
(1) Voids: When radiographing devices, certain types of mounting do not give true representations of
voids. When such devices are inspected, the mounting shall be noted on the inspection report (see
figure 2076-1).
METHOD 2076.3
5
(2) Wires present, other than those connecting specific areas of the semiconductor die to the external
leads.
(3) Angle between semiconductor die surface and edge less than 45 degrees.
(4) Defective seal: Any device wherein the integral lid seal is not continuous or is reduced from its
designed sealing width by more than 75 percent.
NOTE: Expulsion resulting from the final sealing operation is not considered extraneous material as
long as it can be established that it is continuous, uniform, and attached to the parent material and
does not exhibit a ball, splash, or tear-drop configuration.
(5) Inadequate clearance: Acceptable devices shall have adequate internal clearance to assure that the
elements cannot contact one another or the case. No crossover of wires connected to different
electrical elements shall be allowed. Depending upon the case type, devices shall be rejected for the
following conditions:
1. Any lead wire that appears to touch or cross another lead wire or bond (Y plane only).
2. Any lead wire that deviates from a straight line from bond to external lead and appears to be
within .002 inch (0.0504 mm) of another bond (Y plane only).
3. Lead wires that do not deviate from a straight line from bond to external lead and appear to
touch another wire or bond (Y plane only).
4. Any lead wire that touches or is less than .002 inch (0.0504 mm) from the case or external
lead to which it is not attached (X and Y plane).
5. Any bond that is less than .001 inch (0.0254 mm) (excluding bonds connected by a
common conductor) from another bond (Y plane only).
6. Any wire making a straight line run (with no arc) from die bonding pad to package post.
7. Any cracks, nicks, neckdown, or cuts on lead wires that reduces the wire diameter by more
than 25 percent
1. Any lead wire that touches or is less than .002 inch (0.0504 mm) from the case or external
lead to which it is not attached (X and Y plane).
2. Lead wires that sag below an imaginary plane across the top of the bond (X plane only).
3. Any lead wire that appears to touch or cross another lead wire or bond (Y plane only) if
bonded to different electrical elements.
4. Any lead wire that deviates from a straight line from bond to external lead appears to touch
or to be within .002 inch (0.0504 mm) of another wire or bond (Y plane only).
5. Any bond that is less than .001 inch (0.0254 mm) (excluding bonds connected by a
common conductor) from another bond (Y plane only).
6. Any wire making a straight line run (with no arc) from die bonding pad to package post,
unless specifically designed in this manner (e.g., clips, rigid connecting leads, or heavy
power leads).
METHOD 2076.3
6
7. Any internal post that is bent more than 10 degrees from the vertical (or intended design
position), or is not uniform in length and construction, or comes closer than one post
diameter to another post.
8. Any post in a low profile case (such as a TO-46) which comes closer to the top of the case
than 20 percent of the total inside dimension between the header and the top of the case.
Any device in which the semiconductor element is vertical to the header, and comes closer
than .002 inch (0.0504 mm) to the header, or to any part of the case.
9. Any cracks, nicks, neckdown, or cuts on lead wires that reduces the wire diameter by more
than 25 percent
2. Whisker tilted more than 5 degrees in any direction from the device lead axis or deformed to
the extent that it touches itself.
3. Either half of an S or C bend whisker that is compressed so that any dimension is reduced
to less than 50 percent of its design value. On diodes with whiskers metallurgically bonded
to the post and to the die, the whisker may be deformed to the extent that it touches itself if
the minimum whisker clearance zone specified in figure 2076-4a is maintained for metal
packages.
4. Whiskerless construction device with plug displacement distance more than one-fourth of
the diameter of the plug with respect to the central axis of the device.
5. Semiconductor element mounting tilted more than 15E from normal to the main axis of the
device.
6. Die hanging over edge of header or pedestal more than 20 percent of the die contact area
by design.
7. Less than 75 percent of the semiconductor element base area is bonded to the mounting
surface.
8. Voids in the welds which reduce the lead to plug connection by more than 25 percent of the
total weld area.
9. Devices with package deformities such as body glass cracks, incomplete seals (e.g., voids,
position of glass), die chip outs, and severe misalignment of S- and C-shaped whisker
connections to die or post that exceed the limits of the applicable visual inspection
requirements.
3.9.3 Encapsulated non-cavity assemblies of discrete devices. External to the individual devices, the
encapsulating material shall be examined and rejected for the following defects.
3.9.3.1 Extraneous material. Extraneous matter of any shape with any dimension exceeding .020 inch (0.51 mm).
Also, any two adjacent particles of such matter with total dimensions exceeding .030 inch (0.76 mm).
METHOD 2076.3
7
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Marking, if other than indicated in 3.3 and marking of samples to indicate they have been radiographed, if
required (see 3.3.3).
d. Sample defects and criteria for acceptance or rejection, if other than indicated in 3.9.
METHOD 2076.3
8
METHOD 2076.3
9
METHOD 2076.3
10
METHOD 2076.3
11
METHOD 2076.3
12
METHOD 2077.3
1. Purpose. This test method provides a means of judging the quality and acceptability of metallization on
semiconductor dice. It addresses the specific metallization defects that are batch process oriented and which can
best be identified utilizing this method. It should not be used as a test method for workmanship and other type
defects best identified using the visual inspection criteria of test method 2072. The term, "dice", for the purpose of
this test method, includes diodes and transistors which have expanded metallization contacts or metallization
interconnects.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus for this inspection shall be a scanning electron microscope (SEM) having an
ultimate resolution of 100 or less and a variable magnification to at least 20,000X. The apparatus shall be such
that the specimen can be tilted to a viewing angle (see figure 2077-1) of 60 degrees or greater, and can be rotated
through 360 degrees. Evidence of using competent SEM operating personnel, as well as acceptable techniques and
equipment that meet the requirements of this test method, shall be demonstrated for the approval of the qualifying
activity or, when applicable, a designated representative of the acquiring activity.
3. Procedure.
3.1 Sample selection. Proper sampling is an integral part of this test method. Statistical techniques, using
random selection, are not practical here because of the large sample size that would be required. This test method
specifies means of minimizing test samples while maintaining confidence in test integrity by designating for
examination wafers in specific locations on the wafer holder(s) in the metallization chamber, and specific dice on the
wafers. These dice are in typical or worst case positions for the metallization configuration. Dice selected for SEM
examination shall not be immediately adjacent to the wafer edge, and they shall be free of smearing or inking, since
this could obscure processing faults for which they are to be inspected. Metallization acceptance shall be based on
examination of sample dice, using either a single wafer acceptance basis or a process lot acceptance basis. A
process lot is a batch of wafers which has been received together, those common processes which determine the
slope and thickness of the oxide step and which have been metallized as a group.
3.1.1 Sampling condition A, unglassivated devices. This sampling condition applies to devices which have no
glassivation over the metallization. Steps 1 and 2 (See 3.1.1.1 and 3.1.1.2 herein), both apply when acceptance is
on a lot acceptance basis. Only step 2 applies when acceptance is on a single wafer acceptance basis.
3.1.1.1 Step 1: Slice selection. From each lot to be examined on a lot acceptance basis, wafers shall be selected
from the designated positions on the wafer holder(s) in the metallizing chamber. In accordance with the definition of
lot in 3.1, if there is more than one process lot in a metallization chamber, each process lot shall be grouped
approximately in a separate sector within the wafer holder, and a separate set of wafers shall be selected for each
process lot being examined on a lot acceptance basis. Table 2077-I and figure 2077-2 specify the number and sites
of wafers to be selected. Dice selection from the selected wafers shall be in accordance with the sampling plan
established for a single wafer in step 2 (see 3.1.1.2).
3.1.1.2 Step 2: Dice selection. When a wafer is to be evaluated (for acceptance on a single wafer basis, or with
one or more wafers on a lot acceptance basis), either of the following sampling conditions may be used at the
manufacturer's option.
3.1.1.2.1 Sampling condition A1: Quadrants. Immediately following the dicing operation (i.e., scribe and break,
saw, etch) and before relative die location on the wafer is lost, four dice shall be selected. The positions of these
dice shall be near the periphery of the wafer and approximately 90 degrees apart (see figure 2077-2).
3.1.1.2.2 Sampling condition A2: Segment. After completion of all processing steps and, prior to dicing, two
segments shall be separated from opposite sides of each wafer to be examined. These segments shall be detached
along a chord approximately one-third of the wafer radius in from the edge of the wafer. One die from near each end
of each segment (i.e., four dice) shall then be subjected to SEM examination.
METHOD 2077.3
1 of 20
Evaporation Sputtering
1/ If there is more than one process lot in a metallization chamber, each process lot shall be
grouped approximately in a separate sector within the wafer holder. A sector is an area of the
circular wafer holder bounded by two radii and the subtended arc; quadrants and semicircles
are used as examples on figure 2077-2.
2/ Sample wafers need to be selected from only one planet if all process lots contained in the
chamber are included in that planet. Otherwise, sample wafers of the process lot(s) not
included in that planet shall be selected from another planet(s).
NOTE: If a wafer holder has only one circular row, or if only one row is used on a multi-rowed wafer
holder, the total number of a specified sample wafers shall be taken from that row.
METHOD 2077.3
2
3.1.2 Sampling condition C: Glassivated devices. This sampling condition applies to devices which have
glassivation over the metallization. Steps 1 and 2 (see 3.1.2.1 and 3.1.2.2 herein), both apply when acceptance is
on a lot acceptance basis. Only step 2 applies when acceptance is on a single wafer acceptance basis.
3.1.2.1 Step 1: Wafer selection. From each lot to be examined on a lot acceptance basis, wafers shall be
selected from the designated positions on the wafer holder in the metallizing chamber. In accordance with the
definition of lot in 3.1, if there is more than one process lot in a metallization chamber, each process lot shall be
grouped approximately in a separate sector within the wafer holder, and a separate set of wafers shall be selected
for each process lot being examined on a lot acceptance basis. Table 2077-I and figure 2077-2 specify the number
and sites of wafers to be selected. Dice selection from the selected wafers shall be in accordance with the sampling
plan established for a single wafer in step 2 (see 3.1.2.2).
3.1.2.2. Step 2: Dice selection. When a wafer is to be evaluated (for acceptance on a single wafer acceptance
basis, or with one or more other wafers on a lot acceptance basis), any of the following sampling conditions may be
used at the manufacturer's option.
3.1.2.2.1 Sampling condition B1: Quadrants. This is the recommended condition for glassivated devices.
Immediately following the dicing operation (i.e., scribe and break, saw, etch) and before relative die location on the
wafer is lost, four dice shall be selected. The positions of these dice shall be near the periphery of the wafer and
approximately 90 degrees apart. The glassivation shall then be removed from the dice using a suitable etch. It is
recommended that the etchant used have an etch rate for the glassivation which is approximately 200 times that for
the metallization. The dice shall be periodically examined during glass removal using a bright field metallurgical
microscope to determine when all the glassivation has been removed and to minimize the possibility of etching the
metallization.
3.1.2.2.2 Sampling condition B2: Segment, prior to glassivation. This sampling condition may be used only if the
glassivation processing temperature is lower than +400C. Two segments shall be separated from opposite sides of
each wafer to be examined immediately before the glassivation coating operation; (i.e., subsequent to metallization,
etching, and sintering, but before glassivation). These segments shall be detached along a chord approximately
one-third of the wafer radius in from the edge of the wafer. One die from near each end of each segment (i.e., four
dice) shall be subjected to SEM examination.
3.1.2.2.3 Sampling condition B3: Segment, after glassivation. Two segments shall be separated from opposite
sides of each wafer subsequent to sintering and glassivation. These segments shall be detached along a chord
approximately one-third of the wafer radius in from the edge of the wafer. The glassivation shall then be removed
from the segment using a suitable etch (see 3.1.2.2.1 for the etch rate). The segment shall be periodically examined
using a bright field metallurgical microscope to determine when all the glassivation has been removed and to
minimize the possibility of etching the metallization. One die from near each end of each segment (i.e., four dice)
shall be subjected to SEM examination.
3.2 Lot control during SEM examination. After dice sample selection for SEM examination, the manufacturer may
elect either of two options as follows.
3.2.1 Option 1. The manufacturer may continue normal processing of the lot with the risk of later recall and
rejection of product if SEM inspection, when performed, shows defective metallization. If this option is elected,
positive control and recall of processed material shall be demonstrated by the manufacturer by having adequate
traceability documentation.
3.2.2 Option 2. Prior to any further processing, the manufacturer may store the dice or wafers in a suitable
environment until SEM examination has been completed and approval for further processing has been granted.
3.3 Specimen preparation. Specimens shall be mounted in an appropriate manner for examination. Suitable
caution shall be exercised in the use of materials such as conducting paints and adhesives for specimen mounting
so that important features are not obscured. Specimens may be examined without any special coating to facilitate
SEM examination if the required resolution can be obtained, or they may be coated with a vapor-deposited or
sputtered film of a suitable conductive material. If the specimens are coated, thickness or quality of the coatings
shall be such that no artifacts are introduced.
METHOD 2077.3
3
3.4 Specimen examination, general requirements. The metallization on all four edge directions shall be examined
on each die for each type of contact window step and for each other types of oxide steps (see table 2077-II) (oxide
refers to any insulating material used on the semiconductor die, whether SiOx or SiNx). A single window (or other
type of oxide step) may be viewed if metallization covers the entire window (or other type of oxide step) extending up
to and over each edge, and onto the top of the oxide at each edge. Other windows (or other types of oxide steps) on
the die shall be examined to meet the requirement that all four directional edges of each type of window (or other
type of oxide step) shall be examined on each die. General metallization defects, such as peeling and voids, shall
be viewed to provide for the best examination for those defects.
NOTE: For multi-layered-metal interconnection systems, see 3.5.3 and 3.7.3. Window coverage also shall
be examined.
3.4.1. Viewing angle. Specimens shall be viewed at an appropriate angle to accurately assess the quality of the
metallization. Contact windows are normally viewed at an angle of 45 degrees to 60 degrees or greater (see figure
2077-1).
3.4.2. Viewing direction. Specimens shall be viewed in an appropriate direction to accurately assess the quality of
the metallization. This inspection shall include examination of metallization at the edges of contact windows and
other types of oxide steps (see 3.4) in any direction that provides clear views of each edge and that best displays
any defects at the oxide step. The viewing direction may be perpendicular to an edge, parallel with an edge, or at
some oblique angle.
3.4.3 Magnification. The magnification ranges shall be between 4,000X and 20,000X for examination of oxide
steps and between 1,000X and 6,000X for general metallization defects, such as peeling and voids (refer to table
2077-II). When dice are subjected to reinspection, such reinspection shall be accomplished at any magnification
within the specified magnification.
3.5.1. Expanded contact bipolar. Examination shall be as specified herein and summarized in table 2077-II.
3.5.1.1 Oxide steps. Inspect the metallization at all types of oxide steps (see table 2077-II) and document in
accordance with 3.8.
3.5.1.2 General metallization. Inspect all general metallization on each die for defects such as peeling and voids.
Document in accordance with 3.8.
METHOD 2077.3
4
3.5.2 Power FETs. Examination shall be specified herein and summarized in table 2077-II.
3.5.2.1 Oxide steps. Inspect the metallization at all types of oxide steps (see table 2077-II) and document in
accordance with 3.8. For RF or power transistors with interdigitated or mesh structures, each base-emitter stripe
pair within each pattern shall be inspected as a minimum. Particular attention shall be directed to lateral etching
defects and undercut at base and emitter oxide steps. Documentation shall be as specified in 3.8.
3.5.2.2 General metallization. Inspect all general metallization on each die for defects such as peeling and voids.
Document in accordance with 3.8.
3.5.3 Multi-layered metal interconnection systems. Multi-layered metal is defined as two or more layers of metal
or any other material used for interconnections. Each layer of metal shall be examined. The principal current-
carrying layer shall be examined with the SEM; the other layers (i.e., barrier or adhesion) may be examined using
either the SEM or an optical microscope, at the manufacturer's option. Accept/reject criteria for multi-layered metal
systems are given in 3.7.3. The glassivation (if any) and each successive layer of metal shall be stripped by
selective etching with suitable reagents, layer-by-layer, to permit the examination of each layer. If it is impractical to
remove the metal on a single die layer-by-layer, one or more dice immediately adjacent to the original die shall be
etched so that all layers shall be exposed and examined. Specimen examination shall be in accordance with 3.5.
3.6.1. Single slice acceptance basis. The metallization of a wafer shall be judged acceptable only if all sample
dice from that wafer are acceptable.
3.6.2 Lot acceptable basis. An entire lot shall be judged acceptable only when all sample dice from all sample
wafers are acceptable. At the manufacturer's option, if a lot is rejected in accordance with this paragraph, each
wafer from that lot may be individually examined. Acceptance shall then be in accordance with 3.6.1.
3.7 Accept/reject criteria. Rejection of dice shall be based upon batch process oriented defects. Rejection shall
not be based upon workmanship and other type defects such as scratches, smeared metallization, or tooling marks.
In the event that the presence of such defects obscures the detailed features being examined, an additional die shall
be examined which is immediately adjacent to the die with the obscured metallization. Illustrations of typical defects
are shown on figure 2077-3 through figure 2077-20.
3.7.1 Oxide steps. The metallization on all four directional edges of every type of oxide step(s) (contact window or
other type of oxide step) shall be examined (see 3.4.2). The metallization shall be unacceptable if thinning and one
or more defects such as voids, separations, notches, cracks, depressions, or tunnels reduce the cross-sectional
area of the metal at the directional edge to less than 50 percent of metal cross-sectional area on either side of the
directional edge. When less than 50 percent, for the metallization to be acceptable, all four directional edges shall
be covered with metallization (see 3.4.2) and shall be acceptable except in the cases described in 3.7.1.1 and
3.7.1.2.
3.7.1.1 Oxide steps without metallization. In the event that a directional edge profile of a particular type of oxide
step cannot be found which is covered with metallization (see 3.4.2) and therefore, a judgment of the quality of the
metallization at that directional edge profile cannot be made, this shall not be cause for rejection if:
a. It is established that the edge profile from which metal is absent does not occur in a current-carrying
direction, such determination being made either by scanning all oxide steps of this type on the balance of the
die, or by examination of a topographical map supplied by the manufacturer which shows the metal
interconnect pattern, and;
b. Duplicate sample wafers are examined, these duplicates being located adjacent to the original sample
wafers, in the wafer holder, and being rotated so as to be oriented approximately 180 degrees with respect to
the original sample wafers during metallization. If the conditions of both 3.7.1.1.a. and 3.7.1.1.b. are met, a
lot acceptance basis may be used. If only condition a is met, a single wafer acceptance basis must be used.
METHOD 2077.3
5
3.7.1.2 Oxide steps with less than 50 percent metallization. If less than the specified percent of the metallization
is present at a particular directional edge profile (see figure 2077-3), wafer lot rejection shall not be invoked if:
a. It is established that the edge profile from which metal is absent does not occur in a current-carrying
direction, such determination being made either by scanning all oxide steps of this type on the balance of
the die, or by examination of a topographical map supplied by the manufacturer which shows the metal
interconnect pattern;
c. The device is a power FET, no less than 20 percent of the metallization is present, and the maximum
calculated current density does not exceed the value which corresponds to the applicable conductor
material in accordance with table 2077-III.
5 2
Gold 6 x 10 amps/cm
5 2
All other (unless otherwise specified) 2 x 10 amps/cm
3.7.2 General metallization. General metallization is defined for the purpose of this test method as the
metallization at all locations except at oxide steps, and shall include metallization (stripes) in the actual contact
window regions. Any metallization pulling or lifting (lack of adhesion) shall be unacceptable. Any defects, such as
voids which reduce the cross-sectional area of the metallization stripe by more than 50 percent, shall be
unacceptable.
3.7.3 Multi-layered metal interconnection systems. These systems may be more susceptible to undercutting than
single-layered metal systems and shall, therefore, be examined carefully for this type of defect, in addition to the
other types of defects. Refer to 3.5.3 for specimen examination requirements and definition of multi-layered metal
systems.
3.7.3.1 Oxide steps. The criteria of 3.7.1 shall apply to both the principal conducting metal and the barrier layer.
If by design, a barrier layer is not intended to cover the oxide steps, 3.7.1 shall not apply to the barrier layer.
3.7.3.1.1 Barrier or adhesion layer as a nonconductor. When a barrier or adhesion layer is designed to conduct
less than 10 percent of the total current, this layer shall be considered as only a barrier or adhesion layer.
Consequently, this barrier or adhesion barrier layer shall not be used in current density calculations and shall not be
required to satisfy the step coverage requirements. The barrier or adhesion layer shall be required to cover only
these regions where the barrier function is designed with the manufacturer providing suitable verification of this
function. The thickness of the barrier or adhesion layer shall not be permitted to be added to the thickness of the
principal conducting layer when estimating the percentage metallization step coverage. Therefore, the principal
conducting layer shall satisfy the percentage step coverage by itself.
METHOD 2077.3
6
3.7.3.2 General metallization. The criteria of 3.7.2 shall apply here only for the principal conducting metal layer.
Other metal layers (nonprincipal conducting layers such as barrier or adhesion layers) may be examined with the
SEM, or with an optical microscope, the choice of equipment being at the manufacturer's option. Two specific cases
of general metallization are considered. In the examination of other metal layers for the specific case of
interconnection stripes (i.e., exclusive of contact window area), a defect consuming 100 percent of the
cross-sectional area of the strip shall be acceptable provided the length of that defect is not greater than the width of
the metallization strip (see figure 2077-20). For the specific case of contact window area metallization, at least 70
percent of the contact window area must be covered by the principal metal layer and any underlying metal layer(s).
For the metal layer(s) above the principal conducting layer in the contact window area, a defect consuming 100
percent of the cross-sectional area of the metallization strip shall be acceptable provided the length of that defect is
not greater than the width of the stripe. In the examination of the specific case of contact window area metallization
for multi-metal systems, at least one of each type of contact window present shall be examined.
3.8 Specimen documentation requirements. After examination of dice from each wafer, a minimum of three
photographs for each lot shall be taken and retained. Two photographs shall be of worst case oxide steps and the
third photograph of worst case general metallization. If any photograph shows another apparent defect within the
field of view, another photograph shall be taken to certify the extent of that apparent defect (see table 2077-II).
3.8.1 Required information. The following information shall be traceable to each photograph:
d. Manufacturer.
g. Magnification.
i. Viewing angle.
3.9 Control of samples. SEM samples shall not be shipped in any manner as functional devices.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
b. Requirements for photographic documentation (number and kind) if other than as specified in 3.8.
METHOD 2077.3
7
METHOD 2077.3
8
METHOD 2077.3
9
METHOD 2077.3
10
METHOD 2077.3
11
METHOD 2077.3
12
NOTE: Tunnel does not reduce cross-sectional area more than 50 percent.
METHOD 2077.3
14
METHOD 2077.3
15
FIGURE 2077-12. (7,200X) Thinning at oxide step with more than 50 percent of cross-
sectional area remaining at step (multi-level-metal) (accept).
FIGURE 2077-13 (7,200X) Thinning at oxide step with less than 50 percent of cross-
sectional area remaining at step (multi-level-metal) (reject).
METHOD 2077.3
16
METHOD 2077.3
17
METHOD 2077.3
18
METHOD 2077.3
19
METHOD 2077.3
20
METHOD 2078
1. Purpose. The purpose of this inspection is to verify the construction and workmanship of devices utilizing
junction passivated diode and rectifiers chips that use wire to chip technology. This test will be performed prior to
capping or encapsulation.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus for this inspection shall consist of the following:
b. Light sources of sufficient intensity to adequately illuminate the devices being inspected.
c. Adequate fixturing for handling the devices being inspected without causing damage.
d. Adequate covered storage and transportation containers to protect devices from mechanical damage and
environmental contamination.
e. Any visual standards (drawings and photographs) necessary to enable the inspector to make objective
decisions as to the acceptability of the devices being examined.
3. Definitions.
3.1 Glassivation. The top layer of transparent insulating material that covers the active circuit area metallization,
but excludes the bond pads.
3.2 Passivation. Silicon oxide, nitride, or other insulating material that is grown or deposited directly on the die
prior to the deposition of any metal.
4. Procedure.
4.1 General. The device shall be examined in a suitable sequence of observations within the specified
magnification range to determine compliance with the requirements of this test method. It is optional that the chips
used have passed Mil-STD-750 Method 2073 prior to assembly.
a. Inspection control. Within the time interval between visual inspection and preparation for sealing, devices
shall be stored in a controlled environment (one which controls airborne particle count and relative
humidity). The use of an inert gas environment, such as dry nitrogen shall satisfy the requirements for
storing in a controlled environment. Devices examined in accordance with this test method shall be
inspected and stored in a class 100,000 environment, in accordance with FED-STD-209, except that the
maximum allowable relative humidity shall not exceed 65 percent.
b. If devices are subjected to a high temperature bake (> 100C) immediately prior to sealing, the humidity
control is not required. Unless a cleaning operation is performed prior to sealing, devices shall be in
covered containers when transferred from one controlled environment to another.
c. Magnification. High magnification inspection shall be performed perpendicular to the die surface with
normal incident illumination. Low magnification inspection shall be performed with either a monocular,
binocular, or stereo microscope, and the inspection performed within any appropriate angle, with the device
under suitable illumination. The inspection criteria of 4.1.4 and 4.1.6.1 may be examined at "high
magnification" at the manufacturer's option. High power magnification may be used to verify a discrepancy
noted at a low power.
4.1.1 Die metallization defects (high magnification). A die which exhibits any of the following defects shall be
rejected.
4.1.1.1 Metallization scratches, islands and voids exposing underlying material (see figure 2078-1 and 207-2).
a. A scratch or smear that extrudes metal such that it extends over the next geometric boundary such as
guard rings.
b. Any die containing a void in the metallization at the bonding pad covering more than 25 percent of the pad
area.
c. Any scratch or void which isolates more than 25 percent of the total metallization of an active region from
the bonding pad.
METHOD 2078
2
METHOD 2078
3
4.1.1.3 Metallization adherence. Any metallization which has lifted, peeled, or blistered.
4.1.1.4 Metallization probing. Criteria contained in 4.1.1.1 shall apply as limitations on probing damage.
a. Except by design, contact window that has less than 75 percent of its area covered by continuous
metallization.
b. On metal overlay devices, any misalignment causing the metal to be extended to more than 50% of the
way to the next geometric boundary.
4.1.2 Passivation and diffusion faults (high magnification). A device which exhibits any of the following defects
(see figure 2078-3) shall be rejected:
a. Any diffusion fault that allows bridging between any two diffused areas including field rings and guard rings
or any two metallization strips.
b. Any passivation fault including pinholes not covered by glassivation that exposes semiconductor material
and allows bridging between any two diffused areas, any two metallization strips, or any such combination
not intended by design.
d. On metal overlay devices, an absence of passivation visible at the edge and continuing under the
metallization causing an apparent short between the metal and the underlying material (closely spaced
double or triple lines on the edges of the defect indicate that it may have sufficient depth to penetrate down
to the silicon).
METHOD 2078
4
4.1.3 Sawing and die defects (high magnification). A device which exhibits any of the following defects (see figure
2078-4 and 2078-5) shall be rejected:
a. Unless by design, less than 0.1 mil passivation visible between active metallization or bond pad periphery
and the edge of the die.
d. Any crack which exceeds 2.0 mils in length inside the scribe grid or scribe line that points toward active
metallization or active area and extends into the oxide area.
METHOD 2078
6
4.1.4 Bond inspection (low magnification). This inspection and criteria shall be the required inspection for the
bond type(s) and location(s) to which they are applicable when viewed from above (see figures 2078-6 and 2078-7).
Wire tail is not considered part of the bond when determining physical bond dimensions. A device, which exhibits
any of the following defects, shall be rejected.
a. Gold ball bonds on the die or package post where the ball bond diameter is less than 2.0 times or greater
than 5.0 times the wire diameter.
b. Gold ball bonds where the wire exit is not completely within the periphery of the ball.
c. Gold ball bonds where the exiting wire is not within the boundaries of the bonding pad.
d. Any visible intermetallic formation at the periphery of any gold ball bond.
a. Ultrasonic wedge bonds on the die or package post that are less than 1.2times or greater than 3.0 times
the wire diameter in width, or are less than 1.5 times or greater than 5.0 times the wire diameter in length.
b. Thermo compression wedge bonds on the die or package post that are less than 1.2 times or greater than
3.0 times the wire diameter in width or are less than 1.5 or greater than 5.0 times the wire diameter in
length.
4.1.4.2.1 Stitch Wire Bonds, usually done with a wedge bonder, is where a single bond wire has 2 or more bonds
along its length to the chip. These can be evaluated using the criteria for single wedge bonds with the
following guidelines:
b. The bond farthest from the wire end must meet the cutoff tail requirement.
d. Shape and deformation criteria of each bond is the same as for a single bond.
METHOD 2078
7
B. Wedge.
a. Tailless bonds on the die or package post that are less than 1.2 times or greater than 5.0 times the wire
diameter in width, or are less than 0.5 times or greater than 3.0 times the wire diameter in length.
b. Tailless bonds where the bond impression does not cover the entire width of the wire.
A. Tailless or crescent.
NOTES:
1. 1.2.D W 5.0 D (width).
2. 0.5 D L 3.0 D (length).
4.1.4.4 General (gold ball, wedge, and tailless). As viewed from above, a device which exhibits any of the
following defects shall be rejected:
a. Bonds on the die where less than 75 percent of the bond is within the unglassivated bonding pad area
(except where due to geometry, the bonding pad is smaller than the bond, the criteria shall be 50 percent).
b. Wire bond tails that extend over and make contact with any metallization not covered by glassivation and
not connected to the wire.
c. Wire bond tails (pigtails) that exceed two wire diameters in length at the bonding pad or four wire diameters
in length at the package post (see figure 2078-8).
d. Bonds on the package posts that are not bonded entirely on the flat surface of the post top.
f. Bonds placed so that the separation between bonds and adjacent glassivated die metallization is less than
0.25 mil or the separation between adjacent bonds is less than 0.25 mil. This criteria does not apply to
designs which employ multiple bond wires in place of a single wire.
i. Bonds located where any of the bond is placed on an area containing die preform mounting material.
j. For aluminum wires over 2.0 mils diameter, the bond width shall not be less than 1.0 times the wire
diameter.
4.1.5 Internal lead wires (low magnification). This inspection and criteria shall be required inspection for the
location(s) to which they are applicable when viewed from above. A device which exhibits any of the following
defects shall be rejected:
a. Any wire that comes closer than two wire diameters or 5 mils, whichever is less, to unglassivated operating
metallization, another wire (common wires and pigtails excluded) package post, unpassivated die area, or
any portion of the package, including the plane of the lid to be attached. (Within a 5.0 mil spherical radial
distance from the perimeter of the bond on the die surface, the separation can be 1.0 mil.)
b. Nicks, tears, bonds, cuts, crimps, scoring, or neckdown in any wire that reduces the wire diameter by more
than 25 percent. See figure 2078-9.
METHOD 2078
9
FIGURE 2078-9.
c. Missing or extra lead wires.
e. Any wire which runs from die bonding pad to package post and has no arc or stress relief (See figure
2078-10).
FIGURE 2078-10
METHOD 2078
10
FIGURE 2078-11
h. Wire is kinked (unintended sharp bend) with an interior angle of less than 90 or twisted to an extent that
stress marks appear.
i. Wire (ball bonded devices) not within 10 of the perpendicular to the surface of the chip for a distance of
greater than 0.5 mil before bending toward the package post or other termination point.
l. A bow or loop between double bonds at post greater than four times wire diameter.
m. Excessive loops, bows, or sags in any wire such that it could short to another wire, to another pad, to
another package post, to the die or touch any portion of the package.
n. When clips are used, solder fillets shall encompass at least 50 percent of the clip-to-die and post-to-clip
periphery. There shall be no deformation or plating defects on the clip.
METHOD 2078
11
4.1.6 Package conditions (magnification as indicated). A device which exhibits any of the following defects shall
be rejected.
4.1.6.1 Conductive foreign material on die surface. All foreign material or particles may be blown off with a
nominal gas blow (approximately 20 psi (138 kPa)) or removed with a soft camel hairbrush. The device shall then be
inspected for the following reject criteria (low magnification):
a. Loosely attached foreign particles (conductive particles which are attached by less than one-half of their
largest dimension), which are present on the surface of the die that are large enough to bridge the
narrowest unglassivated metal spacing (silicon chips shall be included as conductive particles).
b. Embedded foreign particles on the die that bridge two or more metallization paths or semiconductor
junctions, or any combination of metallization or junction.
c. Liquid droplets, chemical stains, or photoresist on the die surface that bridge any combinations of
unglassivated metal or bare silicon areas.
d. Ink on the surface of the die that covers more than 25 percent of a bonding pad area or that bridges any
combination of unglassivated metallization or bare silicon areas.
a. Die mounting material buildup that extends onto the top surface of the die or extends vertically above the
top surface of the die and interferes with bonding.
b. Die to header mounting material which is not visible around at least three complete sides or 75 percent of
the die perimeter. Wetting criteria is not required if the devices pass an approved electrical die attach
evaluation test.
d. Any balling of the die mounting material which does not exhibit a fillet when viewed from above.
a. Die is not located or orientated in accordance with the applicable assembly drawing of the device.
b. Die is visibly tipped or tilted (more than 10) with respect to the die attach surface.
4.1.6.4 Internal package defects (low magnification inspection) (applicable to headers, bases, caps, and lids).
a. Any header or post plating which is blistered, flaked, cracked, or any combination thereof.
b. Any conductive particle which is attached by less than one-half of the longest dimension.
c. A bubble or a series of interconnecting bubbles in the glass surrounding the pins which are more than
one-half the distance between the pin and body or pin-to-pin.
e. Any glass, die, or other material greater than 1.0 mil in its major dimension which adheres to the flange or
side of the header and would impair sealing.
f. Any stain, varnish, or header discoloration which appears to extend under a die bond or wire bond.
(1) Any defect or abnormality causing the designed isolating paths between the metal island to be
reduced to less than 50 percent of the design separation.
METHOD 2078
12
4.1.6.5 Presence of extraneous matter. Extraneous matter (foreign particles) shall include, but not be limited to:
a. Any foreign particle, loose or attached, greater than .003 inch (0.08 mm) or of any lesser size which is
sufficient to bridge non-connected conducting elements of the device.
b. Any wire tail extending beyond its normal end by more than two diameters at the semiconductor die pad or
by more than four wire diameters at the package post (see figure 2078-11).
c. Any burr on a post (header lead) greater than .003 inch (0.08 mm) in its major dimension or of such
configuration that it may break away.
d. Excessive semiconductor die bonding material buildup (see figure 2078-12 and 2078-13). A
semiconductor die shall be mounted and bonded so that it is not tilted more than 10 from mounting
surface. The bonding agent that accumulates around the perimeter of the semiconductor die and touches
the side of the semiconductor die shall not accumulate to a thickness greater than that of the
semiconductor die. Where the bonding agent is built up but is not touching the semiconductor die, the
build up shall not be greater than twice the thickness of the semiconductor die. There shall be no excess
semiconductor die bonding material in contact with the active surface of the semiconductor die or any lead
or post, or separated from the main bonding material area.
f. Extraneous ball bonds anywhere inside case, except for attached bond residue when re-bonding is
allowed.
4.1.7 Glassivation and silicon nitride defects (high magnification). No device shall be acceptable that exhibits any
of the following defects:
a. Glass crazing that prohibits the detection of visual criteria contained herein.
b. Any glassivation which has delaminated. (Lifting or peeling of the glassivation may be excluded from the
criteria above, when it does not extend more than 1.0 mil distance from the designed periphery of the
glassivation, provided that the only exposure of metal is adjacent to bond pads or of metallization leading
from those pads.)
c. Except by design, two or more adjacent active metallization paths which are not covered by glassivation.
d. Glassivation which covers more than 25 percent of the design bonding pad area.
4.2 Post organic protective coating visual inspection. If devices are to be coated with an organic or silicone
protective coating, the devices shall be visually examined in accordance with the criteria specified in 4.1 prior to
application of the coating. After the application and cure of the organic protective coating the devices shall be
visually examined under a minimum of 10X
magnification. Devices, which exhibit any of the following defects, shall be rejected:
a. Except by design, any unglassivated or unpassivated areas or insulating substrate which has incomplete
coverage.
f. Conductive particles, which are embedded in the coating and are large enough to bridge the narrowest
unglassivated active metal spacing (silicon chips shall be included as conductive particles).
METHOD 2078
13
DETAIL A
METHOD 2078
14
METHOD 2078
15
METHOD 2081
1. Purpose. This test method is intended to detect any device discontinuity "ringing" or shifting of the forward dc
voltage characteristic monitored during shock.
2. Apparatus. The shock testing apparatus shall be capable of providing shock pulses of the specified peak
acceleration and pulse duration to the body of the device. The acceleration pulse, as determined from the unfiltered
output of a transducer with a natural frequency greater than or equal to five times the frequency of the shock pulse
being established, shall be a half-sine waveform with an allowable distortion not greater than 20 percent of the
specified peak acceleration. The pulse duration shall be measured between the points at 10 percent of the peak
acceleration during rise time and at 10 percent of the peak acceleration during decay time. Absolute tolerances of
the pulse duration shall be the greater of 0.6 ms or 15 percent of the specified duration for specified durations of 2
ms and greater. For specified durations less than 2 ms, absolute tolerances shall be the greater of 0.1 ms or 30
percent of the specified duration. The monitoring equipment shall be an oscilloscope or any "latch and hold"
interrupt detector of appropriate sensitivity.
3. Procedure. The shock testing apparatus shall be mounted on a sturdy laboratory table or equivalent base and
leveled before use. The device shall be rigidly mounted or restrained by its case with suitable protection for the
leads. Special care is required to ensure positive electrical connection to the device leads to prevent intermittent
contacts during shock. The device shall be subjected to five shock pulses of 1,000 g peak minimum for the pulse
duration of 1 ms in each of two perpendicular planes. For each blow, the carriage shall be raised to the height
necessary for obtaining the specified acceleration and then allowed to fall. Means may be provided to prevent the
carriage from striking the anvil a second time. With the specified dc voltage and current applied, the forward dc
characteristic shall be displayed on a oscilloscope swept at 60 Hz and shall be monitored continuously during the
shock test.
4. Failure criteria. During the shock test, any discontinuity, flutter, drift, or shift in oscilloscope trace or any
dynamic instabilities shall be cause for rejection of the semiconductor DUT(s).
a. Acceleration and duration of pulse, if other than that specified (see 3.).
b. Number and direction of blows, if other than that specified (see 3.).
METHOD 2081
1 of 1
METHOD 2082
1. Purpose. This test method is intended to detect any device discontinuity "ringing" or shifting of the reverse dc
voltage characteristic monitored during vibration.
2. Apparatus. The vibration testing apparatus shall be capable of providing the required frequency vibration at the
specified levels. The monitoring equipment shall be an oscilloscope or any "latch and hold" interrupt detector of
appropriate sensitivity.
3. Procedure. The device shall be rigidly fastened on the vibration platform. Special care is required to ensure
positive electrical connection to the device leads to prevent intermittent contacts during vibration. Care must also be
exercised to avoid magnetic fields in the area of the device being vibrated. The device shall be vibrated with a
simple harmonic motion at 60 3 Hz, with .1 inch (2.54 mm) minimum double amplitude displacement for a period of
30 seconds minimum in the X orientation planes (see note below). The acceleration shall be monitored at a point
where the "g" level is equivalent to that of the support point for the device(s). With the specified dc voltage and
current applied (for zeners only) and with the specified reverse dc voltage applied (for diodes and rectifiers only), the
reverse dc characteristic shall be displayed on an oscilloscope swept at 60 Hz and shall be monitored continuously
during the vibration test.
g = .0512f2DA.
f = frequency in Hz.
4. Failure criteria. During the vibration test, any discontinuity, flutter, drift, or shift in oscilloscope trace or any
dynamic instabilities shall be cause for rejection of the semiconductor DUT.
METHOD 2082
1 of 1
METHOD 2101.1
1. Purpose. This method describes detail procedures and evaluation guidelines for the destructive physical
analysis (DPA) of commonly specified diodes. It is intended to provide techniques for determining compliance with
specified construction requirements, as well as for evaluating processes, workmanship, and material consistency of
the product in relation to MIL-PRF-19500 requirements.
2. Scope. This method pertains to all diode constructions including metal can, except where the die is
encapsulated in a package normally specified for transistors. Diodes in transistor packages shall be evaluated using
method 2102.
3. Sampling. Sampling for DPA shall be as specified in the applicable diode specification sheet or acquisition
procedure requirements, by contract. Destructive analysis shall be totally compliant with the specification sheet for
electrical and mechanical requirements or as otherwise specified in the acquisition requirements.
4. Procedure. The DPA samples shall be subjected to all procedures specified by contract which are applicable
to the device construction. If a device does not conform to the specific requirements herein, or contains systemic
anomalies known to directly affect reliability, the disposition of the lot shall be according to contract. Random
anomalies detected when devices are subjected to tests or examinations which are additional, or more rigorous than
those in the detail specification, for the product assurance level being inspected, shall be noted in the report but shall
not cause the lot to be considered nonconforming.
Techniques See
Electrical testing in accordance with group A, subgroup II of
4.3
detail specification
Electrical testing in accordance with group A, subgroups III 4.4
and IV and design ratings
External visual 4.5
Radiographic inspection 4.6
Hermetic seal 4.7
Hermetic seal for polymeric encapsulated devices such as 4.8 and 5.4
bridge assemblies which contain hermetically sealed diodes
shall be performed after the removal of the encapsulant
PIND testing 4.9
Residual gas analysis 4.10
For transparent diodes, internal visual inspection 4.11
Axial lead tensile test 4.12
Resistance to solvents 4.13
Solderability 4.14
Terminal strength 4.15
Decap analysis 5
4.1 General. DPA status shall be completely documented in a report containing the following required
information:
b. Device manufacturer.
4.2 Tests. For MIL-PRF-19500 products, the test methods specified herein shall be performed by specific MIL-
PRF-19500 qualified manufacturers, their customers, or approved sources appearing on the DSCC lab suitability list.
a. Group A, subgroup 2 inspections for room temperature dc tests shall be performed prior to DPA to verify
electrical compliance of the sample. Variables data shall be taken and remain as part of the record for the
lot.
b. Package dimensions as described in the outline drawing shall be measured and recorded when required.
Variables data from incoming or source inspection may be used to satisfy certain requirements of this
procedure if the requirements of 4.2 herein are met and the contracting parties are in agreement.
4.4 Optional electricals. Optional electrical tests such as group A, subgroup 3 of MIL-PRF-19500 for high and low
temperature and subgroup 4 for dynamic characteristics may be performed. Additional design capability tests from
the specification sheet; such as surge current, transient thermal resistance, and temperature coefficient may be
performed. These will be specified by the contract.
4.5 External visual. External visual shall be performed according to method 2071. All text on the device body
shall be recorded. If the identifier BeO is found, the manufacturer shall be contacted for information regarding
alternative decap techniques.
4.6 Radiography inspection. Radiographic inspection shall be performed in accordance with method 2076.
METHOD 2101.1
2
4.7 Hermetic seal. Hermetic shall be performed. Devices shall be subject to gross and fine leak in accordance
with method 1071. Omit the fine leak requirement for double plug construction type diodes. Substitute gross leak,
condition E, as applicable, for double plug types and method 2068 for double plug opaque glass body types. Paint
shall be removed prior to subjecting glass devices to hermetic seal evaluations.
4.8 Hermetic seal for polymeric encapsulated devices. Hermetic seal for polymeric encapsulated devices such as
bridge assemblies, which contain hermetically sealed diodes, shall have the diodes evaluated after removal of the
encapsulant (see 5.4 herein).
4.9 PIND testing. PIND testing shall be performed on devices with internal die cavities to method 2052, condition
A.
4.10 Water vapor testing. Water vapor testing to method 1018 shall be performed on additional unopened
devices to one of the three allowed procedures if it has been determined after delidding (see 5.3 herein) that
corrosion or potentially corrosive elements such as chlorine or potassium salts are present in the cavity.
4.11 Internal visual. Internal visual shall be performed prior to any destructive procedures for diodes of clear
glass construction. Criteria shall be in accordance with method 2074. Opaque or metal can construction shall be
evaluated for internal features after the decap procedure (see 5. herein).
4.12 Axial lead tensile test. Axial lead tensile strength shall be tested in accordance with method 2005.
4.13 Resistance to solvents. Resistance to solvents shall be performed in accordance with method 1022.
4.14 Solderability. Solderability shall be performed on "as received" devices within 30 days of receipt according to
method 2026. Care in handling shall be exercised to prevent lead surface contamination prior to and during this test.
4.15 Terminal strength. Terminal strength shall be performed in accordance with method 2036.
5. Decap analysis. Decapping techniques for die inspection and die bond analysis shall be performed. (All
inspections requiring an intact diode shall be completed at this point.)
a. The diode shall be encapsulated longitudinally in a mounting compound suitable for use as a carrier for
further sample processing. The mounting compound will be selected to have expansion and contraction
properties as close as possible to the device body encapsulant to prevent the generation of stress cracks
in sample preparation.
b. For clear glass construction the sample shall be positioned in such a way that one side of the die is parallel
to the sectioning apparatus (see figure 2101-1). This will assure that polishing of the cross section will
reveal areas from which approximate dimensions may be determined.
c. The sample shall be sectioned using a laboratory grade grinding and lapping table. Precautions shall be
taken to prevent damage to the sample by overly aggressive grit paper selection. In the case of cavity type
constructions, the process of grinding shall stop immediately upon opening the cavity to allow for the
insertion and curing of clear backfilling compound material. This is done to assure that the internal
constituents of the assembly are encased and protected from damage to the die as the grinding process
continues.
d. The DPA sample may be polished and stained to enhance construction details at one or several planes.
The specimen will be recorded by photomicroscopy when it is determined that the center of the die has
been reached (see figure 2101-1). Two photographs will be taken; one containing means for dimensioning
the image, or the optical magnification shall be indicated.
e. Due to the brittle characteristics of the various materials in the construction method, damage may be
induced by the sectioning technique. For glass diodes with metallurgical bond, die, or glass cracks,
damage may be induced as the compression built into the seal is relaxed as the structure is weakened in
the cross sectioning process. This method may not be used for disposition of metallurgical bond voids.
METHOD 2101.1
3
5.2 Scribe, break and dig method for glass axial lead and surface mount types.
a. In this method the device is deliberately destroyed to allow visibility to the die attachment area.
b. The diode body is scored circumferentially at the location of the die plane (see figure 2101-2). This is
usually accomplished with a diamond scribe. The device is then snapped into two pieces. (Observe eye
protection against glass particles). Alternatively the glass body may be chemically dissolved and the die
snapped (provided the die and die metallization are not attacked by the chemical that can be a common
problem with this alternative). At this time the two plug surfaces may be inspected for both silicon and die
metallization residue.
c. The silicon remaining on each plug may be chemically removed to provide visibility to the attachment
interface materials or by further scraping or digging through all of the bond interfaces; however, this step is
not mandatory. Photographs will be taken of both separated attachment surfaces. A means may be
provided in the photo to dimension the image.
5.2.1 Die bond evaluation. Metallurgically bonded construction types shall be evaluated to the requirements of
30.14 of MIL-PRF-19500. Both separated contact interfaces shall be optically evaluated for the bond area in
accordance with table 2101-II (die attach criteria). If a device does not satisfy the die attach criteria, as specified, a
thermal transient response test (method 3101, MIL-STD-750) shall be performed, on a sample basis to establish
acceptability for use.
1/ Dumet silver button design contact area is the entire button top view
area in intimate contact with the plug or braze preform interface.
When both sides of the die are adequately bonded, the button to
silicon interface (the area from which silver has grown, but not
including any area which may be expanded over protective oxides)
may become the area where separation occurs using the scribe and
break technique to open the glass. The button to silicon interface will
then become the measured design contact area. The percent bond
area will be determined by the silicon pulled and remaining on the
backside of the button.
METHOD 2101.1
4
b. For crimp construction, encapsulate one device in a specimen mounting compound suitable for grinding,
lapping, and polishing procedures. Section the crimp perpendicular to the longitudinal axis to the point
where the crimp is made (as determined from the construction details in the drawings or radiographic
image) and determine the quality of the mechanical attachment process (see figure 2101-3).
c. This same sample may be used to observe the construction and dimensions of the internal elements. This
will be accomplished by cross section of the device along the longitudinal axis and backfilling the internal
cavity with epoxy as soon as the case is penetrated to prevent damage in the grinding operations to follow.
Section the device to the approximate center of the die by carefully examining the device at various planes
and reducing the grit abrasiveness to limit sectioning damage. Polish and stain the sample to enhance die
construction. Then photograph the internal elements.
d. To view all internal surfaces, unmounted samples shall be delidded by cutting the crimp terminal just below
the mechanical attachment then removing the lid by cutting circumferentially with a delidding device above
the seating flange (see figure 2101-3). Care must be taken to prevent damage to the post connection at
the top of the die when delidding.
e. The device shall be evaluated for die attachment position, die to preform and header interface, die
topography, and post or "C" bend attachment. Photographs of internal construction will be made.
f. Bond strength testing using method 2037 is optional for construction with metal clips or wires.
g. When practical, die shear or punch testing for metal cans shall be in accordance with method 2017.
a. Complex devices such as bridges containing several discrete devices shall be evaluated externally for all
major features as applicable and described above for individual devices.
b. Internal construction shall be evaluated by removing the device encapsulating material with appropriate
reagents using standard laboratory practice. Where uncertainty about the destructiveness of chemicals
exists on internal construction elements, experiments on electrical rejects should occur or the manufacturer
should be contacted for guidance.
c. Individual diode placement and method of attachment to assembly terminals shall be evaluated. Attention
shall be focused on internal conductor diameters and minimum bridging distance of electrically isolated
points.
d. Individual discrete diodes shall be removed from the assembly in a manner which does not impart
mechanical shock or overtemperature conditions. They shall be evaluated according to the method
appropriate to their construction as specified in the appropriate method herein.
METHOD 2101.1
5
METHOD 2101.1
6
METHOD 2101.1
7
METHOD 2102
1. Purpose. This test method describes procedures and evaluation guidelines for the destructive physical
analysis (DPA) of wire bonded semiconductor devices. It is intended to provide techniques for determining
compliance with construction requirements, as well as evaluating processes, consistency, and workmanship with
respect to MIL-PRF-19500 requirements.
2. Scope. This method covers all hermetically sealed, wire bonded device types.
3. Requirements
3.1 Apparatus. Equipment requirements shall be as specified in the various test methods for each procedure
listed. Equipment for delidding will vary from package to package and may be custom built or provided
commercially.
3.2 Sampling. Sampling for DPA shall be specified in the applicable detail specification or acquisition procedure
requirements, by contract. If no quantity is given, three parts shall be used. If internal water vapor (RGA) is to be
performed in 4.9, this sample shall be separate. Parts used for DPA testing must pass group A, subgroup 2 testing
as a minimum.
3.3 Applicable inspections. MIL-PRF-19500, the applicable specification sheet, the reliability level, and any order
or contract requirements determine if a listed inspection is applicable. In the event of a conflict, the following order of
precedence shall be applied; a) purchase order or contract, b) specification sheet, c) MIL-PRF-19500, and d)
individual test methods. The actual revisions of the specifications referenced within shall be determine from the date
code unless superseded by the order or contract or the specification sheet. For the purpose of investigation, higher
magnifications than specified or alternate equipment may be used; however, the report shall clearly indicate whether
the observed phenomena was a violation when inspected at the prescribed inspection magnification, at the time of
manufacture. The term "when specified" is used herein to identify tests specified in MIL-PRF-19500 which do not
apply to all quality levels. These tests are to be performed only on device types which require them as part of the
manufacturing process.
4. Procedure. Unless otherwise stated, inspections shall be performed in the order specified.
4.1 Device identification. If unique serial numbers do not already exist identifying each device, they shall be
assigned to the sample devices. Serial number identity of all samples and parts of samples shall be maintained
throughout the complete analytical process.
4.3 Record markings. The report shall include all markings on the device such as part number, manufacturer,
date code, and serial number.
4.4 Electrical test. Group A, subgroup 2 reverse leakage and "on" parameters shall be read and recorded. If read
and record data traceable to each individual sample has been previously taken and submitted with the samples, this
testing need not be repeated. Sustaining voltage and thermal tests are not to be attempted by the DPA lab since
special test circuits or equipment may be required to prevent device damage.
4.5 Hermeticity. Perform gross leak testing in accordance with method 1071, and the associated specification
sheet. Fine leak shall be performed if RGA is required in 4.10.
4.6 Radiographic Inspection. When specified, perform radiographic inspection in accordance with method 2076.
4.7 PARTICLE IMPACT NOISE DETECTION. When specified, perform PIND test in accordance with method
2052, condition A or B. Devices failing PIND shall have particle capture, particle dimensional analysis, and particle
element (chemical) analysis performed.
METHOD 2102
1 of 3
4.8 Decapsulation. Delidding may be performed by any method, however, since delidding techniques require a
level of skill and special equipment in good condition to prevent damage to internal components, any internal
damage or anomalies observed shall be cause to review the delidding technique used and the potential for the
damage or anomaly to have been caused by the delidding process. The decapsulation process used shall be
detailed in the DPA report.
4.8.1 Photographs. Two magnified photographs shall be taken with a magnification such that in the first one, little
more than both ends of all wires are visible (or would be visible if an opaque coating used were not present) and in
the second, the chip fills the field of view to the maximum possible.
4.8.2 Design verification. Perform design verification in accordance with method 2075.
a. If a design base line exists, the DPA samples shall be compared to that baseline. Differences shall be
documented but may not be rejectable if the difference only involves one or more of the following.
(2) The position of the wire bonds within the same wire bonding terminal or pad.
Violations of the specified internal visual requirements (when specified) take precedence over the above
allowances.
b. If no prior baseline exists, the construction details may be requested from the manufacturers design group.
Manufacturers shall not be required to provide details unless such agreements were made in advance of
purchase.
4.9 Conformal coating removal. If applicable chemicals used to remove compliant coatings must be compatible
with remaining materials of interest. Procedures and materials shall be documented and shall be indicated in the
DPA report. It is encouraged that a chemical recommendation be obtained from the manufacturer of the device
when the manufacturer is not performing the DPA. Additional photos shall be taken in accordance with 4.8.1
following coating removal, and 4.10 shall be repeated.
4.10 Internal visual (when specified). When specified, perform internal visual in accordance with method 2072 for
transistors, method 2069 for method 2073 for diode elements. In the event that foreign material (loose or attached)
is found:
a. Identify the elements contained in that material using Energy Dispersive Spectroscopy (EDS) or other
suitable techniques.
(2) Establish the presence of moisture within the package using internal water vapor (RGA), method 2018
of MIL-STD-883, dew point method 1018 or other suitable means.
(3) If the moisture level passes, the presence of free ions is acceptable.
(4) Data from any DPA performed by or directed by the original equipment manufacturer that shows
defects to this test method shall be shared with the manufacturer.
METHOD 2102
2
4.11 Bond strength. Perform bond pull in accordance with method 2037.
4.12 SEM. When specified perform SEM examination as required in accordance with the specification sheet
and method 2077.
4.13 Die shear. Perform die shear in accordance with method 2017 unless specified otherwise in the
specification sheet.
5.1 Data recording. The data taken at each step of the analysis shall be permanently recorded. The data sheet
shall be referenced as an outline for the testing flow. This data shall identify the test method used for each step, the
results obtained for each sample device at each step, the identity of the person performing each step, and the date
on which each step was accomplished. Photographs, additional comment sheets, and any data taken by agencies
other than the DPA lab shall be clearly identified to maintain traceability to each sample device.
5.2 Report. The analysis report shall identify the part number, lot number, manufacturer, and source of the
sample devices. The report shall include the one of all data generated during the analysis. A separate summary of
any noncomformances or anomalous conditions found shall be included. The reporting laboratory may include
comments or recommendations to the requesting agency if they deem this appropriate.
5.2.1 Sample retention. All samples, along with one copy of the final DPA report, shall be stored and available for
review for a minimum of 5 years from the date of the report.
5.3 Acceptance. This test method only specifies the procedures to be used in DPA. Fitness for use of the
devices represented by the analyzed sample must be determined by the agency requesting the DPA. Acceptance or
rejection of the lot shall be as contractually agreed between the manufacturer and the procuring activity.
6. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified by the agency requesting the DPA:
c. Any tests to be added to, or deleted from, those specified in this test method.
METHOD 2102
3
METHOD 2103
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to qualify the ability of a surface mounted package to withstand the stresses
developed by a thermal mismatch (due to differences in thermal expansion properties) between a standard printed
circuit card and the device under evaluation.
2. Scope. This test procedure is applicable to all surface mount device packages.
3. Background. The initial issue of this test method is intended for the evaluation of leadless packages. Alternate
engineering or characterization data may also be used to demonstrate performance under the stresses imposed by
this test. No attempt has been made to include conformal coatings in this test since the wide range of compounds
and use conditions precludes standardization.
4. Requirements. Testing shall be performed in accordance with IPC-9701, test condition TC1, and test duration
NTC-E.
METHOD 2103
1 of 1
3000 Series
METHOD 3001.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine if the breakdown voltage of the device under the specified
conditions is greater than the specified minimum limit.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short circuit to the terminals between which the current
is being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the ammeter drop.
3. Procedure. The resistor R1 is a current-limiting resistor and should be of sufficiently high resistance to avoid
excessive current flowing through the device and current meter. The voltage shall be gradually increased, with the
specified bias conditions (condition A, B, C, or D) applied, from zero until either the minimum limit for V(BR)CBX or
the specified test current is reached. The device is acceptable if the minimum limit for V(BR)CBX is reached before
the test current reaches the specified value. If the specified test current is reached first, the device is rejected.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Bias condition:
METHOD 3005.1
BURNOUT BY PULSING
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the capabilities of the device to withstand pulses.
2. Procedure. The device shall be subjected to a pulse or pulses of the length, voltages, currents, and repetition
rate specified with the specified prepulse conditions.
3. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3005.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3011.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine if the breakdown voltage of the device under the specified
conditions is greater than the specified minimum limit.
NOTES:
1. A PNP device is shown. For NPN types, reverse the polarities of the voltage and bias sources
and zener diode.
2. An electronic switch, S may be necessary to provide pulses of short duty cycle to minimize the
rise of junction temperature.
3. The current sensor, or ammeter, shall present essentially a short circuit to the terminals between
which the current is being measured, or the voltage readings shall be corrected accordingly.
4. It is important to prevent, or dampen, potentially damaging oscillations in devices exhibiting
negative resistance breakdown characteristics. Protection can be in the form of a circuit which
circumvents the negative resistance region, such as one which provides suitable base current as
the collector voltage is increased; however, the specified bias condition and test current must be
applied when the voltage is measured. Additional protection can be provided with a zener diode,
or transient voltage protection circuit to limit to collector voltage at, or slightly above, the specified
minimum limit.
5. Regardless of the protection used, extreme care must be exercised to ensure the collector
current and junction temperature remain at a safe value, as given in the applicable specification
sheet.
METHOD 3011.2
1 of 2
3. Procedure. The resistor R1 is a current-limiting resistor and should be of sufficiently high resistance to avoid
excessive current flowing through the device and current sensor. The voltage shall be increased, with the specified
bias conditions (condition A, B, C, or D) applied, until the specified test current is reached. The device is acceptable
if the voltage applied at the specified test current is greater than the minimum limit for V(BR)CEX.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Duty cycle and pulse width, when required (see figure 3011-1, above).
c. Bias condition:
METHOD 3011.2
2
METHOD 3015
DRIFT
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the drift of a parameter specified in the applicable
specification sheet of the device.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus used for the performance of the drift test shall be the same as that utilized for
testing the associated parameter.
3. Procedure. The voltages and currents specified in the applicable specification sheet shall be applied. In the
period from 10 seconds to 1 minute, the measurement specified in the applicable specification sheet shall drift no
more than the amount specified in the applicable specification sheet.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3015
1 of 1
METHOD 3020
FLOATING POTENTIAL
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the dc potential between the specified, open-circuited terminal
and reference terminal when a dc potential is applied to the other specified terminals.
NOTE: The circuit shown is for measuring the emitter floating potential. For other device
configurations, the above circuitry should be modified in such a manner that is capable of
demonstrating device conformance to the minimum requirements of the individual
specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The specified dc voltage shall be applied to the specified terminals and the dc voltage of the
open-circuited terminal and reference terminal shall be monitored.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3020
1 of 1
METHOD 3026.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine if the breakdown voltage of the device under the specified
conditions is greater than the specified minimum limit.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the
current is being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the ammeter drop.
3. Procedure. The resistor R1 is a current-limiting resistor and should be of sufficiently high resistance to avoid
excessive current flowing through the device and current meter. The voltage shall be gradually increased, with the
specified condition (A, B, C, or D) applied, from zero until either the minimum limit for V(BR)EBX or the specified test
current is reached. The device is acceptable if the minimum limit for V(BR)EBX is reached before the test current
reaches the specified value. If the specified test current is reached first, the device is rejected.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Bias condition:
METHOD 3026.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3030
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the voltage between the collector and emitter of the device
under specified conditions.
3. Procedure. The bias supplies shall be adjusted until the specified voltages and currents are achieved. The
voltage between the collector and emitter shall then be measured. If high current values are to be used in this
measurement, suitable pulse techniques may be used to provide pulses of short duty cycle to minimize the rise in
junction temperature.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3030
1 of 1
METHOD 3036.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the cutoff current of the device under the specified conditions.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
3. Procedure. The specified dc voltage shall be applied between the collector and the base with the specified
bias condition (A, B, C, or D) applied to the emitter. The measurement of current shall be made at the specified
ambient or case temperature.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Test temperature if other than +25C 3C and whether case or ambient (see 3.).
c. Bias condition:
METHOD 3036.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3041.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the cutoff current of the device under the specified conditions.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
3. Procedure. The specified voltage shall be applied between the collector and emitter with the specified bias
condition (A, B, C, or D) applied to the base. The measurement of current shall be made at the specified ambient or
case temperature.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Test temperature if other than +25C 3C and whether case or ambient (see 3.).
c. Bias condition:
METHOD 3041.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3051
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to verify the boundary of the Safe Operating Area (SOA) of a transistor as
constituted by the interdependency of the specified voltage, current, power, and temperature in a temperature stable
circuit.
3. Procedure.
a. Starting with VCC and VEE at a low value, increase VCC to approximately obtain specified VCE. Increase
VEE to approximately obtain specified IC. Increase VCC and subsequently adjust VEE to obtain specified
VCE and IC. Operate the transistor at the specified temperature and for the specified time duration.
b. Decrease VCC to obtain VCE near zero. Turn off VEE. Turn off VCC.
c. The transistor shall be considered a failure if IC varies 10 percent during operation, or exceeds the end-
points.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
METHOD 3052
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to verify the capability of a transistor to withstand pulses of specific
voltage, current, and time, establishing a SOA.
3. Procedure. Starting at a low value, adjust VBB2 and VCC to the specified levels. With the duty cycle and
pulse width preset to specified conditions, increase VBB1 voltage to achieve the specified IC.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
(4) Values for RBB2, RBB1, and VBB2 (see figure 3052-1).
MEHTOD 3052
1 of 1
METHOD 3053
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to verify the capability of a transistor to withstand switching between
saturation and cutoff for various specified loads, establishing a SOA.
3. Procedure. The output load circuit configuration shall be as specified (condition A, B, or C). Starting at a low
value, adjust VBB2 and VCC to the specified levels. With the duty cycle and repetition rate preset to specified
conditions, increase VBB1 voltage to achieve the specified IC; and the output waveform (IC versus VCE) shall be
observed on the scope. When the transistor is turned off (switched), the observed trace shall be a smooth curve
between saturation and cutoff. Any oscillations or inconsistencies on the trace shall be cause for rejection.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
b. Load condition:
A: Resistive load.
Condition B: Values of RL, IC, VCC, diode type or characteristics, inductance and dc resistance of L.
Condition C: Values of IC, VCC, and characteristics of inductor L including its inductance, Q, dc
resistance, and resonant frequency.
METHOD 3053
2
METHOD 3061.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the cutoff current of the device under the specified conditions.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
3. Procedure. The specified direct current voltages shall be applied between the emitter and the base with the
specified bias condition (condition A, B, C, or D) applied to the collector. The measurement of current shall be made
at the specified ambient or case temperature.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
b. Test temperature if other than +25C 3C and whether ambient or case (see 3.).
c. Bias condition
METHOD 3061.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3066.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the base to emitter voltage of the device in either a saturated
or nonsaturated condition.
2. Test circuit. Circuit and procedure shown are for base to emitter. For other parameters the circuit and
procedure should be changed accordingly. (See figure 3066-1)
NOTE: If necessary, switch S shall be used to provide pulses of short duty cycle to
minimize the rise in junction temperature. When pulsing techniques are used,
oscillograph methods shall be used to measure VBE and the other necessary
parameters and the duty cycle and pulse width shall be specified.
FIGURE 3066-1. Test circuit for base emitter voltage (saturated or nonsaturated).
3. Procedure.
3.1 Test condition A (saturated). The resistor R1 shall be made large. If the pulse method is used, the resistor R2
shall be chosen in combination with VCC so that the specified collector current is achieved at a value of VCC low
enough to ensure that the device will not be operated in breakdown between pulses. If the pulse method is not
used, resistor R2 can be any convenient value. The current IB and voltage VCC shall be adjusted until IB and IC
achieve their specified values. Then, VBE = VBE(sat).
3.2 Test condition B (nonsaturated). For this test, resistor R2 shall be zero. The specified values of IB and VCE
shall be applied. VBE is then measured. Alternately, the specified VCE shall be applied and IB adjusted to obtain
the specified IC.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
d. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3066.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3071
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the saturation voltage and resistance of the device under the
specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. Circuit and procedure shown are for collector to emitter. For other parameters the circuit and
procedure should be changed accordingly. (See figure3071-1.)
NOTE: If necessary, switch S shall be used to provide pulses of short duty cycle to minimize
the rise in junction temperature. When pulsing techniques are used, oscillograph methods
shall be used to measure VBE and the other necessary parameters and the duty cycle and
pulse width shall be specified.
3. Procedure. The resistor R1 shall be made large. If the pulse method is used, resistor R2 shall be chosen in
combination with VCC so that the specified collector current may be achieved at a value of VCC low enough to
ensure that the device is not operated in breakdown between pulses. If pulse methods are not used, R2 may be any
convenient value. The current IB and VCC shall be adjusted until IB and IC achieve their specified values. VCE(sat) is
then equal to the voltage measured by voltmeter VCE under the specified conditions. Saturation resistance may be
determined from the same circuit conditions, as follows:
V CE (sat)
r CE(sat) =
IC
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3071
1 of 1
METHOD 3076.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the forward-current transfer ratio of the device under the
specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. Circuit and procedure shown are for common emitter. For other parameters the circuit and
procedure should be changed accordingly. (See figure 3076-1)
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short circuit to the terminals between which the
current is being measured or the voltmeter shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
3. Procedure. The voltage VCE shall be set to the specified value and the current IB shall be adjusted until the
specified current IC is achieved.
IC
Then, hFE =
IB
If high-current values are to be used in this measurement, switch S shall be used to provide pulses of short duty
cycle to minimize the rise in junction temperature. When pulsing techniques are used, oscillograph methods may be
used to measure IC and IB.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3076.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3086.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the input resistance of the device under the specified
conditions.
2. Test circuit. Circuit and procedure shown are for common emitter. For other parameters the circuit and
procedure should be changed accordingly. (See figure 3086-1)
NOTE: If necessary, switch S shall be used to provide pulses of short duty cycle to minimize the
rise in junction temperature. When pulsing techniques are used, oscillograph methods shall be
used to measure VBE and other necessary parameters and the duty cycle and pulse width shall
be specified.
3. Procedure. The resistor R1 shall be made large. If the pulse method is used, resistor R2 shall be chosen in
combination with VCC so that the specified collector current is achieved at a value of VCC low enough to ensure that
the device will not be operated in breakdown between pulses. If the pulse method is not used, resistor R2 can be
any convenient value. The current IB and VCC shall be adjusted until IB and IC achieve their specified values.
V BE
Then: h IE =
IB
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3086.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3092.1
STATIC TRANSCONDUCTANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the static transconductance of the device under the specified
conditions.
NOTE: For other configurations, the circuit may be modified in such a manner that it is capable of
demonstrating device conformance to the minimum requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The resistor R1 shall be made large or the voltage source VBB shall be replaced by a constant
current source. The resistor R2 shall be chosen in combination with VCC so that the specified collector current is
achieved at a value of VCC which is lower than V(BR)CEO. The current IB shall be adjusted until VCE and IC
achieve their specified values. The current IC or IE and the voltages VBE, VBC, or VEB shall then be measured.
Using the values obtained through these measurements, the static transconductance shall be calculated as follows:
If high current values are to be used in the measurement, suitable pulse techniques may be used to provide pulses
of short duty cycle to minimize the rise in junction temperature.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
METHOD 3092.1
1 of 1
3100 Series
For thermal-resistance measurements, at least three temperature sensitive parameters (TSP) of the transistor can be
used; the collector to base cutoff current, ICBO; the forward voltage drop of the emitter to base diode, VEB; and the
forward voltage drop of the collector to base diode, VCB. The methods described in this standard refer to the thermal
resistance between specified reference points of the device. For this type of measurement, power is applied to the
device at two values of case, ambient, or other reference point temperature, such that identical values of ICBO, VEB,
or VCB are read during the cooling portion of the measurement.
METHOD 3100
1. Purpose. This purpose of this test is to verify a desired junction temperature (TJ) is achieved during burn-in and
life-test environments, and is conducted on a representative sample of devices. There are two methods that may be
used. Both use a temperature sensitive parameter (TSP) that is initially measured at the desired TJ and selected
test-current levels. In the first test, method A, a selected low measuring current that does not cause significant self-
heating is used (similar to thermal resistance test methods). In the second test, method B, a series of sequential
current pulses are taken to characterize the TSP at the desired TJ in the same operating current region expected for
the burn-in and life-test environments. These TSP values are again later compared during burn-in or life-test to verify
the same TJ. In either case, a direct sampling method of TJ in the burn-in or life-test environment minimizes or
eliminates possible errors introduced by ambient conditions, K factor, and non-linearity of component thermal
resistance when applied at high temperatures. The method also allows the burn-in and life-test environment to be
accurately characterized for thermal resistance junction to ambient (RJA) that can be used again to further advantage
for similar products in the same test environment.
2. Scope. This applies to diode and transistor bipolar products requiring TJ verification during power burn-in that
generates self-heating of TJ well above ambient or case temperature with applied power. It may also use an oven
chamber or hot plate for achieving elevated ambient or case temperatures. The applied power testing may include ac
operating life (ACOL) conditions for rectifiers, dc power in the operating breakdown region for zeners, and forward dc
power conditions for signal diodes and others. Transistors also involve applied dc power conditions. This generally
does not apply to high temperature reverse bais (HTRB) unless sufficient power is applied to cause significant self-
heating. Equivalent heating power options are also described in method A to accommodate existing TSP equipment
measurement methods for thermal resistance.
3. Rationale. Increased requirements for semiconductor performance, reliability, and quality have forced the need
for knowledge and greater accuracy of semiconductor devices TJ at burn-in and life-testing. This is necessary for
making long-term calculations for reliability levels if using accelerating effects of burn-in or life-testing.
Accurate TJ measurements can be difficult because of the many variables. Electrical considerations (power, voltage-
current levels, waveforms, etc.), environmental consideration (mounting configuration, surroundings, mounting
methodology, etc.), and selection of the TJ sensing method will affect results. It should also be noted that the thermal
resistance characteristics of any semiconductor device are not necessarily constant with temperature or power
dissipation, thus requiring thermal measurements under conditions that best duplicate actual operation in the burn-in
or life-test environment for determining TJ.
4. Symbols and definitions. Many features are identical to those used for measuring thermal resistance for method
A. For both methods, the burn-in and life-test environment shall simply be known as the test environment. Further
details may be found in other references including EIA-531, JESD51-1, and test methods 3101, 3131, and 4081 of
this general specification.
b. TJ Junction temperature.
METHOD 3100
1 of 11
i. IH Heating current.
j. tH Heating time.
l. PH Heating power.
m. VF Forward voltage.
p. IC Collector current.
q. IB Base current.
s. VZ Zener voltage.
t. IF Forward current.
w. EC End-cap.
5.1 TSP measurement. Test equipment to initially measure the TSP in a controlled temperature chamber, bath, or
hot plate is required at a desired TJ for the sample DUT.
5.2 Power supplies and arrays. The equipment used shall also include the burn-in or life-test power supplies and
panel/socket arrays for electrical contacts or heat sinking where the TJ is to be sample measured for the DUTs. This
test environment is the same as used for all other remaining devices intended for burn-in screening or life-test.
5.3 Oven chamber. An oven chamber, bath, or hot plate to place the panel socket arrays with all the devices shall
be used if elevated ambient temperatures are required.
5.4 Measuring TSP. For method A, equipment for measuring the TSP shall be similar to that described for thermal
resistance in EIA-531, JESD51-1, test methods 3101, 3131, or 4081. The TSP is sampled in a short measurement
delay time (tMD) after switching to a low measuring current (IM) from the applied heating power source. The duty
factor for sampling the TSP shall be 1percent or less of the heating time (tH). It is considered optimum to use the
same mode of power or heating current (IH) as the power used in the test environment conditions. However, this
method also allows for a dc forward heating current (IH) power source often used in thermal resistance test methods
to provide equivalent rms power.
METHOD 3100
2
5.5 Sample-and-hold tester. For method B, a sample-and-hold tester for recording a sequential set of TSP
measurements at operating currents in the same vicinity as the test environment operating current is required such as
a Frothingham VF40, or equivalent, with the approval of the quality activity. The test pulses shall be kept narrow and
widely spaced where additional heating of the junction will be insignificant.
5.6 Voltage and current measurements. In method B, a voltmeter and current meter shall be used to accurately
measure the expected voltage and current levels in the test.
5.7 Thermocouple. A small bare-wire thermocouple of 36 AWG is required for ACOL evaluation.
6. Procedure for method A. This method uses a selected low measuring current for the TSP that does not cause
significant self-heating (similar to thermal resistance test methods). The DUTs are a sample of serialized devices
where the TSP is initially recorded at the desired temperature. They shall also be of the same construction as other
devices in the test environment and be of sufficient quantity to provide a good sample for averaging. Unless
otherwise specified, this shall be a minimum of five devices.
6.1 TSP measurement. First determine the nominal TJ desired for the burn-in or life-test. For military burn-in
screening, the minimum TJ shall be specified by the applicable spec sheet. The maximum TJ is the rating for the DUT
unless otherwise specified.
6.1.1 Desired TJ. In a separate temperature controlled chamber, bath, or hot-plate environment, the nominal TJ
desired for the burn-in or life-test will initially be established within plus or minus 2C (or as required) for recording the
TSP. Additional TJ tolerance considerations are also noted in 6.3.3.
6.1.2 Recording TSP. After the DUTs have been introduced and brought to thermal equilibrium, the TSP shall be
recorded in a serialized manner at a low steady-state measuring current (IM) for method A. This would be the forward
voltage of a diode (VF) or base emitter voltage (VBE) of a transistor. The magnitude of IM shall be large enough to
ensure the VF or VBE is turned on, but not large enough to cause significant self heating. For transistors, it is optimum
to remove any bias voltage to the collector that generates current gain affecting IM. However some thermal
resistance equipment requires use of a collector voltage for a VBE measurement. If so, that same test condition shall
be used for measuring the TSP in burn-in as described in 6.3.2 and 6.4.1.e.
6.2.1 Verifing TJ. The sample DUTs shall then be mounted in the test environment using sockets strategically
located representing the coolest and hottest regions to verify TJ. This shall also include all other devices intended for
the power test environment to duplicate the same cumulative heating effects. Those sockets used for the DUTs shall
also be the same design as all others in the test environment. The DUTs shall also be electrically connected to the
TSP measuring equipment that requires a set of Kelvin-sense leads to monitor junction voltage. The leads shall be
attached so as to minimize heat sinking. Also see 6.5 on further ACOL considerations.
6.3.1 Ambient temperature. The ambient temperature (TA) shall be as specified at thermal equilibrium conditions
including any convection or circulating air effects in an oven chamber where applicable. For hot-plate applications,
the surface temperature and uniformity shall also be as specified to achieve desired case temperature (TC) control as
stated in 6.1.1 and 6.4.1.c.
6.3.2 Appling current or power. The same heating current (or equivalent rms power) shall be applied in increasing
increments for all devices while sampling for TSP on each DUT with a low duty factor at IM in accordance with
equipment description in 5.4. Working with each serialized DUT one at a time, monitor the junction voltage TSP at IM
while slowly increasing the heating current. The TSP will decline with increasing TJ for VF or VBE.
METHOD 3100
3
6.3.3 TSP for the desired TJ. 6.3.1 and 6.3.2 shall be repeated until the same TSP is achieved for the desired TJ in
step 6.1.2 on the sample DUTs after the same equivalent current or rms power is applied for all devices in the test
environment. The power applied for this desired TJ level for each DUT shall be recorded. The average power for the
DUTs shall also be determined and used as the value thereafter for applied power per unit during burn-in or life-test
in 6.3.4. If thermal resistance from junction to ambient (RJA) is desired for future reference as described in 10.2, the
TA should also be recorded at this time.
NOTE: The TJ is also selected based on overall tolerances of the test environment. Also see 10.3 and equation 9 for
slight TJ variations with the averaging effects of applied power above. For worst-case tolerances, the TJ should be
placed nominally at the midpoint between the minimum and maximum allowed TJ required for the test environment.
For example, this may be 155C if the minimum is 135C and maximum is 175C. If either the applied heating power
(PH) or the desired TJ exceeds the DUT ratings, see steps 6.3.3.1 and 6.3.3.2. If not, proceed to 6.3.4.
6.3.3.1 Current and power ratings. If applied heating current or power PH exceeds the rating of the device for
burn-in screening to achieve the desired TJ, the following options apply:
b. The TA may be increased until the desired TJ is achieved when allowed in the applicable specification sheet.
c. The current or power may be increased not to exceed the current density capability of the device.
6.3.3.2 TJ for JANS. The TJ may be higher than typical device ratings of 150C to 200C when applied to JANS
life-test of MIL-PRF-19500 for a faster accelerated test environment. These may be specified at TJ values of 225C
to 275C. However, these options shall not exceed temperatures where the DUTs (and remaining devices) cannot
operate effectively as a semiconductor in the test environment. This may also be identified as the intrinsic or
secondary breakdown region (thermal generation of electron-hole pairs starts approaching or exceeding the
background doping levels of the PN junctions). This may also be observed by significant increases in reverse
leakage current, or in more severe cases, the decline (or collapse) of reverse breakdown voltage (VBR) on rectifiers,
VZ for higher voltage zeners, or VCE for transistors. Also see note in 6.4.1.b for rectifiers.
6.3.4 Criteria once TJ is achieved. After the desired TJ is achieved for all devices, the burn-in or life-test may
proceed with the average power per unit in 6.3.3 until completed for the required number of hours.
6.4 Power requirements. It is desirable to apply the same type of rms heating power required for the test
environment in 6.3 for each DUT as applied to all other devices before switching to the IM level for measuring the
TSP. However power supply equipment for thermal resistance test methods using dc forward heating current (IH) and
a low duty factor sample-and-hold method at IM for the TSP may not offer that added flexibility. In such cases, the
same equivalent rms PH may be used with a forward-heating current (IH) as described in thermal resistance test
methods where PH = IH x VH. When equivalent rms heating power is in question, the duplication of lead, case, or end-
cap temperatures (TL, TC or TEC) is required to verify identical rms power as described in 6.5 for ACOL
considerations.
METHOD 3100
4
a. Signal and Schottky diodes (dc burn-in with IF): The required heating power is forward dc current (IF)
multiplied times the forward voltage (VF) observed during the dc burn-in or life-test (or PH = IF x VF). No
equipment handicaps should exist with this test environment since IF equates to the forward heating current
(IH) for thermal resistance test methods.
b. Rectifiers (ACOL burn-in with IO): The required ac operating life at rated IO may be approximated in equivalent
rms heating power by PH = IO (0.107 + 0.785 VFM) where VFM is the peak forward voltage observed during the
half-sine wave and IO is the rated average rectified output current for 50 Hz or 60 Hz sine-wave input and a
180 degree conduction angle (see JESD282). With this definition, the peak forward current in each half-sine
wave is 3.14 x IO. This PH also assumes the power in the reverse direction is negligible due to leakage current
(IR) and applied reverse voltage (VRRM) as defined in JESD282 or test method 1038 of MIL-STD-750.
For equipment limitations to measure TSP, the DUT samples may also use the same effective forward power
where PH is the forward heating current (IH) multiplied times the forward heating voltage (VH) as described in
6.4. The same effective power with ACOL may be verified with identical TL, TC, or TEC. See 6.5 to measure
TL, TC, or TEC. Also see background information in 9.3 for the correlation of RMS power with TL, TC, or TEC.
NOTE: A reverse power loss may not be observed if limiting resistors have externally absorbed the intended
reverse voltage (VRRM) in an ACOL test environment due to high leakage currents (IR x R voltage drop), or due
to collapsing voltage as described in 6.3.3.2. The required VRRM shall be sample monitored to verify it has
been successfully applied where applicable to all the other remaining rectifier devices under ACOL power.
Limiting or ballast resistors are often used in series with each device that are then placed in parallel array
connections with typical power supplies for burn-in or life-test methods. This regulates IO or limits excessive
current flow if a device electrically degrades or shorts to allow continued burn-in or life-testing of remaining
devices for the period of time required.
c. Schottky (HTRB burn-in with IR): To minimize high power and burn-in current levels, the required PH is applied
as an HTRB with reverse voltage (VR) and selected range of reverse current (IR) for all devices at elevated
temperature. At low power where there is no significant self heating, the TC may be assumed the same value
as TJ. In this example, the PH = IR x VR where IR is increased at elevated temperature. For test equipment
options, the DUT sample may also use the equivalent forward rms power (PH) as described in 6.4. Where
applicable, the TC may simply be measured directly for the TJ equivalent as described in 8.
d. Zeners (dc burn-in with IZ): The required PH is the zener burn-in current (IZ) multiplied times the nominal zener
voltage (VZ) where PH = IZ x VZ. The VZ is also adjusted for the expected TJ using the rated temperature
coefficient of the zener (VZ). For equipment limitations, the DUT sample may use the equivalent forward rms
power (PH) as described in 6.4.
e. Transistors (dc burn-in with IC): The required heating power is the collector current (IC) multiplied times the
collector emitter voltage (VCE) during the dc burn-in or life-test plus any significant base current (IB) multiplied
times base emitter voltage (VBE) where PH = IC x VCE + IB x VBE. Typically the IB x VBE power may be
negligible. The low duty factor sample measurement for the TSP shall be with the same conditions as in 6.1.2.
METHOD 3100
5
6.5 ACOL considerations (rectifiers). If the parts for burn-in or life-test are to receive ACOL conditions, an
additional step shall be added after 6.2.1 to ensure equivalent heating and TJ to the DUT samples.
6.5.1 Thermocouple mounting. When the voltage monitoring leads are being attached to the DUTs for testing in
the burn-in configuration in 6.2.1, also solder on a fine 36 AWG bare wire thermocouple to each of them. The
thermocouple should be mounted at zero distance from the body of the part. The thermocouple shall be mounted to
not interfere when the DUT is placed in the burn-in or life-test fixtures.
6.5.2 Thermocouple usage. Also solder a thermocouple as described in 6.5.1 to the nearest device of each DUT
location that receives ACOL power in the test environment.
6.5.3 Thermocouple temperature. As each of the serialized DUT parts are set to the desired TJ using the dc
current method in the burn-in or life-test environment, also record the thermocouple temperature reading. These
thermocouple readings are then used to set the ac power levels in 6.5.4.
6.5.4 Average TJ. Apply power to heat the remaining diodes using the required ACOL while monitoring the
thermocouple temperature. Increase the ac power input until the thermocouple in 6.5.2 reaches the temperature
level of the DUTs in 6.5.3 at the desired TJ. Record the ACOL power conditions applied for each device described in
6.5.2. These values are then averaged for determining ACOL power applied for all devices. This process
guarantees that all the devices will be tested at the required average TJ for burn-in or life-test. Also see 9.3 for further
background information.
NOTE: The rectifier diode with the lowest VF or the lowest ambient temperature (TA) position in the test environment
would require the greatest power for a given thermocouple reading to ensure the same TJ is achieved.
7. Procedure for method B. This method uses a sequential set of current pulses to characterize the TSP at the TJ
in the same operating current region expected for the burn-in or life-test environment. The DUTs are a sample of
devices where the TSP is recorded at the desired temperature. They shall also be of the same construction as other
devices in the test environment and shall be of sufficient quantity to provide a good sample for averaging. Unless
otherwise specified, this shall be a minimum of five devices.
7.1 TSP measurement. First determine the nominal TJ desired for the burn-in or life-test. For military burn-in
screening, the minimum TJ shall be specified by the applicable specification sheet. The maximum TJ is the rating for
the DUT unless otherwise specified.
7.1.1 Desired TJ. In a separate temperature controlled chamber, bath, or hot-plate environment, the nominal TJ
desired for the burn-in or life-test will initially be established within 2C (or as required) for recording the TSP.
Additional TJ tolerance considerations are also noted in 7.3.3.
METHOD 3100
6
7.1.2 Recording TSP measurements. A sample-and-hold tester shall be programmed for recording a sequential
set of TSP measurements at operating currents in the same vicinity as anticipated for the test environment. This will
perform incremental pulse VF-IF, VZ-IZ, or VBE-ICE tests.
a. Choose the incremental current range so that the recorded values will be centered near the current level that is
expected for the burn-in or life-test environment.
b. Program the sample-and-hold test equipment to record junction TSP voltage readings with a sufficiently low
duty factor that will not warm the DUT when taking sequential readings. Typical test parameters for a leaded
switching diode may be as follows:
NOTE: The smaller the incremental steps, the more accurate the chart will be when correlating to values taken in
burn-in or life-test. Since this test is performed with a low duty factor power and thermally stable parts, any holding
fixture may be used, but Kelvin leads are required.
7.1.3 Data. After the DUTs have been introduced and brought to thermal equilibrium, the TSP shall be recorded in
a serialized manner by cycling each part through the expected current range and printing out the data for each
identified device. Each set of data is applicable only for that particular serialized part and TJ.
7.2.1 Verify TJ. The sample DUTs shall then be mounted in the test environment using sockets strategically
located representing the coolest and hottest regions to verify TJ. All other devices intended for burn-in or life-test
shall also be mounted in the test environment to duplicate the same cumulative heating effects. Those sockets used
for the DUTs shall also be the same design as all others in the test environment. The DUTS shall also be electrically
connected to the TSP measuring equipment that requires a set of Kelvin sense leads to monitor junction voltage.
These leads shall be attached so as to minimize heat sinking. Also see 7.4 for ACOL considerations.
7.3.1 Thermal equilibrium. The ambient temperature (TA) shall be as specified at thermal equilibrium conditions
including any convection or circulating air effects in an oven chamber where applicable.
7.3.2 Desired level. A common heating current shall be applied in increasing increments for all devices while
sampling for TSP on each DUT. Working with each serialized DUT one at a time, monitor the junction voltage TSP
while slowly varying the common junction current. When the DUT being monitored is at thermal equilibrium where
both its current and voltage readings match a set of readings on the chart taken in 7.1.3, the TJ of that DUT is known
to be at the desired level. This is graphically displayed on figure 3100-1. For accuracy, the voltage readings should
optimally use the same test equipment that can record in both a sample-and-hold mode in 7.1.3 and continuously in
7.3.2.
METHOD 3100
7
7.3.3 Desired TJ. Paragraph 7.3.2 shall be repeated until both the current and voltage readings match a set of
corresponding readings for the desired TJ level on each serialized DUT after the same equivalent rms power is
applied for all devices in the test environment. The power applied for this desired TJ level for each DUT shall be
recorded. The average power for the DUTs shall also be determined and used as the value thereafter for applied
power per unit during burn-in or life-test in 7.3.4. If the thermal resistance from junction to ambient RJA is desired for
later reference as indicated in 10.2, the TA should also be recorded.
NOTE: The TJ is also selected based on overall tolerances of the test environment. Also see 10.3 and equation 9 for
slight TJ variations with the averaging effects of applied power above. For worst case tolerances, the TJ should be
placed nominally at the midpoint between the minimum and maximum allowed TJ required for the test environment.
For example, this may be 155C if the minimum is 135C and maximum is 175C. If either the applied heating power
(PH) or the desired TJ exceeds the DUT ratings, see 7.3.3.1 and 7.3.3.2. If not, proceed to 7.3.4.
METHOD 3100
8
7.3.3.1 Power rating. If the applied heating power (PH) exceeds the rating of the device for burn-in screening to
achieve the desired TJ, the following options apply:
b. The TA may be increased until the desired TJ is achieved when allowed by the applicable specification sheet.
c. The current or power may be increased not to exceed the current density capability of the device.
7.3.3.2 TJ for JANS. The TJ may be higher than typical device ratings of 150C to 200C when applied to JANS
life-test in groups B, C, and E of MIL-PRF-19500 for a faster accelerated test environment. These may be specified
at TJ values of 225C to 275C. However, these options shall not exceed temperatures where the DUTs (and
remaining devices) cannot operate effectively as a semiconductor in the test environment. This may also be
identified as the intrinsic or secondary breakdown region (thermal generation of electron-hole pairs starts
approaching or exceeding the background doping levels of the PN junctions). This may also be observed by
significant increases in reverse leakage current, or in more severe cases, the decline (or collapse) of reverse
breakdown voltage (VBR) on rectifiers, VZ for higher voltage zeners, or VCE for transistors. Also see note in 6.4.1.b for
rectifiers.
7.3.4 Desired TJ After the desired TJ is achieved for all devices, the burn-in or life-test may proceed with the
average power per unit in 7.3.3 until completed for the required number of hours.
7.4 ACOL considerations (rectifiers). If the sample-and-hold test equipment is equipped with synchronized test
capabilities for measuring the TSP voltage in the desired forward conducting half-cycle region for ACOL operation,
this can again be tested in a similar manner described in 7.3. As described in 7.3.2, this should optimally be provided
with the same voltage test equipment. For synchronized capabilities, a Frothingham model VF40DB or equivalent
may be used. If a synchronized test capability is not available, alternative steps shall be added after 7.2.1 to ensure
equivalent heating and TJ to the DUT samples. These are described in 7.4.1 through 7.4.4.
7.4.1 Thermocouple mounting. When the voltage monitoring leads are being attached to the DUTs for testing in
the burn-in configuration in 7.2, also solder on a fine 36 AWG bare wire thermocouple to each of them. The
thermocouple should be mounted at zero inch distance from the body of the part. The thermocouple will have to be
mounted to not interfere when the DUT is placed in the burn-in or life-test fixtures.
7.4.2 Thermocouple usage. Also solder a thermocouple as described in 7.4.1 to the nearest device of each DUT
location that receives ACOL power in the test environment.
7.4.3 Thermocouple temperature. As each of the serialized DUT parts is set to the desired TJ using the dc current
method in the ACOL test environment, also record the thermocouple temperature reading. These thermocouple
readings are then used to set the ac power levels in 7.4.4.
7.4.4 Average TJ. Apply power to heat the remaining diodes using the required ACOL while monitoring the
thermocouple temperature. Increase the ac power input until the thermocouple in 7.4.2 reaches the temperature
level of the DUT in 7.4.3 at the desired TJ. Record the ACOL power conditions applied for each device described in
7.4.2. These values are then averaged for determining ACOL power applied for all devices. This process
guarantees that all the devices will be tested at the required average TJ for burn-in or life-test. Also see 9.3 for further
background information.
NOTE: The rectifier diode with the lowest VF or the lowest ambient temperature (TA) position in the test environment
would require the greatest power for a given thermocouple reading to ensure the same TJ is achieved.
METHOD 3100
9
8. Procedure for method C. This method only applies to case mounted power devices where the operating power
or current region expected for the burn-in or life-test environment is still well below that of the rating of the device. In
these examples, the TJ of the device is not significantly higher than the case temperature TC. This operating feature
and direct measurement of case temperature may be used to confirm the minimum required TJ is met for the burn-in
or life-test environment.
9. Background information.
9.1 Equations for TJ, TA, PH, and RJA. The observed values of the TJ rise above TA in the test environment would
be the product of effective rms heating power (PH) multiplied times the total effects of component thermal resistance
from junction to ambient (RJA)
This may also be stated as follows:
TJ = TA + PH x RJA Equation 1
The TA is the ambient temperature in the immediate vicinity of an open burn-in rack or the ambient inside a
convection oven chamber for life-test. If TA is recorded at 6.3.3 or 7.3.3, then the RJA can also be determined as
follows:
RJA = (TJ TA)/PH Equation 2
9.2 Thermal resistance definitions for RJL, RJC, RJEC, RLA, RCA, and RECA. The thermal resistance (RJA) is the
total of the DUT thermal resistance junction to lead or case (RJL or RJC), and the thermal resistance of the test
environment from lead or case (test socket) to ambient (RLA or RCA). For example:
This also applies to surface mount devices that may use an end-cap reference rather than case. In this example:
RJA = RJEC + RECA
The TJ in each of these examples can be determined as follows:
Earlier methods have also determined TJ based on these relations that use thermal resistance of the component and
also the reference point temperature (TL, TC, TEC) measured in the test environment with applied power (PH).
Possible sources of error included the use of maximum rated thermal resistance rather than actual value (see note),
nonlinear features affecting thermal resistance or K factor at notably higher temperatures during life-test and difficulty
in measuring reference temperature (TL, TC, TEC) particularly for enclosed convection air ovens.
NOTE: For accurate determination of TJ, this requires the actual component thermal resistance value rather than the
maximum rating. This distinction is important to ensure adequate TJ values are achieved in 6.3.3 or 7.3.3.
METHOD 3100
10
9.3 Correlation of RMS power with TL, TC, or TEC. The lead, case, or end-cap temperature reference points within
the test environment are as follows:
TL = TA + PH x RLA Equation 6
TC = TA + PH x RCA Equation 7
TEC = TA + PH x RECA Equation 8
If the TL, TC, or TEC is the same between any two devices in identical test environment conditions for ambient
temperature and thermal resistance of the test socket from component to ambient, then the effective rms power shall
be the same between them as may be observed in Equation 6, 7, and 8. This feature may be used to advantage in
determining equivalent PH levels in different power modes as described in 6.5 and 7.4. Also when the same
equivalent heating power levels are applied to devices of identical design with the same thermal resistance at the
same TL, TC, or TEC, then the same TJ is achieved as shown in Equation 3, 4, and 5.
10. Summary.
10.1 Repeatable TJ values. This procedure may not require repeating for every lot processed for burn-in and life-
test if this method verifies the same TJ values (within acceptable tolerances) for thermally identical test environments
and devices to be tested as demonstrated in 9.1 and Equation 1. This would occur in a test environment with the
same TA and heat-sinking effects (RLA, RCA, or RECA), as well as components of the same thermal resistance (RJL,
RJC, or RJEC). These conditions provide the same effective RJA and the same TJ values as demonstrated in 9.2.
The value of RJA is determined in 10.2.
10.2 The effective thermal resistance. RJA for the test environment can be determined for the devices or DUTs
with the PH recorded at 6.3.3 or 7.3.3 with ambient temperature (TA) and junction temperature (TJ) with Equation 2 in
9.1. The RJA for identical test environments and products can then be used to advantage for determining other
desired TJ values when needed at applied power levels PH or ambient temperature (TA) conditions.
10.3 Average power. When an individual (average) power level PH is selected for the test environment in 6.3.3 or
7.3.3, small variations in power PH to this average will exist over the sample number of DUTs to achieve the same
TSP or TJ. As a result, slight variations in TJ will also occur for continuing the burn-in or life-test in 6.3.4 or 7.3.4
with typical power supplies and wiring harnesses. This TJ may also be determined from Equation 1 as shown below
in Equation 9.
TJ = TA + PH x RJA Equation 9
This added consideration for TJ tolerances in 6.3.3 or 7.3.3 is of interest since the same operating current or power
condition is applied to all devices for continuing burn-in or life-test in 6.3.4 or 7.3.4 with typical power supplies and
wiring harnesses. These slight TJ variations may be from small variations in socket and component thermal
resistance. It may also be from notable variations in ambient temperature in the immediate vicinity of each DUT
placed at different locations in the test environment.
METHOD 3100
11
METHOD 3101.4
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the thermal performance of diode devices. This can be done
in two ways, steady-state thermal impedance or transient thermal impedance testing. Steady-state thermal
impedance (referred to as thermal resistance) determines the overall thermal performance of devices. A production
oriented screening process, referred to as thermal transient testing, is a subset of thermal impedance testing and
determines the ability of the diode chip-to-header interface to transfer heat from the chip to the header, and is a
measure of the thermal quality of the die attachment. It is relevant to designs which use headers, or heat conducting
plugs, with mass and thermal conductivity allowing effective discrimination of poor die attachments. This is
particularly true with power devices. The method can be applied to rectifier diodes, transient voltage suppressors,
power zener diodes, and some zener, signal, and switching diodes. This method is intended for production
monitoring, incoming inspection, and pre-burn in screening applications. Some zener constructions, particularly
when used with small junction area designs, cool too rapidly (from a heating current) to provide accurate
measurement when forward (diode) current is used for this test. For such devices, a method is provided to apply
currents in the zener direction and make a measurement much closer to the termination of the heating current. In
this way, no minority carriers are involved and inductive effects are minimized due to lower test current. This may be
considered a lab measurement because cable lengths in an ATE may prevent accurate measurements so close to
cessation of the heating current. This laboratory method is intended on initial zener device design verification for
correlation to forward direction thermal impedance testing (such as with an ATE) prior to establishing a production
test limit. Correlation assurance shall be provided in the forward production monitoring that thermal impedance in
the reverse direction (zener) shall not exceed the specified limit. If this zener test method exceeds the forward
method by 10 percent or more, production monitoring (with an ATE in the forward direction) will require a lower limit,
for some devices, than that required by the more accurate lab method (see 5.1).
1.1 Background and scope for thermal transient testing. Steady-state thermal impedance and transient thermal
impedance of semiconductor devices are sensitive to the presence of these voids in the die attachment material
between the semiconductor chip and package since voids impede the flow of heat from the chip to the substrate
(package). Due to the difference in the thermal time constants of the chip and package, the measurement of
transient thermal response can be made more sensitive to the presence of voids than can the measurement of
steady-state thermal response. This is because the chip thermal time constant is generally several orders of
magnitude shorter than that of the package. Thus, the heating power pulse width can be selected so that only the
chip and the chip-to-substrate interface are heated during the pulse by using a pulse width somewhat greater than
the chip thermal time constant but less than that of the substrate. Heating power pulse widths ranging from 1 to 400
ms for various package designs have been found to satisfy this criterion. This enables the detection of voids to be
greatly enhanced, with the added advantage of not having to heat sink the DUT. Thus, the transient thermal
impedance or thermal response techniques are less time consuming than the measurement of thermal resistance for
use as a manufacturing screen, process control, or incoming inspection measure for die attachment integrity
evaluation.
2. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purpose of this test method
in the forward direction: (When using the zener method, see below):
a. TJ: The change in TJ caused by the application of PH for a time equal to tH.
b. VF The change in the TSP, VF, due to the application of (PH) to the DUT.
c. CU: The comparison unit, consisting of VF divided by VH, that is used to normalize the transient thermal
response for variations in power dissipation; in units of mV/V.
d. IH: The current applied to the DUT during the heating time in order to cause power dissipation.
e. IM: The measurement current used to forward bias the temperature sensing diode junction for measurement
of VF. NOTE: When using the zener, delete forward and use zener bias.
h. RJX: Thermal resistance from device junction to a defined reference point; in units of C/W.
RJC: Thermal resistance from device junction to a point on the outside surface of the case immediately
adjacent to the device chip; in units of C/W.
RJA: Thermal resistance from device junction to an ambient (world); in units of C/W.
k. tMD: Measurement delay time is defined as the time from the start of (PH) removal to the start of the final VF
measurement time, referred to as tSW .
m. tSW: Sample window time during which final VF measurement is made. The value of tSW should be small; it
can approach zero if an oscilloscope is used for manual measurements.
n. VF: The forward biased junction voltage of the DUT used for junction temperature sensing. NOTE: When
using the zener method, delete forward and use zener bias.
VFi: The initial VF value before application of heating power(PH).
VFf: The final VF value after application of (PH).
o. VH: The heating voltage resulting from the application of IH to the DUT.
r. ZJC: Thermal impedance from device junction to a point on the outside surface of the case immediately
adjacent to the device chip measured using time equal time constant of device; in units of C/W.
s. ZJX: Thermal impedance from device junction to a time defined reference point; in units of C/W.
NOTES: (1) When using the zener method, the following changes shall further apply to the definitions whenever
they appear in the text.
(2) VF, K, and CU parameter values will be substantially different when using the zener method (as
compared to the forward biased method). Some difference will be observed between zeners with
different nominal voltages.
METHOD 3101.4
2
3. Apparatus. The apparatus required for this test shall include the following, configured as shown on figure
3101-1, as applicable to the specified test procedure:
a. A constant current source capable of adjustment to the desired value of IH and able to supply the VH value
required by the DUT. The current source should be able to maintain the desired current to within 2 percent
during the entire length of heating time.
b. A constant current source to supply IM with sufficient voltage compliance to turn the TSP junction fully on.
c. An electronic switch capable of switching between the heating period conditions and measurement
conditions in a time frame short enough to avoid DUT cooling during the transition; this typically requires
switching in the microsecond or tens of microseconds range.
d. A voltage measurement circuit capable of accurately making the VFf measurement within the time frame with
millivolt resolution.
4. Test operation.
4.1 General description. The test begins with the adjustment of IM and IH to the desired values. The value of IH
is usually at least 50 times greater than the value of IM. Then with the electronic switch in position 1, the value of
VFi is measured. The switch is then moved to position 2 for a length of time equal to tH and the value of VH is
measured. Finally, at the conclusion of tH, the switch is again moved to position 1 and the VFf value is measured
within a time period defined by tMD (or tMD + tSW , depending on the definitions stated previously). The two current
sources are then turned off at the completion of the test. (See figures 3101-2a and 3101-2b.)
METHOD 3101.4
3
4.2 Notes.
a. Some test equipment may provide a VF directly instead of VFi and VFf; this is an acceptable alternative.
Record the value of VF.
b. Some test equipment may provide ZJX directly instead of VFi and VFf for thermal resistance calculations;
this is an acceptable alternative. Record the value of ZJX .
METHOD 3101.4
4
c. Alternative waveforms, as may be generated by ATE using the general principles of this method, may be
used upon approval of the qualifying activity.
d. The zener biased method in figure 3101-2b illustrates a positive TSP when the zener is in avalanche
breakdown. It is also possible to portray a negative TSP for low voltage zeners when they are in the field
emission or tunneling mode. A near zero TSP can also result from these two off-setting factors of a specific
operating current that shall be avoided by changing to a higher or lower current. Also see 6 herein for TSP.
5. Acceptance limit.
5.1 General discussion. Variations in diode characteristics from one manufacturer to another cause difficulty in
establishing a single acceptance limit for all diodes tested to a given specification sheet. Ideally, a single
acceptance limit value for VF would be the simplest approach. However, different design, materials, and processes
can alter the resultant VF value for a given set of test conditions. Listed below are several different approaches to
defining acceptance limits. The VF limit is the simplest approach and is usually selected for screening purposes.
Paragraphs 5.3 through 5.6 require increasingly greater detail or effort. In some examples, absolute thermal
impedance limits are required for correlation to surge performance such as for zeners. In such examples, setting a
limit for zener diode construction with the forward biased (the usual ATE) method requires prior evaluation of ZJX
(and RJX, when desired) by the zener biased method. If the zener method result is more than 10 percent higher, the
limit shall be based on the more accurate zener biased measurement. In such a case, if it is desired to use the
forward biased method, the limit (of VF, ZJX, or RJX) shall be reduced by the extent (percentage) difference
between the two methods.
5.2 VF limit. A single VF limit is practical if the K factor and VH values for all diodes tested to a given
specification sheet are nearly identical. Since these values may be different for different manufacturers, the use of
different limits is likely to more accurately achieve the desired intent. (A lower limit does not indicate a better die
bond when comparing different product sources.) The diode specification sheet would list the following test
conditions and measurement parameters:
a. IH (in A).
b. tH (in ms).
c. IM (in mA).
5.3 TJ limit. (Much more involved than V , but useful for examining questionable devices.) Since TJ is the
product of K (in accordance with 6 herein) and VF, this approach is the same as defining a maximum acceptable TJ
rise for a given set of test conditions.
5.4 CU limit. (Slightly more involved than TJ.) The TJ limit approach described above does not take into
account potential power dissipation variations between devices. The VH value can vary, depending on chip design
and size, thus causing the power dissipation during the heating time to be different from device to device. This
variation will be small within a lot of devices produced by a single manufacturer but may be large between
manufacturers. A CU limit value takes into account variations in power dissipation due to differences in VH by
dividing the VF value by VH.
METHOD 3101.4
5
5.5 (KCU) limit. (Slightly more involved but provides greater detail.) This is a combinational approach that takes
into account both K factor and power dissipation variations between devices.
5.6 ZJX limit. (For full characterization; not required for screening purposes, but preferred if the proper ATE is
available.) The thermal impedance approach uses an absolute magnitude value specification that overcomes the
problems associated with the other approaches. Thermal impedance is time dependent and is calculated as follows:
TJ ( K )(VF )
ZJX = = C/W
PD ( IH )(VH )
5.7 RJX limit. (For thermal resistance specification testing.) The thermal resistance to some defined point, such
as the case (RJC), lead (RJL), or end cap (RJEC), is an absolute magnitude value specification used for equilibrium
conditions. The tH heating time shall therefore be extended to longer times (typically 20 to 50 seconds). In the
example of RJC, RJL, or RJEC measurements, the case, lead or end cap reference points shall be carefully
stabilized and monitored in temperature which requires an infinite heat sink or careful monitoring for optimum results.
The TJ in the equation below is the difference in TJ to the case, lead, or end cap reference temperature as
applicable by package type.
TJ ( K )(VF )
RJX = = C/W
PD ( IH )(VH )
NOTE: Some automated test equipment designed primarily for thermal impedance testing with short heating times
(tH) may not include capabilities of controlling or monitoring these reference temperatures for an accurate thermal
resistance test measurement at long heating times. Also see method 4081, MIL-STD-750 for further details on
testing thermal resistance of diodes.
5.8 General comment for thermal transient testing. One potential problem in using the thermal transient testing
approach lies in trying to make accurate enough measurements with sufficient resolution to distinguish between
acceptable and nonacceptable diodes. As the diode-under-test current handling capability increases, the thermal
impedance under transient conditions will become a very small value. This raises the potential for rejecting good
devices and accepting bad ones. Higher IH values shall be used in this case.
6. Measurement of the TSP VF (or VZ). The calibration of VF versus TJ is accomplished by monitoring VF for the
required value of IM as the environmental temperature (and thus the DUT temperature), and is varied by external
heating. It is not required if the acceptance limit is VF (see 5.2), but is relevant to the other acceptance criteria (see
5.3 through 5.6). The magnitude of IM shall be chosen so that VF is a linearly decreasing function over the normal
TJ range of the device. IM shall be large enough to ensure that the diode junction is turned on but not large enough
to cause significant self heating. An example of the measurement method and resulting calibration curve is shown
on figure 3101-3.
METHOD 3101.4
6
Step 3: K =
T J2 - T J1
C / mV
V F2 - V F1
IM shall be large enough to overcome surface leakage effects but small enough not to cause significant self heating.
When using the zener direction, the IM may also require adjustment to avoid a near zero TSP where the avalanche
breakdown effects are offset by tunneling or field emission. (See 4.2.d.)
METHOD 3101.4
7
A calibration factor K (which is the reciprocal of the slope of the curve on figure 3101-3) can be defined as:
T J 2 - T J1
K= C/mV
V F 2 - V F1
It has been found experimentally that the K-factor variation for all devices within a given device type class is small.
The usual procedure is to perform a K factor calibration on a 10 to 12 piece sample from a device lot and determine
the average K and standard deviation (). If is less than or equal to 3 percent of the average value of K, then the
average value of K can be used for all devices within the lot. If is greater than 3 percent of the average value of K,
then all the devices in the lot shall be calibrated and the individual values of K shall be used in determining device
acceptance. As an alternative to using individual values of K, the manufacture may establish internal limits unique to
their product that ensures atypical product removal from the population (lot-to-lot and within-the-lot). The
manufacture shall use statistic techniques to establish the limits to the satisfaction of the Government.
7. Establishment of test conditions and acceptance limits. Thermal resistance measurements require that IH be
equal to the required value stated in the device specification sheet, typically at rated current or higher. Values for tH,
tMD, and heat sink conditions are also taken from the device specification sheet. The steps shown below are
primarily for thermal transient testing and thermal characterization purposes.
The following steps describe how to set up the test conditions and determine the acceptance limits for implementing
the transient thermal test for die attachment evaluation using the apparatus and definitions stated above in 6.
7.1 Initial device testing procedure. The following steps describe in detail how to set up the apparatus described
previously for proper testing of various diodes. Since this procedure thermally characterizes the diode out to a point
in heating time required to ensure heat propagation into the case (i.e., the RJX condition), an appropriate heat sink
should be used or the case temperature should be monitored.
Step 1: From a 20 to 25 piece sample, pick any one diode to start the setup process. Set up the test apparatus
as follows:
IH = 1.0 A (Or some other desired value near the DUTs normal operating current: Typically
higher for power diodes, and lower for zener diodes, when measured in the zener
direction.)
50 - 100 ms Unless otherwise specified, for most devices rated up to 200 W power dissipation.
250 ms For steady-state thermal resistance measurement. The pulse shall be shown to
correlate to steady-state conditions before it can be substituted for steady-state
condition. See method 4081, MIL-STD-750 for further details on testing thermal
resistance of diodes.
METHOD 3101.4
8
tMD = 100 s max For non-magnetic or non-inductive lead/package where inductive delay or stored
charge do not influence the reading, tMD = 70 s is a good choice. A larger value
may be required on power devices with magnetic/inductive package elements which
generate non-thermal electrical transients; unless otherwise specified, this would be
observed in the t3 region of figure 3101-2. If, however, a value of tMD greater than
300 s is required in order to be able to test outside of the inductive switching region,
then correlation shall be made back to 70 s from whatever value of tMD you require.
Example: At 70 s your thermal impedance readings (in C/W) show instability or
extreme sensitivity to different IH values. Repeat taking data from 70 s to well
beyond 1,000 us and plot the thermal impedance vs tMD on log-log paper. You will
have a curved line at low values of tMD until the correct value of tMD is reached or
exceeded, at which point the plot should be almost straight. Extend the straight-line
portion past where the plot curves signify inductance to lower tMD values. Where the
straight extension crosses 70 s, that is the actual value of thermal impedance. If
you read thermal impedance using the longer value of tMD where the curve makes
the transition to straight line, you need to multiply that reading by the ratio of the 70
s thermal impedance divided by what you have actually measured. This is
straightforward extraplolation. Again, only on log-log plot paper can you use this
approach.
Step 2: Insert device into the apparatus test fixture and initiate a test. (For best results, a test fixture that offers
some form of heat sinking would be desirable. Heat sinking is not needed if either the power dissipation
during the test is well within the diode's free-air rating or the maximum heating time is limited to less than
that required for the heat to propagate through the case.)
Step 3: If VF is in the 100 to 300 mV range, or VZL is equivalent to the same TJ, then proceed to the next
step. This range approximately corresponds to a junction temperature change of roughly +50C to
+150C and is sufficient for initial comparison purposes.
If VF is less than 50 mV, return to step 1 and increase heating power into device by increasing IH.
Exception: You have reached maximum rated IH. In that case you shall accept the accuracy associated
with using a smaller VF. Be sure you have equipment with at least 100 V resolution for VF.
If VF is greater than 150 mV, approximately corresponding to a junction temperature change greater
than +150C, it would probably be desirable to reduce the heating power by returning to step 1 and
reducing IH. Note that some automatic test equipment automatically guards against this problem.
METHOD 3101.4
9
NOTE: The test equipment shall be capable of resolving VF to within 5 percent. If not, the higher value
of VF shall be selected until the 5 percent tolerance is met. Two different devices can have the same TJ
rise even when PH is different, due to widely differing VH. Within a given lot, however, a higher VH is
more likely to result in a higher TJ rise. For such examples, this screen can be more accurately
accomplished using the CU value. As defined in 2 herein, CU provides a comparison unit that takes into
account different device VH values for a given IH test condition.
Step 4: Test each of the sample devices and record the data detailed in 8.
Step 5: Select out the devices with the highest and lowest values of CU or ZJX and put the remaining devices
aside.
The VF values can be used instead of CU or ZJX if the measured values of VH are very tightly grouped
around the average value.
Step 6: Using the devices from step 5, collect and plot the heating curve data for the two devices in a manner
similar to the examples shown on figure 3101-4.
Step 7: Interpretation of the heating curves is the next step. Realizing that the thermal characteristics of identical
chips should be the same if the tH is less than or equal to the thermal time constant of the chip, the two
curves should start out the same for the low values of tH. Non-identical chips (thinner or smaller in cross
section) will have completely different curves, even at the smaller values of tH. As the value of tH is
increased, thereby exceeding the chip thermal constant, heat will have propagated through the chip into
the die attachment region. Since the heating curve devices of step 5 were specifically chosen for their
difference, the curves of figure 3101-4a or 3101-4b diverge after tH reaches a value where the die
attachment variance has an affect on the device TJ and ZJX as best observed on figure 3101-4b for a log-
log plot. Increasing tH further will eventually result in a flattening of the curve as the heating propagates
in the device package and thermal impedance approaches the thermal resistance value of the device. If
the device package has little thermal mass and is not well mounted to a good heat sink, the curve will not
flatten very much, but will show a definite change in slope.
Step 8: Using the heating curve, select the appropriate value of tH to correspond to the inflection point in the
transition region between heat in the chip and heat in the package.
If there are several different elements in the heat flow path: Chip, die attachment, substrate, substrate
attach, and package for example in a hybrid, there will be several plateaus and transitions in the heating
curve. Appropriate selection of tH will optimize evaluation sensitivity to other attachment areas.
Step 9: Return to the apparatus and set tH equal to the value determined from step 8.
METHOD 3101.4
10
200
150
Theta (C/W)
100
50
0
0.0001 0.001 0.01 0.1 1 10 100
Time (s)
Figure 3101-4a: Log-linear plot (sometimes not as desirable as the log-log plot due to loss of short pulse time
resolution) illustrates the ability of short test pulses during thermal impedance to detect poor die bonds. While log-
log plots are requested, log-linear plots may be substituted with approval of the qualifying activity. See figure 3101-
4b for a log-log example.
Notes:
1). Both figure 3101-4a and figure 3101-4b are of the same data.
2). The log-linear incorrectly leads you to believe that maximum void test sensitivity is available anywhere above
10ms.
METHOD 3101.4
11
100
Theta (C/W)
10
1
0.0001 0.001 0.01 0.1 1 10 100
Time (s)
Figure 3101-4b: Log-log plot (preferred) illustrates the ability of short test pulses during thermal impedance to
detect poor die bonds. The time period wherein the two curves (best vs worst) are farthest apart is the best time to
use for thermal impedance die bond testing. Note that since the range from 10 ms to 100 ms in this example are
nearly parallel, any place in that region is acceptable, however, 10 m to 30ms results in faster testing so that would
be the logical choice. Each construction design may have a different sweet zone.
Notes:
1). Both Figure 3101-4a and Figure 3101-4b are of the same data.
2). The log-log curve deals with resolution accuracy just like any automatic tester. Here the log-log curve makes
it clear that you will lose resolution accuracy above 100ms.
Step 10: Because the selected value of tH is much less than that for thermal equilibrium, it is possible to
significantly increase the (PH) without degrading or destroying the device. The increased power
dissipation within the DUT will result in higher VF or CU values that will make determination of
acceptable and unacceptable devices much easier.
METHOD 3101.4
12
Step 11: The pass/fail limit, the cut-off point between acceptable and nonacceptable devices, can be established
in a variety of ways:
a. Correlation to other die attachment evaluation methods, such as die shear and x-ray. While these two
methods have little actual value from a thermal point of view, they do represent standardization methods
as described in various standards.
b. Maximum allowable junction temperature variations between devices. Since the relationship between
TJ and VF is about 0.5C/mV for forward bias testing, or a measurable equivalent for zener direction
testing, the TJ spread between devices can be easily determined. The TJ predicts reliability.
Conversely, the TJ spread necessary to meet the reliability projections can be translated to a VF or CU
value for pass/fail criteria.
To fully utilize this approach, it will be necessary to calibrate the devices for the exact value of the TJ to
VF characteristic. The characteristic's slope, commonly referred to as K factor, is easily measured on a
sample basis using a voltmeter, environmental chamber, temperature indicator, and a power supply
setup as described in 6 herein. A simple set of equations yield the (TJ) once K and VF are known:
TJ = (K) (VF)
TJ = TA + TJ
Where TA is the ambient or reference temperature. For thermal transient test conditions, this
temperature is usually equivalent to lead temperature (TL) for axial lead devices or case temperature
(TC) for case mounted devices.
c. Statistically, from a 20 to 25 device sample, the distribution of VF or CU values should be a normal one
with defective devices out of the normal range. Figure 3101-5 shows a VF distribution for a sample lot
of diodes. NOTE: The left-hand side of the histogram envelope is fairly well defined but the other side
is greatly skewed to the right. This is because the left-hand side is constrained by the absolute best
heat flow that can be obtained with a given chip assembly material and process unless a test method
error is introduced. The other side has no such constraints because there is no limit as to how poorly a
chip is mounted.
FIGURE 3101-5. Typical VF (or ZJX) distribution with asymmetrical histogram distribution.
METHOD 3101.4
13
The usual rule of thumb in setting the maximum limit for VF , CU, or ZJX is to use the distribution
average value and three standard deviations (). For example:
(VF ) = V F + X
high
limit
(CU ) = CU + X
high
limit
(ZJX ) = ZJX + X
high
limit
Where X = 3 in most cases and VF, CU, and ZJX are the average distribution values.
The statistical data required is obtained by testing 25 or more devices under the conditions of step 11.
The maximum limit determined from this approach should be correlated to the diode's specified thermal
resistance. This will ensure that the VF or CU limits do not pass diodes that would fail the thermal
resistance or transient thermal impedance requirements.
Step 12: Once the test conditions and pass/fail limit have been determined, it is necessary only to record this
information for future testing requirements of the same device in the same package. It is also
recommended that a minimum limit is established to ensure a test method error or other anomaly is
investigated.
Step 13: After the pass/fail limits are established, there shall be verification they correlate to good and bad
bonded devices or the electrical properties such as surge.
METHOD 3101.4
14
7.2 Routine device thermal transient testing procedure. Once the proper control settings have been determined
for a particular device type from a given manufacturing process or vendor, repeated testing of that device type simply
requires that the same test conditions be used as previously determined.
New device types, or the same devices manufactured with a different process, will require a repeat of 7.1 for proper
thermal transient test conditions.
a. IM measuring current mA
b. IH heating current A
c. tH heating time ms
METHOD 3101.4
15
b. VH heating voltage V
NOTE: Some test equipment may provide a VF instead of VFi and VFf; this is an acceptable alternative. Record
the value of VF.
Some test equipment may provide direct display of calculated CU or ZJX; this is an acceptable alternative.
Record the value of CU or ZJX.
8.2 K factor calibration. (Optional for criteria 8.3.a or 8.3.b, mandatory for 8.3.c, 8.3.d, or 8.3.e.)
a. IM current magnitude mA
c. Initial VF voltage mV
e. Final VF voltage mV
T J 2 - T J1
K= C/mV
V F 2 - V F1
K factor C/mV
8.5 Specification limit calculations. One or more of the following should be measured or calculated, as stated on
the device specification sheet (see 5.1):
ZJX C/W (For big variation in K, VH, and IH among devices, same as
KCU for diodes/rectifiers).
RJX C/W
METHOD 3101.4
16
9.0 Thermal impedance production guidelines, logistics of the thermal impedance test. The goal of Thermal
Impedance production screening is to detect and remove any components that have defects that can affect reliability
or performance. The key components for this test upon the DUT are:
a. Determine a temperature sensitive parameter (K-factor) in the DUT and calibrate it (usually in mV/C but not
necessarily always). This parameter is normally measured at a current chosen so that it does not affect
the accuracy of the thermal impedance test.
b. Determine a measurement PT power (voltage x current) and tm measurement pulse time. The pulse time
should be sufficient to delineate the semiconductor package layer being monitored for quality. For
example, 10 ms to 30 ms measures the die attach integrity and 100 ms to 300 ms measures both the die
attach plus an additional die tab attach to the package header. See 9.2 herein. The pulse power should
be sufficient to heat the junction up at least 50C unless limited by a maximum power density rating of the
junction.
c. Determine a tmd measurement delay time (time between when power pulse is turned off and the K-factor is
applied to provide the junction temperature.
d. Deploy equipment capable of applying the above pulse and providing an output that either directly
calculates the peak junction temperature with the supplied K-factor and provides a thermal impedance
reading in C/W or, at the least, provides a delta voltage change that can manually be converted to thermal
impedance by dividing by the K-factor and the PT applied power. This tmd delay time is usually provided by
the appropriate specification but extenuating circumstances such as chip storage time or package
magnetic resonance may dictate using a longer value of tmd. This is permitted provided a correlation is
established between the required value of tmd and the specified value of tmd and DSCC is notified.
It is incumbent upon the supplier to notify DSCC of any specified measurement conditions that might fail to achieve
the thermal impedance test methods primary goal of detecting and removing and defective components.
9.1 Applying the thermal impedance test to production product. Every semiconductor product type is likely to
respond differently in readings to thermal impedance tests. The intent here is not to compare dissimilar product but,
rather, to compare product within a single lot to each other (statistical comparison), to a specification maximum limit
(when applicable) and, if at all possible, to a design ideal value. With this in mind, the following rules can be applied:
a. Any part failing the specification maximum limit (if one exists) is an automatic reject.
b. Any part falling outside of a normal distribution of thermal impedance readings in a histogram is subject to
reject. This distribution should be documented over the course of five production lots and, if each lot has a
similar distribution, then the average distribution and pass-fail limits of the combination of all five
production lots may be used to establish permanent screening limits. If the K-factor does not vary more
than 10 percent from lot-to-lot, then it is permissible to establish a constant K-factor for this particular part
number or chip family. Otherwise, the K-factor may need to be re-established for every lot. If every lot,
even after correcting for K-factor variations, varies more than 20 percent from each other, once the reason
has been determined and no correction is possible, it may be necessary to treat each production lot on a
stand-alone basis.
METHOD 3101.4
17
c. Upper and lower pass-fail limits cannot be determined by using 3-Sigma. This is because in most cases
(except where you have achieved near perfection), the distribution is an a-symmetrical histogram bell
curve where the right (high-side) of the curve extends farther away from center normal than the left (low-
side). This is because making parts less than perfect (extends right) is easy but making parts better than
perfect (extends left) is far less likely. The upper and lower limits can be set one of two ways:
a) Split histogram curve in half at the center peak value and calculate separate 3-sigma limits, one for
the upper side and one for the lower side.
b) Visually have Engineering review the histogram curve and select appropriate limits based upon what
looks normal and what doesnt.
The value of a lower pass-fail limit is to catch changes in the product that might otherwise go undetected. For
example: Braze preform is suddenly too thin, chip size was just changed, or package design was changed by
package vendor.
d. Since the original Engineering design-value for thermal impedance remains the one constant through all
testing, this is an excellent tool to confirm that thermal impedance is giving meaningful readings and that
the design is being executed correctly by production. The design-value should fall somewhere in the lower
region of the histogram curve or slightly below the curve. Major deviations indicate that one or the other is
in error or that the measurement conditions cannot give an absolute accurate value (though relative values
for statistical screening may continue to be usable for screening).
9.2 Heat Flow Distance vs. Elapsed Time Plot. This section is provided to assist in determining the tm measurement
time required to adequately delineate a particular interface. Figure 3101-6 shows effectively how far heat travels in
the time shown in the X-axis.
The example listed on the graph shows that heat in 10 mils of silicon takes 1.2 ms to reach the back side. During
the 1.2 ms, the heat has remained inside the chip, has not passed through the chip bond interface, and is too short a
time to measure the chip bond interface. As a first try, multiply by at least seven to get a minimum test time.
The example continues to show that it would take 8.7 ms for heat to reach through the silicon chip, across the braze
layer that is being evaluated, and through, but not outside of, the tab the chip is mounted on. Based on this, 8.7 ms
would work as a tm that would maximize sensitivity to bad bonds but not be influenced by anything beyond the first
tab. This is where the popular default value of 10ms came from.
METHOD 3101.4
18
100
10
1
Elapsed Time (ms)
0.1
0.01
0.001
0.000001
0.01 0.1 1 10 100 1000
Distance Heat Travels (mils)
METHOD 3103
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the thermal impedance of the insulated gate bipolar transistors
(IGBT) under the specified conditions of applied voltage, current, and pulse duration. The temperature sensitivity of
the gate emitter ON voltage, under conditions of applied collector emitter voltage and low emitter current, is used as
the junction temperature (TJ) indicator. This method is particularly suitable to enhancement mode, power IGBTs
having relatively long thermal response times. This test method is used to measure the thermal response of the
junction to a heating pulse. Specifically, the test may be used to measure dc thermal resistance and to ensure
proper die mountdown to its case. This is accomplished through the appropriate choice of pulse duration and heat
power magnitude. The appropriate test conditions and limits are detailed in 6.
2. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purpose of this test
method:
a. IM: Emitter current applied during measurement of the gate emitter ON voltage.
d. PH Magnitude of the heating power pulse applied to DUT in watts; the product of IH and VH.
TJi: Junction temperature in degrees Celsius before start of the power pulse.
TJf: Junction temperature in degrees Celsius at the end of the power pulse.
METHOD 3103
1 of 11
n. tMD: Measurement delay time is defined as the time from the removal of heating power PH to the
start of the VGE(ON) measurement.
o. tSW : Sample window time during which final VGE(ON) measurement is made.
p. ZJX: Transient junction-to-reference point thermal impedance in C/W. ZJX or specified power
pulse duration is:
Tx
Z JX = T jf - T ji -
PH
Where: Tx = change in reference point temperature during the heating pulse (see 5.2 for
short heating pulses, (e.g., die attach evaluation) this term is normally negligible.)
3. Apparatus. The apparatus required for this test shall include the following as applicable to the specified test
procedure.
3.1 Case temperature measurement. A thermocouple for measuring the case temperature at a specified
reference point. The recommended reference point shall be located on the case under the heat source.
Thermocouple material shall be copper-constantan (type T) or equivalent. The wire size shall be no larger than
AWG size 30. The junction of the thermocouple shall be welded, rather than soldered or twisted, to form a bead.
The accuracy of the thermocouple and its associated measuring system shall be 0.5C. Proper mounting of the
thermocouple to ensure intimate contact to the reference point is critical for system accuracy.
3.2 Controlled temperature environment. A controlled temperature environment capable of maintaining the case
temperature during the device calibration procedure to within 1C over the temperature range of +23C to +100C,
the recommended temperatures for measuring K-factor.
METHOD 3103
2
3.3 K factor calibration. A K factor calibration setup, as shown on figure 3103-1, that measures VGE(ON) for the
specified values of VCE and IM in an environment where temperature is both controlled and measured. A
temperature controlled circulating fluid bath is recommended. The current source shall be capable of supplying IM
with an accuracy of 2 percent. The voltage source VCG is adjusted to supply VCE with an accuracy of 2 percent.
The voltage measurement of VGE(ON) shall be made with a voltmeter capable of 1 mV resolution. The device to
current source wire size shall be sufficient to handle the measurement current (AWG size 22 stranded is typically
used for up to 100 mA).
3.4 Thermal testing. There are two approaches to the actual thermal testing, either the common gate or the
common source method. Both methods work equally well, although the common source method may be more
reliable and less potentially damaging to the DUT. The figures and description below describe the thermal
measurement for n-channel enhancement mode devices. Opposite polarity devices can be tested by appropriately
reversing the various supplies. Depletion mode devices can be tested by applying the gate emitter voltage (VGE) in
the appropriate manner.
3.4.1 Common gate thermal test circuit. A common gate configuration test circuit used to control the device and
to measure the temperature using the gate emitter ON voltage as the temperature sensing parameter as shown on
figure 3103-2. Polarities shown are for n-channel devices but the circuit may be used for p-channel types by
reversing the polarities of the voltage and current sources (For common source test circuit see figure 3103-3).
The circuit consists of the DUT, two voltage sources, two current sources, and two electronic switches. During the
heating phase of the measurement, switches S1 and S2 are in position 1. The values of VCG and IE are adjusted to
achieve the desired values of IC and VCE for the PH heating condition.
To measure the initial and post heating pulse (TJ) of the DUT, switches S1 and S2 are each switched to position 2.
This puts the gate at the measurement voltage level VCG(M) and connects the current source IM to supply
measurement current to the emitter. The values of VCG(M) and IM shall be the same as used in the K factor
calibration if actual (TJ)rise data is required. Figures 3103-4 and 3103-5 show the waveforms associated with the
three segments of the test.
3.4.2 Common source thermal test circuit. A common source configuration test circuit used to control the device
and to measure the temperature using the gate emitter ON voltage as the temperature sensing parameter as shown
on figure 3103-3. Polarities shown are for n-channel devices but the circuit may be used for p-channel types by
reversing the polarities of the voltage and current sources.
NOTE: The circuit consists of the DUT, four voltage sources, and two electronic switches. During the heating
phase of the measurement, switches S1 and S2 are in position 1. The values of VCE and VGE are adjusted to
achieve the desired values of IC and VCE for the PH heating condition.
METHOD 3103
4
To measure the initial and post heating pulse (TJ) of the DUT, switches S1 and S2 are each switched to
position 2. This puts the collector at the measurement voltage level VCE(M) and the gate at VGE(M),
which shall be adjusted to obtain IM. The values of VCE(M) and IM shall be the same as used in the K
factor calibration if actual (TJ)rise data is required. Figures 3103-4 and 3103-5 show the waveforms
associated with the three segments of the test.
FIGURE 3103-4. Device waveforms during the three segments of the thermal transient test.
METHOD 3103
5
The value of tMD is critical to the accuracy of the measurement and shall be properly specified in order to
ensure measurement repeatability. Note that some test equipment manufacturers include the sample and
hold window time tSW within their tMD specification.
NOTE: The circuits for both common gate and common source thermal measurements can be modified
so that VCE is applied during both measurement and heating periods if the value of VCE is at least ten
times the value of VGE(ON). Further, the common gate circuit can be modified so that IM is continually
applied as long as the IE current source can be adjusted for the desired value of heating current.
3.5 Source-drain forward voltage. Suitable sample-and-hold voltmeter or oscilloscope to measure source drain
forward voltage at specified times. VGE(ON) shall be measured to within 5 mV, or within 5 percent of
(VGE(ON)i - VGE(ON)f), whichever is less.
4. Measurement of the TSP. The required calibration of VGE(ON) versus TJ is accomplished by monitoring
VGE(ON) for the required values of VCE and IM as the heat sink temperature (and thus the DUT temperature) is varied
by external heating. The magnitudes of VCE and IM shall be chosen so that VGE(ON) is a linearly decreasing function
over the expected range of TJ during the power pulse. For this condition, VCE shall be at least three times VGE(ON).
IM shall be large enough to ensure that the device is turned on but not so large as to cause any significant self
heating. (This will normally be 1 mA for low power devices and up to 100 mA for high power ones.) An example
calibration curve is shown on figure 3103-6.
METHOD 3103
6
4.1 K factor calibration. A calibration factor K (which is the reciprocal of VTC or the slope of the curve on figure
3103-4) can be defined as:
1 TJ 1-TJ 2
K= = C/mV
VTC V GE(ON)1 - V GE(ON)2
It has been found experimentally that the K-factor variation for all devices within a given device type class is small.
The usual procedure is to perform a K factor calibration on a 10 to 12 piece sample from a device lot and determine
the average K and standard deviation (K). If K is less than or equal to three percent of the average value of K,
then the average value of K can be used for all devices within the lot. If K is greater than three percent of the
average value of K, then all the devices in the lot shall be calibrated and the individual values of K shall be used in
thermal impedance calculations or in correcting VGE(ON) values for comparison purposes.
When screening to ensure proper die attachment within a given lot, this calibration step is not required, (e.g.,
devices of a single manufacturer with identical PIN and case style). In such cases, the measure of thermal response
may be VGE(ON) for a short heating pulse, and the computation of TJ or ZJX is not necessary. (For this
purpose, tH shall be 10 ms for TO-39 size packages and 100 ms for TO-3 packages.)
5. Calibration. K factor shall be determined according to the procedure outlined in 4, except as noted in 4.1.
5.1 Reference point temperature. The reference point is usually chosen to be on the bottom of the transistor case
directly below the semiconductor chip in a TO-204 metal can or in close proximity to the chip-in other styles of
packages. Reference temperature point location shall be specified and its temperature shall be monitored using the
thermocouple mentioned in 3.1 during the preliminary testing. If it is ascertained that TX increases by more than five
percent of measured (TJ) rise during the power pulse, then either the heating power pulse magnitude shall be
decreased, the DUT shall be mounted in a temperature controlled heat sink, or the calculated value of thermal
impedance shall be corrected to take into account the thermal impedance of the reference point to the cooling
medium or heat sink.
METHOD 3103
7
Temperature measurements for monitoring, controlling or correcting reference point temperature changes are not
required if the tH value is low enough to ensure that the heat generated within the DUT has not had time to
propagate through the package. Typical values of tH for this case are in the 10 ms to 500 ms range, depending on
DUT package type and material.
5.2 Thermal measurements. The following sequence of tests and measurements shall be made.
(4) Measure gate emitter ON voltage VGE(ON)i (a measurement of the initial (TJ)).
(2) Apply collector heating current IH as required by adjustment of gate emitter voltage.
(3) Allow heating condition to exist for the required heating pulse duration tH.
(4) Measure reference point temperature TXf at the end of heating pulse duration.
NOTE: TX measurements are not required if the tH value meets the requirements stated in 5.2.
(3) Measure gate emitter ON voltage VGE(ON)f (a measurement of the final (TJ)).
(4) Time delay between the end of the power pulse and the completion of the VGE(ON)f measurement
as defined by the waveform of figure 3103-4 in terms of tMD plus tSW .
d. The value of thermal impedance, ZJX, is calculated from the following formula:
TJ K ( V GE(ON)f - V GE(ON)i)
Z JX = = C/W
PH ( I H )(V H )
This value of thermal impedance will have to be corrected if TXf is greater than TXi by +5C. The correction consists
of subtracting the component of thermal impedance due to the thermal impedance from the reference point (typically
the device case) to the cooling medium or heat sink. TX measurements are not required if the tH value meets the
requirements stated in 5.2.
METHOD 3103
8
NOTE: This last step is not necessary for die attach evaluation (see 4.1).
a. IM current magnitude mA
(See applicable specification sheet for current value)
K= T J 1-T J 2 C/mV
V GE(ON)1 - V GE(ON)2
6.1.4 For die attachment evaluation, this step may not be necessary (see 4.1).
METHOD 3103
9
a. IM measuring current mA
(Shall be same as used for K factor calibration)
c. IH heating current A
e. tH heating time s
NOTE: IH and VH are usually chosen so that PH is approximately two-thirds of device rated power dissipation.
VGE(ON) mV
NOTE: TX measurements are not required if the tH value meets the requirements stated in 5.2.
6.2.3 Thermal impedance. Calculate thermal impedance using the procedure and equations shown in 5.2.
6.3 VGE(ON) measurements for screening. These measurements are made for tH values that meet the intent of
4.1 and the requirements stated in 5.2.
a. IM measuring current mA
c. IH heating current A
e. tH heating time s
METHOD 3103
10
The values of IH and VH are usually chosen equal to or greater than the values used for thermal impedance
measurements.
6.3.2 Specified limits. The following data is compared to the specified limits:
VGE(ON) mV
Compute VGE(ON) mV
6.3.2.3 TJ calculation. Optionally calculate TJ if the K factor results produce a greater than three percent of
the average value of K.
T J = K( V GE(ON) ) C
METHOD 3103
11
METHOD 3104
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the thermal resistance of the MOSFET under the specified
conditions of applied voltage, current, and pulse width. The temperature sensitivity of the forward voltage drop of the
gate source diode is used as the (TJ) indicator. This method is particularly suitable for completely packaged devices.
2. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purpose of this test
method:
d. PH Magnitude of the heating power pulse applied to DUT in watts; the product of IH and VH.
TJi: Junction temperature in degrees Celsius before start of the power pulse.
TJf: Junction temperature in degrees Celsius at the end of the power pulse.
j. tMD: The time from the start of heating power (PH) removal to the completion of the final VGSf
measurement.
( T Jf - T Ji )
JX =
PH
l. CU: Comparison unit for screening devices against specification limits. Defined as the change in
forward biased gate-source voltage divided by heating current in mV/A.
3. Apparatus. The apparatus required for this test shall include the following as applicable to the specified test
procedure.
METHOD 3104
1 of 10
3.1 Case reference point temperature. The case reference point temperature shall be measured using a
thermocouple. The recommended reference point should be located immediately outside the case under the heat
source. Thermocouple material shall be copper-constantan (type T) or equivalent. The wire size shall be no larger
than AWG size 30. The junction of the thermocouple shall be welded to form a bead rather than soldered or twisted.
The accuracy of the thermocouple and associated measuring system shall be 0.5C.
3.2 Controlled temperature environment. A controlled temperature environment capable of maintaining the case
temperature during the device calibration procedure to within 1C over the temperature range of room temperature
(approximately +23C) to +100C.
3.3 K factor calibration setup. A K factor calibration setup, as shown on figure 3104-1, that measures VGSf for a
specified value of IM in an environment that is both temperature controlled and measured. The current source must
be capable of supplying IM with an accuracy of 1 percent and have a compliance of at least 1 volt and not more
than 2 volts. The voltage measurement of VGSf should be made to 1 mV resolution. The device-to-current source
wire size shall be sufficient to handle the measurement current (AWG size 26 stranded is typically used for up to 10
mA).
3.4 Controlled temperature heat sink. Controlled temperature heat sink capable of maintaining the specified
reference point temperature to within 5 of the preset (measured) value.
3.5 Test circuit. The circuit used to control the device and to measure the temperature using the forward voltage
of the gate-source diode as the temperature sensing parameter is shown on figure 3104-2. Polarities shown are for
n-channel devices but the circuit may be used for p-channel types by reversing the polarities of the voltage and
current sources.
METHOD 3104
2
NOTE: The circuit consists of the DUT, one voltage source, one current source, and one electronic switch.
During the heating phase of the measurement, switch S1 is in position 2. The value of VD is adjusted to
achieve the desired values of ID and VDS for the PH heating condition.
METHOD 3104
3
To measure the initial and post heating pulse (TJ) of the DUT, switch S1 is switched to position 1. This
disconnects the VD source during the measurement time and allows for the measurement of VGSf(i) and V
GSf(f) before and after the heating time, respectively. Figure 3104-3 shows the waveforms associated with the
three segments of the test.
FIGURE 3104-3. Device waveforms during the three segments of the thermal resistance test.
METHOD 3104
4
The time required to make the second VGSf reading is critical to the accuracy of the measurement and must be
properly specified in order to ensure measurement repeatability. The definition of measurement delay time (tMD) is
described by the waveform on figure 3104-4.
3.6 Source drain forward voltage. Suitable sample-and-hold voltmeter or oscilloscope to measure source drain
forward voltage at specified times. VGSf should be measured with 1 mV resolutions.
METHOD 3104
5
4. Measurement of the TSP VGSf. The required calibration of VGSf versus TJ is accomplished by monitoring
VGSf for the required value of IM without any connection to the drain as the heat sink temperature (and thus the DUT
temperature) is varied by external heating. The magnitude of IM should be chosen so that VGSf is a linearly
decreasing function over the expected TJ range during the power pulse. IM must be large enough to ensure that the
gate-source junction is turned on but not large enough to cause significant self heating or device destruction. An
example calibration curve is shown on figure 3104-5.
A calibration factor K (which is the reciprocal of the slope of the curve on figure 3104-5) can be defined as:
1- 2
K= TJ TJ C/mV
V GSf 1 - V GSf 2
It has been found experimentally that the K factor should vary less than several percent for all devices within a given
device type class. The usual procedure is to perform a K factor calibration on a 10 to 12 piece sample from a device
lot and determine the average K and standard deviation (). If is less than or equal to three percent of the average
value of K, then the average value of K can be used for all devices within the lot. If is greater than the average
value of K, then all the devices in the lot shall be calibrated and the individual values of K shall be used in thermal
resistance calculations.
5. Test procedure.
5.2 Reference point temperature. The reference point is usually chosen to be on the bottom of the transistor case
directly below the semiconductor chip. Reference temperature point location shall be specified and its temperature
should be monitored using the thermocouple mentioned in 3.1 during the preliminary testing. If it is ascertained that
TXf increases by more than +5C during the power pulse, then either the heating power pulse magnitude shall be
decreased, the DUT shall be mounted in a temperature controlled heat sink, or the calculated value of thermal
resistance shall be corrected to take into account the thermal resistance associated with the temperature rise of the
reference point.
METHOD 3104
6
5.3 Thermal measurements. The following sequence of tests and measurements shall be made:
(3) Measure gate-source voltage drop: VGSf(i) (A measurement of the initial (TJ)).
(4) Allow heating condition to exist for the required heating pulse width: tH.
(5) Measure reference point temperature: TXf, at the end of heating pulse width.
(2) Measure gate-source voltage drop: VGSf(f) (A measurement of the final (TJ)).
(3) Determine time delay between the end of the power pulse and the completion of the VGSf(f)
measurement as defined by the waveform of figure 3104-4.
5.4 Thermal resistance. The value of thermal resistance, JX, is calculated from the following formula:
TJ K |V GSF(f) - V GSf(i)|
JX = =
PH ( I H )(V H )
This value of thermal resistance will have to be corrected if TXf is greater than TXi. The correction consists of
subtracting out the component of thermal resistance due to the heat flow path from the reference point (typically the
device case) to the heat sink and the environment. This thermal resistance component has a value calculated as
follows:
TX ( T Xf - T Xi )
X - HS = =
PH ( I H ) (V H )
Then: JX | = JX | - X-HS
| |
| |
Corrected Calculated
METHOD 3104
7
An additional correction may be required because of the fast cooling of a typical MOSFET heat source area. This
requires that the thermal resistance measurements be made for two different values of tMD. Care shall be taken to
ensure that the shorter of the chosen tMD values does not lie within the non-thermal (i.e, electrical) switching
transient region. Similarly, if the longer tMD value is too large, the resultant value of JX will be too small for an
accurate measurement due to device cooling. The correction for the calculated thermal resistance is given below for
test conditions in which IM, VH, and tH remain the same for both tests.
JX 2 - JX 1
JX = JX = JX | = 1/2
t MD1 - t MD2 1/2
|
calculated value
K= T J 1 - T J 2 C/mV
V GSf 1 - V GSf 2
d. For die attachment evaluation, this step may not be necessary (see 4.1).
a. IM measuring current mA
(Shall be same as used for K factor calibration)
c. tH heating time s
NOTE: The value of VH is usually chosen to produce an IH value that results in a PH approximately two-thirds of the
device rated power dissipation.
METHOD 3104
8
VGSf mV
6.2.2.3 JX data:
JX C/W
NOTE: TX measurements are not required if the tH value meets the requirements stated in 5.2.
6.2.3 Thermal impedance calculations. Using the data collected in 6.2.2 and the procedure and equations shown
in 5.4, calculate the thermal resistance.
6.3 VGSF measurements for screening. These measurements are made for tH values that meet the intent of
4.1 and the requirements stated in 5.2.
a. IM measuring current mA
c. tH heating time s
NOTE: The value of VH is usually chosen to produce an IH value that results in a PH equal to or greater than the
values used for thermal impedance measurements.
6.3.2 Specified limits. Data from one or more of the following is compared to the specified limits:
VGSf mV
Compute VSD mV
METHOD 3104
9
6.3.2.3 TJ data. Optionally calculate TJ if the K factor results (see 4. and 6.1) produce a greater than three
percent of the average value of K and if the IH variation between devices to be compared is relatively small.
T J = K( V GSf ) C
NOTE: The test apparatus shall be capable of directly providing a computed value of TJ.
6.3.2.4 CU data. Optionally calculate CU for comparison purposes if the K factor results (see 4. and 6.1) produce
a less than three percent of the average value of K and if the IH variation between devices to be compared is
relatively large.
CU = comparison unit
CU = VGSf/IH mV/A
NOTE: The test apparatus may be capable of directly providing a computed value of CU.
METHOD 3104
10
METHOD 3105.1
1. Purpose. This test describes a means to cause current to flow alternately through the legs of a single-phase or
three-phase bridge assembly under conditions to make it feasible to determines its effective thermal resistance. The
bridge is operated under steady-state (IO) conditions and the current in each leg is interrupted while readings are
taken from which to calculate thermal resistance.
2. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purposes of this test
method:
a. VF: The forward-biased junction voltage of the DUT used for (TJ) sensing. For bridge, this
applies to individual legs (i.e., one ac to one dc terminal).
c. VF2: The forward voltage at Iref and +100C above that at VF1.
d. VF2A: The computed forward voltage at Iref and at maximum rated TJ.
e. VF3: The initial VF value at Iref before the application of heating power, with the device at rated
case temperature.
f. VF4: The final VF value at Iref after stabilization of temperatures due to the application of rated
current at rated case temperature.
g. VF: The change in the TSP VF, due to the application of heating power to the DUT in volts.
h. VFH: The maximum forward voltage resulting from the application of IO to the DUT.
j. Iref: The measurement current used to forward-bias the temperature sensing diode junction
for measurement of VF.
q. RJX: Thermal resistance from device junction to a defined reference point (e.g., lead or ambient)
in units of C/W.
r. RJC: Thermal resistance from device junction to a defined reference point on the outside surface
of the case in units of C/W.
METHOD 3105.1
1 of 6
3. Test circuit. The apparatus required for this test shall include the following, configured as shown on figures
3105-1 and 3105-2.
a. A source of 60 Hz, single or three-phase sine wave (AC) capable of being adjusted to the desired value of
IO and able to supply the VFH value required by the DUT. The current source should be able to maintain
the desired current to within 2 percent during the entire time needed for temperature stabilization and
measurements.
b. A constant current source to supply IREF with sufficient compliance voltage range to turn on fully the
junction of the diode leg being measured.
c. Anti-parallel fast recovery rectifier diodes with ratings exceeding IO, to provide isolation of the high current
source from IREF during commutation of IO between legs.
d. A voltage measurement circuit capable of accurately making the VF measurements within the available
time interval (when the anti-parallel diodes are not conducting), with millivolt resolution.
4. Procedure. Refer to figures 3105-1 and 3105-2, test circuits for single- and three-phase bridges.
a. With S1 open, and DUT at +20C to +30C (temperature T1), read VF1 of each leg at current IREF.
Elevate the device temperature to +100C above temperature T1 (temperature T2). Allow the device to
stabilize until the junction temperature is at T2. Read VF2 of each leg at IREF current. Compute the TCVF
of each leg as follows:
Determine the average TCVF and the standard deviation of the TCVF from the readings on each leg. If the
standard deviation is less than or equal to three percent of the average value of TCVF, TCVF may be used
for all devices. If the standard deviation is greater than three percent of the average value of TCVF, then
the individual values of TCVF shall be used in determining the performance of the bridge.
b. With the device held at T3, at or below rated case temperature of IO, close S1 and read VF3 for each leg.
c. After closing S1, adjust the power source, the load resistor, or both to obtain the maximum rated IO (either
IO1 or IO2, depending on the rated TC selected) and readjust the case temperature to the chosen rated
value. Allow the device to achieve stable junction temperatures (see note 1).
d. Measure VF4 (see figure 3105-2) for each leg at the same reference current (1 percent) as in steps 4.a.
and 4.b. (The instrumentation used to measure VF4 must have sufficient resolution to read it within 2 mV
or 2 percent).
NOTE: If VF3 for the leg is greater than VF2, TJ is less than TJmax.
METHOD 3105.1
2
V F
(2) Compute TJ = 1/
TCVF
T JC
(3) Compute RJC of the full bridge: RJC =
I o x 2 V FH
Where: TJ is the average of all legs. VFH is the average of all legs and IO is the rectified
output current of the full bridge. 2/ 3/ 4/
IO ____________________
TC ____________________
IREF ____________________
Frequency____________________
(if other than 60 Hz)
6. Characteristics to be determined:
______
1/ If, under power, the case is held to T4, slightly above T3, a corrected TJ (TJ(corr) = TJC - (T4 - T3)) should
be used for step 4 f(2).
2/ Step 4 f(3) gives Rth for the bridge. The average per leg Rth for a single-phase bridge is four times the value; six
times for a three-phase bridge (see 3/).
3/ If desired, Rth of individual legs may be computed from the individual values of TJC and VFH.
4/ The power dissipated IO x 2VFH is a reasonable approximation.
METHOD 3105.1
3
NOTES:
1. All voltage measurements shall be made using leads Kelvin-connected directly to the bridge terminals.
2. VAC is adjusted so that the VF4 step (tF4) shown on figure 3105-3 is 100 s 50 s and is clearly defined.
A typical VAC might be 10 volts peak. Bridges with parasitic inductive components shall adjust VAC so
that after the inductive ringing settles, the VF4 step on figure 3105-3 (tF4) is 100 s 50 s.
METHOD 3105.1
4
NOTES:
1. All voltage measurements shall be made using leads Kelvin-connected directly to the bridge terminals.
2. VAC is adjusted so that the VF4 step (tF4) shown on figure 3105-3 is 100 s 50 s and is clearly
defined. A typical VAC might be 10 volts peak. Bridges with parasitic inductive components shall adjust
VAC so that after the inductive ringing settles, the VF4 step on figure 3105-3 (tF4) is 100 s 50 s.
METHOD 3105.1
5
METHOD 3105.1
6
METHOD 3126
THERMAL RESISTANCE
(COLLECTOR CUTOFF CURRENT METHOD)
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the thermal resistance of the device under the specified
conditions. This method is particularly applicable to the measurement of germanium devices having relatively large
thermal response times.
FIGURE 3126-1. Test circuit for thermal resistance (collector cutoff current method).
3. Procedure. Switches S1 and S2 are ganged and are operated such that the time they are closed (heat interval)
is much larger than the time they are open (measurement interval). S1 is arranged to open slightly before S2 opens,
and the interval between the opening of S1 and S2 is adjusted to be short compared to the thermal time constant of
the device being measured. The length of the measurement interval should be short compared to the thermal
response time of the transistor being measured. When both switches are open, the value of ICBO is read as the
drop across RB. If the ICBO varies during the measurement interval, the value immediately following the opening of
S2 should be read. A calibrated oscilloscope makes a convenient detector. Care should be taken that the collector
voltage stays constant.
3.1 Measurement interval. The measurement is made in the following manner: The case, ambient, or other
reference point is elevated to a high temperature T2, not exceeding the maximum (TJ), and the cutoff current, ICBO,
read with the constant current source supplying no current. The reference temperature is then reduced to a lower
temperature T1, and power, P1, is applied to heat the transistor, by increasing the current from the constant current
source, until the same value of ICBO is read as was read above.
T 2 - T1
Then: =
P1
Where: P1 = (n) ( I C V CC + I E V EB )
t on
n = duty cycle
t total
METHOD 3126
1 of 2
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3126
2
METHOD 3131.5
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the thermal performance of transistor devices. This can be
done in two ways, steady-state thermal impedance or thermal transient testing. Steady-state thermal impedance
(referred to as thermal resistance) determines the overall thermal performance of devices. A production oriented
screening process, referred to as transient thermal impedance testing, is a subset of steady-state thermal
impedance testing and determines the ability of the transistor chip-to-header interface to transfer heat from the chip
to the header, and is a measure of the thermal quality of the die attachment. It is relevant to designs which use
headers, or heat conducting plugs, with mass and thermal conductivity allowing effective discrimination of poor die
attachments. This is particularly true with power devices. The method can be applied to small signal, power,
switching, and Darlington transistors. This method is intended for production monitoring, incoming inspection, and
pre-burn in screening applications. The measurement current (IM) shall be large enough to ensure that the
Darlington output transistor is biased into the linear conduction mode of the temperature sensing measurement
periods of the thermal test.
1.1 Background and scope for transient thermal impedance testing. Transient thermal impedance of
semiconductor devices are sensitive to the presence of voids in the die attachment material between the
semiconductor chip and package since voids impede the flow of heat from the chip to the substrate (package). Due
to the difference in the thermal time constants of the chip and package, the measurement of transient thermal
impedance can be made more sensitive to the presence of voids than can the measurement of steady-state thermal
impedance. This is because the chip thermal time constant is generally several orders of magnitude shorter than
that of the package. Thus, the heating power pulse width can be selected so that only the chip and the chip-to-
substrate interface are heated during the pulse by using a pulse width somewhat greater than the chip thermal time
constant but less than that of the substrate. Heating power pulse widths ranging from 1 to 400 ms for various
package designs have been found to satisfy this criterion. This enables the detection of voids to be greatly
enhanced, with the added advantage of not having to heat sink the device under test (DUT). Thus, the transient
thermal impedance techniques are less time consuming than the measurement of thermal resistance for use as a
manufacturing screen, process control, or incoming inspection measure for die attachment integrity evaluation.
2. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purpose of this test
method:
a. TJ: The change in TJ caused by the application of PH for a time equal to tH.
b. VBE: The change in VBE, (VBEi-VBEf) due to the application of heating power PH to the DUT.
c. CU: The comparison unit, consisting of VBE divided by VBE, that is used to normalize the transient
thermal impedance for variations in power dissipation; in units of mV/V.
d. IH: The collector current applied to the DUT during the heating period.
e. IM: The measurement current applied to forward bias the junction for measurement of VBE.
h. RJA: Steady-state. Thermal resistance from device junction to an ambient (world); in units of C/W.
i. RJC: Steady-state. Thermal resistance from device junction to a point on the outside surface of the case
immediately adjacent to the device chip; in units of C/W.
METHOD 3131.5
1 of 15
j. RJX: Steady-state. Thermal resistance from device junction to a defined reference point; in units of C/W.
l. ti: The time after application of the measurement current (IM) and before application of the PH pulse.
n. tMD: Measurement delay time is the time from the end of the PH pulse to the beginning of the sample
window time (tSW ). Delay shall be sufficient in length to allow for attenuation of switching transients to
occur. The delay time will vary according to the length of the cable to test fixture and associated fixture
inductances.
p. tSW: Sample window time during which final VBE measurement is made. The value of tSW should be small;
and occur at precisely the conclusion of tMD. It can approach zero if an oscilloscope is used for
manual measurements and no transient effects are present.
q. VBE: The forward-biased base emitter junction voltage of the DUT used for TJ sensing.
VBEi: The initial VBE value during application of measurement current (IM) and before application of heating
power.
VBEf: The final VBE value during the sample window time (tSW ) after application and subsequent removal of
heating power.
r. VCE: The voltage between the collector and emitter. VCE is constant throughout the test.
s. VTC: Voltage-temperature coefficient of VBE with respect to TJ at a fixed value of IM; in mV/C.
t. ZJC: Transient. Thermal impedance from device junction to a point on the outside surface of the case
immediately adjacent to the device chip measured using time equal time constant of device; in units of
C/W.
u. ZJX: Transient. Thermal impedance from device junction to a time defined reference point; in units of C/W.
3. Apparatus. The apparatus required for this test shall include the following, configured as shown on figure
3131-1, as applicable to the specified test procedure:
a. A constant current source capable of adjustment to the desired value of IH and able to supply the VBE value
required by the DUT. The current source should be able to maintain the desired current to within 2 percent
during the entire length of heating time.
b. A constant current source to supply IM with sufficient voltage compliance to turn the TSP junction fully on.
c. An electronic switch capable of switching between the heating period conditions and measurement
conditions in a time frame short enough to avoid DUT cooling during the transition; this typically requires
switching in the microsecond or tens of microseconds range.
d. A voltage measurement circuit capable of accurately making the VBEf measurement within the time frame
with millivolt resolution.
METHOD 3131.5
2
4.1 General description. The test begins with the adjustment of IM and IH to the desired values. The value of IH is
usually at least 50 times greater than the value of IM. Then with the electronic switch in position 1, the value of
VBEi is measured. The switch is then moved to position 2 for a length of time equal to tH and the value of VBE is
measured. Finally, at the conclusion of tH, the switch is again moved to position 1 and the VBEf value is measured
within a time period defined by tMD (or tMD + tSW , depending on the definitions stated previously). The two current
sources are then turned off at the completion of the test.
4.1.2 Thermal resistance characterization of dual and quad bipolar transistors. Traditionally, thermal resistance
has been called out on specification sheets without any clarification as to whether the values are for each element or
all elements in parallel. While the assumption has been that the specifications for thermal resistance apply to all
elements in parallel, there has been no procedure on how to do this. The thermal resistance test setup cannot
directly parallel the transistors because the higher gain element will draw all of the current from the elements.
Further complicating this scenario is the case of complimentary NPN-PNP pairs and quads. Circuitry necessary for
measuring thermal resistance and thermal impedance is prohibitive. It is recommended that thermal resistance and
thermal impedance be measured on each element individually while the other elements are un-powered. These
individual readings cannot be combined in any way to yield the total rating. This means that there is no universal
method to measure the dual or quad as a whole and the individual device specification shall not require such a
measurement. Overall power rating can be derived from similar packages employing single elements.
4.1.3 Thermal resistance characterization of small emitter bipolar transistors. The accepted practice for
measuring junction temperature for thermal impedance and thermal resistance measurements of BJTs is to employ
the base-emitter (BE) junction as the temperature sensor. However, since the base area is always larger than the
emitter area, some measurement errors can arise. When the ratio of emitter area (AE) to base area (AB) is greater
than 0.5 (i.e. AE/AB > 0.5), this error is negligible, especially for long heating times. However, for small emitter BJT
structures (low capacitance, high frequency, low current) this ratio can fall significantly below 0.5. For example, a
2
BJT with two emitter elements sized each at 1x2 mils would have an emitter area of 4 mil total. That same structure
2
could have a base region of 6x6 mils for a base area of 36 mil total. This makes AE/AB = 4/36 =0.11, a value
considerably lower than the 0.5 guideline mentioned above. The problem with structures where AE/AB is below 0.5 is
that you will be measuring a thermal response rather than a thermal impedance. A thermal response is defined as a
measurement with no usable readings other that being able to be used for comparison. This measurement will no
longer be able to tell the peak temperature of the emitter because the emitter region will be hotter than parts of the
base and base contact region giving an average temperature rather than a peak temperature. This error is greatest
for short measurement times where the radial temperature gradient is greatest and diminishes significantly for
steady-state thermal resistance measurements where the entire chip has had a chance to heat up thereby reducing
the error causing temperature gradient. The meaning of all this to the user and to the supplier is that, for small
emitter area BJTs, only thermal response will be available for process monitor and not thermal impedance. Also,
true thermal resistance may be higher than measured especially if the BJT is tested case-mounted rather than free-
air. Where users require an accurate thermal impedance verses heating time curve, that curve will either have to be
calculated or not be supplied at all. There is no currently accepted way in this test method to verify a BJT against a
calculated curve.
METHOD 3131.5
3
4.2 Notes.
a. Some test equipment may provide a VBE directly instead of VBEi and VBEf; this is an acceptable alternative.
Record the value of VBE.
b. Some test equipment may provide ZJX directly instead of VBEi and VBEf for thermal resistance calculations; this
is an acceptable alternative. Record the value of ZJX .
c. Alternative waveforms, as may be generated by ATE using the general principles of this method, may be used
upon approval of the qualifying activity.
d. Some test equipment allows you to set VCB and not VCE. This is acceptable provided that you measure VBE at
some point in the procedure and add that value to VCB to obtain VCE.
5. Acceptance limit.
5.1 General discussion. Variations in transistor characteristics from one manufacturer to another cause difficulty
in establishing a single acceptance limit for all transistors tested to a given specification sheet. Ideally, a single
acceptance limit value for VBE would be the simplest approach. However, different design, materials, and
processes can alter the resultant VBE value for a given set of test conditions. Listed below are several different
approaches to defining acceptance limits. The VBE limit is the simplest approach and is usually selected for
screening purposes. Paragraphs 5.3 through 5.6 require increasingly greater detail or effort.
5.2 VBE limit. A single VBE limit is practical if the K factor and VBE values for all transistors tested to a given
specification sheet are nearly identical. Since these values may be different for different manufacturers, the use of
different limits is likely to more accurately achieve the desired intent. (A lower limit does not indicate a better die
bond when comparing different product sources.) The transistor specification sheet would list the following test
conditions and measurement parameters:
a. IH (in A).
b. tH (in ms).
c. IM (in mA).
5.3 TJ limit. (Much more involved than VBE, but useful for examining questionable devices.) Since TJ is the
product of K (in accordance with 6 herein) and VBE, this approach is the same as defining a maximum acceptable
TJ rise for a given set of test conditions.
5.4 CU limit. (Slightly more involved than TJ.) The TJ limit approach described above does not take into
account potential power dissipation variations between devices. The VBE value can vary, depending on chip design
and size, thus causing the power dissipation during the heating time to be different from device to device. This
variation will be small within a lot of devices produced by a single manufacturer but may be large between
manufacturers. A CU limit value takes into account variations in power dissipation due to differences in VBE by
dividing the VBE value by VBE.
METHOD 3131.5
4
5.5 (KCU) limit. (Slightly more involved but provides greater detail.) This is a combinational approach that takes
into account both K factor and power dissipation variations between devices.
5.6 ZJX limit. (For full characterization; not required for screening purposes, but preferred if the proper ATE is
available.) The transient thermal impedance approach uses an absolute magnitude value specification that
overcomes the problems associated with the other approaches. Transient thermal impedance is time dependent
and is calculated as follows:
TJ ( K )(VBE ) OC/W
ZJX = =
PD ( IH )(VH )
5.7 RJX limit. (For thermal resistance specification testing.) The thermal resistance to some defined point, such
as the case, is an absolute magnitude value specification used for equilibrium conditions. The tH heating time shall
therefore be extended to longer times (typically 20 to 50 seconds). In the example of RJC measurements, the case
shall be carefully stabilized and monitored in temperature which requires an infinite heat sink for optimum results.
The TJ is the difference in TJ to the case temperature for the example of RJC.
TJ ( K )(VBE ) OC/W
RJX = =
PD ( IH )(VH )
5.8 General comment for transient thermal impedance testing. One potential problem in using the transient
thermal impedance testing approach lies in trying to make accurate enough measurements with sufficient resolution
to distinguish between acceptable and non-acceptable transistors. As the DUT current handling capability
increases, the thermal impedance under transient conditions will become a very small value. This raises the
potential for rejecting good devices and accepting bad ones. Higher IH values shall be used in this case.
METHOD 3131.5
5
6. Measurement of the TSP VBE. The calibration of VBE versus TJ is accomplished by monitoring VBE for the
required value of IM as the environmental temperature (and thus the DUT temperature), and is varied by external
heating. It is not required if the acceptance limit is VBE (see 5.2), but is relevant to the other acceptance criteria
(see 5.3 through 5.6). The magnitude of IM shall be chosen so that VBE is a linearly decreasing function over the
normal TJ range of the device. IM shall be large enough to ensure that the base-emitter junction is turned on but not
large enough to cause significant self heating. An example of the measurement method and resulting calibration
curve is shown on figure 3131-2.
VCB
T J2 - T J1
Step 3: K= C/mV
V BE2 - V BE1
NOTES:
1. IM: Shall be large enough to overcome surface leakage effects but small enough not to cause significant self
heating.
METHOD 3131.5
6
A calibration factor K (which is the reciprocal of the slope of the curve on figure 3131-2) can be defined as:
T J 2 - T J1
K= C/mV
V BE 2 - V BE1
The K factor is used to calibrate the DUT such that the measured forward voltage drop corresponds to the
temperature of the junction at a given bias condition. In order to ensure accurate results, the bias conditions used to
determine the K factor shall be chosen such that the application is duplicated. Therefore, the results will be unique
for each particular biasing condition and should be reestablished for different values of base or collector. This
method should be used for each of the following conditions: Transient thermal impedance, burn-in, and life-tests.
Verify actual TJ seen by a device in field applications.
NOTE: It is important that the range of temperatures that K-factor is measured over approximately correlates to the
range of temperature used for thermal measurements. It is wise to characterize your product at least once over a
broad temperature range using increments of 25C.
It has been found experimentally that the K-factor variation for all devices within a given device type class is small.
The usual procedure is to perform a K factor calibration on a 10 piece to 12 piece sample from a device lot and
determine the average K and standard deviation (). If is less than or equal to 3 percent of the average value of K,
then the average value of K can be used for all devices within the lot. If is greater than 3 percent of the average
value of K, then all the devices in the lot shall be calibrated and the individual values of K shall be used in
determining device acceptance. As an alternative to using individual values of K, the manufacture may establish
internal limits unique to their product that ensures atypical product removal from the population (lot-to-lot and within-
the-lot). The manufacturer shall use statistic techniques to establish the limits to the satisfaction of the Government.
7. Establishment of test conditions and acceptance limits. Thermal resistance measurements require that IH be
equal to the required value stated in the device specification sheet, typically at rated current or higher. Values for tH,
tMD, and heat sink conditions are also taken from the device specification sheet. The steps shown below are
primarily for transient thermal impedance testing and thermal characterization purposes.
The following steps describe how to set up the test conditions and determine the acceptance limits for implementing
the transient thermal test for die attachment evaluation using the apparatus and definitions stated above.
7.1 Initial device testing procedure. The following steps describe in detail how to set up the apparatus described
previously for proper testing of various transistors. Since this procedure thermally characterizes the transistor out to
a point in heating time required to ensure heat propagation into the case (i.e., the RJX condition), an appropriate
heat sink should be used or the case temperature should be monitored.
Step 1: From a statistically valid sample, pick any one DUT to start the setup process. Set up the test apparatus
as follows:
IH = 1.0 A (Or some other desired value near the DUTs normal operating current, typically
higher for power transistors.)
50 - 100 ms Unless otherwise specified, for most devices rated up to 200 W power dissipation.
250 ms For steady-state thermal impedance measurement. The pulse shall be shown to
correlate to steady-state conditions before it can be substituted for steady-state
condition.
METHOD 3131.5
7
tMD = 100 s max A different max value may be required by the specification or on power devices with
inductive package elements which generate non-thermal electrical transients; unless
otherwise specified, this would be observed in the t3 region of figure 3131-3.
METHOD 3131.5
8
Step 2: Insert device into the apparatus test fixture and initiate a test. (For best results, a test fixture that offers
some form of heat sinking would be desirable. Heat sinking is not needed if either the power dissipation
during the test is well within the DUTs free air rating or the maximum heating time is limited to less than
that required for the heat to propagate through the case.)
Step 3: If TJ is at least high enough to resolve thermal impedance/resistance to within 1 percent and the DUT
does not exceed TJ(max), the applied power is likely appropriate. High power case-mounted DUTs will
tend to have lower TJ while air cooled DUTs may need the higher TJ since their thermal resistance
depends upon operating temperature.
If TJ is less than specified above, return to 7.1, step 1 and increase heating power into device by
increasing IH.
If TJ is greater than the safe junction operating temperature, it is required to reduce the heating power
by returning to 7.1, step 1 and reducing IH.
NOTE: The test equipment shall be capable of resolving VBE to within 5 percent. If not, the higher
value of VBE shall be selected until the 5 percent tolerance is met. Two different devices can have the
same TJ rise even when PH is different, due to widely differing VBE. Within a given lot, however, a higher
VBE is more likely to result in a higher TJ rise. For such examples, this screen can be more accurately
accomplished using the CU value. As defined in 2.c herein, CU provides a comparison unit that takes
into account different device VBE values for a given IH test condition.
Step 4: Test each of the sample devices and record the data detailed in 8.1.
Step 5: Select out the devices with the highest and lowest values of CU or ZJX and put the remaining devices
aside.
The VBE values can be used instead of CU or ZJX if the measured values of VBE are very tightly grouped
around the average value.
Step 6: Using the devices from 7.1, step 5, collect and plot the heating curve data for the two devices in a
manner similar to the examples shown on figure 3131-4.
Step 7: Interpretation of the heating curves is the next step. Realizing that the thermal characteristics of identical
chips should be the same if the tH is less than or equal to the thermal time constant of the chip, the two
curves should start out the same for the low values of tH. Non-identical chips (thinner or smaller in cross
section) will have completely different curves, even at the smaller values of tH. As the value of tH is
increased, thereby exceeding the chip thermal constant, heat will have propagated through the chip into
the die attachment region. Since the heating curve devices of 7.1, step 5 were specifically chosen for
their difference, the curves of figure 3131-4 diverge after tH reaches a value where the die attachment
variance has an affect on the device TJ. Increasing tH further will probably result in a flattening of the
curve as the heating propagates in the device package. If the device package has little thermal mass
and is not well mounted to a good heat sink, the curve will not flatten very much, but will show a definite
change in slope.
METHOD 3131.5
9
Step 8: Using the heating curve, select the appropriate value of tH to correspond to the inflection point in the
transition region between heat in the chip and heat in the package.
If there are several different elements in the heat flow path: Chip, die attachment, substrate, substrate
attach, and package, for example in a hybrid, there will be several plateaus and transitions in the heating
curve. Appropriate selection of tH will optimize evaluation sensitivity to other attachment areas.
Step 9: Return to the apparatus and set tH equal to the value determined from 7.1, step 8.
10
Steady State
Heat Crossing
Die Bond Area
Heat in Header
ZJX
1
(C/W)
Good Die
Bond
Questionable
Heat in Die Die Bond
0.1
0.001 0.01 0.1 1 10
Tp Elapsed Time (Seconds)
METHOD 3131.5
10
Step 10: Because the selected value of tH is much less than that for thermal equilibrium, it is possible to
significantly increase the PH without degrading or destroying the device. The increased power
dissipation within the DUT will result in higher VBE or CU values that will make determination of
acceptable and non-acceptable devices much easier.
Step 11: The pass/fail limit, the cut-off point between acceptable and non-acceptable devices, can be established
in a variety of ways:
a. Correlation to other die attachment evaluation methods, such as die shear and x-ray. While these two
methods have little actual value from a thermal point of view, they do represent standardization methods
as described in various standards.
b. Maximum allowable junction temperature variations between devices. Since the relationship between
TJ and VBE is about 0.5C/mV for forward bias testing, or 0.25C/mV for Darlington transistors, the TJ
spread between devices can be easily determined. The TJ predicts reliability. Conversely, the TJ
spread necessary to meet the reliability projections can be translated to a VBE or CU value for pass/fail
criteria.
To fully utilize this approach, it will be necessary to calibrate the devices for the exact value of the TJ to
VBE characteristic. The characteristic's slope, commonly referred to as K factor, is easily measured on a
sample basis using a voltmeter, environmental chamber, temperature indicator, and a power supply
setup as described in 6 herein. A simple set of equations yield the TJ once K and VBE are known:
TJ = (K) (VBE)
TJ = TA + TJ
Where: TA is the ambient or reference temperature. For thermal transient test conditions, this
temperature is usually equivalent to case temperature (TC) for case mounted devices.
c. From a statistically valid sample, the distribution of VBE or CU values should be a normal one with
defective devices out of the normal range. Figure 3131-5 shows a VBE distribution for a sample lot of
transistors. NOTE: The left-hand side of the histogram envelope is fairly well defined but the other side
is greatly skewed to the right. This is because the left-hand side is constrained by the absolute best
heat flow that can be obtained with a given chip assembly material and process unless a test method
error is introduced. The other side has no such constraints because there is no limit as to how poorly a
chip is mounted.
VBE
METHOD 3131.5
11
The usual rule of thumb in setting the maximum limit for VBE, CU, or ZJX is to use the distribution
average value and three standard deviations (). For example:
__
| (VBE) | = VBE + X
high
limit
__
| (CU) | = CU + X
high
limit
__
| (ZJX) | = ZJX + X
high
limit
Where: X = 3 in most cases and VBE, CU, and ZJX are the average distribution values.
The statistical data required is obtained by testing a statistically valid sample size of devices
under the conditions of 7.1, step 11.
The maximum limit determined from this approach should be correlated to the transistor's
specified thermal resistance. This will ensure that the VBE or CU limits do not pass DUTs
that would fail the thermal resistance or transient thermal impedance requirements.
METHOD 3131.5
12
Step 12: Once the test conditions and pass/fail limit have been determined, it is necessary only to record this
information for future testing requirements of the same device in the same package. It is also
recommended that a minimum limit is established to ensure a test method error or other anomaly is
investigated.
Step 13: After the pass/fail limits are established, there shall be verification they correlate to good and bad
bonded devices or the electrical properties such as surge.
7.2 Routine device thermal transient testing procedure. Once the proper control settings have been determined
for a particular device type from a given manufacturing process or vendor, repeated testing of that device type simply
requires that the same test conditions be used as previously determined. New device types, or the same devices
manufactured with a different process, will require a repeat of 7.1 for proper thermal transient test conditions.
METHOD 3131.5
13
a. IM measuring current mA
b. IH heating current A
c. tH heating time ms
b. VH heating voltage V
NOTE: Some test equipment may provide a VBE instead of VBEi and VBEf; this is an acceptable alternative.
Record the value of VBE.
Some test equipment may provide direct display of calculated CU or ZJX; this is an acceptable alternative. Record
the value of CU or ZJX.
8.2 K factor calibration. (Optional for criteria 8.2.1.a or 8.2.1.b, mandatory for 8.2.1.c, 8.2.1.d, or 8.2.1.e.)
a. IM current magnitude mA
METHOD 3131.5
14
T J 2 - T J1
K= C/mV
V BE 2 - V BE 1
K factor C/mV
8.3 Specification limit calculations. One or more of the following should be measured or calculated, as stated on
the device specification sheet (see 5.1):
a. VBE mV
b. CU mV/V
c. TJ C
d. KCU C/V
e. ZJX C/W
f. RJX C/W
METHOD 3131.5
15
METHOD 3132
THERMAL RESISTANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the thermal resistance of the device under the specified
conditions.
FIGURE 3132-1. Test circuit for thermal resistance (dc forward voltage drop,
emitter base, continuous method).
3. Procedure. The measurement technique assumes that the forward emitter voltage drop varies with
temperature. It further assumes that during the course of measurement, the variation in forward emitter voltage drop
varies monotonically due to temperature and is much greater than that due to the variation with collector voltage.
3.1 Measurement. The measurement is made in the following manner: The case, ambient, or other reference
point is elevated to a high temperature T2, not exceeding the maximum TJ. Current IC is set to a value and a voltage
applied to the collector base diode, V2. The value of V2 applied shall be low yet high enough so that the device is
operating in a normal manner. V1EB is read under these conditions. The reference temperature is reduced to a
lower temperature T1 and VCC varied until the same value of V1EB is read as was read above. The thermal
resistance is then:
T 2 - T1
=
I C (V 1 - V 2 )
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test temperatures.
b. IC and V2.
METHOD 3132
1 of 1
METHOD 3136
THERMAL RESISTANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the thermal resistance of the device under the specified
conditions. This method is particularly applicable to the measurement of germanium and silicon devices having
relatively long thermal response times.
FIGURE 3136-1. Test circuit for thermal resistance (forward voltage drop,
collector to base, diode method).
3. Procedure. Switches S1 and S2 are ganged switches and are so arranged that S2 opens very shortly after S1
opens and such that the delay between the openings is much shorter than the thermal response time of the device
being measured. S1 and S2 should be closed (heat interval) for a much larger time than they are open
(measurement interval) and the measurement interval should be short compared to the thermal response time of the
device being measured.
METHOD 3136
1 of 2
3.1 Measurement. The measurement is made in the following manner: The case, ambient, or other reference
point is elevated to a high temperature T2, not exceeding the maximum TJ, and the collector base voltage, VCB, is
read. This reading is made at the beginning of the measurement interval. An oscilloscope makes a convenient
detector. The reference temperature is then reduced to a lower temperature, T1. The heating power, P1, is adjusted
by adjusting the heating current source in the emitter circuit until the same value of VCB is read as was read above.
The value of is calculated from the equation:
-
= T 2 T1
P1
Where: P1 = (n) (IC VCC + IE VEB)
t
and n = duty cycle on
t total
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3136
2
METHOD 3141
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the time required for the junction to reach 90 percent of the
final value of junction temperature change following application of a step function of power dissipation under
specified conditions.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus used to determine the thermal response time shall be capable of demonstrating
device conformance to the minimum requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The thermal response time shall be determined by measuring the time required for the TJ (as
indicated by a precalibrated temperature sensitive electrical parameter) to reach 90 percent of the final value of TJ
change caused by a step function in power dissipation when the device case or ambient temperature, as specified,
is held constant.
4. Summary. The device case or ambient temperature shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
METHOD 3141
1 of 1
METHOD 3146.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the time required for the junction to reach 63.2 percent of the
final value of TJ change following application of a step function of power dissipation under specified conditions.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus used to determine the thermal time constant shall be capable of demonstrating
device conformance to the minimum requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The thermal time constant shall be determined by measuring the time required for the TJ (as
indicated by a precalibrated temperature sensitive electrical parameter) to reach 63.2 percent of the final value of TJ
change caused by a step function in power dissipation, when the device case or ambient temperature, as specified,
is held constant.
4. Summary. The device case or ambient temperature shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
METHOD 3146.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3151
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the temperature rise per unit power dissipation of the
designated junction above the case of the device or ambient temperature, under conditions of steady state
operation.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus used to determine the thermal resistance shall be capable of demonstrating device
conformance to the minimum requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
a. Measuring the junction power required to maintain the TJ constant (as indicated by a precalibrated
temperature sensitive electrical parameter) when the case of the device or ambient temperature, as
specified, is changed by a known amount.
b. Measuring the TJ (as indicated by a precalibrated temperature sensitive electrical parameter) when the
junction power is changed a known amount while the case of the device or ambient temperature, as
specified, is held constant.
4. Summary. The characteristic being measured, RJC or RJA shall be specified in the applicable specification
sheet.
METHOD 3151
1 of 1
METHOD 3161.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the thermal impedance of the MOSFET under the specified
conditions of applied voltage, current, and pulse duration. The temperature sensitivity of the forward voltage of the
source drain diode is used as the junction temperature indicator. This method is particularly suitable to
enhancement mode, power MOSFET's having relatively long thermal response times. This test method may be
used to measure the thermal response of the junction to a heating pulse, to ensure proper die mountdown to its
case, or the dc thermal resistance, by the proper choice of the pulse duration and magnitude of the heating pulse.
The appropriate test conditions and limits are detailed in 5 herein.
1.1 Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purpose of this test
method:
IH: Heating current through the drain.
IM: Current in the source drain diode during measurement of the source drain voltage.
TJi: Junction temperature in degrees Celsius before start of the power pulse.
TJf: Junction temperature in degrees Celsius at the end of the power pulse.
tMD: Measurement delay time is defined as the time from the removal of heating power (PH) to the
start of the VSD measurement.
tSW : Sample window time during which final VSD measurement is made.
VGS(M): Gate source voltage applied during the initial and final measurement periods.
METHOD 3161.1
1 of 14
ZJX: Transient junction-to-reference point thermal impedance in degrees Celsius/watt. ZJX for
specified power pulse duration is:
( T jf - T ji - T X )
Z JX =
PH
Where: TX = Change in reference point temperature during the heating pulse (see 4.2 and 4.4).
For short heating pulses, e.g., die attach evaluation, this term is normally negligible).
2. Apparatus. The apparatus required for this test shall include the following, as applicable, to the specified test
procedure:
a. A thermocouple for measuring the case temperature at a specified reference point. The recommended
reference point shall be located on the case under the heat source. Thermocouple material shall be
copper-constantan (type T) or equivalent. The wire size shall be no larger than AWG size 30. The junction
of the thermocouple shall be welded to form a bead rather than soldered or twisted. The accuracy of the
thermocouple and its associated measuring system shall be 0.5C. Proper mounting of the thermocouple
to ensure intimate contact to the reference point is critical for system accuracy.
b. A controlled temperature environment capable of maintaining the case temperature during the device
calibration procedure to within 1C over the temperature range of +23C to +100C, the recommended
temperatures for measuring K factor.
c. A K factor calibration setup, as shown on figure 3161-1, that measures VSD for a specified value of IM in
an environment in which temperature is both controlled and measured. A temperature controlled,
circulating fluid bath may be used. The current source shall be capable of supplying IM with an accuracy
of 1 percent. The voltage source shall be capable of supplying a stable VGS(M) in the range of -1 to -5 V
(opposite polarity for p-channel devices). This voltage is applied in such a way as to turn the DUT off (i.e.,
gate negative with respect to source for n-channel device). The voltage measurement of VSD shall be
made using Kelvin contacts and with voltmeters capable of 1 mV resolution. The device-to-current source
wire size shall be sufficient to handle the measurement current (AWG size 22 stranded is typically used for
up to 100 mA).
d. A test circuit used to control the device and to measure the temperature using the forward voltage of the
source drain diode as the temperature sensing parameter as shown on figure 3161-2. Polarities shown are
for n-channel devices but the circuit may be used for p-channel types by reversing the polarities of the
voltage and current sources.
e. Suitable sample-and-hold voltmeter or oscilloscope to measure source drain forward voltage at specified
times. VSD shall be measured to within 5 mV, or within 5 percent of (VSDi - VSDf), whichever is less.
METHOD 3161.1
2
NOTES:
1. The circuit consists of the DUT, three voltage sources, a current source, and two electronic switches.
During the heating phase of the measurement, switches S1 and S2 are in position 1. The values of VG
and VD are adjusted to achieve the desired values of ID and VDS for the PH heating condition.
2. To measure the initial and post-heating pulse junction temperatures of the DUT, switches S1 and S2 are
each switched to position 2. This puts the gate at the measurement voltage level VGS(M) and connects
the current source IM to supply forward measurement current to the source drain diode. The polarity of
the current source is such that the voltage applied to the MOSFET source and drain are opposite to those
employed during normal MOSFET operation. Figures 3161-3 and 3161-4 show the waveforms associated
with the three segments of the test.
FIGURE 3161-2. Thermal impedance measurement circuit (source drain diode method).
METHOD 3161.1
3
FIGURE 3161-3. Device waveforms during the three segments of the thermal transient test.
NOTE: The value of tMD is critical to the accuracy of the measurement and shall be properly specified in order
to ensure measurement repeatability. Note that some test equipment manufacturers include the sample-and-
hold window time tSW within their tMD specification.
METHOD 3161.1
4
3. Measurement of the TSP. The required calibration of VSD versus TJ is accomplished by monitoring VSD for
the required value of IM as the heat sink temperature (and thus the DUT temperature) is varied by external heating.
The magnitude of IM shall be chosen so that VSD is a linearly decreasing function over the expected range of TJ
during the power pulse. IM shall be large enough to ensure that the source drain junction is turned on but not so
large as to cause any significant self heating. (This will normally be 10 mA for small power devices and up to 100
mA for large ones.) The VGS(M) value shall be large enough to decouple the gate from controlling the DUT; typical
values are in the 1 to 5 V range. An example calibration curve is shown on figure 3161-5.
3.1 Measurement of die attachment integrity. When screening to ensure proper die attachment integrity within a
given lot or in a group of same type number devices of one manufacturer, this calibration step is not required. In
such cases, the measure of thermal response may be VSD for a short heating pulse, and the computation of TJ or
ZJX is not necessary. (For this purpose, tH shall be 10 ms for TO-39 size packages and 100 ms for TO-3 size
packages.)
3.2 K factor calibration. A K factor calibration (which is the reciprocal of VTC or the slope of the curve on figure
3161-4) can be defined as:
1 T J1 - T J 2
K = = C / mV
VTC V SD1 - V SD 2
It has been found experimentally that the K factor variation for all devices within a given device type class is small.
The usual procedure is to perform a K factor calibration on a 10 to 12 piece sample from a device lot and determine
the average K and standard deviation (). If is less than or equal to three percent of the average value of K, then
the average value of K can be used for all devices within the lot. If is greater than three percent of the average
value of K, then all the devices in the lot shall be calibrated and the individual values of K shall be used in thermal
impedance calculations or in correcting VSD values for comparison purposes.
METHOD 3161.1
5
4. Test procedure.
4.1 Calibration. K factor shall be determined according to the procedure outlined in 3 herein, except as noted in
3.1.
4.2 Reference point temperature. The reference point is usually chosen to be on the bottom of the transistor case
directly below the semiconductor chip in a TO-204 metal can or in close proximity to the chip in other styles of
packages. Reference temperature point location shall be specified and its temperature shall be monitored using the
thermocouple as stated in 2.a herein during the preliminary testing. If it is determined that TX increases by more
than +5C of measured junction temperature rise during the power pulse, then either the heating power pulse
magnitude shall be decreased, the DUT shall be mounted in a temperature controlled heat sink, or the calculated
value of thermal impedance shall be corrected to take into account the thermal impedance of the reference point to
the cooling medium or heat sink. Temperature measurements for monitoring, controlling, and correcting for
reference point temperature changes are not required if the tH value is low enough to ensure that the heat generated
within the DUT has not had time to propagate through the package. Typical values of tH for this case are in the 10
to 500 ms range, depending on DUT package type and material.
4.3 Thermal measurements. The following sequence of tests and measurements shall be made:
(4) Measure source drain voltage drop (VSDi) (a measurement of the initial junction temperature).
(2) Apply drain heating current (IH) as required by adjustment of gate source voltage.
(3) Allow heating condition to exist for the required heating pulse duration (tH).
(4) Measure reference point temperature (TXf) at the end of heating pulse duration.
(NOTE: TX measurements are not required if the tH value meets the requirements stated in 4.2.)
(3) Measurement source drain voltage drop (VSDf) (a measurement of the final junction temperature).
(4) Time delay between the end of the power pulse and the completion of the VSDf measurement as
defined by the waveform on figure 3161-4 in terms of tMD + tSW .
METHOD 3161.1
6
4.4 Thermal impedance. The value of thermal impedance (ZJX) is calculated from the following formula:
TJ K ( V SDf - V SDi )
Z JX = = C/W
PH ( I H ) (V H )
This value of thermal impedance will have to be corrected if TXf is greater than TXi by +5C. The correction consists
of subtracting out the component of thermal impedance due to the thermal impedance from the reference point
(typically the device case) to the cooling medium or heat sink. TX measurements are not required if the tH value
meets the requirements stated in 4.2 herein. This thermal impedance component has a value calculated as follows:
TX ( T xf - T xi )
Z X - HS = =
PH [( I H )( V H )]
Where: HS = cooling medium or heat sink (if used).
NOTE: This last step is not necessary for die attach evaluation (see 3.1 herein).
5.1.3 Calculation data. Calculate K factor in accordance with the following equation:
T J 1-T J 2
K= C/mV
V SD 1 - V SD 2
5.1.4 Die attach procedure. K factor calibration (see 5.1) may not be necessary for die attachment evaluation
(see 3.1).
METHOD 3161.1
7
5.2.1 Conditions data. Specify the following test conditions in the applicable specification sheet.
(NOTE: IH and VH are usually chosen so that PH is approximately two-thirds of device rated power dissipation).
c. TX measurements are not required if the tH value meets the requirements stated in 4.2.
d. Calculate thermal impedance using the procedure and equations shown in 4.4.
5.2.2.1 VSD data. This parameter can either be read directly from suitable test instrumentation or calculated by
taking the difference between initial and final values of VSD (i.e., VSD = |VSD(i) - VSD(f)|.)
5.2.3 Thermal resistance measurements. This is a thermal impedance measurement for the condition in which
the heating time (tH) has been applied long enough to ensure that the temperature drop from the device junction to
the case reference point in accordance with 2.a has reached equilibrium and no longer increases for greater values
of tH. In practical measurements, this condition can be assumed to exist when the rate of junction temperature
change matches the rate of case temperature change.
5.3 Thermal response VDS measurements for screening. These measurements are made for tH values that
meet the intent of 3.1 and the requirements stated in 4.2.
5.3.1 Conditions data. Specify the following test conditions in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3161.1
8
g. Gate-source voltage (VGS(M)) (shall be the same as used if and when K factor calibration is performed
(see 5.3.2.1b herein)).
NOTE: The values of IH and VH are usually chosen equal to or greater than the values used for thermal
impedance measurements.
5.3.2 Specified limits. The following data is compared to the specified limits:
b. Optionally calculate TJ for comparison or screening purposes, or both, if the K factor results (see 3 herein
and 5.1 herein) produce a greater than three percent of the average value of K.
TJ = K (VSD) in C
6. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. IM measuring current.
c. tH heating time.
a. IM measuring current.
c. tH heating time.
METHOD 3161.1
9
7. Tutorial guidelines. Thermal response, thermal impedance, and thermal resistance measurements require that
IH and VH not to exceed the rated specified values and tH for IH and VH not to exceed the specified safe-operating
area (SOA) stated in the device specifications. Values of IM, tMD conditions are also taken from the device
specifications.
The steps shown below are guidelines of how to reach the proper test conditions and determine the acceptance
limits, primarily for thermal transient testing and thermal characterization purposes.
7.1 Characterizing thermal resistance and thermal impedance. The following steps describe in detail how to set
up the apparatus stated in above sections to achieve the thermal resistance and thermal impedance
characterizations on MOSFET devices.
a. Step 1 - K-factor calibration: using apparatus 2.c herein, best with circulating bath and Kelvin cable, on ten
devices. IM = 10 mA for most MOSFET (or 5 mA for smaller power devices). Temperatures start from 150C
and cool down to 25C (25 points). K-factors are individually calculated and analyzed for possible usage of
average value in all calculations of thermal impedances and resistances. The linear relationship of VSD
verses TJ can expressed as calculated slope (K-factor) and offset. These data can be performed
automatically by some test equipment and can be kept to traceable device serial numbers.
b. Step 2 - Measurement-delay-time (tMD) characterization: With above K-factor data, on ten devices
VH = 12 V for devices with rated breakdown voltage of beyond 30 V. (VH = 10 V for devices with rated
breakdown voltage of 30 V or lower). IM = 10 mA for most MOSFET (or 5 mA for smaller power devices). tH
= 10 ms and IH = adjusted to achieve TJ of about 90C to 100C (not to exceed the rated SOA). tMD = set at
each 10 sec., 20 sec., 30 sec., 50 sec., 100 sec., 200 sec. and 320 sec.
The measured VSD verses square-root of tMD can be plotted, as shown on figure 3161-6 herein, to show the
optimum 30 sec. tMD as well as added TJ-factor for 0 sec. The added TJ-factor will be used to calculated true TJ.
Measurement-delay-time (tMD) optimization can be performed automatically by some test equipment and can be kept
to traceable device serial numbers.
140
120
100
TJ (C)
80
60
40
100s
200s
320s
10s
20s
30s
50s
0
0 5 10 15 20
SQRT(tMD )
METHOD 3161.1
10
d. Step 4 - Thermal impedance / heating CURVE Characterization: with same set-up in thermal resistance prior
to running heating curve, perform the 5-msec. Thermal impedance while adjusting heating VH and IH for
minimized ringing and transient waveforms. IH is typically selected 1.5 Amps. higher than the final IH of
above Rth characterization. Power VH x IH is typically selected for TJ about 20C. For each tH, VSD
measurement will be converted to TJ and Zth using individual K-factor and added TJ-factor (for 0 sec. tMD)
with referent temperature measurement.
Example of heating curve and thermal model in both semi-log and log-log scales, see figure 3161-7:
The inflection point, defined for transition between thermal interfaces, are more visibly shown in log-log graph than
in semi-log graph.
Thermal impedance curves for various different duty cycles can also be simulated from the model and added to the
specifications.
METHOD 3161.1
11
7.2 Optimizing production test conditions for die-attach thermal response or thermal impedance: The following
steps describe in detail how to set up the apparatus stated in above sections (production equipment) to achieve
proper production test conditions for die-attach thermal response and impedance on MOSFET devices.
a. Step 1 - Selection of two extreme devices: Use the following guidelines to select proper conditions and
apparatus: VH = 12 V for devices with rated breakdown voltage of beyond 30 V. (VH = 10 V for devices with
rated breakdown voltage of 30 V or lower). IH = (0.66 x rated power) / (above VH) or adjusted for 195 to 255
mV VSD (about 100C TJ). tH = 10ms for TO-205AF (TO-39), LCC18 and TO-276AA (SMD-.5). 20 ms for
TO-276AB (SMD-1) and TO-276AC (SMD-2). 50 ms for TO-257AA, TO-254AA, and TO-204AA (TO-3). IM =
10 mA for most MOSFET (Or 5 mA for smaller power devices). tMD = 30 s from above characterization.
Larger value may be required on power devices with high inductive package elements which generate non-
thermal electrical transients; unless otherwise specified, this would be observed in the tf region of figure
3161-3. k = value from measurements of above K-factor calibration (at above IM condition). Record the
VSD measurements of above conditions for 20 to 25 devices, correlated with X-ray results of die-
attachment. One device with highest VSD value (best with X-ray failure) and one device with lowest VSD
value (best die attachment) are selected for test and generate heating curves.
b. Step 2 - Thermal impedance / heating curve characterization: On two extreme devices follow Step 4 of 7.1
herein to generate the heating curve for each of the two extreme devices selected in accordance with 7.2.a
herein (superimposed in one graph).
The thermal impedance curves for both Highest and lowest delta-VSD devices, as well as the curves for average
and average+4sigma values, are displayed on figure 3161-8. The final thermal impedance specification is typically
scaled from average curve, with ratio factor of final RthJC value (which is round-off from average+4.Sigma RthJC
value) to average RthJC value.
0.70
Highest Delta-VSD Device Lowest Delta-VSD Device "Low" Model "Hi" Model Average Model 4-Sigma Spec Final Spec
0.60
Thermal Impedance
0.50
0.40
Z th (C /W )
0.30
0.20
0.10
0.00
0.00001 0.0001 0.001 Heating PulseWidth tH (second) 0.01 0.1 1
METHOD 3161.1
12
c. Step 3 - Heating curve interpretation: For proper selection of die-attach thermal response tH:
At heating time tH less than or equal thermal time constant of identical chips, the thermal characteristics are
the same. As tH is increased (exceeding the chip thermal constant) and the heat propagated through the
chip into the die attachment region, the curves of the specially selected extreme devices diverge (changes in
slope), starting from time point where the die attachment variance has an affect on device junction
temperature. As tH is increased further, the curve somewhat flattened out (more flattening with higher
thermal mass), with same slope for identical package. With several different elements in heat flow path
(chip, die attachment, substrate, substrate attachment, package, package attachment, and printer circuit
board / heatsink), several plateaus and transitions will be shown in the heating curve. Proper selection of
extreme devices (correlating to X-ray inspection results) would provide better differentiation in attachment
areas on heating curves.
Using heating curves and 7.2.c herein, select appropriate die attachment tH to correspond to the immediate
point in the region beyond the die attachment area.
7.3 Deriving statistical-process-control (SPC) limits for production die-attach thermal response. The following
steps describe in detail how to derive proper SPC limits for 100 percent production testing of die-attach thermal
response or thermal impedance on MOSFET devices.
a. Step 1 - Data collection and data types: (first production lots and subsequent production lots). Using above
optimized test conditions, thermal data should be recorded for setting limit from minimum 30 devices
sampling of first five production lots and from five to Ten devices sampling from each subsequent production
lot.
These data can be VSD or TJ [=VSD x K-factor] or CU [=VSD / PH] or ZthJX [=(VSD x K-factor / PH).+Tref].
(1) A single VSD limit is practical if the K-factor values for all devices (of the same type) tested to a given
specification are nearly identical (see 3.2 herein). Different device type (from different manufacturer)
should have different limit with its unique conditions specified.
(2) When a single K-factor can not be used (see 3.2 herein), the TJ (or TJ) single limit is practical to take
into account the individual device K-factor.
(3) Other single limits of CU (if identical K-factor but individual PH), K.CU (if individual K-factor and individual
PH) and ZthJX (absolute magnitude with individual K-factor, PH and Tref) have the same significance as
TJ (or TJ) single limit, since PH and Tref are identical and insignificant to MOSFET.
Thus, for MOSFET, the significant data types are VSD and ZthJX (or TJ or TJ).
b. Step 2 - Statistical analysis and limit setting: The data shall be statistically analyzed to establish the pass/fail
limit (the cut-off point between acceptable and non-acceptable devices) for each initial lot, as well as derived
to final SPC limits.
For each of the first five production lots, the statistical analysis of sample data should be shown in a single-
lot histogram with upper SPC limit (UCL) and lower SPC limit (LCL) resulted from average plus three
standard deviations and average minus three standard deviations, respectively. In this example, figure
3161-9, the single lot will be tested to LCL of 166 mV and UCL of 177 mV.
METHOD 3161.1
13
14
12 Delta-VSD
10 Single-Lot
F re q u e n c y
8 Histogram
6
4 Average 171.6 mV
2 Sigma 1.8 mV
0
Mean-3Sigma 166.2 mV
166 168 170 172 174 176 178 180 182 184 186 188 190 192 Mean+3Sigma 176.9 mV
Delta-VSD (mV)
FIGURE 3161-9. Delta VSD single lot histogram.
Very high VSD in some devices can be confirmed of unacceptance limit with results from X-ray,
SonaScanning or die shear.
For setting of final SPC limits, the statistical analysis of combined sample data from five production lots
should be shown in a summary table (inverse normalization graph optional) as shown in figure 3161-10
herein.
195 195
190
190
185
Delta-VSD (mV)
Delta-VSD (mV)
185
Production Lot # 1 180
180
Production Lot # 2 175
175 Production Lot # 3
170
Production Lot # 4
170 165
Production Lot # 5
165 Normal 160
160 155
-4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4 -4 -3 -2 -1 0 1 2 3 4
Standard Deviation from Mean Standard Deviation from Mean
All Production Lot # 1 Production Lot # 2 Production Lot # 3 Production Lot # 4 Production Lot # 5
n= 184 42 47 30 33 32
2
R = 0.936 0.621 0.957 0.895 0.617 0.926
Mean = 180.076087 172.2142857 186.6382979 183.5333333 174.8181818 182.9375
Standard Deviation = 6.481134785 3.679446633 2.877389607 2.687561814 3.273516319 1.216486214
Mean - 4 Standard Deviation 4= 154.1515478 157.4964992 175.1287394 172.7830861 161.7241165 178.0715551
Mean + 4 Standard Deviation +4= 206.0006261 186.9320722 198.1478563 194.2835806 187.9122471 187.8034449
/= 3.60% 2.14% 1.54% 1.46% 1.87% 0.66%
FIGURE 3161-10. Summary table and sample data from five production lots.
In this example, all succeeding production lots (after fifth production lot) will be tested to final lower SPC limit of 154
mV and final upper SPC limit of 206 mV, the calculated mean 4 sigma values.
7.4 Process change control for thermal response/impedance/resistance. At any time that production die attach
process (temperature profile) changes or related material property (compositions or finshes) changes, new thermal
resistance and thermal impedance shall be re-characterized for new defined specifications, as well as new SPC
limits shall be re-established from data of devices sampling from new production lots.
METHOD 3161.1
14
METHOD 3181
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the thermal resistance of thyristors under specified conditions.
3. Procedure. S1 is closed for a much longer interval (heat) than it is opened (measurement). The measurement
interval should be short compared to the thermal response time of the device being measured. The constant
measurement current is a small current (of the order of a few milliamperes) and so selected that the magnitude of
VF1 changes appropriately with the device material (silicon approximately 2 mV/C) and junction temperature. The
heating current source is adjustable.
3.1 Measurement. The measurement is made in the following manner. The case ambient or other reference
point is elevated to a high temperature, T2, not exceeding the maximum junction temperature and the forward
voltage drop (VF1) read with the heating source supplying no current (i.e., the forward voltage (VF1) is to be read at
the start of the measurement interval). An oscilloscope makes a suitable detector. At T2 there will be a small power
dissipated in the device due to the measurement current source. The reference is then reduced to a lower
temperature (T1), and power (P1) is applied to heat the device by increasing the current from the constant current
source until the same value of VF1 is read as was read above. However, if P1 is calculated as the heating power
contributed by the heating current source only, the equation:
-
= T 2 T 1 gives accurately
P1
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3181
1 of 1
3200 Series
Unless otherwise specified, the measurements shall be made at the electrical test frequency, 1,000 25 Hz. At
1,000 Hz, the reactive components may not be negligible.
METHOD 3201.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the input impedance of the device under the specified
conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown are for common emitter configuration. For other parameters the
circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly. See figure 3201-1.
NOTE: The biasing circuit shown is for purposes of illustration only. Other stable
biasing circuits may be used (see 3).
3. Procedure. The capacitors C1, C2, and C3 shall present short-circuits at the test frequency in order to
effectively couple and bypass the test signal. The inductance L shall be resonated with a capacitor and the
combination shall have a large impedance compared with hie at the test frequency. RL shall be a short-circuit
compared with the output impedance of the device. Vg and Vbe are measured on high-impedance ac voltmeters
after setting the specified values of IE and VCE.
V be V g - V be
Then : hie = , where I b =
Ib RB
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3201.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3206.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the forward-current transfer ratio of the device under the
specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown are for common emitter configuration. For other parameters the
circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly. See 3206.1.
NOTE: The biasing circuit shown is for purposes of illustration only. Other stable
biasing circuits may be used (see 3).
FIGURE 3206-1. Test circuit for small-signal, short-circuit forward-current transfer ratio.
3. Procedure. The capacitors C1, C2, and C3 shall present short-circuits at the test frequency in order to
effectively couple and bypass the test signal. The inductance L shall be resonated with a capacitor and the
combination shall have a large impedance compared with hie at the test frequency. RL shall be a short-circuit
compared with the output impedance of the device. Vg, Vbe, and Vce shall be measured on high-impedance ac
voltmeters after setting the specified values of IE and VCE.
V V -V
Then : h fe = I c , where : I c = ce and I b = g be
Ib RL RB
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3206.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3211
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the reverse-voltage transfer ratio of the device under the
specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedures shown are for common emitter configuration. For other parameters the
circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly. See figure 3211-1
NOTE: The biasing circuit shown is for purposes of illustration only. Other stable
biasing circuits may be used (see 3).
FIGURE 3211-1. Test circuit for small-signal, open-circuit reverse-voltage transfer ratio.
3. Procedure. Inductance L1 shall be resonated with a capacitor and the combination shall have a large
impedance compared with hic at the test frequency. The capacitors C1 and C2 shall present short-circuits at the test
frequency in order to effectively couple and bypass the test signal. Voltmeters Vbe and Vce shall be high
impedance voltmeters. Thus, after applying the specified test voltages and currents:
V be
hre =
V ce
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3211
1 of 1
METHOD 3216
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the output admittance of the device under the specified
conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown are for common emitter configuration. For other parameters the
circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly. See figure 3216-1.
NOTE: The biasing circuit shown is for purposes of illustration only. Other stable
biasing circuits may be used (see 3).
3. Procedure. Inductance L1 shall be resonated with a capacitor and the combination shall have a large
impedance compared with hie at the test frequency. The capacitors C1 and C2 shall present short-circuits at the test
frequency in order to effectively couple and bypass the test signal. Voltmeters Vbe and Vce shall be high
impedance voltmeters. Then:
Ic
hoe =
V ce
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3216
1 of 1
METHOD 3221
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the input admittance of the device under the specified
conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown are for common emitter configuration. For other parameters the
circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly. See figure 3221-1.
NOTE: The biasing circuit shown is for purposes of illustration only. Other stable
biasing circuits may be used (see 4.3.4).
3. Procedure. The capacitors C1, C2, and C3 shall present short circuits at the test frequency in order to
effectively couple and bypass the test signal. The inductance L shall be resonated with a capacitor and the
combination shall have a large impedance compared with hie at the test frequency. RL is optional and shall be a
short-circuit compared with the output impedance of the device. Vg and Vbe are measured on high-impedance ac
voltmeters.
Then : hie = V be
Ib
1
Thus : Y ie =
hie
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3221
1 of 1
METHOD 3231
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the output admittance of the device under the specified
conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown are for common emitter configuration. For other parameters the
circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly. See figure 3231-1.
3. Procedure. The capacitors C1 and C2 shall present short-circuits at the test frequency in order to effectively
couple and bypass the test signal. Resistor RC is not zero but chosen for any convenient value.
Ic
Then: yo e =
V ce
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3231
1 of 1
METHOD 3236
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is designed to measure the open-circuit output capacitance of the device
under the specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown are for common base configuration. For other parameters the
circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly. See figure 3236-1.
3. Procedure. The bridge should have low dc resistance between its output terminals and should be capable of
carrying the specified collector current without affecting the desired accuracy of measurement. The emitter should
be open-circuited to ac and the frequency of measurement shall be as specified. Capacitor C should be sufficiently
large to provide a short-circuit at the test frequency.
3.1 Measurement. The capacitance reading instrument is nulled with the circuitry connected, thereby eliminating
errors due to the stray capacitances of the circuit wiring. The device to be measured is inserted into the test socket,
is properly biased, and the output capacitance is measured.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3236
1 of 1
METHOD 3240.1
INPUT CAPACITANCE
(OUTPUT OPEN-CIRCUITED OR SHORT-CIRCUITED)
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the shunt capacitance of the input terminals of the device
under the specified conditions.
NOTE: For other configurations, the circuit may be modified in such a manner that it is capable of
demonstrating device conformance to the minimum requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The bridge should have a low dc resistance between the input terminals and should be capable of
carrying the required emitter current without effecting the desired accuracy of measurement. The specified voltages
or voltage and current shall be applied to the terminals; an ac small-signal shall be applied to the input terminals.
Switch SW shall be opened or closed depending upon whether the output is intended to be ac open-circuited or ac
short-circuited. The input capacitance shall then be measured. The capacitance reading instrument is nulled with
the circuitry connected, thereby eliminating errors due to stray capacitances and circuit wiring.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3240.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3241
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the direct interterminal capacitance between specified
terminals using specified electrical biases.
2. Apparatus. A direct capacitance bridge or resonance method may be used to determine the value of the direct
interterminal capacitance.
3. Procedure. The direct interterminal capacitance may be determined by using method A or method B as
follows.
3.1 Method A. The specified voltage shall be applied between specified terminals: an ac small-signal shall be
applied to the terminals and the direct interterminal capacitance shall be measured. The lead capacitance beyond .5
inch (12.70 mm) from the body seat shall be effectively eliminated by suitable means such as test socket shielding.
The abbreviations and symbols used are defined as follows:
3.2 Method B. A suitable resonance method can be utilized to measure the following two-terminal capacitances:
C1: Capacitance between collector terminal and ground, with base and emitter terminals grounded.
C2: Capacitance between the base terminal and ground, with collector and emitter terminals grounded.
C3: Capacitance between the collector and base terminals strapped together and ground, with the
emitter terminal grounded.
The direct interterminal capacitance can then be calculated from the following relationship:
C1 + C 2 - C 3
C cb(dir) =
2
The direct interterminal capacitance for other configurations may be determined by suitable modifications of the
above procedure. Such modifications shall be capable of demonstrating device conformance to the minimum
requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Terminal arrangement.
b. DC biasing conditions.
d. Measurement frequency.
METHOD 3241
1 of 1
METHOD 3246.1
NOISE FIGURE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the noise figure of the device under the specified conditions.
2. Apparatus. An average responding rms calibrated indicator shall be used in addition to other suitable
apparatus to measure the noise figure of the diode.
3. Procedure. The voltage and current specified in the applicable specification sheet shall be applied to the
terminals, and the noise figure shall then be measured at the frequency specified in the applicable specification
sheet (normally 1,000 Hz) with an input resistance of 1,000 A and as referred to a 1 Hz bandwidth.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Test frequency.
c. Load resistance.
METHOD 3246.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3251.1
PULSE RESPONSE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the pulse response (td, tr, ts, and tf) of the device under the
specified conditions.
FIGURE 3251-1. Test circuit FIGURE 3251-2. Test circuit for pulse
for pulse response, test response, test condition B.
condition A.
3. Procedure. The pulse response of the device shall be measured using test condition A or B.
3.1 Test condition A. The device shall be operated in the common emitter configuration as shown on figure
3251-1 with the collector load resistance (RC) and collector supply voltage (VCC) specified. When measuring delay
or rise time, IB(0) and IB(1) or VBE(1) shall be specified. When measuring storage or fall time, IB(1) or VBE(1) and IB(2) or
VBE(2) shall be specified. The input transition and the collector voltage response detector shall have rise and
response fall times such that doubling these responses will not affect the results greater than the precision of
measurement. The current and voltages specified shall be constant. Stray capacitance of the circuit shall be
sufficiently small so that doubling it does not affect the test results greater than the precision of measurement.
METHOD 3251.1
1 of 2
3.2 Test condition B. The device shall be operated in the test circuit shown on figure 3251-2 (constant current
drive) with the voltages and component values as specified. The pulse or square-wave generator and scope shall
have rise and fall response times such that doubling these responses will not affect the results greater than the
precision of measurement.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Collector load resistance (RC) and collector supply voltage (VCC) for A.
c. Base resistance (RB) collector load resistance (RC), and collector supply voltage (VCC) for B.
METHOD 3251.1
2
METHOD 3255
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the ratio of ac output power to the ac input power (usually
specified in dB) under specified large-signal conditions.
2. Test circuit. The test circuit shall be as specified in the applicable specification sheet.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
c. Test circuit.
METHOD 3255
1 of 1
METHOD 3256
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the ratio of the ac output power to the ac input power under
the specified conditions (usually specified in dB) for small-signal power gain.
NOTE: For other configurations, the circuit should be modified in such a manner that the circuit is
capable of demonstrating device conformance to the applicable specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The specified voltage(s) and current(s) should be applied to the terminals; an ac small-signal
should be applied to the input terminals of the specified circuit. The resistors R1 and R2 should have values larger
than the hie of the device. The phase angle 1 between the input current and Vbe shall be considered to be 0, if the
specified test frequency is less than the extrapolated unity gain frequency (ft) of the device.
Pout
P ge = 10 log
Pin
Where, Pin = ( V be ) ( i b ) cos
V g - V be
ib =
Rg
METHOD 3256
1 of 2
2 ( V L2 )
Pout = ( i c ) ( RL ) or
RL
2
( ic ) ( R L )
Thus, P ge = 10 log or
V g - V be
( V be )
Rg
2
VL
10 log RL
V g - V be
V be
Rg
For other configurations, modifications to the procedure should be made in such a manner that it is capable of
demonstrating device conformance to the applicable specification sheet.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test circuit.
METHOD 3256
2
METHOD 3261.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the extrapolated unity-gain frequency (gain-bandwidth
product) of the device under the specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. The test circuit employed in determining the extrapolated unity-gain frequency shall be that which
is used for measuring the magnitude of the common emitter small-signal, short-circuit forward-current transfer ratio.
(See method 3306.)
3. Procedure. The magnitude of the common emitter short-circuit forward-current transfer ratio shall be
determined at the specified frequency with the specified bias voltages and currents applied. The product of the
specified signal frequency (f) and the measured common emitter small-signal, short-circuit forward-current transfer
ratio (hfe) is the extrapolated unity gain frequency (ft).
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Test frequency.
METHOD 3261.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3266
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the resistive component of the small-signal, short-circuit input
impedance of the device under the specified conditions.
NOTE: The circuit shown is used for measuring the common emitter
real part of the small-signal, short-circuit input impedance. For other
device configurations, the above circuitry should be modified in such a
manner that it is capable of demonstrating device conformance to the
minimum requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
FIGURE 3166-1. Test circuit for real part of small-signal short-circuit input impedance.
3. Procedure. The voltage and current specified shall be applied to the terminals. An ac small-signal of the
frequency specified shall be applied to the input terminals and the output terminals shall be ac short-circuited. The
real part of the input impedance shall then be measured.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Test frequency.
METHOD 3266
1 of 1
3300 Series
Care shall be taken that, in designing the circuit and transistor mounting, adequate shielding and decoupling are
provided and that series inductances in circuits are negligible.
METHOD 3301
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the forward-current transfer ratio cut off frequency under the
specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown are for common base configuration. For other parameters the
circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly.
NOTE: Normal VHF circuit precautions should be taken. At frequencies higher than 10 MHz, the
use of this circuit may lead to excessive errors. The biasing circuit shown is for the purposes of
illustration only and any stable biasing circuit may be used.
FIGURE 3301-1. Test circuit for small-signal, short-circuit forward-current transfer ratio cutoff
frequency.
METHOD 3301
1 of 2
3. Procedure. The voltages and currents shall be as specified. Resistors RG and RE shall be large to present
open-circuits to hib. Resistor RC shall be small to present a short-circuit to hob. Capacitors C1, C2, C3, and C4
shall present short-circuits at the test frequency to effectively couple and bypass the test signal.
a. The circuitry shall be frequency independent. This can be checked by removing the device from the circuit
and shorting between emitter and collector with no bias voltages applied. Care should be taken to ensure
that the generator has a sufficiently pure waveform and that the high-impedance voltmeter is adequately
sensitive to enable the measurement to be made at a low enough signal level to avoid the introduction of
harmonics by the device.
b. The generator is set to a frequency at least 30 times lower than the lowest cut off frequency limit and the
low frequency hfb is measured. The frequency is then increased until the magnitude of hfb has fallen to
1/2 of its low frequency value. This is the cut off frequency.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3301
2
METHOD 3306.4
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the forward-current transfer ratio under the specified
conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit (see figure 3306-1) and procedure shown are for common emitter configuration. For
other parameters the circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly.
NOTE: The biasing circuit shown is for purpose of illustration only. Other stable biasing circuits may be used.
FIGURE 3306-1. Test circuit for small-signal, short-circuit forward-current transfer ratio.
3. Procedure. Capacitors C1, C2, and C3 shall present short-circuits in order to effectively couple and bypass the
test signal at the frequency of measurement. The value of RB shall be sufficiently large to provide a constant current
source. Resistor RC shall be a short-circuit compared to the output impedance of the device. With the device
removed from the circuit, a shorting link is placed between the base and collector and the output voltage of the
signal generator is adjusted until a reading of one (in arbitrary units) is obtained on the high-impedance ac voltmeter,
Vce. With the device in the circuit and biased as specified, the reading on voltmeter VCE is now equal to the
magnitude of (hfe). (NOTE: Care must be taken to assure that the output signal is not clipped.)
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Measurement frequency.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3306.4
1 of 1
METHOD 3311
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the maximum frequency of oscillation for the device under the
specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit utilized for the maximum frequency of oscillation test shall be as specified in the
applicable specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The voltage(s) and current(s) specified shall be applied to the device in the circuit specified, and
the circuit resonant frequency shall be increased until oscillation ceases. The frequency at which oscillation ceases
is the maximum frequency of oscillation.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test circuit.
METHOD 3311
1 of 1
METHOD 3320
RADIO FREQUENCY (RF) POWER OUTPUT, RF POWER GAIN, AND COLLECTOR EFFICIENCY
1. TEST CONDITION A
1.1 Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the RF power output, RF power gain, and collector efficiency
of a transistor under actual operating conditions in a specific RF amplifier test circuit. Test condition A shall be valid
for devices operating at RF power levels greater than 10 dBm when tested in the frequency range between 10 MHz
and 2 GHz.
1.2 Apparatus. All referenced equipment may be replaced by equivalents suitable for the frequency of test. The
equipment setup shall be as shown on figures 3320-1 and 3320-2.
1.3 Procedure. The test fixture shall be disconnected and directional couplers number 1 and number 2 shall be
directly connected using a minimum number of connectors. The RF switch shall be set to the output position C and
the frequency and RF power source adjusted to the specific conditions by monitoring the frequency counter and RF
power meter respectively. The RF switch shall be set to position A and the variable attenuator adjusted to obtain the
identical reading as power out in position C. The test fixture shall be reconnected with the DUT inserted and the dc
power supply adjusted to the specified voltage. The circuit output tuning shall be adjusted for maximum power gain
and circuit input tuning for minimum reflected power. (The RF switch shall be alternated between power in, reflected
power, and power out while tuning and this procedure shall be repeated as many times as necessary to obtain
minimum reflected power and maximum power out.) The power in level shall be checked before taking the final
measurement. If input reflected power calibration is required, the above procedure shall be repeated with directional
coupler number 1 reversed and switch position A changed to switch position B.
NOTE: Minimum reflected power is defined as minimum reading obtained with switch in position 'B' and maintaining
power in.
1.3.1 Measurements.
1.3.1.1 Power output. Power output (Pout) is measured by adjusting the RF power source to obtain the specified
forward input power and reading the output power in watts.
1.3.1.2 Power input. Power input (Pin) is measured by adjusting the RF power source to obtain the specified
forward output power and reading the input power in watts.
1.3.1.3 Power gain. Power gain (Gp) is measured by adjusting the RF power source to the value of Pin which
produces the specified Pout. Pin and Pout shall be observed and the gain (in dB) determined as follows:
Pout
G P = 10 log
Pin
1.3.1.4 Collector efficiency. Collector efficiency () is measured by adjusting the RF source to the specified Pin
(or Pout) and reading Pout. The collector efficiency shall be computed as follows:
(W) (W)
(%) = P out X 100 = P out X 100
P in (W) I C X V CC
METHOD 3320
1 of 9
METHOD 3320
2
NOTES:
1. Test fixture is the circuit as described in the applicable applicable specification sheet (circuit layout and
components quality are critical).
2. RF power source shall be a unit capable of generating desired power level at desired frequency with a
harmonic and spurious content 20 dB below operating frequency level of 100 MHz to 1 GHz.
3. The RF isolator shall be a device (e.g., pad, circulator) capable of establishing 20 dB of isolation between
RF power source and test fixture. (A resistive attenuator shall be used for out-of-band isolation.)
4. Variable attenuators (or fixed, if calibrated): Attenuators are set so that the actual power into and out of test
fixture are known. Attenuation on directional coupler number 2 shall be calibrated against a known working
standard either by means of a calibration chart or suitable adjustment if variable. Attenuation at position A of
directional coupler number 1 shall be calibrated or adjusted so that actual power at test fixture is known.
Attenuation at position B shall be adjusted to establish sensitivity needed to measure reflected power
(normally 10 dB less than the attenuation at position A).
5. RF switch may be eliminated if additional power meters are used.
6. More than one directional coupler may be used in place of coupler number 1. If more than one coupler is
used, the power in and reflected power position may be interchanged.
7. The directional couplers shall have a minimum directivity of 30 dB and a nominal 20 dB coupling attenuation
except where test level sensitivities require 10 dB or less attenuation.
8. The dc power supply shall be RF decoupled at the test fixture.
9. Voltmeter readings shall be sensed at test fixture, not at power supply.
10. Coupler number 2 and 50 load may be replaced by coaxial fixed attenuators (Narda) and a power meter
(HP 432A). Power meter may be separate or connected to the one shown on the other side through port C of
the RF switch (see figure 3320-2).
11. If harmonic or subharmonic contents less than 20 dB down from the desired signal are present and could
influence the measured output power, a suitable filter (low pass, band pass, or high pass) shall be employed
between the attenuator(s) and power meter used for output power measurement.
1.4 Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Test frequency.
e. Parameter to be measured.
2. TEST CONDITION B
2.1 Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the RF power output, RF power gain, and collector efficiency
of a transistor under actual operating conditions in a specific RF amplifier test circuit. Test condition B shall be valid
for devices operating at RF power levels greater than 0 dBm when tested in the frequency range between 100 MHz
and 10 GHz.
2.2. Apparatus. All referenced equipment may be replaced by equipment of equal or superior capability. A typical
equipment setup is as follows (see figures 3320-3, 3320-4, and 3320-5). All components shall be suitable for the
frequency range of measurement.
METHOD 3320
3
METHOD 3320
4
METHOD 3320
5
NOTE: The unswitched port automatically terminates the alternate coupler port in 50
when using the coax switch specified in the equipment list.
METHOD 3320
6
2.3 Equipment list. (All referenced equipment may be replaced by equipment of equal or superior quality.)
CW source As desired 1/
a. With the RF test setup as on figure 3320-3 and with the test fixture removed, hook up the output of coupler
number 1 to the input of coupler number 2 (attenuation of directional coupler number 2 shall be calibrated
against a known working standard either by means of calibration chart or suitable adjustment if variable).
b. Set the frequency of the source as indicated by the readout of the frequency counter or a dip in the power
level when using an in-line wavemeter.
c. Adjust the variable attenuator on the source by decreasing the attenuator until the desired power level is
observed on the output power meter (apply correction factor if necessary to correct for coupler number 2 or
output attenuator error).
d. Observe the input power meter, and adjust the attenuator associated with this meter until it reads the same
power output as the output power meter in . (If using the alternate input setup on figure 3320-5, calibrate
with coaxial switch in the forward position.)
e. Disconnect the output coupler and power meter from the circuit so that the output of coupler number 1 is
open-circuited. Adjust the attenuator associated with the reflected power meter until it reads the same as
the forward meter. With a calibrated short on the input of the coupler, observe the difference in reflected
power between an open-circuit condition and a short. Adjust the reflected power variable attenuator for an
average between the open and short-circuit readings. (If using the alternate input setup on figure 3320-5,
the reflected power port is automatically calibrated when the forward power is calibrated if both ports of the
coupler are balanced.)
______
1/ Model depends on frequency of test: See manufacturer's catalog for correct model number.
METHOD 3320
7
f. Increase the input attenuator until power output is zero (calibration completed).
g. If multiple frequency testing is required repeat through 1f for each frequency, noting the variable attenuator
and power source settings for each specified frequency. All equipment must be returned to the noted
settings during test at each specified frequency point.
2.4.2 RF testing.
b. With the RF test setup on figure 3320-3 or with alternate circuits of figures 3320-4 and 3320-5, and with the
test fixture in place, clamp a device in the test fixture.
c. Switch on the dc power supply. Precautions should be observed to prevent voltages exceeding the
specified test level.
d. Adjust the attenuator at the source until the input power reads the appropriate power.
e. Observe the output power, reflected power, and collector current (record, if necessary).
f. Increase the attenuator at the source until the input power reads zero.
g. Repeat through as required, with the previously noted power source and attenuator settings, if other test
frequencies are required.
a. Power output (Pout) is measured by adjusting the RF power source as outlined in to obtain the specified
forward input power and reading the output power in watts.
b. Power input (Pin) is measured by adjusting the RF power source to obtain the specified forward output
power and reading the input power in watts.
c. Power gain (Gp) is calculated from the measured RF data. Pin and Pout shall be observed and the gain (in
dB) determined as follows:
Pout
G p = 10 log
Pin
d. Collector efficiency () is calculated from the measured RF and dc data. The collector efficiency shall be
computed as follows:
(W) (W)
(%) = P out X 100 = P out X 100
Pin (dc - w) I C X V CC
Where: IC = Collector current
e. Reflected power may be observed directly from the power meter if the setup is calibrated as specified in .
Even though reflected power may not be part of the RF specifications, it is included here because it is an
indication as to how much of the input is actually reaching the device. Good practice dictates that, where
possible, the external circuit should be adjusted from minimum reflected power.
METHOD 3320
8
2.6 Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Test frequency.
e. Parameter(s) to be measured.
f. Parameter(s) to be calculated.
g. RF test fixture.
METHOD 3320
9
3400 Series
Circuits are shown for n-channel field-effect transistors in one circuit configuration only. They may readily be
adapted for p-channel devices and for other circuit configurations.
METHOD 3401.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine if the breakdown voltage of the field-effect transistor or IGBT
under the specified conditions is greater than the specified minimum limit. For the IGBT, replace the drain and
source MOSFET designations with collector and emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the
current is being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the
ammeter.
3. Procedure. The resistor R1 is a current-limiting resistor and should be of sufficiently high resistance to avoid
excessive current flowing through the device and current meter. The voltage shall be gradually increased, with the
specified bias condition (condition A, B, C, or D) applied, from zero until either the minimum limit for V(BR)GSX or
the specified test current is reached.1/ The device is acceptable if the minimum limit for V(BR)GSX is reached
before the test current reaches the specified value. If the specified test current is reached first, the device shall be
considered a failure.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Bias condition:
D: Drain-to-source: Open-circuit.
_______
1/ V(BR)GSX: Breakdown voltage, gate-to-source, with the specified bias condition applied from drain-to-source.
METHOD 3401.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3402
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the Gate Equivalent Series Resistance (ESR) of MOSFET
devices. This can be done in two ways, using either manual test circuit or LCR test equipment. This test method
provides a mean to ensure switching consistency of power MOSFET. ESR combined with gate charge
measurements provide an alternative to high-current high-speed measurements where device fast switching
characteristics are over-masked by test circuit stray elements.
1.1 Background. High-speed switching measurements of power semiconductor devices are sensitive and
dependent to the stray elements (capacitive, inductive and resistive impedances) of the test circuit. As a result,
switching data of identical devices have difficult time reaching reasonable agreement. The ESR by design directly
relates to die gate processing such as polysilicon doping level, metallization, contact resistance, all of which affect
high-speed performance. Since big process variation usually results in an ESR increase in significant magnitude,
the ESR test method provide an alternative for the industry to reach agreement on high speed switching
measurements.
2. Definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purpose of this test method:
b. f Test frequency
3. Condition A. This is the test in which a LCR Meter is used with the Ciss test circuit. The test frequency is fixed at 1
MHz and the Rg & Cg of MOSFET device-under-test are calculated by the impedance analyzer.
3.1 The apparatus required for this test condition shall include the following, configured as shown on figure 3402-1,
as applicable to the specified test procedure:
a. Ciss Test Circuit, as shown in Figure 3402-1. Capacitors C1 and C2 present short circuits at the test
frequency; L1 and L2 present high ac impedance at test frequency for isolation; Bridge has low dc resistance
between its output terminals and capable of carrying test current without affecting the desired accuracy of
measurement.
b. A LCR Meter capable to supply the sine wave signal with magnitude up to 1 Volt and frequency of MHz
(1MHZ typical) and to measure series resistance and series capacitance
METHOD 3402
1 of 4
3.2 Procedure. The test begins with applying 1MHZ sine wave voltage of less than 1V and measuring stray
capacitances of test circuit and socket in both Drain and Source OPEN mode as well as SHORT mode (short Drain
and Source contacts prior to this measurement). Insert MOSFET device-under-test and record RS (CS optional)
measurements.
3.3 Summary. The following conditions & limit shall be specified in detail specification for Condition A:
4. Condition B. This is the test in which an external inductor is added in series with Rg & Cg of MOSFET device-
under-test. The test frequency is then adjusted to get capacitive and inductive impedances cancelled out and thus
pure resistance Rg can be measured.
METHOD 3402
2
4.1 The apparatus required for this test condition shall include the following, configured as shown on figure 3402-2,
as applicable to the specified test procedure:
b. A function generator source capable to supply the sine wave signal with magnitude up to 1 Volt and
frequency of MHz (1MHZ typical).
4.2 Procedure. The test begins with applying 1 MHz sine wave voltage of less than 1 Volt. V1 voltage is
monitored not to exceed the rated VGS (typical 20V). Adjust the test frequency until the source output voltage V2
waveform and source output current I waveform are in phase. The MOSFET Gate ESR measurement can then be
calculated from below formula:
V2
Rg =
I
4.3 Notes.
a. The effective Gate Capacitance can also be calculated with below formula
1
Cg =
(2f )2 L
b. The inductor in the circuit is normally 50 H in value; however, if the gate resistance (or capacitance) is very
high then the proper inductor value can be estimated with below formula
1
L=
(
2 2 10 6 Ciss )
2
4.4 Summary. The following conditions & limit shall be specified in detail specification for Condition A:
METHOD 3402
3
5. General note.
a. Even though the Gate ESR together with Gate Charges helps better representing MOSFET in high speed
applications and circuit simulations, the lumped Rg and effective Cg presentation does have its limitation.
Some power MOSFET die in latest technology do not have symmetrical or uniform connecting conductances
from Gate and Source terminations to each individual cell or stripe structures. The switching responses
from the lumped Rg and effective Cg model may not be true responses. The correct series resistor and
parallel capacitor model in these cases suggests a somewhat test frequency dependence in lumped Rg
measurement.
b. Because of DC Bias & AC Bias Dependencies of Cg, the DC voltage induced from AC Bias applying through
LRC Series Resonant Circuitry would cause Cg to be changed. The measured Rg with Condition B at
resonant frequency thus somewhat dependent of input signal
1
Series Resonant Frequency: WO =
L Cg
L
Series Resonant Characteristic Impedance: ZO =
C
METHOD 3402
4
METHOD 3403.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the gate-to-source voltage or current of the field-effect
transistor or IGBT under the specified conditions. For the IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET designations
with collector and emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the
current is being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the
ammeter.
3. Procedure. The voltage source and bias source shall be adjusted to bring VDS and ID to their specified
values. The voltage VGS or current IG may then be read.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3403.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3404
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test establishes the means for measuring MOSFET threshold voltage. This
method applies to both enhancement-mode and depletion-mode MOSFETs, and for both silicon-on-sapphire and
bulk-silicon MOSFETs. It is for use primarily in evaluating the response of MOSFETs to ionizing radiation, and for
this reason the test differs from conventional methods for measuring threshold voltage.
1.1 Definition.
MOSFET threshold voltage, VGS(TH): The gate-to-source voltage at which the drain current is reduced to the
leakage current, as determined by this test method.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus shall consist of a suitable ammeter, voltmeters, and voltage sources. The
apparatus may be manually adjusted or, alternatively, may be digitally programmed or controlled by a computer.
Such alternative arrangements shall be capable of the same accuracy as specified below for manually adjusted
apparatus.
2.1 Ammeter (A1). The ammeter shall be capable of measuring current in the range specified with a full scale
accuracy of 0.5 percent or better.
2.2 Voltmeters (V1 and V2). The voltmeters shall have an input impedance of 10 m or greater and have a
capability of measuring 0 V to 20 V with a full scale accuracy of 0.5 percent or better.
2.3 Voltage sources (VGS and VDS). The voltage sources shall be adjustable over a nominal range of 0 V to 20 V,
have a capability of supplying output currents at least equal to the maximum rated drain current of the device to be
tested, and have noise and ripple outputs less than 0.5 percent of the output voltage.
3. Procedure.
WARNING: The absolute maximum values of power dissipation, drain-to-source voltage, drain current, or
gate-to-source voltage specified is either the applicable acquisition document or the manufacturer's
specifications shall not be exceeded under any circumstances.
3.1.1 Test circuit for n-channel devices. The test circuit shown on figure 3404-1 shall be assembled and the
apparatus turned on. With the voltage sources VDS and VGS set to 0 volts, the MOSFET to be tested shall be
inserted into the test circuit. The gate-to-source polarity switch shall be set to the appropriate position, and voltage
source VGS shall be set 1.0 V negative with respect to the anticipated value of threshold voltage VGS(TH). Voltage
source VDS shall be adjusted until voltmeter V2 indicates the specified drain-to-source voltage VDS. The current ID,
indicated by ammeter A1, and the gate-to-source voltage VGS, indicated by voltmeter V1, shall be measured and
recorded.
3.1.2 Measurement for n-channel devices. The measurement shall be repeated at gate-to-source voltages which
are successively 0.25 volts more positive until either the maximum gate-to-source voltage or maximum drain current
is reached. If the gate-to-source voltage reaches 0 volts before either of these limits has been reached, the gate-to-
source polarity switch shall be changed as necessary and measurements shall continue to be made at gate-to-
source voltages which are successively 0.25 volts more positive until one of these limits has been reached.
METHOD 3404
1 of 5
3.2.1 Test circuit for p-channel devices. The test circuit shown on figure 3404-2 shall be assembled and the
apparatus turned on. With the voltage sources VGS and VDS set to 0 volts, the MOSFET to be tested shall be
inserted into the test circuit. The gate-to-source polarity switch shall be set to the appropriate position, and voltage
source VGS shall be set 1.0 V positive with respect to the anticipated value of threshold voltage VGS(TH). Voltage
source VDS shall be adjusted until voltmeter V2 indicates the specified drain-to-source voltage VDS. The current ID,
indicated by ammeter A1, and the gate-to-source voltage VGS, indicated by voltmeter V1, shall be measured and
recorded.
3.2.2 Measurement for p-channel devices. The measurement shall be repeated at gate-to-source voltages are
successively 0.25 volts more negative until either the maximum gate-to-source voltage or maximum drain current is
reached. If the gate-to-source voltage reaches 0 volts before either of these limits has been reached, the gate-to-
source polarity switch shall be changed as necessary and measurements shall continue to be made at gate-to-
source voltages which are successfully 0.25 volts more negative until one of these limits has been reached.
3.3 Leakage current measurement. Using method 3415, the leakage current shall be measured.
3.3.2 Gate-to-source voltage. The gate-to-source voltage shall be five volts different from the anticipated
threshold voltage in the direction of reduced drain current.
3.4 Gate-to-source voltage graph. The gate-to-source voltage, VGS, shall be plotted versus the square-root of the
drain current minus the leakage current, ID - IL. At the point of maximum slope, a straight line shall be
extrapolated downward. The threshold voltage (VGS(TH)) is the intersection of this line with the gate-to-source
voltage axis. Examples are shown on figure 3404-3.
3.5 Report. As a minimum, the report shall include the device identification, the test date, the test operator, the
test temperature, the drain-to-source voltage, the range of gate-to-source voltage, the leakage current, and the
threshold voltage.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test temperature. Unless otherwise specified, the test shall be performed at ambient.
b. Drain-to-source voltage.
METHOD 3404
2
METHOD 3404
3
METHOD 3404
4
METHOD 3404
5
METHOD 3405.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the drain-to-source voltage of the field-effect transistor or IGBT
at the specified value of drain current. For the IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET designations with
collector and emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
3. Procedure. The specified bias condition shall be applied between the gate and source and the voltage source
shall be adjusted to bring ID to the specified value. The voltage VDS may then be read.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
B: Short-circuited.
METHOD 3405.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3407.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine if the breakdown voltage of the field-effect transistor or IGBT
under the specified conditions is greater than the specified minimum limit. For the IGBT, replace the drain and
source MOSFET designations with collector and emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short circuit to the terminals between which the
current is being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the
ammeter.
3. Procedure. The resistor R1 is a current-limiting resistor and should be of sufficiently high resistance to avoid
excessive current flowing through the device and current meter. The voltage shall be gradually increased from zero,
with the specified bias condition (condition A, B, C, or D) applied, until either the minimum limit for V(BR)DSX 1/ or
the specified test current is reached.1/ The device is acceptable if the minimum limit for V(BR)DSX is reached
before the test current reaches the specified value. If the specified test current is reached first, the device shall be
considered a failure.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Bias condition:
C: Gate-to-source: Short-circuit.
D: Gate-to-source: Open-circuit.
_____
1/ V(BR)DSX: Breakdown voltage, drain-to-source, with the specified bias condition applied from gate-to-source.
METHOD 3407.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3411.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the gate reverse current of the field-effect transistor or IGBT
under the specified conditions. For the IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET designations with collector and
emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the
current is being measured or the volt meter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the
ammeter.
3. Procedure. The specified dc voltage shall be applied between the gate and the source with the specified bias
condition (condition A, B, C, or D) applied to the drain. The measurement of current shall be made at the specified
ambient or case temperature.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Bias condition:
C: Drain-to-source: Short-circuit.
D: Drain-to-source: Open-circuit.
METHOD 3411.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3413.1
DRAIN CURRENT
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the drain current of the field-effect transistor or IGBT under the
specified conditions. For the IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET designations with collector and emitter
IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the
current is being measured or the volt meter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the
ammeter.
3. Procedure. The specified voltage shall be applied between the drain and source with the specified bias
condition (condition A, B, C, or D) applied to the gate. The measurement of current shall be made at the specified
ambient or case temperature.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Parameter to be measured.
d. Bias condition:
C: Gate-to-source: Short-circuit.
D: Gate-to-source: Open-circuit.
METHOD 3413.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3415.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the drain reverse current of the field-effect transistor or IGBT
under the specified conditions. For the IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET designations with collector and
emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the
current is being measured or the volt meter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the
ammeter.
3. Procedure. The specified dc voltage shall be applied between the drain and the gate. The measurement of
current shall be made at the specified ambient or case temperature.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3415.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3421.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the resistance between the drain and source of the field-effect
transistor or IGBT under the specified static condition. For the IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET
designations with collector and emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
3. Procedure. The specified bias condition shall be applied between the gate and source and the voltage source
shall be adjusted so that the specified current is achieved. The drain-to-source voltage shall then be measured.
V DS
Then : r DS(on) =
ID
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test currents.
B: Short-circuited.
METHOD 3421.1
1 of 1
METHOD 3423
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the resistance between the drain and source of the field-effect
transistor under the specified small-signal conditions.
NOTE: The ac voltmeter shall have an input impedance high enough that halving it does not
change the measured value within the required accuracy of the measurement.
3. Procedure. The specified bias condition shall be applied between the gate and the source and an ac sinusoidal
signal current, Id, of the specified rms value shall be applied.
Then : r ds(on)= V ds
Id
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Test frequency.
B: Short-circuited.
METHOD 3423
1 of 1
METHOD 3431
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the input capacitance of the field-effect transistor under the
specified small-signal conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown on figure 3431-1 are for common-source configuration. For other
configurations, the circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly.
FIGURE 3431-1. Test circuit for small-signal, common-source, short-circuit, input capacitance.
3. Procedure. The capacitors C1 and C2 shall present short-circuits at the test frequency. L1 and L2 shall
present a high ac impedance at the test frequency for isolation. The bridge shall have low dc resistance between its
output terminals and should be capable of carrying the test current without affecting the desired accuracy of
measurement.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Measurement frequency.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3431
1 of 1
METHOD 3433
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the reverse transfer capacitance of the field-effect transistor
under the specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown on figure 3433-1 are for common-source configuration. For other
configurations, the circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly. Terminal 2 of bridge shall be the terminal
with an ac potential closest to the ac potential of the guard terminal so as to provide an effective short-circuit of the
input.
NOTE: The dotted connection between the case and ground shall be used for devices in which the case is
not internally electrically connected to any element. If the case is internally electrically connected to any
element, the dotted connection shall not be used.
3. Procedure. The capacitor C1 shall present a short-circuit at the test frequency. L1 and L2 shall present a
high ac impedance at the test frequency for isolation. The bridge shall have low dc resistance between its
output terminals and should be capable of carrying the test current without affecting the desired accuracy of
measurement.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Measurement frequency.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3433
1 of 1
METHOD 3453
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the output admittance of the field-effect transistor under the
specified small-signal conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure are shown on figure 3453-1 for common-source configuration. For other
configurations, the circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly.
FIGURE 3453-1. Test circuit for small-signal, common-source, short-circuit, output admittance.
3. Procedure. The capacitors C1, C2, and C3 shall present short-circuits at the test frequency in order to
effectively couple and bypass the test signal. R1 and RL shall be short-circuits compared with the output impedance
of the device. After setting the specified dc conditions, the VDS meter shall be disconnected from the circuit while
measuring e1 and e2. The voltages e1 and e2 shall be measured with high-impedance ac voltmeters.
e2
Id e2 RL
Then: y os = Where: I d = Thus: yos =
e1 - e2 RL e1 - e2
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test frequency.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3453
1 of 1
METHOD 3455
1. Purpose. The purpose of the test is to measure the forward transadmittance of the field-effect transistor under
the specified small-signal conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown on figure 3455-1 are for common-source configuration. For other
configurations, the circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly.
FIGURE 3455-1. Test circuit for small-signal, common-source, short-circuit, forward transadmittance.
3. Procedure. The capacitors C1, C2, C3, and C4 shall present short-circuits at the test frequency in order to
effectively couple and bypass the test signal. R1 shall be a short-circuit compared with the input impedance of the
device. RL shall be a short circuit compared with the output impedance of the device. The voltages e1 and e2 shall
be measured with high-impedance ac voltmeters.
e2
Id e2 RL e2
Then: y fs = Where: I d = Thus: y fs = =
e1 RL e1 e1 R L
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test frequency.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3455
1 of 1
METHOD 3457
1. Purpose. The purpose of the test is to measure the reverse transfer admittance under the specified
small-signal conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown on figure 3457-1 are for common-source configuration. For other
configurations, the circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly.
3. Procedure. The capacitors C1, C2, C3, and C4 shall present short-circuits at the test frequency in order to
effectively couple and bypass the test signal. R1 shall be impedance matched to the generator. RL shall be a
short-circuit compared with the input impedance of the device. The rms voltages e1 and e2 shall be measured with
high-impedance ac voltmeters.
VDS shall be adjusted to the specified value, then the gate voltage supply shall be adjusted so that VGS or ID
equals the specified value, and the voltages e1 and e2 shall be measured.
Ig e2
Then: y rs = Where: I g =
e1 RL
e2
RL e2
Thus: y rs = or y rs =
e1 e1 R L
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test frequency.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3457
1 of 1
METHOD 3459
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the pulse response (td(on), tr, td(off), and tf) of the field-effect
transistor under the specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. The test circuit shall be as shown in the applicable specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The FET shall be tested in the specified circuit. Vin(on), Vin(off), pulse generator impedance, all
circuit components, and supply voltages shall be as specified in figure 3459-1.
Pulse characteristics are defined on figure 3459-1. The rise time, fall time, duty cycle or pulse repetition rate, and
pulse width of the input waveform, together with the input resistance, capacitance, and response time of the
response detector shall all be such that halving or doubling these parameters will not affect the results of the
measurement greater than the precision of measurement.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
e. Parameters to be measured.
METHOD 3459
1 of 1
METHOD 3461
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the input admittance of the field-effect transistor under the
specified small-signal conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit and procedure shown on figure 3461-1 are for common-source configuration. For other
configurations, the circuit and procedure should be changed accordingly.
FIGURE 3461-1. Test circuit for small-signal, common-source, short-circuit, input admittance.
3. Procedure. The capacitors C1, C2, C3, and C4 shall present short-circuits at the test frequency in order to
effectively couple and bypass the test signal. R1 facilitates the adjustment of e1. Its use is optional. R2 shall be
such that dc biasing is possible. RL shall be a short-circuit compared with the input impedance of the device. VDS
shall be adjusted to the specified value, then the gate voltage supply shall be adjusted so that VGS or ID equals the
specified value, and the voltages e1 and e2 shall be measured.
Ig e2
Then: yis = Where: I g =
e1 - e2 RL
e2
R L e2
Thus: yis = or yis =
e1 - e2 R L ( e1 - e2 )
e2
e1 must be greater than e2 ; therefore, yis =
R L e1
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test frequency.
c. Parameter to be measured.
METHOD 3461
1 of 1
METHOD 3469
1. Purpose. This purpose of this test method is to determine the repetitive inductive avalanche switching
capability of power devices.
2. Scope. This method is intended as an endurance test for any power switching device designed and specified
with repetitive avalanche capability.
3. Circuitry. The circuit shall be designed so that all stray reactances are held to a minimum. The inductor L shall
be of a fast response type.
4. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology apply to this test method:
c. f: Frequency.
5. Procedure.
5.1 Screening. The DUT must be screened prior to avalanche and meet all specified parameters.
METHOD 3469
1 of 3
5.2 Calculations. The energy delivered to the DUT can be calculated as follows:
L * I AR2 * V (BR)
a. E AR =
[
V (BR) - V DD ]
2
LI AR2
NOTE: R S = 0, where, V (BR) =
t AV
b. L I AR R S
E AR = V (BR) I AR ( ) ln (V -V ) + 1
RS BR DD
NOTE: RS 0
5.2.1 Energy delivered. The actual energy delivered to the DUT can vary depending on the real value of RS.
Since this is test circuit dependent, the actual energy delivered must be verified by observing the voltage across the
DUT and current through the DUT waveforms. Empirically record the V(BR), IAR, and tav. Then calculate:
If this empirically derived value is not greater than or equal to the specified minimum EAR value, the circuit must be
compensated until it is.
5.3 Junction temperature. TJ during the test must be held constant to TJ (max) +0C -10C, based on the case
temperature of the DUT and the RJC or the junction temperature as determined using a TSP. The power
dissipated in the DUT is equal to the sum of the on-energy and the avalanche-energy multiplied by the frequency.
The Eon in most cases can be neglected.
TJ = PD * RJC + TC
The case temperature of the DUT will be measured at a specified reference point under the heat source. It is also
possible to measure the temperature of the heat sink at a specified reference point provided that an accurate value
of the thermal resistance case-to-heat-sink-reference-point is known. The measured junction temperature based on
measurements of a TSP may also be substituted for the junction temperature calculated from case temperature.
5.4 Number of pulses. The DUT will be avalanched for a specified minimum number of pulses at specified
conditions. Upon completion the specified device parameters will be tested.
6. Summary. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable specification sheet, the following parameters shall be
as follows:
METHOD 3469
2
2 E AR V BR - V DD
L = 2 V nH minimum
( I DI ) BR
Supply voltage 50 V.
7. Failure criteria. The DUT shall be within all specified parameter limits at the completion of the test. As a
minimum, VBR shall be greater than or equal to rated breakdown voltage and applicable leakage currents.
METHOD 3469
3
METHOD 3470.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this method is applicable to power MOSFETs and IGBT. For the IGBT, replace the
drain and source MOSFET designations with collector and emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E. The
purpose of this test method is to screen out weak devices which otherwise may result in costly equipment failures.
This is accomplished by providing a controlled means of testing the capability of a power MOSFET or IGBT to
withstand avalanche breakdown while turning off with an unclamped inductive load under specified conditions. The
device capability is a strong function of the peak drain current at turn-off and the circuit inductance. Since no voltage
clamping circuits or devices are employed, essentially, all of the energy stored in the inductor must be dissipated in
the DUT at turn-off. It is not the intent of this test method to closely duplicate actual application conditions where
device temperatures may approach maximum rated value, repetition rates may be 10 to 100 kHz, and voltage
transients are usually only a few microseconds in duration. However, experience has shown that failures in actual
applications can be greatly reduced or eliminated if devices are tested for avalanche operation under defined circuit
conditions at very low repetition rates and at room ambient temperature.
2. Test procedures. The specified value of inductance L shall be connected into the circuit (see figures 3470-1
and 3470-2). The gate pulse shall be applied to the device at the specified repetition rate. The VDD supply voltage
shall be applied. The gate pulse width shall be adjusted as necessary until the specified drain current ID is reached.
Test failures are defined as those devices which fail catastrophically.
METHOD 3470.2
1 of 3
NOTES: The following notes are provided in the interest of achieving comparable results from various test
circuits employed to perform this test.
a. Air core inductors are recommended for this test to avoid the possibility of core problems. If iron core
inductors are used, care must be taken such that core saturation is not changing the effective value to
the inductance L which will lead to non-repeatable test results.
b. The resistance of the inductor must be controlled since I2R losses in the inductor will decrease the
percentage of LI2/2 stored energy transferred to the DUT. The relationship R = 0.015 (VDS/ID)
applies for one percent of the stored energy being dissipated in the resistance. For two percent loss,
R = 2 (.015) (VDS/ID) or (VCE/IC). The resistance loss shall be limited to two percent maximum, if not
compensated by the equipment.
c. The gate-to-source resistor shall be closely connected to the test device. The gate-to-source resistor
shall be a low enough value that the switching performance of the device does not affect the test and
the inductor in the drain circuit determines the current waveform. The design of the pulsed gate
source must be such that RGS or RGE is the effective gate-to-source resistance during the tf portion
of the test.
d. The repetition rate and duty cycle of the test shall be chosen so that device average junction
temperature rise is minimal. Limits of one pulse per second or 0.5 percent duty cycle are
recommended. The device peak junction temperature shall not exceed maximum rated value.
e. If the VDD or VCE power supply remains in series with the inductor during the tf interval, then the
energy transferred to the DUT may be considerably higher than LI2/2. If the gate pulse width is
adjusted so that VCC or VDD < 0.1 VDS or VCE then the contribution of the power supply will be less
than 10 percent of the stored LI2/2 energy.
METHOD 3470.2
2
3. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
e. Inductance (L).
f. VDD.
METHOD 3470.2
3
METHOD 3471.2
GATE CHARGE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the gate charge (Qg) of power MOSFETs and IGBT. For the
IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET designations with collector and emitter IGBT designations, D = C and
S = E.
1.1 Definitions.
a. Test 1: Qg(th) is the gate charge that shall be supplied to reach the minimum specified gate-source
threshold voltage. It establishes line loci through the origin of a Q = f(Vgs) graph that is invariant with ID, V
DD, and TJ. It establishes a relationship with capacitance, i.e.,
Q g(th) Q gs
C GS = =
V g(th) V GP
b. Test 2: Qg(on) is the gate charge that shall be supplied to reach the gate-source voltage specified for the
device rDS(on) measurement.
c. Test 3: Qgm(on) is the gate charge that shall be supplied to the device to reach the maximum rated gate-
source voltage. Qgm(on) and Qg(on) establish line loci on a Q = f(Vgs) graph that may be considered
invariant with ID and TJ. The slope of the loci is invariant with VDD, while the intercept with the Q axis is
variant with VDD.
d. Test 4: VGP is the gate voltage necessary to support a specified drain current. VGP, and, ID is a point on
the device gate voltage, drain current transfer characteristic. VGP is variant with ID and TJ. It may be
measured one of two ways:
(1) Using a dc parameter test set employing a circuit similar to that described in method 3474 for SOA
setting VDD > VGS.
(2) Using a gate charge test circuit employing a constant ID drain load.
e. Test 5: Qgs is the charge required by CGS to reach a specified ID. It is variant with ID and TJ. It is
measured in a gate charge test circuit employing a constant drain current load.
f. Test 6: Qgd is the charge supplied to the drain from the gate to change the drain voltage under constant
drain current conditions. It is variant with VDD and may be considered invariant with ID and TJ. It can be
related to an effective gate-drain capacitance (i.e., Crss = Qgd/VDD). The effective input capacitance is:
Ciss = CGS + Crss.
METHOD 3471.2
1 of 10
2. Test procedure.
a. The gate charge test is performed by driving the device gate with a constant current and measuring the
resulting gate source voltage response. Constant gate current scales the gate-source voltage, a function of
time, to a function of coulombs. The value of gate current is chosen so that the device on-state is of the order
of 100 s.
The resulting gate-source voltage waveform is nonlinear and is representative of device behavior in the low to
mid-frequency ranges. The slope of the generated response reflects the active device capacitance (Cg = dQg
/dVGS) as it varies during the switching transition. The input characteristic obtained from this test reflects the
chip design while avoiding high frequency effects.
b. Figure 3471-1 is the test circuit schematic for testing an n-channel device. Polarities are simply reversed for a
p-channel device.
c. Figure 3471-2 is an example of a practical embodiment of figure 3471-1. It illustrates a gate drive and
instrument circuit that will test n-channel and p-channel devices.
d. The circuit has Ig programmability ranging from microamperes to milliamperes. For very large power MOSFET
devices, the output Ig can be extended to tens of milliamperes by paralleling additional CA3280 devices.
e. The circuit provides an independent gate voltage clamp control to prevent voltage excursions from exceeding
test device gate voltage ratings.
f. The CA3240E follower ensures that the smallest power devices will not be loaded by the oscilloscope. (Rin =
1.5 T , IIN = 10 pA, CIN = 4 pF).
g. Gate charge is to be measured starting at zero gate voltage to a specified gate voltage value.
h. The magnitude of input step constant gate current Ig should be such that gate propagation and inductive
effects are not evident. Typically this means the device on-state should be of the order of 100 s.
i. The dynamic response, source impedance, and duty factor of the pulsed gate current generator are to be such
that they do not materially affect the measurement.
j. Typically, the instrument used for a gate charge measurement is an oscilloscope with an input amplifier and
probe. The switching response and probe impedance are to be such that they do not materially affect the
measurement. Too low a probe resistance relative to the magnitude of Ig can significantly increase the
apparent Qg for a given VGS. Too high a value of probe capacitance relative to the device Ciss will also
increase the apparent Qg for a given VGS.
C g dV GS
Ig = , Q g = C g V GS .
dt
METHOD 3471.2
2
3. Summary. Figure 3471-3 illustrates the waveform and tests 1 through 4, condition A. Figure 3471-4 illustrates
the waveform for tests 2, 4, 5, and 6, condition B. Only four of the six tests need be performed since the results of
the remaining two are uniquely determined and may be calculated. Either condition A or condition B may be used.
3.1 Condition A.
c. Off-state drain voltage (VDD): Between 50 percent and 80 percent of the device's rated drain-source
breakdown voltage.
e. Gate current (Ig): Constant gate current such that the transition from off-state to on-state or on-state to off-
state is of the order of 50 s. The value of Ig varies with die size and ranges from 0.1 mA to 5 mA.
f. Gate-to-source voltage (Vg(th) min): The minimum rated gate-source threshold voltage.
g. Minimum off-state gate charge (Qg(th)): A minimum and maximum limit shall be specified.
b. VGS: The gate-source voltage specified for the rDS(on) test, V(on).
c. On-state gate charge (Qg(on)): A minimum and maximum limit shall be specified.
c. Maximum on-state gate charge (Qgm(on)): A minimum and maximum limit shall be specified.
METHOD 3471.2
3
c. The pulse width and duty factor are such that they do not materially affect the measurement.
e. TC: +25C.
3.1.5 Test 5, Qgs; test 6, Qgd. No tests are required. The calculations in terms of the results of tests 1 through 4
are as follows:
V GP
a. Q gs = Q g(th)
V g(th) min
b. Determine the fully on-state charge slope:
V -V
m = ( max ) (on)
Q gm(on) - Q g(on)
c. Determine the Vgs axis intercept:
b = V(on) - m Qg(on).
d.
( V - b)
Calculate Q gd : Q gd = GP - Q gs
m
3.2 Condition B.
b. On-state drain current (ID): The continuous rated drain current at TC = +25C.
c. Off-state drain voltage (VDD): Between 50 percent and 80 percent of the device's rated drain-source
breakdown voltage.
d. The drain load shall be such that the drain current will remain essentially constant.
g. On-state gate charge (Qg(on)): A minimum and maximum limit shall be specified.
METHOD 3471.2
4
b. VGP: This is the gate plateau voltage where Qgs and Qgd are measured. This voltage is essentially
constant during the drain voltage transition when Qgd is supplied from the gate to the drain under constant Ig,
and, ID conditions.
3.2.5 Test 1, Qg(th); test 3, Qgm(on). No tests are required. The calculations in terms of the results of test 2, 4, 5,
and 6 are as follows:
a. V g(th) min
Q g(th) = Q gs
V GP
V (on) - V GP
m=
Q g(on) - Q gs - Q gd
b = V (on) - m Q g(on)
d. Calculate Qgm(on):
[ V ( max ) - b]
Q gm(on) =
m
METHOD 3471.2
5
NOTES:
1. Condition B requires a constant drain current regulator.
2. Ig x t = Qg.
METHOD 3471.2
6
NOTES:
1. This test method provides gate voltage as a monotonic function of gate charge. Charge or capacitance may be
unambiguously specified at any gate voltage. Gate voltage assuring that the device is well into the on-state will
result in very reproducible measurements. For a given device, the gate charges at these voltages are
independent of drain current and a weak function of the off-state voltage.
2. Condition B requires a constant current drain regulator.
METHOD 3471.2
7
NOTES:
1. Qg = Igt.
2. VGP is measured by a dc test, same ID, VDS >> VGP (see 3.1.4).
3. V(max) and V(on) are specified voltages for charge measurements Qgm(on) and Qg(on).
4. VGS(th) min is a specified voltage for measuring Qg(th).
METHOD 3471.2
8
METHOD 3471.2
9
METHOD 3471.2
10
METHOD 3472.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the pulse response (td(on), tr, td(off), tf) of power MOSFET or
IGBT devices under specified conditions. For the IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET designations with
collector and emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
2. Test procedure. Monitor VGS and VDS versus time using the following notes and precautions. Refer to figures
3472-1 through 3472-4 for clarification.
a. This method presumes that good engineering practice will be employed in the physical construction of the
test circuit, i.e., short leads, good ground plane, minimum gate-to-drain mutual inductance, and appropriate
high speed generators and instruments.
b. The value of RGS or RGE includes instrumentation resistive loading. RGEN and RGS RGE should be low
enough in value that gate propagation effects are evident.
c. The value of LDST or LCET, CGST or CGET, and CDST or CCET are understood to include those of the
test fixture, circuit elements, instrumentation and any added values, exclusive of the DUT. LDST or LCET
shall not exceed 100 nH nor shall (CDST or CCET) or (CGST or CGET) exceed 100 pF. Devices with small
die may need smaller values of LDST or LCET, CDST or CCET, and CGST or CGET. LDST, CDST, and
CGST need not be measured when using figure 3472-3 and figure 3472-4. When rCS(on) or rDS(on) is
measured at a VGS or VGE of less than 10 V, then figure 3472-3 and figure 3472-4 do not apply.
d. Gate circuit inductance need not be specified. With the DUT removed, the gate-source voltage waveform
should be free of anomalies that could materially affect the measurement. Inductance is difficult to
measure accurately in a well designed test fixture. The gate drive common should be Kelvin connected to
the device source lead.
e. Passive circuit elements referred to in this method are lumped parameter representations whose values
would be those obtained through the use of an RLC bridge using a 1 MHz test frequency.
f. Voltage and current sources are to be interpreted as effective idealizations of active elements.
g. The phrase "affect the measurement" is intended to mean that doubling a value will not affect results greater
than the precision of measurement.
h. The turn-off drain voltage overshoot should not be allowed to exceed the device rated drain-source
breakdown voltage. Drain circuit ringing begins when the inductive time constant is 25 percent of the
capacitive time constant. Ringing is particularly serious when testing low voltage high current devices at
high speeds. When the ratio LDST/R2 L(CDST + COSS) exceeds 10, test conditions may have to be
adjusted to ensure that device breakdown is not reached.
i. The instrument used for switching parameter measurement is an oscilloscope with input amplifiers and
probes. The affect on rise and fall times can be estimated by the following relationship:
METHOD 3472.2
1 of 8
j. When two channels with probes are involved in a measurement (turn-on and turn-off delays), the relative
channel probe delays should not materially affect the measurement. Simultaneous viewing the same
waveform using the two channel/probes is an effective means of estimating errors.
k. Unless otherwise specified, half rated drain voltage and rated drain current are mandatory conditions for
measuring switching parameters.
l. When measuring rise time, VGS(on) shall be as specified on the input waveform. When measuring fall time
VGS(off) shall be specified on the input waveform. The input transition and drain voltage response detector
shall have rise and fall response times such that doubling these responses will not affect the results greater
than the precision of measurement. The current shall be sufficiently small so that doubling it does not affect
test results greater than the precision of measurement.
3. Test circuit and waveform: See figures 3472-1, 3472-2, 3472-3, and tables 3472-I and 3472-II.
1/ Figure 3472-3 board layout is an artist's view for an n-channel TO-3 package.
The following company will provide the circuit boards or a drawing of the exact
board layout for a TO-3 as well as other packages such as the TO-39, TO-61,
and TO-66:
a. Integrated Technology Corporation
1228 N. Stadem Drive
Tempe, AZ 85281
2/ LDST, CDST, and CGST need not be measured when using these circuit
boards derived from figures 3472-3 and 3472-4.
METHOD 3472.2
3
METHOD 3472.2
4
METHOD 3472.2
6
METHOD 3472.2
7
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 3472.2
8
METHOD 3473.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the time required for the DUT to switch off when a reverse
bias is applied after the DUT has been forward biased and to determine the charge recovered under the same
conditions.
2. Test conditions.
2.1 Test condition A, reverse recovery time (trr). Monitor diode current versus time. If the DUT is a power
MOSFET, the gate lead must be shorted to the source lead. Use the following notes and precautions as a guide.
Refer to figures 3473-1 through 3473-3 for clarification.
a. This method presumes that good engineering practice will be employed in the construction of the test
circuit, i.e., short leads, good ground plane, minimum inductance of the measuring loop, and minimum
self-inductance (L1) of the current sampling resistor (R4). Also, appropriate high speed generators and
instruments will be employed.
b. The measuring-loop inductance (LLOOP, see figure 3473-1) represents the net effect of all inductive
elements, whether lumped or distributed, i.e., bonding wires, test fixture, circuit board foil, and inductance
of energy storage capacitors. The value of LLOOP should be 100 nH or less. The reason for controlling
this circuit parameter is that it, combined with diode characteristics, determines the value of tb.
c. The turn-off reverse-voltage overshoot shall not be allowed to exceed the device rated breakdown voltage.
Ringing and overshoot may become a problem with RLOOP < 2(L/C)1/2; where L = LLOOP. That is
another reason for minimizing LLOOP.
e. The self-inductance of the current-sample resistor R4 (see figure 3473-1) shall be kept low relative to ta
because the observed values of ta and IRM increase with increasing self-inductance. Since the value of
R4 is not specified, the recommended maximum inductance is expressed as a time constant (L1/R4) with a
maximum value of ta(minimum)/10, where ta(minimum) is the lowest ta value to be measured. This ratio
was chosen as a practical compromise and would yield an observed ta which is 10 percent high (ta = L1
/R4). The IRM error is a function of the L1/R4 time constant and di/dt. For a di/dt of 100A/s the observed
IRM would also be 10 percent high. IRM = L1/R4 di/dt.
f. The di/dt of 100A/s was chosen so as to provide reasonably high signal levels and still not introduce the
large IRM errors caused by higher di/dt.
g. The forward current (IF) used for this test shall be as specified at T = +25C.
h. The values of ta, tb, and IRM are to be measured and recorded separately. trr = ta + tb.
i. The forward current value must be specified, otherwise the ta and IRM values have little useful meaning.
j. The forward current generator consisting of Q1, Q2, R1, and R2 may be replaced with any functionally
equivalent circuit. Likewise the current ramp generator consisting of Q3, Q4, R3, and C1.
METHOD 3473.1
1 of 8
2.2 Test condition B, reverse recovered charge (Qrr). This method is direct reading and therefore does not require
an oscilloscope. Use the following notes and precautions as a guide. Refer to figures 3473-4 and 3473-5 for
clarification.
a. This method presumes that good engineering practice will be employed in the construction of the test
circuit, i.e., short leads, good ground plane, minimum inductance of the measuring loop. Also, appropriate
high speed generators and instruments will be employed.
b. The measuring-loop inductance (LLOOP, see figure 3473-4) represents the net affect of all inductive
elements in the loop, whether lumped or distributed, i.e., DUT bonding wires, test fixture, circuit board foil,
and inductive component of energy storage capacitors. The value of LLOOP should be 100 nH or less.
c. The turn-off reverse-voltage overshoot shall not be allowed to exceed the device rated breakdown voltage.
Ringing and overshoot may become a problem when RLOOP < 2(L/C)1/2; where L = LLOOP.
e. The di/dt of 100A/s was chosen as a compromise between having reasonably high signal levels for the
faster devices and the need to keep the reverse voltage as low as possible. Higher di/dt requires a higher
reverse voltage to overcome the drop across LLOOP.
f. The forward current (IF) used for this test shall be as specified at +25C.
g. The capacitor C2 (see figure 3473-4) shall be large enough so that there is no appreciable voltage drop
across it. Reducing its value by 50 percent shall not change the reading by more than the required
measurement accuracy.
h. The current meter across C2 should have as low a resistance as possible. Doubling the resistance shall
not change the reading by more than the required measurement accuracy. A good compromise may be a
digital ammeter with a full scale drop of 0.2 volt. If the reverse bias supply is 30 volts, the maximum meter
potential differences is then less than one percent of supply voltage.
j. The forward current generator consisting of Q1, Q2, R1, and R2 may be replaced by any functionally
equivalent circuit. Likewise the reverse current ramp generator consisting of Q3, Q4, R3, and C1.
METHOD 3473.1
2
t1 > = 5 ta (max)
t2 > trr
t3 > 0
L1 t a ( min )
< =
R4 10
NOTES:
1. V1 amplitude controls forward current (If).
2. V2 amplitude controls di/dt.
3. L1 is self inductance of R4.
4. ta (max) is longest ta to be measured.
5. ta (min) is shortest ta to be measured.
METHOD 3473.1
3
METHOD 3473.1
4
NOTE: Bottom resistor current flow is in opposite direction of top resistor current flow, providing magnetic field
cancellation. Sense lead to center conductor of probe jack exits at right angle to resistor axes and is located
between the resistor layers; five on the top layer and five on the bottom layer.
METHOD 3473.1
5
NOTES:
1. D1 provides forward current path to ground.
2. D2 steers reverse signal current into integrating capacitor (C2).
3. V1 amplitude controls forward current (If).
4. V2 amplitude controls di/dt.
5. t1 > = 5 ta (max); ta (max) is the highest ta to be measured.
6. t2 > trr.
7. t3 > 0.
8. D1 is a low voltage Schottky rectifier.
9. D2 must have a much lower recovered charge than the value being measured.
10. Qrr = IS PRR; where PRR is pulse repetition rate.
11. di/dt = 100 A/s.
METHOD 3473.1
6
METHOD 3473.1
7
3. Summary. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable specification sheet, the following conditions shall be as
follows.
c. di/dt: 100A/s.
e. VDD: As specified.
METHOD 3473.1
8
METHOD 3474.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to verify the boundary of the SOA as constituted by the interdependency of
the specified voltage, current, power, and temperature in a temperature stable circuit. Deliberate consideration is
given to the problem of unavoidable case temperature rise during the test. For the IGBT, replace the drain and
source MOSFET designations with collector and emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
1.1 Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purpose of this test
method:
2. Test circuit. See figure 3474-1. Circuit polarities shall be reversed for p-channel devices.
b. Operational amplifier shall have a speed and accuracy such that the errors it produces will contribute less
than a five percent error to the measurement.
d. S1 shall have adequate speed and characteristics such that the accuracy of the measurement will not be
affected by more than five percent.
METHOD 3474.1
1 of 3
METHOD 3474
2
3. Procedure. Set the precision voltage source to ID x RS. Applied VDD to the circuit. Close S1 for tp seconds.
4. Summary. In any practical application, the junction temperature during an SOA test can be calculated by
adding all of the temperature drops in the system to the ambient temperature:
RS (maximum rated gate voltage) ID not to exceed (.2 x maximum rated VDS)/ID
TJ = TA + sink to ambient + case to sink + junction to case
( P DM - ( T C - T CR ) x DF )
ID=
V DS
Under a controlled set of conditions, such as those that are encountered in an SOA test, the case temperature can
be measured and therefore known as a constant. This simplifies the expression substantially:
TJ = TC + junction to case
TJ = TC + PD x RJC
By substituting in the maximum rated junction temperature and rearranging the terms, the maximum power
dissipation for this condition can be calculated:
( T JM - T C )
PD
RJC
If a case temperature of TCRC was chosen for the purpose of specifying the device SOA, then a derating factor DF
can be determined:
P DM
DF =
( T JM - T CR )
PDM can be any PDM from the SOA curves for that particular device type, either dc or pulsed. The maximum power
dissipation for any case temperature can now be readily calculated and used in an SOA test
Unless otherwise specified in the applicable specification sheet, the following conditions shall be as follows.
a. VDS = as specified.
b. ID = as calculated above.
c. +20C TC +45C.
d. tp shall be that which corresponds with the SOA curve being used.
e. D F = P DM .
( T JM - T CR )
f. RS = as calculated above.
g. PDM shall be a value chosen from one of the SOA curves for that particular device either dc or pulsed.
METHOD 3474.1
3
METHOD 3475.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this establishes a basic test circuit for the purpose of establishing forward
transconductance (gFS) using pulsed dc for the test conditions to enable measurements above the small signal (gFS
) output current levels. The described method is adaptable to ATE where large ac test currents are often impractical.
For the IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET designations with collector and emitter IGBT designations, D =
C and S = E.
2. Procedure. The gate-source voltage (VGS1) is applied as necessary to achieve a specified drain-source
current. ID1 shall be five percent minimum less than the value of ID used in specifying rDS(on) (normally 50 percent
of rated dc current). The gate-source voltage (VGS1) is then decreased to achieve a second drain-source current
(ID2). ID2 shall be five percent minimum below the ID1 used in specifying rDS(on). The drain-source voltage (VGS2)
shall remain equal to the value specified for establishing ID2.
Calculation: I D1 - I D 2
g FS =
V GS
Where: VGS = VGS1 - VGS2
NOTE: VGS should not be set lower than 0.05 volt or test equipment accuracy can adversely affect
measurement. ID1 and ID2 can be adjusted such that VGS is 0.1 volt. In all cases ID1 and ID2 should be
adjusted so they are equally above and below specified current. The formula below can be used as initial
reference point:
-
If: V GS = I D1 I D 2
G FS
then:
I D1 - I D 2 = desired
ID
2
The previous calculations can be used in establishing minimum VGS desired to achieve highest accuracy.
4. Summary. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable specification sheet, the following conditions shall be as
follows.
e. rDS(on) as specified.
METHOD 3475.1
1 of 2
NOTES:
1. Pulse the device according to 4.3.2.2 of MIL-STD-750. Resistor R1 shall be used to damp spurious oscillations
that can occur (approximately 100 ).
2. The device used for circuit illustration is an n-channel, enhancement-mode FET. The methodology described is
not limited solely to this type of device. For all other field effect devices where the power ratings are such that
the dc method is the preferred method, the parameter symbols need only indicate the appropriate voltage or
current polarity.
3. When performing this test on a nonheat-sinked part, the following caution is applicable. The implementation of
this test requires the use of repeated incremental steps of gate voltage, while measuring drain current. The
number of steps and the duration of each step result is cumulative energy which may thermally overstress the
part if it is not heat-sinked. A stepped program to perform this test will result in higher power dissipation during
test of a unit requiring a high gate drive voltage than during test of a unit requiring a lesser gate drive voltage.
4. R2 is a noninductive, current sensing resistor and is normally 0.1 .
METHOD 3475.1
2
METHOD 3476
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to define a way for verifying the diode recovery stress capability of power
MOSFET transistors. The focus is on simplicity and practicality.
2. Scope. This test covers all power transistors which have an internal diode capable of commutating current
generated during reverse recovery.
b. Driver: A device is used in the lower portion of a half H bridge (see figure 3476-1) and is an
equivalent to the DUT.
c. dv/dt: Rate of change of reapplied diode voltage, as measured as maximum value of inflection.
g. L(LOAD): Load inductor. Shall be of a large enough value that the decay of current during the
forward conduction of the DUT is less than five percent of IFM.
METHOD 3476
1 of 5
4. Circuit. Basic circuitry for testing this parameter is shown on figure 3476-1. Idealized waveforms are shown on
figure 3476-2. Snubbers may not be used. Stray capacitance and inductance, especially in the source of the drive
transistor, shall be minimized.
The basic principle of the circuit may not be altered; that is, the lower half H bridge device must be equivalent to the
DUT. The circuit may operate continuously or single shot, as long as the required test conditions are achieved.
Gate drive to the driver may be any Thevenin equivalent of that specified.
b. Driver is turned off until current in DUT reaches IFM. The minimum time for DUT forward
conduction is 5 s or 10 times the rated maximum trr, whichever is greater.
c. If testing repetitively, go back to 4.a. Else, driver is turned on for the reverse recovery period of
the device plus a minimum additional one microsecond. The DUT shall be monitored for VDS
collapse during this additional time period and gate drive to the driver transistor may be removed
at any time a failure is encountered.
If the device operates with a low repetition rate, the device may not be exposed to sufficient energy to cause a
catastrophic failure. The circuit must be equipped to either cause catastrophic failure or generate a failure signal in
the event of a collapse of VDS during voltage recovery.
5. Specification details. The specification may take the form of a single point tabular specification, a graphical
representation, or both. Ideally, a device will have both. This will allow for easy comparison of devices with the
tabular specification, but still have the detail of the graph available to the designer.
a. A tabular specification will define a single point of operation. The following must be specified in
the applicable specification sheet.
b. A graphical representation could take several different forms; for example: RG versus IFM, di/dt
versus dv/dt, or IFM versus VDS. An example of RG versus IFM is shown on figure 3476-3.
6. Acceptance criteria. If a specification requires that this test be performed for verification of a maximum limit,
then the device VDS must not collapse during or after reverse recovery and (in addition) shall pass any specified
parametric limits, as a minimum: V(BR)DSS, IGSS, IDSS, and RDS(ON).
METHOD 3476
2
METHOD 3476
3
Body Diode
Forward Current
Ringing
IFM 50%IFM
ID Current
0 di
Reverse
IRM Recovery
Current
75%IRM dt
Body Diode
Stress
Reverse Voltage
Period
0
10%VDD
VDD Voltage
Body Diode
Forward Voltage
VDD
dv
90%VDD
dt
METHOD 3476
4
METHOD 3476
5
METHOD 3477.1
1. Purpose. This test defines the basic test circuitry and waveform definitions by which to measure the total
switching losses of an IGBT.
2. Scope. This method applies only to measurements of IGBT devices without an integral diode.
3. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purposes of this test
method:
f. t0: Time point where VCE is at 10 percent of the specified gate drive.
h. t2: Time point where VCE = 5 percent VCL when VCE is decreasing.
i. t3: Time point where VCE = 5 percent VCL when VCE is increasing.
j. t4: t3 + 5 s.
l. t r: Rise time.
METHOD 3477.1
1 of 4
4. Circuitry. Figure 3477-1 shows the basic test circuit. The circuit has to satisfy two fundamental requirements.
a. The circuit reflects the losses that are attributed to the IGBT only and is independent from those
due to other circuit components, like the freewheeling diode.
(1) The driver IGBT builds the test current in the inductor. When it is turned off, current flows in the zener.
At this point, the switching time and switching energy test begins, by turning on and off the DUT. In its
switching, the DUT will see the test current that is flowing into the inductor and the voltage across the
zener, without any reverse recovery component from a freewheeling diode. This test can exercise the
IGBT to its full voltage and current without any spurious effect due to diode reverse recovery.
(2) Input drive duty cycle should be chosen such that Tj is not affected. Control of Tj is best done
using external methods.
5. Method. Figure 3477-2 shows the DUT current and voltage waveforms and test points.
5.1 Energy loss during turn on. During turn on, the energy loss is defined as follows in equation (1).
t2
(1) W ON = iCE V CE dt joules/pulse
t1
5.2 Energy loss during turn off. During turn off, the energy loss is defined as follows in equation (2).
t3
(2) W ON = iCE V CE dt joules/pulse
t4
5.3 Total switching loss. The total switching loss is the sum of equations (1) and (2).
5.4 Switching time measurements. Switching time measurements, while not the preferred method of delineating
between devices, may be determined using the measurements below and as seen on figure 3477-2.
a. td(on): The interval measured from the 10 percent point of the rising input pulse Vg and the 10 percent
rise of the output current IC.
b. tr: The interval measured from the 10 percent to the 90 percent point of the rising output current IC.
c. td(off): The interval measured from the 90 percent point of the falling input pulse Vg to the 90 percent
point of the falling output current IC.
d. tf: The interval measured from the 90 percent to the 10 percent point of the falling output current IC.
MEHTOD 3477.1
2
6. Equipment. A modern high speed digitizing system is recommended. The measurement of W ON or W OFF is
accomplished by accessing the output V(t) and I(t) waveforms, digitizing them, and transmitting the data to a
computer where W ON or W OFF is calculated and the results displayed. Two factors of importance must be
considered.
a. Sample spacing must be short, relative to transition times for accurate and repeatable results.
b. The relative V(t), I(t) channel delay must be known and accounted for in the computer program
that does the point by point multiplication and summation that determines either W ON or W OFF
(see figure 3477-2).
7. Specifications.
METHOD 3477.1
3
MEHTOD 3477.1
4
METHOD 3478
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test method establishes a baseline methodology for characterizing high-voltage
transistors to high gamma dose rate radiation and for establishing electrical criteria to evaluate key test fixture
parameters. From this data, a valid comparison can then be made between the device's response and its radiation
data. Since power transistors are susceptible to radiation-induced burnout/damage, this test method should be
considered a destructive test. For the IGBT, replace the drain and source MOSFET designations with collector and
emitter IGBT designations, D = C and S = E.
2. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall appl for the purposes of this test
method.
a. Power transistor burnout: Burnout is defined as a condition that renders the power transistor
nonfunctional, usually a result of current-induced avalanche and second breakdown. Identification is
accomplished by observing the drain current during irradiation and by verifying the device's performance
after irradiation.
PW: Radiation pulse width defined by the full-width half-max (FWHM) measurement (seconds).
3. Test plan. A detailed test plan shall be prepared specifying, as a minimum, the following information.
c. Test fixture characteristics of stray Rs and Ls, based upon previous data or calculations (see 5.8).
d. Electrical characterization required in accordance with applicable specification sheet before and after the
radiation event.
METHOD 3478
1 of 7
4. Apparatus.
4.1 Instrumentation. Instrumentation required to monitor and test the device to high gamma dose rate radiation
will generally consist of the following types of equipment.
a. Curve tracer.
c. DC current probe.
4.2 Holding fixture. The holding fixture may be mandated by the test facility. Coordination between users and
facility is an absolute necessity. The fixture shall be capable of interfacing the power and signal lines between the
test board and DUT, as well as, collimating the radiation beam to expose only the DUT.
4.3 Test fixture. The test board shall be constructed to meet the following requirements.
a. Construction: Circuit layout and construction are critical. Circuit layout and construction shall be optimized
to minimize stray Ls and Rs effects presented to the DUT. Applicable gauge wires, ground planes, and
materials shall be used to minimize these effects of stray inductance and resistance. Wire lengths shall be
kept to an absolute minimum.
CAUTION: Wire lengths connecting the DUT in excess of four inches (101.60 mm) should be re-
evaluated to determine shortest possible wire length.
b. Components: Circuit components shall be chosen to optimize performance. Capacitors shall have high Q
ratings reflecting high di/dt. The test circuit shall have multiple capacitors in parallel, minimizing the
parasitic resistance presented by each capacitor while obtaining the required dv/dt response. DC current
probes shall be passive having minimal ac insertion resistance. The current probe shall also be capable of
measuring a large current without saturating its magnetic core.
c. DUT package: Circuit and device parameters will dictate the power transistor response to high gamma
dose rate radiation. The DUT shall be tested in the same package type that will be used in the system. If
a different package type is used, then electrical, mechanical, and thermal properties of that package need
to be considered and their effects accounted for in the test results.
d. Test circuit: Schematically, test circuits are as shown on figure 3478-1 and representative waveforms are
depicted on figure 3478-2. Components and wiring shall not be placed directly in the radiation beam. An
isolation resistor shall be placed between the stiffening capacitors and high-voltage power supply,
minimizing its interaction with the DUT response. The resistor value will depend on the RC time constant
required to isolate interaction. Biasing of the gate shall be accomplished using an RC filtering or ballasting
resistor network (see figure 3478-1a or 3478-1b), unless it is connected directly to the common source
(see figure 3478-1c).
CAUTION: Peak currents in excess of 1,000 amperes with di/dt in excess of 1,000 amperes per
microsecond are possible.
METHOD 3478
2
NOTES:
1. C1: Consists of several small capacitors (typically .1 F).
2. C2: Consists of several large capacitors (typically 200 F).
3. R1: Drain isolation resistor (typically > 1 k).
4. R2: Gate filter resistor (typically 1 k).
5. C3: Gate filter capacitance (typically 0.1 F).
6. P1: Current probe (Pearson Model +11 or similar).
METHOD 3478
3
METHOD 3478
4
5. Procedure. Two essential requirements are outlined in this procedure that allow a meaningful analysis of a
device's radiation response as compared to data obtained on a different test fixture.
a. In 5.1 through 5.7, the procedure to characterize power transistors to high gamma dose rate radiation and
what data to collect and record are described.
b. In 5.8, there is a description for a technique to extract key electrical parameters, Ls and Rs, allowing the
test fixture to be characterized using the above radiation data.
5.1 Sample size. A minimum of five samples per device type shall be tested to determine the dose rate response
of each power transistor type. All devices shall meet the electrical specifications required for that particular device
type before initial exposure.
5.2 Identification. In all cases, each test sample shall be individually marked to ensure that the test data can be
traced to its corresponding test sample.
b. The facility/source shall be capable of varying the dose rate levels to characterize the device's response to
various dose rates.
c. The minimum pulse width shall be performed using a 20 to 50 ns pulse width (FWHM).
5.4 Dosimetry. Dosimetry shall be used to measure the actual dose in rad(Si) of the radiation pulse. Any
dosimetry technique that meets ASTM standards (ASTM F526-77) may be used.
5.5 Waveform recording. The voltage, Vds, and test current, Ids, shall be monitored before, during, and after
each irradiation. Voltage in excess of the maximum input voltage of the recording device shall be attenuated.
5.6 Test conditions. The DUT shall be biased with the specified test conditions and verified for each irradiation.
Drain and gate current shall be monitored before, during, and after each exposure. The capacitive load across the
drain/source shall maintain the drain bias voltage, Vds, during the exposure within 10 percent of that specified. The
test shall not be repeated until the stiffening capacitors have sufficiently recharged. All tests shall be performed at
the required ambient temperature.
CAUTION: Some transistors may require a gate bias to turn the DUT off after the radiation event.
a. Tune LINAC/flash x-ray to desired pulse width and dose rates and perform initial beam dosimetry.
METHOD 3478
5
i. Record test information: Test conditions Vds and Vgs; actual dose rate, accumulated total dose, date, and
other information pertinent to test.
j. Verify survivability of test device: Check electrical parameters to determine any damage.
k. Repeat with new test conditions: Different Vds, dose rate, or Vgs.
5.8 Determination of stray inductance/resistance. Knowing the stray components, Ls and Rs, will provide a
technique to compare test data from different test fixtures and packages. Ls and Rs will limit the amount of current
flow and the peak current observed by the DUT.
a. Using the recorded photocurrent waveforms, the quantitative values of the stray resistance, Rs, and
inductance, Ls, can be extracted for that test fixture and package.
CAUTION. The stray fixture components may change with exposure to radiation, testing, or time.
V ds R
I ds = * 1 - exp - (t * s
R s L s
The calculated resistance should be determined from the peak primary photocurrent response and its
corresponding time. Using iterative calculations, Rs shall be determined within 5 percent based upon this
experimental data.
6. Documentation. Test records shall be maintained by the experimenter. Test records shall include the
following:
6.1 Reporting. This documentation shall be used to prepare a summary describing the test system, data, results,
and analysis. The summary shall include a description of the device, dc electrical parameters before and after
testing, a statistic summary indicating the sample mean and standard deviation of each device type, plots of
photocurrent versus dose rate at a specified Vds and Vgs, calculations for stray Ls and Rs for the test fixture for
each device type or package type, and a general synopsis of the test results.
METHOD 3478
7
METHOD 3479
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test finds out the length of time a device can survive a short-circuit condition. In
some circuits, such as motor drives, it is necessary for a semiconductor device to withstand a short-circuit condition
for short periods of time. During such a condition, the current in the device is dependent on the gain of the device
and the level of the drive supplied. It is important for the designer to know how long a device can survive a short-
circuit condition with a given drive level. Fault detect circuits can be designed to react within this time period. In
some cases the junction temperature may exceed the maximum rating. If it does, the rating shall be nonrepetitive
with a limit on the maximum number of events over the lifetime of the device. Otherwise, it will be a repetitive rating.
In the case of a nonrepetitive rating, the manufacturer shall perform adequate reliability testing so as to ensure the
validity of this rating. For performance specifications, the controlling document shall mandate such tests.
2. Scope. This test covers all power semiconductors or hybrids that can be turned off with a control terminal and
which are intended for use as switching devices. Power MOSFETs, IGBTs, and bipolar transistors are examples of
these devices.
3. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purposes of this test
method:
b. LS: Stray inductance of the output circuit (see figure 3479-1) shall be kept as low
as is practical. In order to verify this, the maximum value of LS shall be a
condition of the test called out on the applicable specification sheet of the
device (see figure 3479-2). LS = V dt/di during the first 10 percent of the
output current waveform.
d. Tj: Junction temperature (C). Its starting value shall be specified, and controlled
to five percent at the beginning of the test.
e. tsc: Short-circuit withstand time (seconds). Measured between the time the
device drive rises above 50 percent of its peak value and when it falls below
50 percent of its peak value.
f. VSC: Nominal short-circuit voltage (volts). Shall be maintained between +5 percent and -10 percent of
the specified value during the test.
4. Circuitry. Electrical test circuitry is as shown on figure 3479-1. Drive circuitry must be appropriate for the
device being tested, whether voltage or current driven. Care must be taken to minimize stray inductance in the
output circuit in order to avoid limiting the current during the test, or avalanching the device during turn-off at the end
of the test.
METHOD 3479
1 of 4
4.1 Procedure for measurement of short-circuit withstand time (see figure 3479-2).
5. Acceptance criteria. DC electrical test shall be conducted before and after the test. Exactly which parameters
are to be measured will be device dependent, and shall be called out on the applicable specification sheet.
METHOD 3479
2
METHOD 3479
3
METHOD 3479
4
METHOD 3490
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to define a method for verifying the inductive switching SOA for MOS
gated power transistors and to assure devices are free from latch up.
2. Scope. This test includes all power MOSFETs and IGBTs used in switching applications for power supplies
and motor controls.
3. Circuitry. As shown on figure 3490-1, a simple inductive load circuit is employed. Drive circuitry applies a
voltage to the DUT to achieve a specified current. The turn-off dv/dt is controlled by a gate resistor. A clamping
diode or suppression device is used to limit the maximum voltage which occurs during turn-off. The clamping device
shall be located as close as possible to the DUT to minimize voltage spikes due to stray inductance Ls. For
inductive load waveform see 3490-2.
4. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purposes of this test
method:
a. dv/dt: Change in voltage during turn-on and turn-off measured between 75 percent and 25 percent of
total clamp voltage during turn-off.
c. L: Series inductance.
e. Rg: Resistor in series with the gate which is used to limit turn-off dv/dt during switching.
g. TC: Case temperature (C): Temperature of the DUT as measured on the exterior of the package as
close as possible to the die location.
h. TJ: Junction temperature (C): Shall not exceed maximum rating of the DUT.
m. VDM: Maximum off-state voltage measure at the DUT which is caused by stray inductance between the
DUT and the voltage suppressor. VDM is due to L di/dt generated during turn-off.
o. VG: Drive voltage from a voltage source used to turn-on and turn-off the MOS DUT to achieve a
specified current.
METHOD 3490
1 of 3
5. Specification conditions. The following conditions shall be as specified in the applicable specification sheet.
a. VCC: V.
b. VCF: V.
c. IL: A.
d. TC = TA: C.
e. L: mH.
f. tp: s.
h. N: Number of pulses.
6. Acceptance criteria.
a. Gate resistor or gate drive source shall be as close as possible to the DUT to minimize
oscillations during turn-off.
b. Gate resistor valve or gate drive is selected to assure minimum peak dv/dt is achieved.
c. VCF clamping device should be as close as possible to the DUT to minimize voltage over shoot.
A general guideline is VCF should not exceed 110 percent of VDM and shall be less than
avalanche breakdown of DUT.
d. L should be selected to assure peak current is reached. The IC will not be reached if too large of
an inductor is used.
e. Safety precautions should be taken when testing high voltage devices and rules and regulations
for handling high voltage devices should be followed.
METHOD 3490
2
NOTES:
1. Vclamp (in a clamped inductive-load switching circuit) or V(BR)DSX (in an unclamped circuit) is the
peak off-state.
2. Drain and source references for MOSFETs are equivalent to collector and emitter references for
IGBTs.
3500 Series
METHOD 3501
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine if the breakdown voltage of the gallium arsenide field-effect
transistor under the specified conditions is greater than the specified minimum limit.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
3. Procedure. A negative (reverse) voltage shall be applied to the gate, with the specified bias condition
(condition A) applied, then a positive voltage applied to the drain. The device is acceptable if the gate current is
less than the maximum specified with the voltage bias conditions on the gate and drain as specified in the applicable
specification sheet. 1/ With the specified gate and drain voltages, if the specified maximum gate current is
exceeded, the device shall be considered a failure.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. The bias condition is gate-to-source and drain-to-source - reverse bias (specify bias voltages).
____
1/ Iq Breakdown voltage as determined by maximum. Allowed gate current, with the specified bias condition
applied from gate-to-source and drain-to-source.
METHOD 3501
1 of 1
METHOD 3505
1. Purpose. The purpose of this method establishes a basic test circuit for the purpose of determining the
associated gain of a gallium arsenide field-effect transistor (FET).
2. Procedure. Configure the test setup as shown on figure 3505-1. First apply the gate voltage (VGS) then apply
the drain voltage (VDS). Adjust the gate voltage so that the FET is biased at the specified operating point as noted
in the applicable specification sheet, such as IDS = 50 percent of IDSS. Adjust the input and output tuners so that
the transistor exhibits maximum output power and near maximum gain; that is, the transistor's gain must not be
compressed more than 2 dB. The input power level is then reduced by at least 10 dB. At this reduced input signal
level, the small signal gain is defined as G0.
Calculation:
The gain of the FET (output power/input power in dB) is recorded as the input power is increased in 1 dB increments.
When the measured gain of the FET is less than or equal to G1dB, as calculated above, the output power is
recorded and this value represents the 1 dB compression point (P1dB) power level and is used in determining the
pass/fail status of the DUT in accordance with the value specified in the detail specification.
4. Summary. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable specification sheet, the following condition shall be as
follows: TC = (Temperature of case) = +25C.
METHOD 3505
1 of 1
METHOD 3510
1. Purpose. The purpose of this method establishes a basic test circuit for the purpose of determining the 1 dB
compression point of a gallium arsenide FET.
2. Procedure. Configure the test setup as shown on figure 3510-1. To prevent damage to the DUT, first apply the
gate voltage (VGS) then apply the drain voltage (VDS). Adjust the gate voltage so the FET is biased at the specified
operating point as noted in the applicable specification sheet, such as IDS = 50 percent of IDSS. Adjust the input
power to the level and frequency given in the applicable specification sheet; adjust the input and output tuners so the
transistor exhibits maximum output power while its gain remains within 2 dB of the manufacturer's specified minimum
gain for the part and while the gate current remains within the range specified in the applicable specification sheet.
The gate current shall also remain within the range specified in the applicable specification sheet. The input power
level is then reduced by 10 dB or some greater amount specified in the applicable specification sheet. At this
reduced input signal level, the small signal gain is defined as G0.
The gain of the FET (output power/input power in dB) is recorded as the input power is increased in increments of
1 dB decreasing to 0.25 dB, or smaller, as G1dB is approached. When the gain of the FET is less than or equal to
G1dB, as calculated above, the output is recorded and this value represents the 1 dB compression point (P1dB) and
is used in determining the pass/fail status of the DUT in accordance with the value specified in the applicable
specification sheet.
4. Summary. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable specification sheet, the following condition shall be as
follows: (TC) = (Temperature of case) = +25C.
METHOD 3510
1 of 1
METHOD 3570
1. Purpose. The purpose of this method establishes a basic test method, test setup, and procedure for measuring
the forward gain (magnitude of S21) of GaAs FETs.
2. Procedure. Configure and calibrate the test setup as shown on figure 3570-1. To prevent damage to the DUT,
first apply the gate voltage (VGS) and then apply the drain voltage (VDS) to the bias levels specified in the
applicable specification sheet. Adjust the gate voltage so that the DUT is biased at the specified operating point,
such as IDS = 50 percent of IDSS. Record the DUTs magnitude of S21 (in dB) using the network analyzer as shown
on figure 3570-1.
4. Summary. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable specification sheet, the following condition shall be as
follows: (TC) = (Temperature of case) = +25C.
METHOD 3570
1 of 1
METHOD 3575
FORWARD TRANSCONDUCTANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this method establishes a basic test circuit for the purpose of establishing forward
transconductance gm for gallium arsenide field-effect transistors.
2. Procedure. The gate-to-source voltage (Vg1) is applied as necessary to achieve the specified drain-to-source
current (IDS1). The gate-to-source voltage is reduced gradually or increased gradually by 0.050 volts (Vg2) and the
drain-to-source current is measured (IDS2). The transconductance (gm) is calculated using the following formula:
Calculation:
-
gm = I d 1 I d 2
0.050
4. Summary. Unless otherwise specified in the applicable specification sheet, the following conditions shall be as
follows:
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
METHOD 3575
1 of 1
4000 Series
METHOD 4000
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is for measuring a temperature-sensitive static parameter under conditions
such that the product of the applied voltage and current at the test point produces a power dissipation level that will
cause significant heating of the junction, the measured result may be subject to errors due to thermal or transient
effects. In order to avoid such errors, the measurement should be made under defined conditions.
2. Steady-state dc measurements. When making measurements under conditions of steady-state dc, a condition
of thermal equilibrium may be considered to have been achieved if halving the time between the application of power
and the taking of the reading causes no error in the indicated results within the required accuracy of measurement.
For these purposes very long pulses or step functions may be considered as steady-state dc. When appropriate, the
mounting conditions (TL or TC) or the thermal resistance (reference point to ambient RCA or RLA) shall be
specified.
3. Pulse measurements. When a measurement is made under pulse conditions, the point of measurement after
the start of the pulse shall be chosen such that it is long enough to charge interconnecting test cable capacitance,
avoid electrical transient effects, and short enough to avoid heating effects. This can be ensured if halving the
minimum selected time, or doubling the maximum selected time, will not produce errors beyond the defined accuracy
of the measurement. The pulse measurement may be intended to correlate to a steady-state dc measurement,
provided that a correlation has been established.
METHOD 4000
1 of 1
METHOD 4001.1
CAPACITANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the capacitance across the device terminals under specified
dc bias and ac signal voltages.
NOTE: Both dc bias and ac signal sources may be incorporated in the capacitance
bridge. The dc bias source should be properly isolated, preferably with an
inductance L in series and have negligible capacitance compared to the DUT. The
reactance of C must be negligible compared to the reactance of the DUT, at the
frequency of measurement. Impedance of voltmeter should be at least 10 times that
of the DUT.
3. Procedure. The dc voltage source shall be adjusted to the specified bias voltage. The ac small signal voltage
shall be adjusted to the specified frequency for the capacitance measurement. The bridge shall be nulled and
adjusted for zero capacitance reading just prior to insertion of the DUT to eliminate error from external circuitry.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
a. DC bias voltage.
b. Test frequency.
METHOD 4001.1
1 of 1
METHOD 4011.4
FORWARD VOLTAGE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the voltage across the device when a specified current flows
through the device in the forward direction.
NOTE: When specified, switch SW1 shall consist of either an electronic switch or a
pulse generator to provide pulses of short-duty cycle to minimize device heating.
When pulse techniques are used, suitable peak-reading methods shall be used to
measure the parameters of pulse amplitude, frequency, duty cycle, and pulse width.
When dc techniques are used, device thermal equilibrium shall be achieved before
the measurement is made.
3. Procedure.
3.1 DC method. The specified test current (IF) shall be adjusted by varying either the variable voltage source or
the resistor (R). The value of IF shall be measured using an ammeter. The forward voltage (VF) shall be measured
using a dc voltmeter. The voltmeter connections shall be made at specified points on the device and always within
the current connection points.
3.2 Pulse method. An oscilloscope shall be used to measure the pulse characteristics. The pulse generator or
electronic switch shall be adjusted to achieve the specified amplitude, frequency, and pulse width values. Device
current (IF) may be determined by measuring the voltage drop across a known value of resistor (R) where:
V peak X duty cycle
IF =
R
After adjusting pulse level to correct value for required IF, measure forward voltage VF.
3.3 Curve tracer method. A Tektronix Model 576 or equivalent curve tracer shall be used. The device shall be
tested by applying a positive voltage to the anode and limiting the current to within the manufacturer's ratings for IF.
The forward voltage may be determined by observing the curve tracer waveform at the specified IF.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
c. Duty cycle and pulse width, when pulse techniques are used.
METHOD 4011.4
1 of 1
METHOD 4016.4
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the reverse current leakage through a device at a specified
reverse voltage using a dc method or an ac method, as applicable.
2. DC method.
NOTE: To assure accurate measurement of reverse leakage current, the voltage drop across the ammeter shall
be subtracted from the measured value of reverse voltage. Resistor (R) shall be chosen to limit the current flow in
the event the device goes into reverse breakdown.
FIGURE 4016-1. Test circuit for reverse current leakage (dc method).
2.2 Procedure.
2.2.1 Reverse current. The dc voltage shall be adjusted to the specified value by voltmeter (V) and the reverse
current (IR) shall be measured by current meter (I).
3. AC method.
FIGURE 4016-2. Test circuit for reverse current leakage (ac method).
METHOD 4016.4
1 of 2
3.2 Procedure.
3.2.1 Reverse current. A Tektronix 576-curve tracer or equivalent shall be used to apply voltage in the reverse
direction only. The curve tracer supply shall be adjusted to obtain the specified peak reverse voltage across the
device. Current and voltage shall be measured on the curve tracer.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
a. DC or ac method.
c. Thermal resistance of minimum heat dissipater on which device is mounted in C/W (where applicable).
d. Thermal equilibrium or pulse condition such as specified in EIA-320-A. (If pulse test is not specified, thermal
equilibrium dc test method correlation will be applicable. This may include pulse measurement intended to
correlate to steady-state dc measurement as described in EIA-320-A.)
METHOD 4016.4
2
METHOD 4021.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine if the breakdown voltage of the device is greater than the
specified minimum limit.
2. Test circuit. The resistance R is a current-limiting resistance and is chosen to avoid excessive current flowing
through the device. (See figure 4021-1.)
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
3. Procedure. The reverse current shall be adjusted from zero until either the minimum limit for breakdown
voltage or the specified test current is reached. The device is acceptable if the specified minimum limit for BV is
reached before the test current reaches the specified value. If the specified test current is reached first, the device is
rejected.
4. Summary. The test current (see 3.) shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
METHOD 4021.2
1 of 1
METHOD 4022
BREAKDOWN VOLTAGE
(VOLTAGE REGULATORS AND VOLTAGE-REFERENCE DIODES)
1. Purpose. This test is designed to measure the breakdown voltage of voltage regulator and voltage-reference
devices under the specified conditions.
NOTE: The voltmeter being used to measure the terminal voltage should present an open circuit to the
terminals across which the voltage is being measured.
3. Procedure. The reverse current shall be adjusted from zero until the specified test current is reached. The
specified test current shall remain applied for the specified time to approach thermal equilibrium with the device
mounted as specified in the individual specification sheet. The breakdown voltage shall then be read from the
voltmeter.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
b. Time after application of test current when breakdown voltage shall be read.
c. Method of mounting.
METHOD 4022
1 of 1
METHOD 4023.2
SCOPE DISPLAY
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to define criteria for inspection of the dynamic reverse characteristics of
rectifiers, switching, and zener diodes when viewed on a curve tracer. This inspection criteria may not be applicable
to specific rectifier designs where the device is not intended to be driven into avalanche breakdown, or where the
applicable specification sheet has not provided for this inspection.
2. Scope.
a. This test applies to all devices requiring stable or sharp and stable breakdown characteristics. NOTE:
Since low voltage zeners do not inherently have, and some other devices may not have a sharp
breakdown, specific exceptions in requirements are also provided herein. For ideal reverse see figure
4023-1. For soft knee see 4023-2. For drift see 4023-3.
b. For condition A, stable (only) types, figures 4023-3, 4023-7, 4023-9, and 4023-10 shall apply.
c. For condition B, sharp and stable types, figures 4023-2 through 4023-11 shall apply. The ideal sharp and
stable trace is one which exhibits a single horizontal line up to the point of breakdown, then transitions
vertically to form a 90 degree angle while maintaining the single line (see figure 4023-1). Deviations from
this ideal, which are not specifically allowed in this method or applicable specification sheet shall be cause
for rejection of the DUT. The following depictions (figures 4023-2 through 4023-11) have been compiled to
describe commonly observed faults. Tolerances from acceptable devices have been assigned when
applicable.
3. Procedures
a. The curve tracer presentation shall be configured so that the horizontal axis shall be calibrated in volts per
division and the vertical axis shall be calibrated in amperes per division (or fractions thereof). The vertical
and horizontal axis of the curve tracer presentation will be graduated into eight or ten divisions, each
representing a precalibrated increment of current or voltage.
b. A series load resistor shall be used to limit the device reverse current and prevent device damage. This
typical resistance should be approximately one quarter or more of the device resistance at the breakdown
specification, when the curve trace set-up permits. Example: A device to be observed at IBR of 100 A
which is specified to be 400 volts minimum, would have a series resistance chosen according to the
following:
The curve tracer peak voltage (VCT) may also require limitation, particularly if the series load resistance
described cannot be achieved. See figure 4023-1 and 3.e. for typical load line relationships to assure safe
reverse current monitoring.
*Unless otherwise specified, the breakdown current shall be the current used for the breakdown voltage
test.
c. The trace should occur in the first and third quadrant of the display and be slowly adjusted from zero volts
to attain the specified current with the maximum amount of resolution for determination of trace
characteristics. 8-9
* d. The DUT shall be held under breakdown conditions for at least two second to ensure freedom from
intermittent instability for breakdown drift. NOTE: All figures herein are shown in the first quadrant.
METHOD 4023.2
1 of 8
e. The vertical and horizontal sensitivity shall be adjusted on the curve tracer to provide a rendition of the
complete trace to the specified current. Horizontal and vertical sensitivity shall be adjusted to provide a
trace occupying no less than 50 percent of the available screen.
f. The curve trace voltage shall not be simply set at a predetermined value and snapped on instantaneously.
This may be done only if the product to be tested is known to have a sufficiently narrow breakdown voltage
(VBR) range with a predetermined series (load line) resistor setting (see b.) and described below, to assure
that the device will not be overpowered. This is typically the case for zener diodes prescreened on VZ (or
VBR). The peak open circuit supply voltage of the curve tracer (VCT) may then be adjusted such that the
VCT setting can provide no more current (IBR or IZ) than that required for avalanche breakdown, taking
into account the series load resistance R in figure 4023-1. Unless otherwise specified, these relationships
may be calculated by:
VCT VBR
I BR = , and VCT = I BR R + VBR
R
The resistance R may be determined by:
VCT VBR
R=
I BR
The VBR (or VZ) utilized in this equation should be the minimum expected so as to always maximize the R
value selected.
g. Allowance for deviation from the desired characteristics described in this method or applicable
specification sheet shall be granted by the qualifying activity. If a particular rejectable trace described is
expected in a manufacturer's normal process, it shall be identified and explained during device
conformance/ qualification. Devices exhibiting the exceptional trace characteristic shall be present in the
conformance/qualification lot to establish reliability.
h. Any device that is stable and passes the applicable illustrated scope conditions shall be passed. Any
device that exceeds the conditions in the applicable illustrate scope conditions will be failed. Any device
that passes but is continuing to move, drift or otherwise change shall be observed for another 2 seconds.
This cycle of 2 second intervals will continue until the part stabilizes and passes by still meeting the pass
criteria or fails by exceeding the pass criteria. Any device that is still drifting after a total of 10 seconds
shall be failed as being chronically unstable.
4. Summary. The following shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet. Test condition to be used.
METHOD 4023.2
2
This ideal trace exhibits none of the characteristics described on the figures below. Also, illustrated are the basic
curve tracer adjustments and relation for a safe maximum operating current (IBR) with the series load resistor (R)
versus peak open circuit voltage (VCT) and device breakdown voltage (VBR).
The knee area is the area in which the trace transitions from the horizontal to the vertical. Unless otherwise
specified, this area should not require more than 10 percent of the total horizontal voltage component being viewed,
or more than 20 percent of the specified IBR. Not applicable to signal diodes, low voltage zeners, fast, ultrafast, and
Schottky rectifiers or low voltage zeners 10 volts.
METHOD 4023.2
3
The vertical component of the trace should remain stable in the horizontal axis. An undesirable drift is defined as
greater than a 10 percent increase or 2 percent decrease in actual breakdown voltage up to 1,500 volts. If over
1,500 volts, the allowable drift should be separately specified.
The slope shall be less than 10 percent of VBR when viewed between 20 percent to 100 percent of the specified IBR
or IZ. Low voltage zeners below 5.5 volts are in exception to this requirement also, or other devices, as may be
specified.
METHOD 4023.2
4
The double break is the area in which the trace transitions from the horizontal to the vertical. Unless otherwise
specified, this area should not occupy more than 10 percent of the total horizontal voltage component being viewed,
or more than 20 percent of the specified IBR or IZT. This requirement is not applicable to ultrafast or Schottky
rectifiers, and low voltage zeners 10 volts.
FIGURE 4023-5. Double break (reject criteria for sharp knee devices).
For standard rectifiers and zeners, the region at the knee may display a secondary trace no more than 5 percent of
the total voltage of the DUT (see detail).
METHOD 4023.2
5
Measure at
Widest Point
For soft knee diodes including signal diodes, low voltage zeners, and altered junction fast, superfast and ultrafast
rectifiers, the region at the knee may display a secondary trace no more than 10 percent of the total voltage of the
DUT (see detail).
Any jittery movement of the trace in any direction, not caused by power line voltage fluctuations, shall not
occur.
METHOD 4023.2
6
The vertical component shall not depart from a single vertical line, except as allowed on figures 4023-5 and
4023-6.
The vertical component shall not decrease its value abruptly by 2 percent or more of VBR.
METHOD 4023.2
7
Instability (arcing) appearing at or near the specified IBR region on the vertical trace (such as may be coincident with
visible sparking activity within the device die region) shall not be present. Noise at or near the knee is permissible,
such as typically observed on avalanche-zener devices.
METHOD 4023.2
8
METHOD 4026.3
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is intended to measure the forward voltage and recovery time of the device.
A device reveals an excessive transient forward voltage when it is switched rapidly into the forward conductance
region. The amplitude and time duration of this voltage peak can be measured by observing the voltage waveform
across the device when a flat-top pulse of the specified amplitude, rise time, pulse width, and frequency are applied
to the device.
a. The forward transient test circuit shown on figure 4026-1 is used in conjunction with a pulse
generator and an output sensing device. Care should be taken to minimize lead length where
lead inductance might cause ringing in the test circuit.
b. The value of resistor Rp shall be chosen to optimize the impedance match between pulse
generator and test circuit, thereby minimizing the ringing in the test circuit.
FIGURE 4026-1. Test circuit for forward recovery voltage and time.
METHOD 4026.3
1 of 2
3.1 Conditions:
a. Pulse input A:
(5) Pulse frequency shall be such that a reduction in frequency shall result in no change in forward
recovery characteristics.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
c. Forward recovery voltage V(peak) chosen to terminate the forward recovery time measurement (see figure
4026-1).
d. The following measurements should be made: Forward recovery time (tfr) (measured from the time
forward voltage becomes positive to the time that forward voltage recovers to a specified vfr) (see figure
4026-1).
e. The peak forward voltage V(peak) (see figure 4026-1). This symbol is interchangeable with VFM.
METHOD 4026.3
2
METHOD 4031.4
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the reverse recovery time and other specified recovery
characteristics related to signal, switching, and rectifier diodes by observing the reverse transient current versus time
when switching from a specified forward current to a reverse biased state in a specified manner.
2. General guide for selecting appropriate condition. Four conditions are given to include recommended practice
for the range of diodes considered. A general guide for selecting the appropriate condition letter is:
b. Low to medium current rectifiers with maximum specified recovery times of 50 to 3,000 ns.
c. High current rectifiers with maximum specified recovery times of 350 ns or greater.
3. Test condition A. This condition is particularly relevant to low current, signal diodes faster than 6 ns and tested
at 10 mA. However, it is practicable for measurements up to 20 ns and 100 mA.
a. Rise time of the reverse voltage pulse across a noninductive calibration resistor in place of the DUT shall
be less than 20 percent of the recovery time of the DUT, for greatest accuracy.
b. Oscilloscope rise time shall be less than 20 percent of device recovery time, for greatest accuracy.
c. Proper coaxial networks and terminations shall be employed to ensure against error-producing pulse
reflections.
d. R > 10 RL.
f. C > 10 PW RL.
MEHTOD 4031.4
1 of 12
NOTE: The test circuit shall comply with the test conditions as stated in 2.1.
PW = Pulse width of reverse voltage pulse (see figure 4031-2).
RL = Load resistance.
C = Coupling capacitance.
3.2 Procedure for condition A. The specified forward current shall be adjusted by resistor R and the + supply.
Voltage E, developed across the 50 ohm oscilloscope input impedance shall be measured. Specified forward
current shall be calculated by the expression IF = E/50. The time duration of IF shall be at least 10 times the device
recovery time. The oscilloscope trace deflection above zero reference shall be adjusted by the oscilloscope vertical
sensitivity to produce an amplitude of 2 cm minimum vertical deflection. Adjustment of the reverse transient current
(IRM) shall be made by varying the pulse generator output, observing the voltage E across the 50 ohm oscilloscope
input impedance, and calculating IRM by the expression I = E/50. When reverse bias voltage VR is specified, and
IRM is not, the DUT shall be replaced with a shorting bar and IRM shall be calculated by the expression VR/50 (see
figure 4031-2.)
3.3 Summary for condition A. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
c. Load resistance, if other than 100 (this is the sum of ZPG and ZSCOPE).
d. Ambient temperature in C.
METHOD 4031.4
2
4. Test condition B. (See suggested conditions in table 4031-I (e.g., B1, B2) and figure 4031-3A and 4031-3B for
test circuit and board layout.) This condition is particularly relevant to medium current (axial and similar) types of
standard and fast rectifiers with maximum specified recovery times between 50 and 3,000 ns that measured at peak
forward currents greater than 100 mA and less than or equal to 1.0 ampere. It is readily adapted to lower test
currents. This test is also appropriate for devices with recovery times less than 50 ns that are measured at peak
forward currents of 1A or less; below 25 ns, or at higher current, particular care shall be used to achieve low loop
inductance and low circuit rise times to achieve acceptable repeatability.
This condition differs from condition D in that the reverse current (IRM) is limited by the test circuit, not by the DUT.
Designation (condition) B1 B2 B3 B4 B5
Test current, IF 0.5 0.5 1.0 1.0 0.01
(amperes)
(see figure 4031-4) IRM 1.0 0.5 1.0 1.0 0.01
i
0.25 0.1 0.5 0.1 0.005
R(REC)
Circuit RF 33 33 50 50 1,200
resistor 1/ RR 9 9 15 15 200
(ohms)
R4 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 10.0
METHOD 4031.4
3
4.1 Circuit notes for condition B. The timing and test circuit of figure 4031-3A is a guide to what is needed. An
equivalent circuit may be used. Figure 4031-3B shows a suggested configuration for R4. Duty factor shall be 5
percent maximum.
a. The rise time of the reverse voltage pulse across a noninductive calibration resistor in place of DUT shall
be less than 20 percent of the recovery time of the DUT.
b. The oscilloscope rise time shall be less than 50 percent of the pulse generator rise time.
METHOD 4031.4
4
NOTES:
1. Resistor assembly R4 consists of 10 resistors (1 , .25 W metal film), 5 on top and 5 on the bottom foils. The
center of resistor bodies are not shown, and leads are shown dotted so that conducting foils may be more
clearly shown. Bottom resistor current flow L to R () is opposite to top current flow R to L (), providing
magnetic field cancellation. Sense lead to the center conductor of the probe jack exits at right angle to
resistor axes and is located between the top and bottom resistor layers.
2. Cross hatched circular areas show the connections between those top and bottom foil regions indicated by
arrows.
3. To ground of circuit and probe.
4. To center conductor of miniature probe jack.
5. To cathode of DUT.
FIGURE 4031-3B. Suggested board layout for low L1/R4 for condition B.
4.2 Procedure for condition B. Specified forward current (IF) shall be adjusted by varying positive voltage, V3.
Reverse current (IRM) shall be controlled by varying the negative voltage, V4 (see figure 4031-4). With the DUT in
place the circuit shall be capable of higher than specified IRM; the circuit, and not the diode, must limit IRM.
METHOD 4031.4
5
4.3 Summary for condition B. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
a. Test condition (e.g., B1, B2) (see 3.) If not in table 4031-I, specify c, d, and e.
5. Test condition C. This test is intended for high current rectifiers with reverse recovery times equal to or greater
than 350 ns and tested with peak forward currents equal to or greater than 10 amperes. See figure 4031-5.
FIGURE 4031-5. Circuit for measuring reverse recovery characteristics (condition C).
METHOD 4031.4
6
a. The circuit is designed to simulate the commutation duty encountered in power rectifier diode circuits while also
keeping average power dissipation low to minimize the need for thermal management.
__
b. The resistance of the C.L. and DUT loop (R2 and parasitics) is small, e.g., 2 L / C much greater than R so
the test current will essentially be sinusoidal, possessing a width of LC , a di/dt of V/L and a peak value of
L / C . The peak voltage across the capacitor shall be as small as practicable to achieve the desired test
conditions. The effects of reverse voltage magnitude on the test device recovery characteristics are neglected.
c. The minimum forward current pulse time (tp) shall be at least five times the recovery time (trr) of the DUT so
that the di/dt will be linear and of the same value before and after current reversal.
d. The oscilloscope rise time shall be less than 20 percent of ta or tb (see figure 4031-6), whichever is less.
e. The inductance of the current viewing resistor shall be extremely low, e.g., 0.01 micro Henry. Abrupt recovery
rectifiers (figure 4031-6) can cause current oscillations which may be reduced by using a lower inductance
current viewing resistor and by properly terminating the oscilloscope cable. A current transformer / with
suitable rise time may be substituted for the current viewing resistor 1/. Rectifier diode RD2 provides a very
low inductance path around SCR1 if the reverse recovery time of SCR1 is shorter than that of the DUT. An
external SCR triggering source may be required to achieve stable triggering.
f. A slight oscillation may appear on the waveform following device recovery. This may be reduced by lowering
the current viewing resistor's inductance, or properly terminating the viewing cable. The oscillation, however,
does not affect the test results.
g. D2 and its circuit branch should provide a very low inductance path around the SCR if the reverse recovery
time of the SCR is shorter than that of the DUT.
h. R3 shall be sufficiently large such that the SCR triggers only after the capacitor, C, has had ample time to
charge to its desired value. If stable triggering or ample charging is a problem, a momentary pushbutton switch
may be inserted in line with R3 to provide triggering. A pulse transformer technique is also acceptable in the
triggering circuit.
5.2 Procedure for condition C. C, L, and V are adjusted to obtain the specified test current di/dt and magnitude,
IFM. The recovery time for rectifier diodes is defined as trr = ta + tb (see figure 4031-6), ta is measured from the
instant of current reversal to the instant that current reaches its peak reverse value IRM(REC) and tb is measured
from IRM(REC) to the instant the straight line connecting IRM(REC) and 0.25 IRM(REC) intercepts the zero current
axis. The recovery time for devices with abrupt recovery characteristics is defined in the same manner except tb is
measured from IRM(REC) to the instant the test current waveform intercepts the zero current axis, if applicable.
_____
1/ Pearson Electronics, Inc. or equivalent types.
METHOD 4031.4
7
FIGURE 4031-6. Test current waveforms for various types of rectifier diodes under
test in the circuit for measuring reverse recovery characteristics.
(5) Minimum test current pulse width, tp, in microseconds. (Duty cycle shall be one percent).
b. The following characteristics shall be specified for measurement in the applicable specification sheet as
required:
METHOD 4031.4
8
6. Test condition D. (See suggested conditions in table 4031-II. (e.g., D1, D2, D3)) This condition is intended for
ultra-fast medium current rectifiers (axial and case mount, or equivalent styles) measured at IF 1A and with reverse
recovery time 100 ns. With good engineering practice, condition D can adequately measure trr down to about 10
ns; it can also utilize If up to at least 10 A.
1/ For devices with substantially higher rated current, it is desirable to use test conditions for IF close to rated
current, and higher values of di/dt.
6.1 Test circuit. Refer to figures 4031-7 and 4031-8 for timing and circuit details. Equivalent circuits may be
used. The forward current generator consisting of Q1, Q2, R1, and R2 may be replaced with any functionally
equivalent circuit. Likewise, the current-ramp generator consisting of Q3, Q4, R3, and C1. The duty factor shall be
5 percent.
a. This method presumes that good engineering practice will be employed in the construction of the test
circuit, e.g., short leads, good ground plane, minimum inductance of the measuring loop, and minimum
self-inductance (L1) of the current sampling resistor (R4). Also, appropriate high speed generators and
instruments shall be used.
b. The measuring-loop inductance (LLOOP, see figure 4031-7) represents the net effect of all inductive
elements, whether lumped or distributed, e.g., bonding wires, test fixture, circuit board foil, or inductance of
energy storage capacitors. The value of LLOOP should be 100 nH or less. The reason for controlling this
circuit parameter is that it, combined with diode characteristics including CT, determines the value of tb.
c. The turn-off reverse-voltage overshoot shall not be allowed to exceed the device rated breakdown voltage.
Ringing and overshoot may become a problem with RLOOP < 2 (L / C ) ; where L = LLOOP. That is
another reason for minimizing LLOOP.
d. Regarding breakdown voltage, -V4 should be kept as low as practicable, especially when test low voltage
devices. A value of approximately 30 volts is recommended.
e. The time constant of the self-inductance of the current-sample resistor R4 (see figure 4031-8) shall be kept
low relative to ta because the observed values of ta and IRM increase with increasing self-inductance. Since
the value of R4 is not specified, the recommended maximum inductance is expressed as a time constant
(L1/R4) with a maximum value of ta (minimum)/10, where ta (minimum) is the lowest ta value expected. This
ratio was chosen as a practical compromise and would yield an observed ta, which is 10 percent high (ta =
L1/R4). The IRM error is a function of the L1/R4 time constant and di/dt. For a di/dt of 100 A/s the
observed IRM would also be 10 percent high. IRM = L1/R4 di/dt.
f. The di/dt of 100 A/s was chosen so as to provide reasonably high signal levels and still not introduce the
large IRM errors caused by higher di/dt. Higher values of di/dt, without large errors, can be achieved with
lower L1/R4.
METHOD 4031.4
9
METHOD 4031.4
10
NOTES:
1. Resistor assembly Rr is made from 10 resistors (1 , .25 W metal film), 5 on top and 5 on the bottom foils.
The center of resistor bodies are not shown, and leads are shown dotted so that conducting foils may be more
clearly shown. Bottom resistor current flow L or R () is opposite to top resistor current flow R to L (),
providing magnetic field cancellation. Sense lead to the center conductor of the probe jack exits at right angle
to resistor axes and is located between the top and bottom resistor layers.
2. Crosses hatched circular areas show the connections between those top and bottom foil regions indicated by
arrows.
3. To ground of circuit and probe.
4. To center conductor of miniature probe jack.
5. To cathode of DUT.
FIGURE 4031-8. Suggest board layout for low L1/R4 for condition D.
METHOD 4031.4
11
6.2 Procedure for condition D. Adjust V1 for the specified forward current, IF. Adjust -V2 for the specified di/dt
(see figures 4031-7 and 4031-9).
(1) Designation (condition, see table 4031-II). If another is desired, 4 and 5 herein shall be specified. If
another is desired, d and e shall be specified.
(4) IF, .25 (minimum) of the continuous rated current is the suggested alternative (see table 4031-II).
(5) di/dt, 100 A/s is the suggested alternative (see table 4031-II).
NOTE: An additional measurement, ta may be made if desired to compute tb = trr - ta, and the recovery
softness factor, RSF = tb/ta.
METHOD 4031.4
12
METHOD 4036.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the quality factor (Q) of the device. By definition, Q expresses
the ratio of reactance to effective resistance of the device, under rf signal conditions and specified dc bias
conditions.
NOTE: The impedance of C1, C2, and L1, L2 shall be small and large, respectively, compared to the DUT at
the frequency of measurement.
3. Procedure. The test equipment shall be connected as shown in figure 4036-1. The dc bias supply shall be
adjusted for the specified voltage where Q is to be measured. Unless otherwise specified, the rf level shall be
adjusted to 50 mV (rms). The parallel resistance Rp and capacitance Cp of the test device shall be measured using
rf bridge methods. Unless otherwise specified, the point of measurement shall be .062 inch (1.57 mm) from the
device body. Q shall be calculated using the following formula: Q = 2fRpCp.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Test frequency.
d. Required Q.
METHOD 4036.1
1 of 1
METHOD 4041.2
RECTIFICATION EFFICIENCY
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure rectification efficiency which is the ratio of dc output voltage to
peak ac input voltage.
NOTE: The voltmeter shall have a high impedance as compared with the load circuit of RL
and CL.
3. Procedure. The ac signal shall be adjusted to the specified frequency and signal level measured by means of
peak reading voltmeter (Vpk). The rectified output voltage shall be measured by means of voltmeter (VDC).
V DC
Rectification efficiency (%) = X 100
V pk
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4041.2
1 of 1
METHOD 4046.1
1. Purpose. This test is designed to measure the average reverse current through the device under the specified
conditions.
NOTE: The reverse leakage current at each device D1 and D2 shall be less
than .05 percent of the maximum allowable specified leakage current of the
DUT. In other respects, the devices D1 and D2 should be of the same type as
the DUT.
3. Procedure. After thermal equilibrium, at the temperature specified, the specified voltage shall be applied.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4046.1
1 of 1
METHOD 4051.3
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the reverse breakdown impedance of the device under small-
signal conditions.
NOTES:
1. The impedances of C1 and C2 shall be small compared to the DUT at the test frequency.
2. Voltmeters VAC and V2 shall be high input impedance rms types.
3. The resistance of R1 shall be large compared with the breakdown impedance being measured.
4. A low pass filter may be installed in series with the ac signal source.
3. Procedure. The specified reverse direct current shall be applied to the DUT. An ac signal in the frequency
range of 45 through 1,000 Hz shall be applied to the DUT through coupling capacitor C2. Associated specification
limits for ZZT shall apply at 45 through 60 Hz. Tests at frequencies greater than 60 Hz shall be corrected to those
readings taken at 45 through 60 Hz. This current shall be 10 percent of the value of the dc breakdown current
through the DUT. The small-signal impedance shall be determined as follows:
V (RMS) V AC R2
Z ZT = =
I (RMS) V2
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4051.3
1 of 1
METHOD 4056.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the forward impedance of the device under small-signal
conditions.
NOTES:
1. The impedances of C1 and C2 shall be small compared to the DUT at the test frequency.
2. Voltmeters VAC and V2 shall be high input impedance types.
3. The resistance of R1 shall be large compared with the forward impedance being measured.
4. A low pass filter may be installed in series with the ac signal source.
3. Procedure. The specified forward direct current shall be applied to the DUT. An ac signal in the frequency
range of 45 through 1,000 Hz shall be applied to the DUT through coupling capacitor C2. associated specification
sheet limits for Zf shall apply at 45 through 60 Hz. Tests at frequencies greater than 60 Hz shall be corrected to
those readings at 45 through 60 Hz. This current shall not be greater than 10 percent of the value of the dc forward
current If. The small-signal impedance shall be determined as follows:
V (RMS) V AC R 2
Zf= =
I (RMS) V2
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4056.2
1 of 1
METHOD 4061.1
STORED CHARGE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure directly the charge recovered from a semi-conductor diode
when it is rapidly switched from a forward biased condition to a reverse biased condition.
3. Test precautions.
a. The diode under test is forward biased by the current flowing from voltage source number 2
through diode D1 and through resistor R1 to voltage source number 1. The diode under test is
periodically reverse biased by the pulse from the generator and the charge stored in the diode is
caused to flow through diode D2 and is measured on the current meter. A similar measurement
is made at zero bias current to determine the component of charge resulting from the diode
capacitance and the stray circuit capacitance. The stored charge can then be computed from the
current readings and the pulse frequency.
b. Resistor R1 should be large enough to ensure a constant current through the diode under test. Capacitor
C1 should be large enough to maintain a nearly constant voltage across the diode under test during the
pulse. The output impedance of the pulse generator including R3 should have a low value, preferably 10
to 25 . The rise time of the pulse should be short enough and the pulse length should be long enough so
that further change will not alter the measurement results.
METHOD 4061.1
1 of 2
c. Diode D1 should have a much smaller stored charge than the diode under test. Diode D2 should
have a fast turn on time, a low dynamic resistance at high currents, and a low reverse leakage
current. Capacitors C2 and C4 should have low inductance and should be of sufficient
capacitance so that a further increase in their values would not alter the measurement results.
The current meter should be of sufficiently low impedance that the average voltage drop across it
during any test does not exceed 10 millivolts. Capacitor C3 should be of sufficient size that a
small current will flow through the current meter with the diode under test removed. Resistor R2
should have approximately the same value as the output impedance of the pulse generator.
d. The portion of the circuit within the dotted lines should be constructed in accordance with good
practices for high speed pulse circuits. Particular attention should be paid to minimizing the
circuit inductance including the connections to the diode under test. The capacitance between
point A and ground should be made as small as possible.
4. Test procedure.
a. Adjust the pulse generator for the desired amplitude, pulse width, and frequency (f). Set voltage
source one to zero. Insert the diode under test and adjust voltage source two for the specified
voltage from point A to ground as measured on a high impedance voltmeter. A common value
used for this voltage is -0.6 volts. Read the current, I1, flowing through the current meter.
b. Set voltage source one for the specified forward current through the diode under test. Adjust
voltage source two for the specified voltage from point A to ground. This voltage must be the
same as used in 3.a. Read the current, I2, flowing through the current meter.
I2 - I1
QS =
f
5. Summary. The following conditions shall be included in the applicable specification sheet:
a. The bias current If at which the stored charge measurement is made (see 4.).
b. Pulse generator rise time (1 percent to 50 percent), amplitude, width, impedance, and frequency (see 4.).
METHOD 4061.1
2
METHOD 4064
1. Purpose. This purpose of this test method is to determine the avalanche capability of schottky diodes. The
intent of the test is to stress the termination of the device.
2. Scope. This method is intended as a test for diode devices designed and specified with avalanche capability.
3. Circuitry. The circuit shall be designed so that all stray reactances are held to a minimum. The inductor L shall
be of a fast response type.
4. Symbols and definitions. The following symbols and terminology apply to this test method:
5. Procedure.
5.1 Screening. The DUT must be screened prior to avalanche and meet all specified parameters.
5.2 Calculations. The energy delivered to the DUT can be calculated as follows:
a.
NOTE: RS 0
b.
METHOD 4064
1 of 4
5.3.1 The circuit shown below is typical for unclamped inductive switching. In this circuit design the VDD power supply
may contribute to the total energy transferred to the diode if its value is not small compared to the V(BR) of the device
under test. The calculation of the energy should include the transfer from the VDD supply when the ratio of V(BR)DUT
over VDD is less than 10, which is calculation (a) in section 5.2.
VDD
V(BR)DUT
I AS
S1 DUT
5.3.2 Switch S1 is normally a power semiconductor, such as a mosfet but the breakdown voltage of this device must
be greater than that of the device under test.
5.3.3 A current transformer or probe should be used to monitor the avalanche current of the device. This probe must
be mounted in either the cathode or anode leg of the device under test.
5.3.4 The value of inductance (L) for the load should be selected to keep the time in avalanche below 200uS. Air
core inductors are recommended for this test to avoid the possibility of core problems. If iron core inductors are
used, care must be taken such that core saturation is not changing the effective value to the inductance (L), which
will lead to non-repeatable test results.
5.3.5 The current and voltage waveform below shows typical response of a device in this test circuit.
V(BR)DUT
I LPK
tAV
IL
VDD
5.4.1 The circuit shown below is also applicable for unclamped inductive switching. In this circuit design the VDD
power supply is removed from the test circuit via S1 after the inductive load is fully charged. The calculation of the
energy does not need to include the transfer from the VDD supply when using this test circuit, which is calculation (b)
in section 5.2.
VDD
L V(BR)DUT
S1
I AS
FREE WHEELING
DIODE S2
DUT
5.4.2 Switches S1 and S2 are a power semiconductors, such as mosfets but the breakdown voltages of the devices
must be greater than that of the device under test. These devices are switched off simultaneously in order to achieve
the proper response on the device under test.
5.4.3 The free wheeling diode is required to close the current loop for the inductive load after S1 opens the
connection to the VDD power supply.
5.4.4 A current transformer or probe should be used to monitor the avalanche current of the device. This probe must
be mounted in either the cathode or anode leg of the device under test.
5.4.5 The value of inductance (L) for the load should be selected to keep the time in avalanche below 200uS. Air
core inductors are recommended for this test to avoid the possibility of core problems. If iron core inductors are
used, care must be taken such that core saturation is not changing the effective value to the inductance (L), which
will lead to non-repeatable test results.
5.4.6 The current and voltage waveform below shows typical response of a device in this test circuit.
VOLTAGE
ACROSS S1
CURRENT IN
INDUCTIVE LOAD
I LPK
AVALANCHE
CURRENT
V(BR)DUT
tAV
AVALANCHE
VOLTAGE
GATE DRIVE
SIGNAL, IF S1
AND S2 ARE
MOSFETS
METHOD 4064
3
6. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
7. Failure criteria. The DUT shall tested and be within all specified static parametric limits at the completion of the
test.
METHOD 4064
4
METHOD 4065
1. Purpose. This describes a test method for subjecting the device under test (DUT) to a high power stress
condition in the reverse direction of rectifiers to determine the ability of the device to withstand a specified peak
reverse power. This is intended to verify reverse power stress capabilities by various test conditions. Each condition
is considered nonrepetitive where there is sufficient time between their applications to permit the device temperature
to return to its original value before it may be repeated.
2. Applicability. A current impulse is applied for 20 s that will provide a constant level of power in the reverse
direction of the rectifier. This test method also utilizes a monitoring circuit to sense voltage for determination of power
and possible voltage collapse during the current impulse.
3. Definitions. The following symbols and terms shall apply for the purpose of this test method.
4.1 Apparatus. A simplified circuit is shown in figure one where the current source (I) and switch (SW1)
combination shall apply the peak value of current pulse IRSM for the pulse duration of 20 s as required (see Figure
2A). The rise and fall times of the pulse shall be less than 10 percent of the pulse duration and the IRSM will not vary
during the impulse by more than 10%. The DUT shall also be monitored during the pulse using an oscilloscope to
verify the instantaneous v(BR) voltage. The monitored v(BR) will typically increase during the 20 s impulse from
heating effects as shown in Figure 2B. The v(BR) may also simply be monitored at the end of the pulse duration by a
gated switch (SW2) or other automated methods to determine its highest value and also ensure the v(BR) has not
collapsed below the rated minimum breakdown voltage VBR of the rectifier from excessive heat. Although a simplified
circuit is depicted, there are other more automated test equipment (ATE) methods that can also accomplish this such
as the Frothingham RE20A, B, or C as well as a FEC200 tester with a separate dual monitor oscilloscope for both
current and voltage.
4.2 Procedure. No current is applied to the DUT prior to the starting time (to) of the test. At to, SW1 applies IRSM
for 20 s after which SW1 causes the current to cease flowing in the DUT.
a. Apply a specified rectangular impulse level of current IRSM as shown in Figure 2A. The rectangular impulse
may decline slightly to optimize a constant peak reverse power level (PRSM) since the v(BR) will increase due to
heating effects and positive temperature coefficient during the 20 s impulse. This impulse shall control the
effective power to within 10% during the impulse duration. The DUT is also monitored for the response in
reverse voltage v(BR).
b. If testing to a specific peak reverse power (PRSM) requirement, the current (IRSM) will be increased to the level
where the calculated PRSM level meets or exceeds the requirement. The PRSM value is determined with the
average IRSM and v(BR) values where PRSM = IRSM x v(BR) . These average values typically occur at 10 s or half
way into the 20 s impulse.
METHOD 4065
1 of 3
NOTE: The test may need to be repeated to achieve the desired power level after the initial v(BR) is
determined. If repeated, the time between pulses shall be sufficient to permit the DUT temperature to return to
its original value.
c. If it is noted that the v(BR) collapses below the minimum rated breakdown voltage V(BR) during the testing in
4.2.1 and 4.2.2, this is considered a failure to the applied PRSM level.
d. Electrical measurements shall also be performed after each reverse power test to ensure the DUT has not
permanently degraded. As a minimum, this shall include verification the reverse current (IR) does not exceed
its maximum specified value at the rated voltage VR for the DUT. Although a device can collapse in 4.2.3
without permanently degrading, such a collapse will still be considered a failure to this Peak Reverse Power
test method.
e. If characterizing the DUT for peak reverse power, steps 4.2.1 through 4.2.4 shall be repeated at higher levels
until failure occurs. For this purpose, 10% progressive increases in IRSM are recommended. The time between
pulses shall be sufficient to permit the DUT temperature to return to its original value before it is repeated.
4.3 Test parameters to be specified and recorded. The following conditions shall be specified:
c. The v(BR) monitored during the 20 s impulse. A collapse below minimum rated V(BR) is a failure.
METHOD 4065
2
IRSM
V
I Monitor
DUT
RECTIFIER
METHOD 4065
3
METHOD 4066.4
SURGE CURRENT
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to subject the device under test (DUT) to high current stress conditions to
determine the ability of the device chip and contacts to withstand current surges. This is intended to verify a
nonrepetitive surge rating where there is sufficient time between surges to permit the device temperature to return to
its original value.
2. Applicability. This test describes three different conditions: A, B, and C. Surge current is applied in the
forward direction to signal diodes and rectifier diodes, and in the reverse direction to voltage regulator (zener)
diodes. Condition A uses half sinusoidal forward current surges, at low duty factor, applied to either a baseline ac or
dc current. Condition B uses rectangular current pulse(s) and is intended primarily for zener diodes or where
otherwise applicable. When used with zener diodes, this method utilizes a monitoring circuit to sense possible
voltage collapse during the current pulse. Condition C is intended for high current devices that can be applied to
either condition A or condition B.
3. Symbols and Definitions. The following symbols and terminology shall apply for the purpose of this test
method.
i. n: Number of pulses.
METHOD 4066.4
1 of 5
4.2 Procedure. The continuously applied electrical conditions shall be specified and applied to the device under
the specified conditions. Unless otherwise specified, the specified number of current pulses (n) shall be
superimposed on the continuously applied electrical conditions at the specified duty factor in accordance with figure
4066-1 (condition A1) for rectifiers, or figure 4066-2, (condition A2) for signal and switching diodes, zeners or
bridges, as applicable. The surge pulses shall be half-sine waveform and of specified duration (tp). The duty factor
shall be chosen so that the junction temperature is not changed significantly. The continuously-applied electrical
conditions, shall be satisfied if the time of applied current permits the junction temperature rise to be within 10
percent of its final equilibrium value above ambient before each surge or if an additional temperature or surge
current is applied beyond that specified to provide equivalent junction temperature heating during surge without the
continuous applied electrical conditions. Also reference condition C for the external heating method.
NOTE: Surge current pulse (tp) does not require synchronization with applied baseline ac.
FIGURE 4066-1. Surge pulse applied to continuous halfwave conditions (condition A1).
METHOD 4066.4
2
4.3 Test conditions to be specified and recorded. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable
specification sheet:
a. Average forward current (IO); or dc forward current (IF) for rectifiers; or zener current (IZ) for zener diodes; as
applicable.
d. Duty factor of pulses, normally less than .1 percent, or the period normally between 8 and 60 seconds.
e. Peak value of forward surge current pulse, IFSM for rectifiers, or IZSM for zeners.
5.1 Apparatus. The current source (I) and switch (SW1) combination shown on figure 4066-3 shall be able to
apply the peak value of current pulse IFSMor IZ for the pulse duration (tp) as required, and shall be able to handle
any number of pulses (n) and duty cycle as required in the applicable specification sheet. The rise and fall times of
the pulse shall be less than 10 percent of the pulse duration. For zeners, the dashed lines replace the solid
connecting lines (vertical) to the DUT. The monitor shall sense VZSM voltage at the end of the pulse duration before
the pulse is removed via gated switch (SW2) to ensure zener voltage has not collapsed below rated VZ(min)
5.2 Procedure. As shown on figure 4066-4, no current is applied to the DUT prior to the starting time (to) of the
test. For zeners, a maximum of 5 percent of rated IZ may be used for baseline current flow. At to, SW1 causes the
application of IFSM or IZSM for time period tp, after which SW1 causes the current to cease flowing in the DUT. For
multiple pulse requirements, SW1 again causes current flow in the DUT after being off for a time necessary to meet
the duty factor requirements; this process is repeated for n times as specified. The duty factor and pulse width (tp)
shall be chosen to ensure that the DUT average junction temperature is not changed significantly. For zeners, VZ
monitoring is mandatory. NOTE: If an excessive duty factor is applied where average junction temperature rises
with each successive surge, the surge is considered repetitive and must be derated.
5.3 Test conditions to be specified and recorded. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable
specification sheet:
a. The peak surge current (IFSM) for rectifiers or IZSM for zeners. For rectifiers, this is normally the equivalent rms
current as the rated half sine condition. Zeners normally are specified with square wave value of surge current.
e. VZSM to be monitored during IZSM for zeners. A collapse below VZ (min) is a failure.
METHOD 4066.4
3
5.4 Alternative to measurements after test. For rectifiers, there is a minor modification to the test that offers the
advantage of immediately determining if the DUT survived the test. This consists of monitoring the forward voltage
(VFSM) during tp to determine if device degradation, open-circuit or short-circuit conditions occur. A recorded value
of VFSM can be compared to minimum and maximum values in the applicable specification sheet to determine if the
device survived the test. NOTE: Zener monitoring is mandatory; it is not an alternative. Collapse below VZ(min) is a
failure.
METHOD 4066.4
4
6. Condition C (external heating). The worst case test condition for surge current is for device junction
temperature at the rated maximum allowable junction temperature. Test condition A approximates this condition by
applying forward current to dissipate power in the DUT. The product of this power dissipation and the device thermal
resistance produces a temperature rise of the junction over the case temperature at which the surge test is
performed. This represents what actually happens to a device in use. However, the actual junction temperature
during the surge current test is only at the rated allowable maximum for those individual devices which have both the
worst case maximum forward voltage drop and the worst case maximum thermal resistance. Only a very small
percentage of actual devices will truly be worst case. The vast majority of devices will be tested at junction
temperatures below rated maximum.
Test condition C avoids this short fall in junction temperature and truly represents worst case operation by externally
heating the DUT to the specified rated maximum operating junction temperature of the DUT. Consequently, there is
no applied heating current prior to, or concurrent with, the surge current. Once the DUT has stabilized at thermal
equilibrium at the specified maximum operating junction temperature, the desired surge current pulses are applied at
the specified duty factor. The time between current surges shall be long enough to permit the device junction
temperature to return to its original thermal equilibrium.
6.1 Test conditions to be specified and recorded. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable
specification sheet:
7. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Average forward current, IO, or dc forward current, IF for rectifiers, or dc zener current IZ; as applicable for
baseline current.
g. Peak value of forward surge current for rectifiers or IZSM for zeners.
h. Maximum reverse voltage (non-repetitive), VRSM. (VRSM = 0 for conditions A2 and C.)
METHOD 4066.4
5
METHOD 4071.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the temperature coefficient of breakdown voltage under
specified conditions.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus used to measure the temperature coefficient of breakdown voltage shall be capable
of demonstrating device conformance to the minimum requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The temperature coefficient of breakdown voltage is the percent of the voltage change from the
breakdown voltage obtained at the specified reference temperature to the breakdown voltage obtained at the
specified test temperatures.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Temperatures.
b. Test current.
METHOD 4071.1
1 of 1
METHOD 4076.1
SATURATION CURRENT
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the saturation current under the specified conditions.
3. Procedure. The supply voltage is adjusted until the specified reverse voltage across the diode is achieved.
The saturation current is then read from the current meter. Unless otherwise specified, the reverse voltage for
measurement of saturation current shall be approximately 80 percent of the nominal breakdown voltage for voltage
regulator diodes and approximately 80 percent of the minimum breakdown voltage for rectifiers.
4. Summary. The test voltage (see 3.) shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4076.1
1 of 1
METHOD 4081.3
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the thermal resistance of lead, case, or surface mounted
diodes under the specified conditions.
1.1 Definitions. The following symbols shall apply for the purpose of this test method:
d. PC: Magnitude of power in watts applied to diode during measuring and calibration.
e. PH: Magnitude of heating power in watts applied to diode causing temperature difference TJ - TR.
g. TCC: Case temperature in degrees Celsius, measured at the reference point prior to application of
heating power PH.
h. TCH: Case temperature in degrees Celsius, measured at the reference point after the junction has been
heated by PH.
j. TLC: Lead temperature in degrees Celsius, measured at the reference point prior to application of
heating power PH.
k. TLH: Lead temperature in degrees Celsius, measured at the reference point after the junction has been
heated by PH.
m. tMD: Measurement delay time in microseconds. This is the delay between when PH is removed and
when the temperature sensitive parameter (TSP) is recorded to determine junction temperature
rise (see 3.a).
p. VMC: Value of temperature-sensitive parameter in millivolts, measured at IM and specific value of TMC.
METHOD 4081.3
1 of 6
q. VMH: Value of temperature-sensitive parameter in millivolts, measured at IM, and corresponding to the
temperature of the junction heated by PH.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus required for this test shall include the following as applicable to the specified test
procedure.
a. Thermocouple material may be copper-constantan (type T), chromal-alumel (type K) or equivalent, for the
temperature range -180C to +370C. The wire size shall be no larger than AWG size 30. The junction of
the thermocouple shall be welded to form a bead rather than soldered or twisted (exception is the type K
open junction method where the junction is formed upon each wires contact with the measured metallic
surface). The accuracy of the thermocouple and associated measuring system shall be 1.0C.
b. Controlled temperature chamber or heat sink capable of maintaining the specified reference point
temperature to within 1.0C of the preset (measured) value. For various package mounting configuration
examples, see Figure 4081-2 for axial-leaded, Figure 4081-3 and Figure 4081-4 for case mounted, Figure
4081-5 for power SMD mounting, and Figure 4081-6 for small signal LCC surface mounted.
c. Suitable electrical equipment as required to provide controlled levels of conditioning power and to make the
specified measurements. The instrument used to electrically measure the temperature-sensitive parameter
shall be capable of resolving a voltage change of 1.0 mV. An appropriate sample-and-hold unit or a
cathode ray oscilloscope shall be used for this purpose.
3. Procedure. In measuring thermal resistance, the forward voltage is used as the temperature-sensitive
parameter (TSP) to indicate the junction temperature (see figure 4081-2 for mounting arrangement).
a. Power application test. The power application test shall be performed in two parts. For both portions of the
test, the reference point temperature shall be held constant at the specified value. The value of the
temperature-sensitive parameter VMC shall be measured with a measuring current (IM) that will produce
negligible internal heating. The diode under test shall then be operated with heating power (PH)
intermittently applied at a greater than or equal to 0.98 duty factor. The temperature-sensitive parameter V
MH shall be measured during the interval between heating pulses with constant measuring current (IM)
applied. The delay time between the heating power turning off and the VMH being read is the measurement
delay time tMD.
If it is not possible to maintain the reference point temperature constant during the power application test
[such as lead (TLH) or case (TCH) temperature], the difference in the reference temperature at which VMH
and VMC are measured shall be recorded. For an axial-leaded device example, the lead temperature
difference (TLH - TLC) divided by the average heating power (DPH) shall be subtracted from the calculated
thermal resistance to correct for this error. It is not possible, due to the presence of electrical transients in
the voltage waveform, to measure the TSP at the instant that the heating current is removed.
For a particular device type or when the appropriate performance specification does not specify tMD, the
shortest tMD time after removal of heating current before the TSP is measured shall be found by performing
the test at various power levels and noting the shortest time where the measured value of thermal
resistance is essentially independent of power dissipated. Power levels of 25 percent above and below the
power corresponding to the specified heating current are recommended for determining this delay time.
The junction-to-lead thermal resistance shall therefore be calculated from the value of the
temperature-sensitive parameter VMH as measured at the previously determined delay time. This will vary
depending on package design and materials, particularly for metal package encapsulations for high power
devices involving magnetic materials requiring longer delay time due to switching transients. The heating
power (PH) shall be chosen such that the calculated junction-to-reference point temperature difference as
measured at VMH is greater than or equal to +50C.
METHOD 4081.3
2
c. Calculation of thermal resistance. Examples shown are for thermal resistance junction to lead (RJL) for
both axial-lead designs and surface mount configurations with very short terminations. Also thermal
resistance junction to case (RJC) and thermal resistance junction to end cap (RJEC) for surface mount
MELF packages DO-213AA and DO-213AB JEDEC outlines are described.
3.1.1 Axial lead diodes. For axial-lead diodes, the reference point for calculations of the junction-to-lead thermal
resistance (RJL) shall be at a point on the lead 0.375 inch (9.52 mm) from the body of the diode under test. For
thermally unsymmetrical devices, the specified lead temperature shall be the average of the two lead temperatures
measured with both leads terminated thermally in the same manner. For surface mount diode packages with short-
lead terminations such as J-bends or gull wings, the reference point for calculation of thermal resistance shall be at or
near the mounting plain of the terminal configuration of the diode under test. The following equation is used to
calculate the junction-to-lead thermal resistance:
V MC
-1
TJ - TR VMH - V MC T LH - T LC
RJR = = Calibration - Optional
DP H DP H T MC DP H
where VMC is the value of the temperature-sensitive parameter for TMC equal to TLC and TLH - TLC corrects for
variations in the lead temperature during the Power Application Test.
3.1.2 Case mounted power diodes. For case-mounted power diodes such as TO-3, stud mounts (DO-4 thru DO-
9), and high power surface mount devices (SMD) with a metal bottom for heat transfer, the reference point for
calculation of the junction-to-case thermal resistance (RJC) shall be at or near the mounting plain and in the heat-
flow path to the heat sink for a diode under test. This requires drilling a hole in the component case to insert a
thermocouple for accurate measurement as shown in Figure 4081-3, or providing an access-hole in the heat sink to
locate the TR reference point on the case in the heat-flow path as shown in Figures 4081-4 and 4081-5B. The TLH
and TLC in 3.1.1 then become TCH and TCC respectively to calculate junction-to-case thermal resistance. The TCH -
TCC corrects for possible variations in the case temperature during the Power Application Test. For some of the
surface mount designs, an accurate thermal resistance measurement may require soldering the device under test to
a heat sink. In these examples, soldering methods should not exceed rated soldering temperatures for the package.
METHOD 4081.3
3
3.1.3 Low power surface mount. For lower power surface mount packages such as MELFs or LCC devices, this
reference point may instead be identified as the end cap temperature (TEC) or the solder pad (TSP) as shown in Figure
4081-6. The TLH and TLC in the above equation would then become TECH and TECC or TTPH and TTPC respectively to
calculate the junction-to-endcap thermal resistance.
Measurements of TR and TMC for all examples are made by means of a thermocouple attached to the referenced
point. The power dissipation in the DUT is calculated from the equation PH = IHVF. If the power dissipation during
measuring and calibration is not negligible, then PC should be subtracted from PH when calculating the thermal
resistance. The PC is calculated from the equation PC = IMVM. The specimen junction-temperature shall be
considered stabilized when doubling the time between the initial application of power and the taking of the reading
causes no error in the indicated results beyond the required accuracy of measurement. The time for stabilization will
typically be 20 to 60 seconds depending on package configuration and size.
The circuit is controlled by a clock pulse with a pulse width less than or equal to 300 s and repetition rate less than
or equal to 66.7 Hz. When the voltage level of the clock pulse is zero, the transistor Q1 is off and the forward current
through the DUT is the sum of the constant heating current and the constant measuring current. Biasing transistor
Q1 on, shunts the heating current to ground and effectively reverse biases the diode D1. The sample-and-hold unit
(S and H) (or cathode ray oscilloscope) is triggered when the heating current is removed and is used to monitor the
forward voltage of the diode under test. During calibration, switch S1 is open.
METHOD 4081.3
4
Diode electrical
contact for anode (or cathode)
Not Case
Temp
Not Case
Tj TO-3 or TO-66 or Equivalent Temp Not Case
Temp Not Case
Temp
Copper Heatsink
(Thermal Grease is Optional)
Tc (Case Temp)
via Thermocou- Leads
ple access hole
METHOD 4081.3
5
Not Case
Temp Tj
Not Case
Temp
Power SMD Package
Tj
METHOD 4081.3
6
4100 Series
1. Measurement of conversion loss, output-noise ratio, and other microwave parameters shall be conducted with
the device fitted in the holder. All fixed adjustments of the holder shall be made at a laboratory designated by the
Government. In the test equipment, the impedance presented to the mixer by the local oscillator (and the signal
generator, if used) shall be the characteristic impedance of the transmission line between the local oscillator and
mixer (the maximum VSWR, looking toward the local oscillator, shall be 1.05 at the signal and image frequencies).
2. For qualification inspection of reversible UHF and microwave devices, the radio-frequency measurements,
excluding the post-environmental-test end points and high-temperature-life (nonoperating) end points, shall be made,
first, with the adapter on one end of the device, and then repeated with the adapter at the opposite end of the device;
for the environmental and life tests, fifty percent of each sample shall be tested with the adapter on one end of the
device and the remaining half of the sample shall be tested with the adapter on the opposite end of the device.
End-point measurements shall be made without moving the adapter. This procedure shall be repeated on at least
one lot every 6 months.
3. For quality conformance inspection of reversible UHF and microwave devices, the electrical measurements,
including the post-environmental-test end points, may be made with the adapter on either end of the device.
METHOD 4101.3
CONVERSION LOSS
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the ratio of the available RF input power to the available IF
output power under specified conditions.
2. Test circuits. The following test circuits shall apply. (See figures 4101-1 through 4101-4.)
2.1 Overall noise figure method. See method 4121 for output noise ratio and method 4126 for overall noise
figure.
3. Procedure.
3.1 Test condition A (incremental). The equipment for this test is shown in figures 4101-1 and 4101-2. An
expression for conversion loss is shown in the equation:
I
4 Gb
L=
Gb V
I Gb + I
2 2
2 Po
P V
L = Conversion loss.
I = Incremental change in current.
P = Incremental change in power.
1
Gb =
Zm
I
= IF conductance of diode under test.
V
1
IF conductance =
Z if
The diode is loaded by the resistance RL + r2 that is adjusted to the specified load impedance (Zm). ZmRL is the dc
load resistance; load resistance shall be specified. The current supplied by the battery balances out the diode
current at some standard power level P, and makes the current in the microammeter zero. With a change in power
P, I can be measured directly. With the injection of a small voltage (few millivolts) V at Po power level, I can be
directly measured. (This impedance can be measured by other means. See IF impedance, method 4116, Zif.)
These values can be inserted in the equation and the conversion loss can be calculated for the conditions of test.
3.2 Test condition B (heterodyne). A signal generator feeds signal power to the mixer that converts the power to
the IF by beating with the local oscillator. The converted power is measured with an IF power meter. Both the
available signal power from the generator at A, shown on figure 4101-3, and the increase in the available IF power at
B shall be measured when the noise is applied, their ratio being the conversion loss.
METHOD 4101.3
2
3.3 Test condition C (modulation). The equipment for this test is shown in figure 4101-4. Conversion loss is given
by the equation:
4n m2 p
L = 2 2
(1 + n ) Gb x E B
m = modulation coefficient.
P = available power.
Gb = 1
Zm
A high impedance voltmeter can be used to measure 20 log EB directly. The voltmeter is set on the 0.01 volt full
scale, and the modulation voltage set so that the term 10 log(m2p/Gp) is equal to 20.0 on the dB scale. To obtain
this setting, the modulation is adjusted, so the voltmeter reading on the decibel scale is 20.0 minus the value of
conversion loss for the standard diodes. This corresponds to a value of m of 1.58 percent for P = 1.0 mW and Gp =
.0025 . The conversion loss for unknown diodes is then 20.0 minus the reading of the output meter in decibels.
3.4 Test condition D (overall-noise-figure). The overall-noise-figure method derives the conversion loss by known
properties of the apparatus and is expressed by the equation:
_
Fo = L(N + Fi -1)
Where:
L = conversion loss of the mixer.
METHOD 4101.3
3
4. Detail drawings. The following drawings, as applicable, are used in the performance of this test: JAN 103, 107,
124, 174, 233, 234, and 266; DESC D64100, C64169, D65019, C65042, D65084, C65101, C65017, and C66053.
5. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4101.3
4
METHOD 4102
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the low frequency capacitance of a semiconductor diode. The
capacitance is the small signal capacitance of the diode as measured in a defined test holder under specified bias
conditions.
2. Test circuit. A bridge or meter should be used for the measurement. The specified signal level at the diode
terminals, as measured with a suitable voltmeter, should be low enough so that a doubling of the level produces no
measurable change in either the capacitance or shunt conductance of the diode. The test holder should be
constructed so that the fringing capacitance is not altered by inserting the diode.
3. Procedure. The measurement shall be made at a specified frequency and bias voltage. A low frequency
capacitance bridge or meter is used to measure the capacitance of the diode at a specified bias point. The effective
case capacitance is measured in the same test holder as the diode. Junction capacitance may be determined by
subtracting the effective case capacitance from the total measured capacitance.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4102
1 of 1
METHOD 4106
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the detector power efficiency.
3. Procedure. Resistor RL and capacitor C1 comprise the load circuit and shall be as specified. Resistor R1, in
conjunction with RL, provides the specified bias current for the DUT. Capacitor C2 provides RF bypass for the
output current meter IDC. The frequency and amplitude of the ac signal and the output impedance of the generator
shall be as specified. The change in output current Idc is measured when the ac signal is applied.
4( I DC ) RL RG
2
Then : Detector power efficiency= 2
x 100 percent.
V rms
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4106
1 of 1
METHOD 4111.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the figure of merit of a semiconductor detector diode. The
figure of merit is as follows:
RV
M=
RV + R a
2. Test circuit. The following test circuit shall apply. (See figure 4111-1.)
METHOD 4111.1
1 of 3
3. Procedure. The equipment for this test is shown on figure 4111-1. A continuous wave (cw) radio frequency (rf)
signal is applied to the detector whose output short circuit current is measured and the short circuit current sensitivity
() is computed. The figure of merit (M) is then determined from:
RV
M=
RV + R a
Approximate method:
1 + 1/2
M = 2 RX
1+
Where:
= i/P
and
Where:
1
RX =
( R1 + R a )( R 2 + Ra )
and
and where:
1 + 1/2
is the correction factor
1+
and:
+
= RV Ra - 1
RX
When the extreme values of the video resistance for a given diode type are known, it is possible to relate figure of
merit to rectified current if other conditions are satisfied.
For all normal ranges of video resistance, the correction factor is very close to unity and an approximation:
M = 2 RX
therefore, the figure of merit (M) may be determined by measuring the rectified current under proper conditions.
METHOD 4111.1
2
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4111.1
3
METHOD 4116.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the real part of the impedance at the IF output terminals of the
mixer diode under test.
2. Test circuit. The following test circuits shall apply. (See figures 4116-1 and 4116-2)
3. Procedure. Since the IF resistance is the slope of the mixer diode's I-V characteristic under the specified test
conditions, the requirement of any measuring technique is to measure the slope without affecting the operating
characteristics of the DUT. At all times, the device holder RF input port should see a broadband match (minimum of
two times IF frequency). The IF test frequency, local oscillator frequency, and power shall be specified.
3.1 Test condition A (ac). With equipment arranged as shown on figure 4116-1, a constant current ac generator
is coupled to the diode under test. The dc and ac diode loads are arranged as specified and the ac current is set at
a level low enough so that halving the level produces a change in the measured IF impedance of the diode of less
than 5 percent. The IF impedance is calculated as follows:
V
Z if =
I
Where:
Zif = diode IF impedance.
V = measured ac voltage.
I = ac current.
METHOD 4116.1
1 of 2
3.2 Test condition B (impedance bridge). The equipment is arranged as shown on figure 4116-2. The impedance
bridge signal level is adjusted to a low level using the same criterion in 3.1. The diode IF impedance is determined
from the impedance bridge.
4. Detail drawings. The following drawings, as applicable, are used in the performance of this test: JAN 107, 124,
174, 233, 234, and 266; DESC D64100, C64169, D65019, C65042, D65084, C65101, C65017, and C66053.
5. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet.
g. DC bias, if applicable.
METHOD 4116.1
2
METHOD 4121.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the output noise ratio of a mixer diode. Since the output noise
ratio is a measure of the excess noise generated by a mixer diode in its normal operating condition, the
measurement should be in the appropriate standard holder.
2. Test circuit. The following test circuits shall apply. (See figures 4121-1 and 4121-2.)
3. Procedure.
3.1 Test condition A (direct measurement). In this method, the output noise ratio is determined by establishing a
reference output reading on the output meter shown on figure 4121-1, with the diode operating under specified test
conditions, then a resistor equal to the specified IF impedance of the diode is substituted for the diode. The resistor
becomes noisy when the current passes from a noise diode (temperature limited diode). Value for noise resistor
shall be specified. The current is adjusted to provide the reference output reading and the noise ratio is computed
from the relationship:
e IR
N = + 1 = 20 IR + 1
2 kT o
Where:
METHOD 4121.2
1 of 2
3.2 Test condition B (computational). In this method, the output noise ratio is determined from the equation:
_
Fo _
N = L - Fi + 1
Where:
_
Fo = overall receiver noise figure.
_
Fo and Fi are determined as described in method 4126; L is determined as described in method 4101.
3.3 Test condition C (Y-factor). In this method, the output noise ratio is determined by establishing a reference
output reading on the output meter shown on figure 4121-2, with the diode operating under specified test conditions,
then a resistor equal to the specified IF impedance of the diode is substituted for the diode by a switch in the Y-factor
circuit. The output noise ratio is then determined from:
_
N = Fi (Y -1) + 1
where:
Y = Noc/Nor
Noc is the reference output reading on the output meter with the diode connected to the circuit.
Nor is the output reading with the resistor connected to the circuit.
_
Fi is determined as described in method 4126.
4. Detail drawings. The following drawings, as applicable, are used in the performance of this test: JAN 103, 107,
124, 174, 233, 234, and 266; DESC D64100, C64169, D65019, C65042, D65084, C65101, C65017 and C66053.
5. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
f. DC bias, if applicable.
METHOD 4121.2
2
METHOD 4126.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the overall noise figure of a mixer diode and the noise figure of
the associated IF amplifier. Since the noise figure of a network is defined as follows:
FO =
(available input signal power ) / (available input noise power )
(available output signal power ) / (available output noisepower )
it is necessary to measure the noise power that is actually delivered to the output termination. This measurement is
divided by a similar measure of the output noise that would have been obtained if the network were noiseless and
only transmitted the thermal noise of the input termination. In making noise figure measurements, the standard
practice is to provide matched impedance at the signal and image frequencies and make suitable corrections (by
calculations or appropriate filtering) to obtain an equivalent single-side-band noise figure. The noise figure obtained
without a signal band-pass filter to eliminate the image-frequency band is commonly referred to as the
double-side-band noise figure and is approximately 3 dB smaller than the single-side-band noise figure, depending
on the exact transmission characteristics of the particular mixer. If a single-side-band noise figure is being
measured directly, it is necessary to terminate the image resistively in a matched load (isolator) to avoid errors due
to second-order effects. These second-order effects may arise from reflection of the image back into the mixer to
give a larger or smaller than true value of noise figure, depending on the phase of the reflected image.
3. Procedure. When using test conditions A and C, the local oscillator frequency and power, IF, and excess noise
ratio of noise source shall be specified.
3.1 Test condition A (dispersed-signal-source). A signal source with available power dispersed uniformly over the
pass band of the network, and calibrated in terms of available power per unit bandwidth, is used to determine that
portion of the output noise power that results from the input termination noise. Suitable dispersed-signal generators
are thermionic-noise diodes, gas discharge tubes, resistors of known temperature, or an oscillator whose frequency
is swept through the band at a uniform rate. Single-side-band noise figure is obtained by adding 3 dB to the
measured (double-side-band) noise figure. At all times, the device holder rf input should see a broadband match
(minimum of two times IF frequency).
METHOD 4126.2
1 of 3
3.2 Test condition B (computation). Assuming the IF amplifier noise figure is known, the overall noise figure can
be computed as follows:
(
F O = L N + F i 1 )
Where:
3.3 Test condition C (IF amplifier noise figure). Resistors in the particular diode type cases are required,
constructed so that when they are inserted in the standard holder (mixer), the output susceptance of the holder is
approximately the same as when the diodes are inserted. A sufficient number of resistors should be used so that the
output conductance of the standard holder may be finely varied over the specified maximum range for the diode
type. A common junction (defining the mixer IF port) joins the holder to the IF amplifier and the noise
(temperature-limited diode). The entire circuit, including the noise diode power supply and the current meters, shall
be well shielded or filtered to avoid IF feedback. With the resistor in the holder, the IF amplifier gain is adjusted to
give an output meter reference reading near full scale. Precise IF attenuation is then inserted, and the noise diode
turned on and adjusted in emission to restore the output meter reference reading. The average (dc) noise anode
current is then noted and used to compute the IF average noise figure from:
eIR T
F i = 1+ - a
2 kT o (A - 1) T o
20IR T a
F i = 1+ -
A-1 To
Where:
METHOD 4126.2
2
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
d. IF (see 3.).
METHOD 4126.2
3
METHOD 4131.1
VIDEO RESISTANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the video resistance of the device. Video resistance shall be
defined as the reciprocal of the slope of the current versus voltage characteristic curve at the operating point.
2. Test circuits. The test circuits shall be as follows. (See figures 4131-1 through 4131-4.)
METHOD 4131.1
1 of 2
3. Procedure. The measurement shall be made with the diode operating under the specified test conditions. The
applied signal used and the instrument impedance shall be such that doubling or halving their value does not change
the video impedance by more than 5 percent.
3.1 Test condition A (constant voltage). Test equipment used is shown on figure 4131-1. A small specified ac
signal is applied to the diode from a constant voltage source. Current is measured with a low resistance
microammeter. RV equals e/i.
3.2 Test condition B (constant current). Test equipment used is shown on figure 4131-2. A small specified ac
current is passed through the diode from a constant current source. The voltage is measured across the device with
a high impedance millivoltmeter. RV equals e/i.
3.3 Test condition C (pulsed rf). Test equipment used is shown on figure 4131-3. A pulsed rf signal, as specified,
is fed to the diode whose output is fed into the vertical amplifier of an oscilloscope. A resistor is placed in parallel
with the device and varied to lower the rectified pulse to half its value. RV equals the resistance required to halve
the pulse. Bandwidth of vertical amplifier should be a minimum of two times the reciprocal of the pulse width.
3.4 Test condition D (continuous wave (cw) radio frequency (rf)). Test equipment used is shown on figure 4131-4.
A specified cw rf signal is applied to the detector whose output open circuit rectified voltage is measured on a high
impedance dc millivoltmeter. A resistor is placed in parallel with the device and varied to lower this voltage to half its
initial value. RV equals the resistance required to halve the voltage.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be included in the applicable specification sheet:
e. DC bias, if applicable.
METHOD 4131.1
2
METHOD 4136.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the SWR of the device at the local oscillator terminals. SWR
shall be defined as the ratio of the maximum voltage (or current) to the minimum voltage (or current) along the
transmission line between the device and the local oscillator terminals. The measurement shall be made with the
diode operating under normal operating conditions.
2. Test circuits. The test circuits shall be as follows: (See figures 4136-1, and 4136-2)
METHOD 4136.1
1 of 2
3. Procedure.
3.1 Test condition A (slotted line). A slotted line is inserted between the device in its holder and the local
oscillator, and the probe is moved to determine the maximum and minimum voltage or current points. To limit probe
errors and keep the power in the slotted line section at a level high enough to operate the standing wave indicator
and low enough to maintain small signal conditions, the normal signal generator and indicator connections to the
slotted line as shown on figure 4136-1 should be interchanged. That is, the signal generator should be connected to
the moving probe and the detector indicator should be connected to the slotted line section opposite the test diode
holder.
a. The power source may be used without modulation if a sensitive galvanometer is substituted for the
standing wave indicator (tuned voltmeter).
e. Move the probe in the slotted line until the standing wave indicator shows at voltage maximum (or current).
Adjust the range switch and gain until an SWR of 1 is indicated.
3.2 Test condition B (reflectometer). A calibrated reflectometer is inserted between the device in its holder and
the local oscillator; then the SWR is read, see figure 4136-2.
NOTE: When this technique is used, the filter detector combination shall have an SWR <1.2.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be as specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4136.1
2
METHOD 4141.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the capabilities of the device to withstand repetitive pulses.
3. Procedure. This method shall be acceptable to determine the device capability to withstand repetitive pulses.
The general method of measuring device capability to withstand burnout by repetitive pulsing is to apply the
specified number of pulses to the DUT and then measure the specified electrical parameters. The pulse polarity
shall be such as to cause the current to flow in the forward direction. When the maximum change in the specified
electrical parameter is exceeded, the device shall have failed to meet this burnout test. The pulse generator source
impedance shall be specified. While the device to be tested is not in the circuit, adjust the pulse generator output for
the specified open-circuit pulse voltage, pulse width, and pulse repetition rate. Then insert the device in the circuit.
The device shall be left in the circuit for a minimum specified time.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4141.1
1 of 1
METHOD 4146.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the capability of the device to withstand a single pulse.
2. Test circuit. The test circuit shall be as follows: (See figure 4146-1)
3. Procedure. The device shall be subjected to a pulse from the coaxial line shown on figure 4146-1. The line
shall be charged with the specified voltage, and the contact shall be made by dropping the center conductor
vertically from a height of 2 .05 inches (50.8 1.27 mm) above the contact position. The electrical and mechanical
connection shall be such as to have a minimum effect on the free fall of the conductor. The polarity of the inner
conductor with respect to the outer conductor shall be such as to cause the device current to flow in the forward
direction or as specified.
4. Detail drawings. DSCC drawings B66054 and C66058 as applicable, are used to perform this test.
5. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Polarity, if required.
METHOD 4146.1
1 of 1
METHOD 4151
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the rectified microwave diode current under conditions for
conversion loss.
2. Apparatus. The apparatus used for this test should be capable of demonstrating device conformance to the
minimum requirements of the applicable specification sheet.
3. Procedure. The rectified microwave diode current shall be measured under the conditions for conversion loss.
The test shall be conducted in the mixer shown on the specified drawing under the conditions specified for the
conversion loss test.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4151
1 of 1
4200 Series
METHOD 4201.2
HOLDING CURRENT
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the holding current of the device under the specified
conditions.
3. Procedure. The anode supply voltage is set at its specified value with resistance R1 adjusted so that the initial
forward current, IF1, which flows when the device is triggered, equals the value specified. Switch SW is then
momentarily closed to trigger the device and reopened. The initial current is quickly reduced to the specified test
current IF2. Then the specified gate bias condition is applied. The resistance R1 is then gradually increased, until
the device turns off. The value of forward current immediately prior to turn-off is the holding current.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
A: Bias (specify VGG, gate-to-cathode polarity, equivalent bias circuit resistance, Re).
C: Short-circuit.
D: Open-circuit.
e. Gate trigger source voltage, open circuit magnitude and pulse width.
METHOD 4201.2
1 of 1
METHOD 4206.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the forward blocking current under the specified conditions,
using the dc method or the ac method, as applicable.
2. DC method.
2.1 Test circuit. R1 shall be chosen to limit the current flow in the event the device switches to the on state. (See
figure 4206-1)
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
FIGURE 4206-1. Test circuit for forward blocking current (dc method).
2.2 Procedure. The supply voltage is adjusted to obtain the specified value of forward voltage across the device
with the specified gate bias condition applied (see figure 4206-1). The forward blocking current is then read from the
current meter.
2.3 Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. DC method.
b. Test voltage.
A: Bias (specify VGG, gate-to-cathode polarity, equivalent bias circuit resistance, Re).
C: Short-circuit.
D: Open-circuit.
METHOD 4206.1
1 of 2
3. AC method.
3.1 Test circuit. R1 shall be chosen to limit the current flow in the event the device switches to the on state. D1
and D2 are diodes capable of blocking the peak value of the ac voltage supply. Peak reading techniques shall be
used to measure the necessary parameters. (See figure 4206-2)
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
FIGURE 4206-2. Test circuit for forward blocking current (ac method).
3.2 Procedure. The peak supply voltage is adjusted to obtain the specified peak forward voltage across the
device with the specified gate bias condition applied (see figure 4206-2). The peak forward blocking current is then
read from the current indicator. Voltage should be gradually applied to prevent turn-on of the device due to
excessive dv/dt.
3.3 Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. AC method.
c. Frequency.
A: Bias (specify VGG, gate-to-cathode polarity, equivalent bias circuit resistance, Re).
C: Short-circuit.
D: Open-circuit.
METHOD 4206.1
2
METHOD 4211.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the reverse blocking current under the specified conditions,
using the dc method or the ac method, as applicable.
2. DC method.
2.1 Test circuit. R1 shall be chosen to limit the current flow in the event of the device goes into reverse
breakdown.
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the readings shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
FIGURE 4211-1. Test circuit for reverse blocking current (dc method).
2.2 Procedure. The supply voltage is adjusted to obtain the specified value of reverse voltage across the device
with the specified gate bias condition applied (see figure 4211-1). The reverse blocking current is then read from the
current meter.
2.3 Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. DC method.
b. Test voltage.
A: Bias (specify VGG, gate-to-cathode polarity, equivalent bias circuit resistance, Re).
C: Short-circuit.
D: Open-circuit.
METHOD 4211.1
1 of 2
3. AC method.
3.1 Test circuit. R1 shall be chosen to limit the current flow in the event the device goes into reverse breakdown.
D1 and D2 are diodes capable of blocking the peak value of the ac voltage supply. Peak reading techniques shall
be used to measure the necessary parameters. (See figure 4211-2)
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
FIGURE 4211-2. Test circuit for reverse blocking current (ac method).
3.2 Procedure. The peak supply voltage is adjusted to obtain the specified peak reverse voltage across the
device with the specified gate bias condition applied (see figure 4211-2). The peak reverse blocking current is then
read from the current indicator.
3.3 Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. AC method.
c. Frequency.
A: Bias (specify VGG, gate-to-cathode polarity, equivalent bias circuit resistance, Re).
C: Short-circuit.
D: Open-circuit.
METHOD 4211.1
2
METHOD 4216
PULSE RESPONSE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the pulse response of the device under the specified
conditions.
3. Procedure. The pulse response of the device shall be measured in the circuit on figure 4216-1. R2 is adjusted
to permit the specified value of forward current to flow in the device being measured when it is the on-state. C, R1,
and the secured controlled rectifier, D2, are used to switch off the device being measured. C shall be large enough
to ensure that the device will turn off. R1 limits the recurrent peak reverse current to below the rated value. The
pulse repetition rate should be low enough to ensure that the anode-cathode voltage of the device being measured
reaches the value of forward working voltage specified for the measurement.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Test current.
d. Repetition rate.
METHOD 4216
1 of 1
METHOD 4219
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the dc reverse gate current of the device at a specified reverse
gate voltage.
2. Test circuit. R is chosen to limit the current in the event the reverse gate breakdown voltage is exceeded. (See
figure 4219-1)
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
3. Procedure. Set the specified reverse gate voltage and read the reverse gate current.
4. Summary. The dc reverse gate voltage shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4219
1 of 1
METHOD 4221.1
GATE-TRIGGER VOLTAGE
OR
GATE-TRIGGER CURRENT
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the dc gate-trigger voltage or dc gate-trigger current.
2. Test circuit. Care should be taken to minimize noise or spurious signals in the trigger circuit. (See figure 4221-
1)
NOTE: The ammeter shall present essentially a short-circuit to the terminals between which the current is
being measured or the voltmeter readings shall be corrected for the drop across the ammeter.
3. Procedure. The anode voltage, V2, is set to the specified value. The gate voltage, V1, is slowly increased from
zero. The gate-trigger current or gate-trigger voltage is read as the highest value achieved prior to a sharp decrease
in anode voltage.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Equivalent gate circuit resistance, Re (the resistance looking into the gate circuit from the DUT
gate-to-cathode terminals).
METHOD 4221.1
1 of 1
METHOD 4223
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the time between initiation (10 percentage point) of gate pulse
and the time at which the output pulse is at 90 percent of its final value.
2. Test circuit. The anode circuit loop L/R shall be >0.01 and <0.1 of the forward current rise time, tr. The
open-circuit, gate-voltage rise time shall be <0.1 of the delay time, td of the DUT. VAA must have stabilized at its
peak value prior to triggering the gate pulse generator. (See figures 423-1, and 4223-2)
METHOD 4223
1 of 2
3. Procedure. Set the anode voltage pulse source and the gate conditions as specified. Adjust RL to achieve the
specified iFM. The turn-on time is then read from the dual trace scope as shown on figure 4223-2.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4223
2
METHOD 4224
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the turn-off time of the device under the specified conditions.
NOTE: The simplified circuit diagram on figure 4224-2 illustrates the operating principles of a circuit used to
generate the waveforms illustrated on figure 4224-1. For purposes of clarity, the circuit diagram utilizes
current generators, ideal switches, and no provision for repetitive test cycles.
METHOD 4224
1 of 2
3. Test description. The test is performed by first causing the thyristor under test to conduct the specified on-state
current at the specified thermal condition. This current is conducted for the specified time (a period long enough to
establish carrier equilibrium). Next, the current is reversed through the thyristor at the specified rate (di/dt) by means
of an externally applied reverse blocking voltage. The reverse current recovers stored charge from the anode and
cathode junctions of the thyristor, allowing the thyristor to support the specified reverse blocking voltage. A further
waiting time is required for the collector junction charges to recombine before the thyristor is capable of blocking
forward voltage. Since this recombination cannot be observed directly, the test is performed by applying an off-state
voltage at the specified rate of rise (dv/dt) after successively shorter waiting times until it is observed that the
thyristor is unable to support the off-state voltage (without switching to the on-state). The thyristor current and
voltage waveforms are illustrated on figure 4224-1.
4. Procedure.
a. S2 and S4 are closed simultaneously causing the thyristor under test to switch to the on-state and conduct
the specified current iFM; S4 is then opened to disconnect the gate trigger supply R1 and V3.
b. After the specified on-state current duration, S3 is closed to cause current reversal. The rate of current
change (di/dt) is determined by L1 and R2. Diode D2 prevents a commutation voltage transient when the
thyristor under test begins to recover its reverse blocking capability. Diode D1 shall have a longer reverse
recovery time than the thyristor under test so that the reverse voltage appears across the thyristor under
test.
c. The application of off-state voltage is initiated by closing S1. The current I1 completes the reverse
recovery of D1 and is then diverted to C1. C1 charges linearly with time at a rate equal to I1/C1 producing
the required dv/dt illustrated on figure 4224-1. This voltage rises to a value equal to V1 which is adjusted
to the specified off-state voltage.
5. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
c. Commutation rate (di/dt) (the slope of the line from 50 percent of + peak to 50 percent of - peak).
f. Operating temperature.
i. Off-state voltage.
METHOD 4224
2
METHOD 4225
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the gate-controlled turn-off time of the device under the
specified conditions.
2. Test circuit. The circuit used for the test is shown on figure 4225-1. The thyristor is turned on by the gate pulse
delivered by the on pulse generator. On-state current is determined by the off-state supply voltage and the load
resistor RL.
After a predetermined time, a specified gate turn-off current is supplied to the gate terminal by the off pulse
generator.
The storage time and fall time may be observed by means of an oscilloscope connected across the current sensing
resistor.
Storage time is the time interval between the 10 percent point on the leading edge of the gate current off-pulse and
the 90 percent point on the trailing edge on-state current waveform. Fall time is the time interval between the 90
percent and 10 percent points on the trailing edge of the on-state current waveform. Turn-off time is the sum of
storage time and fall time. Typical waveforms are shown on figure 4225-2.
METHOD 4225
1 of 2
3. Test description. A turn-off thyristor can be switched from the on-state to the off-state with a control signal of
appropriate polarity to the gate terminal. The delay and fall times of anode current during the turn-off of the thyristor
are affected by gate trigger pulse variations and anode circuit conditions. This method establishes a test circuit and
provision for measuring of critical test conditions.
4. Procedure.
a. Gate current or gate source voltage rise time shall not exceed 10 percent of the storage time
interval.
b. Duty cycle should be chosen considering heating effects of switching power losses. Sufficient
anode current off time of at least 10 times the off pulse width shall be allowed to ensure that the
DUT remains turned off after the turn-off pulse ends.
c. The inductance of the anode circuit should be minimized to prevent anode voltage overshoot on
turn-off.
5. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Off-state voltage.
b. On-state current.
g. Gate turn-off current (peak); or gate source voltage and gate source resistance.
h. RL.
j. Gate off pulse width, amplitude, and delay time from gate on pulse.
METHOD 4225
2
METHOD 4226.1
FORWARD ON VOLTAGE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the voltage in the forward direction across the device under
the specified conditions.
3. Procedure. The supply voltage is adjusted to obtain the specified value of forward current through the device
with SW 1 and SW 2 closed. SW 2 shall be opened, and then the forward voltage is read when the forward current
equals the specified value. When the specified test current is greater than 0.20 ampere, the voltage measuring
probes shall be connected to the device inside of the current carrying connections. For axial lead devices, the
voltage measuring probe(s) shall contact the lead(s) at a point .375 .062 inch (9.52 1.57 mm) from the case. For
all other devices, the voltage shall be measured across the normal electrical connection points.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Duty cycle and pulse width when pulse techniques are to be used (see above note).
METHOD 4226.1
1 of 1
METHOD 4231.2
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine if the device is capable of blocking a forward voltage which is
increasing at an exponential rate starting from zero without switching on in the forward direction.
2. Test circuit. R2 is chosen to discharge C between cycles when SW is opened and R L is a protective resistor
chosen to limit the maximum device current if the device turns on during the voltage rise. Switch SW should have a
closure time (including bounce) of not more than 0.1 T and be closed a minimum of 5 T. (See figure 4231-1, and
4231-2)
METHOD 4231.2
1 of 2
3. Procedure. The voltage VAA shall be adjusted to the specified value with switch SW open (see figure 4231-1).
The resistor, R1, shall be adjusted to achieve the specified rate of voltage rise, dv/dt, across the DUT with the
specified gate bias condition applied. The rate of voltage rise is defined as shown on figure 4231-2. Close SW and
monitor VFB on the response detector. A device shall be considered a failure if VFB does not rise to, and maintain,
a value greater than the minimum specified forward-blocking voltage during the first 5 T of each voltage pulse after
switch SW is closed.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
d. Repetition rate.
e. Duration of test.
g. Test temperature.
A: Bias (specify VGG, gate-to-cathode polarity, equivalent bias circuit resistance, Re).
C: Short-circuit.
D: Open-circuit.
METHOD 4231.2
2
4300 Series
METHOD 4301
JUNCTION CAPACITANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the small signal junction capacitance of the tunnel diode
under the specified conditions.
3. Procedure. Since junction capacitance is a function of bias, it is necessary to specify the forward bias at which
C1 is to be determined. The true value of junction capacitance (at a given bias) is obtained by subtracting the
capacitance of the diode package from the observed capacitance. Isolation of the dc power supply from the complex
impedance bridge (see figure 4301-1) is affected by the R1, L1, C2 branch of the circuit.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Values for the circuit elements R1, C1, C2, L1, and R2.
b. Signal frequency.
c. Bias level.
METHOD 4301
1 of 1
METHOD 4306.1
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the static characteristics (Vp, Vv, Ip, Iv, VFP, and Rd) of the
tunnel diode under the specified conditions:
FIGURE 4306-1. Test circuit for static characteristics of tunnel diodes (dc method).
FIGURE 4306-2. Test circuit for static characteristics of tunnel diodes (ac method).
METHOD 4306.1
1 of 2
3. Procedure.
a. For the measurement of the static characteristics by point-by-point method, the circuit of figure
4306-1 shall be used. Resistor, R2, is small to obtain low voltage and low impedance. Resistor
R3 is a current measuring resistor. Resistor R1 is much larger than R2. To obtain a plot in the
negative resistance region R1 shall be less than the magnitude of the incremental negative
resistance of the tunnel diode.
b. For the measurement of the static forward characteristics of the device by oscillographic means,
the circuit shown on figure 4306-2 shall be used. The magnitude of R1 shall be less than the
magnitude of the incremental negative resistance of the tunnel diode. Resistance R3 is a current
measuring resistor and should be chosen to give a suitable CRO deflection. Since the negative
resistance is represented by the inverse slope of the IV curve between the peak and valley
voltage points, its approximate value can be estimated from the curve. For a more accurate
method for the measurement of the negative resistance see method 4321.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4306.1
2
METHOD 4316
SERIES INDUCTANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the value of the small signal series inductance under the
specified conditions.
3. Procedure. The device shall be reverse biased for the series inductance measurement. A sufficiently high
frequency signal shall be employed to emphasize the inductive reactance, but not high enough to allow any
capacitive parasitics to short-circuit the device, thus precluding the determination of LS. A recommended frequency
device is one approximately 25 percent of the self-resonant frequency of the DUT. Isolation of the dc power supply
from the complex impedance is accomplished by the choke, L1, in conjunction with C1, R1, C2, branch (see figure
4316-1).
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
b. Signal frequency.
METHOD 4316
1 of 1
METHOD 4321
NEGATIVE RESISTANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the magnitude of the negative resistance under the specified
conditions.
FIGURE 4321-1. Test circuit for negative resistance, short-circuit stable method.
FIGURE 4321-2. Test circuit for negative resistance, open-circuit stable method.
3. Procedure. The magnitude of R1 shall be less than the incremental negative resistance of the tunnel diode.
Resistor R3 is a current limiting resistor and should be chosen to give a suitable CRO deflection. Diode D1 is a half
wave rectifier.
3.1 Short-circuit stable method. Shunt the tunnel diode, with a variable resistor R4 (see figure 4321-1). Vary R4
until the slope of the negative resistance appears horizontal (zero slope) on the curve trace. The shunting resistance
is now equal to the magnitude of the negative resistance, Rd. (R4 = Rd.)
3.1.1 Open-circuit stable method. In series with the tunnel diode connect a variable resistor R4 (see figure
4321-2). Vary R4 until the slope in the negative resistance appears vertical (infinite slope) on the curve trace. The
series resistance R4 is now equal to the magnitude of the negative resistance (R4 = Rd).
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4321
1 of 1
METHOD 4326
SERIES RESISTANCE
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the series resistance of the device under the specified
conditions.
3. Procedure. The measurement of the series resistance shall be accomplished for the device when biased in the
reverse direction (see figure 4326-1). The linearity of the ohmic region shall be assured and the value of the power
dissipation shall be such that no error is introduced as a result of excessive diode heating. The slope of the linear
portion of the reverse biased tunnel diode shall be sealed within a specified accuracy in the direct determination of
the series resistance of the device.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
METHOD 4326
1 of 1
METHOD 4331
SWITCHING TIME
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to measure the switching time of the tunnel diode under the specified
conditions.
3. Procedure. A block diagram of the measuring circuit is shown in figure 4331-1. To perform the switching time
measurement, it is necessary that the maximum generator current be greater than the diode peak current and that
changes in generator current during measurement time be negligible compared to IP. The oscilloscope input probe
impedance shall be such that the current absorbed by the probe is at all times less than the peak current of the
diode.
4. Summary. The following conditions shall be specified in the applicable specification sheet:
a. Generator current.
b. Repetition rate.
METHOD 4331
1 of 1
5000 Class
METHOD 5001.2
The content of this test method has been transferred to MIL-PRF-19500, Appendix D.
METHOD 5001.2
1 of 1
METHOD 5002
1. Purpose. The purpose of this test is to determine the quality of an oxide layer as indicated by capacitance
voltage measurements of a metal-oxide semiconductor capacitor. The overall shape and position of the initial C/V
curve can be interpreted in terms of the charge density, and to a certain extent charge type, at the
oxide-semiconductor interface. By applying an appropriate bias while heating the sample to a moderate temperature
(e.g., +200C), the mobile ion contamination level of the sample oxide may be determined.
2. Apparatus/materials. Capacitance-voltage plotting system complete with heated/cooled stage and probe
(Princeton Applied Research Model 410, MSI Electronics Model 868 or equivalent). A C/V plotter may be
constructed from the following components (see figure 5002-1 for equipment setup).
f. Probe in micromanipulator.
3. Suggested procedure.
a. The sample is typically a silicon wafer on which has been grown the oxide to be measured, or wafers with
known clean oxide which is exposed to a furnace at temperature to measure the furnace cleanliness. An
array of metal dots on the surface of the oxide provides the top electrodes of the metal-oxide
semiconductor capacitors. The metal may either have been deposited through a shadow mask to form the
dots, or it may have been deposited uniformly over the oxide surface and then etched into the dot pattern
by photolithographic techniques. Cleanliness of the metal deposition is paramount. Contamination
introduced during metal deposition is as catastrophic to the oxide quality as is contamination introduced
during oxide growth. The metal shall have been annealed, except in cases where the method is being
used to investigate the effectiveness of annealing.
NOTE: This test also may be used to determine metal deposition system cleanliness when used with oxide
samples known to be contamination free.
b. The minimum dot size should be such that the capacitance of the MOS capacitor is > 20 pF.
c. The oxide thickness is typically 1,100 . Reduced sensitivity results from oxide thickness greater than
2,000 .
d. The backside of the sample shall have the oxide removed to expose the silicon. The backside may have
metal, such as aluminum or gold deposited on it.
METHOD 5002
1 of 5
a. Place the wafer on the heated/cooled stage. Use vacuum to hold the wafer firmly in place.
b. Zero the capacitance meter as necessary, place the paper in X-Y plotter and set up the voltage source for
the desired range.
c. Select the capacitor dot to be measured and carefully lower the probe to contact it.
d. Lower the pen on the X-Y plotter and sweep the voltage over the desired range so a C/V trace for an
N-type substrate or P-type substrate, similar to that shown on figure 5002-2, is obtained.
NOTE: If an anomalous trace is obtained, it may be because the capacitor is leaking or shorted. In this case,
another dot should be selected.
b. With the probe making good contact, apply a positive bias of 1010 v/cm to the capacitor dot. (For a 1,000
thick oxide, this is a 10-volt bias.) A different voltage is acceptable, if the manufacturer can demonstrate
effectiveness.
c. Heat the sample to +300C 5C with the bias applied. Hold at this temperature for 3 minutes (different
times may be acceptable if the manufacturer can demonstrate effectiveness).
d. With the bias still applied, cool the sample to room temperature (the heating and cooling cycle can be
automatically programmed if the Thermochuck system is used).
NOTE: Be certain that the probe does not lose contact with the capacitor dot during the heat/cool cycle. If it
should, the test is invalid and should be repeated.
e. Lower the pen on the X-Y plotter and sweep the voltage over the range necessary to obtain a C/V trace
similar to that obtained in 3.2.d. The trace may be displaced on the voltage scale from the original trace,
but should be parallel to the original trace. Label this trace as the (+) trace.
f. Apply a negative bias of the same magnitude selected in 3.3.b to the capacitor dot and repeat steps 3.3.c
and 3.3.d.
g. Lower the pen on the X-Y plotter and sweep the voltage over the range again. This trace may be displaced
from the two previous traces and should be labeled as the (-) trace.
h. An automatic system that performs equivalent functions may be substituted for steps 3.3.b and 3.3.g.
3.4 Interpretation.
a. Determine the VFB (voltage difference between original trace and bias trace, taken at 90 percent
capacitance level (see figure 5002-2)).
b. Determine the mobile ion contamination concentration (For mobile ion density versus voltage shift (VFB)
see figure 5002-3), No, as follows:
0 K ox V FB
No =
q t ox
METHOD 5002
2
Example:
VFB (measured from C/V curves similar to those shown on figure 5002-2) = 1.4 V.
So, the mobile ion contamination level is 3.1 x 1011 mobile ions per square centimeter in this
example.
c. Considerably more information concerning the oxide and the semiconductor substrate can be obtained
from interpretation of the C/V trace.
4. Summary.
4.1 Calibration. The voltage scale calibration of the X-Y plotter should be checked against the DVM during set up.
Other instruments should be calibrated at regular intervals.
4.2 Accuracy. The voltage accuracy obtainable is 0.1 volt and the VFB accuracy obtainable is 0.2 volt. The
practical lower limit of detectability of mobile ion contamination is on the order of 2 x 1011/cm2.
Reference:
Whelon, N.V., "Graphical Relation Between Surface Parameters of Silicon, to be Used in Connections with MOS
Capacitance Measurements", Phillips Res. Apt., 620-630 (1965).
METHOD 5002
3
METHOD 5002
4
METHOD 5002
5
METHOD 5010
1. Purpose. This test method provides a classification system for, and means of measuring, air cleanliness. It is
intended to be used in conjunction with the environmental controls specified in MIL-PRF-19500.
2. Air cleanliness classes. There are three classes defined by this method. Classifications are based upon
particle count with a maximum allowable number of particles per unit volume 0.5 micron or larger, or 5.0 microns and
larger. Particle counts are to be taken during normal work activity periods and at a location which will yield the
particle count of the air as it approaches the work location.
2.1 Class 100 (3.5). Particle counts must not exceed a total of 100 particles per cubic foot (3.5 particles per liter)
of a size of 0.5 micron or larger.
2.2 Class 1,000 (35). Particle counts must not exceed a total of 1,000 particles per cubic foot (35 particles per
liter) of a size of 0.5 micron or larger of 7 particles per cubic foot (0.25 particles per liter) of a size 5.0 microns and
larger.
2.3 Class 10,000 (350). Particle counts must not exceed a total of 10,000 particles per cubic foot (350 particles
per liter) of a size of 0.5 micron or larger or 65 particles per cubic foot (2.3 particles per liter) of a size of 5.0 microns
and larger.
2.4 Class 100,000 (3,500). Particle counts must not exceed a total of 100,000 particles per cubic foot (3,500
particles per liter) of a size of 0.5 micron or larger or 700 particles per cubic foot (25 particles per liter) of a size of 5.0
microns and larger.
3. Particle counting methods. For proof of meeting the requirements of the class of clean room or clean work
station, one or more of the following particle counting methods shall be employed on the site of use.
3.1 Particle sizes 0.5 micron and larger. The equipment to be used must employ the light scattering
measurement principle as specified in ASTM F50.
3.2 Particle sizes 5.0 micron and larger. A microscopic counting of particles collected on a membrane filter,
through which a sample of the air to be measured has been drawn, may be used in lieu of the light scattering
measurement principle as specified in ASTM F25 and SAE-ARP-743.
4. Monitoring techniques. Appropriate equipment shall be selected and monitoring routines established to
measure the air cleanliness levels under normal use conditions.
5. Items to be specified. The general specification shall specify the following information:
b. The frequency of test. Unless otherwise specified, this frequency shall be, at a minimum, once per month
per working shift.
METHOD 5010
1 of 1
Review activities:
Army - AR, MI, SM
Navy - AS, CG, MC, SH
Air Force - 19, 99
NOTE: The activities listed above were interested in this document as of the date of this document. Since
organizations and responsibilities can change, you should verify the currency of the information above using the
ASSIST online database at http://assist.daps.dla.mil.
14